Yamaha RX-A800 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Receptores AV
Tipo
El manual del propietario
Owner’s Manual
AV Receiver English for U.S.A.
En 2
CONTENTS
INTRODUCTION
Features and capabilities ...................................................4
Using the TV OSD to operate the unit .............................5
View or modify content for the current input source
<Content window> ...........................................................5
Configuring settings for this unit
<ON SCREEN menu>......................................................5
Adjust settings for each input source
<OPTION menu> ............................................................. 6
About this manual............................................................. 7
Supplied accessories......................................................... 7
Part names and functions..................................................8
Front panel........................................................................8
Rear panel.........................................................................9
Front panel display .........................................................10
Remote control ...............................................................11
On-screen display ...........................................................12
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers ........................................................ 13
Speaker channels and functions...................................... 13
Speaker layout ................................................................ 14
Connecting speakers and subwoofer .............................. 17
Connecting external components....................................21
Cable plugs and jacks .....................................................21
Connecting a TV monitor...............................................22
Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices............25
Connecting game consoles .............................................29
Connecting a multi-format player
or an external decoder .................................................... 29
Connecting an external amplifier ................................... 30
Connecting a SCENE link
playback-compatible device ...........................................30
Using the Trigger function to link
external component power..............................................31
Connecting audio/video recording devices.....................31
Connecting the FM/AM antennas .................................. 32
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically
(YPAO).............................................................................. 33
PLAYBACK
Basic playback procedure ............................................... 41
Adjusting high/low-frequency sound (Tone control) ..... 42
Changing input settings with a single key
(SCENE function) ............................................................ 43
Registering input sources/sound program/
HDMI OUT .................................................................... 43
Enjoying the desired sound field effect.......................... 43
Selecting sound programs and sound decoders.............. 43
Sound programs.............................................................. 47
Using the TV display to control this unit....................... 49
Basic operations via the TV screen display ................... 49
Configuring settings specific to
an individual input source (OPTION menu)................. 51
OPTION menu display and setup................................... 51
OPTION menu ............................................................... 52
Confirming and operating input sources
from the Content window ............................................... 55
Displaying the Content window on the TV screen......... 55
Switching the display between the Now Playing view
and the Content browse view ......................................... 55
FM/AM tuning ................................................................. 56
Selecting a frequency for reception (Normal tuning)..... 56
Confirming and operating the FM/AM tuner
from the Content window............................................... 58
Using HD Radio™ features............................................. 60
Selecting HD Radio™ audio programs.......................... 60
Using the iTunes Tagging............................................... 61
Displaying the HD Radio™ information ....................... 61
Confirming and operating the HD Radio™ tuner
from the Content window............................................... 62
Listening to Satellite Radio............................................. 64
Connecting the SiriusConnect™ tuner .......................... 64
Activating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ subscription ........ 65
SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ operations............................. 65
Registering and recalling the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
channels.......................................................................... 66
Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ information .. 68
Confirming and operating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
from the Content window .............................................. 69
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™........... 71
Connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone ........... 71
Controlling an iPod™/iPhone™ .................................... 71
Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu screen
(Menu browse control)................................................... 72
Operating basic playback functions
via the remote control (Simple remote control) ............. 74
Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with wireless connection ...... 74
Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components ...... 76
Connecting a Yamaha Bluetooth
wireless audio receiver................................................... 76
Pairing Bluetooth™ components ................................... 76
Using Bluetooth™ components ..................................... 77
En 3
SETUP
Configuring input sources (Input menu) .......................78
Configuring input sources ..............................................78
Input menu......................................................................79
Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu) ...............82
Editing a scene................................................................ 82
SCENE menu..................................................................83
Setting sound program parameters
(Sound Program menu) ...................................................85
Editing sound programs..................................................85
CINEMA DSP parameters ............................................. 86
Parameters usable in certain sound programs ................88
Parameters usable in surround decoder .......................... 89
Setting various functions (Setup menu) .........................90
Operating the Setup menu ..............................................90
Setup menu .....................................................................91
Manages settings for speakers ........................................91
Setting the audio output function of this unit .................95
Setting this unit’s video output function.........................96
Setting HDMI functions .................................................97
Setting this unit’s multi-zone function ......................... 100
Making the receiver easier to use ................................. 100
Language ......................................................................103
Confirming information of this unit
(Information menu) .......................................................104
Selecting information ...................................................104
Controlling other components
with the remote control.................................................. 105
Keys connecting external components .........................105
Default remote control code settings............................106
Registering remote control codes
for external component operations ............................... 106
Resetting all remote control codes ............................... 107
Extended functionality that can be configured
as needed (Advanced Setup menu)...............................108
Displaying/Setting the Advanced Setup menu .............108
Setting the impedance of speakers ..............................108
Avoiding crossing remote control signals
when using multiple Yamaha receivers ........................ 109
Resetting the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
parental lock code......................................................... 109
Changing TV format .................................................... 110
Removing HDMI video output up-scaling limits......... 110
Initializing various settings for this unit....................... 110
Using the HDMI Control function ............................... 111
Using multi-zone configuration .................................... 115
Connecting Zone2 ........................................................ 115
Controlling Zone2 ........................................................ 116
Using the party mode ................................................... 116
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting ............................................................. 117
General ......................................................................... 117
HDMI™ ....................................................................... 119
Tuner (FM/AM) ........................................................... 120
HD Radio™ Reception ................................................ 120
iTunes Tagging ............................................................. 121
SIRIUS Satellite Radio™............................................. 121
iPod™/iPhone™ .......................................................... 122
Bluetooth™ .................................................................. 123
Remote control ............................................................. 123
Glossary .......................................................................... 124
Audio information ........................................................ 124
Sound program information ......................................... 125
Video information ........................................................ 125
Video conversion .......................................................... 126
Information on HDMI™............................................... 127
About trademarks.......................................................... 127
Specifications.................................................................. 128
Index ............................................................................... 130
En 4
INTRODUCTION
Built-in high-quality, high-power 7-channel amplifier
6 HDMI input jacks (5 + 1 VIDEO AUX) supporting Audio Return Channel and 3D
video signal
2 HDMI output jacks
Selecting the HDMI OUT jack ................................................................................................................41
1-button input/sound program switching (SCENE function)................................43
Speaker connections for 2- to 7.1-channel configurations
Speaker impedance configuration............................................................................................................18
Speaker channels and functions ...............................................................................................................13
Speaker layout..........................................................................................................................................14
Speaker cable connection.........................................................................................................................17
Subwoofer cable connection ....................................................................................................................20
High quality playback using bi-amplification connections .....................................................................18
Automatic settings for speaker acoustic parameters
(YPAO - Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) ......................................33
External component connection (max. 16 inputs) and playback
External component connection...............................................................................................................21
Protective cover for front panel jacks ........................................................................................................7
Configuring the settings specific for each input source <OPTION menu>.............................................51
Playback from external components........................................................................................................41
Playback from an iPod/iPhone with wired connection............................................................................72
Playback from an iPod/iPhone with wireless connection........................................................................74
Playback from a Bluetooth component (Bluetooth and components sold separately) ............................76
FM/AM tuner
HD Radio digital broadcast listening.......................................................................................................60
Receiving an FM/AM broadcast..............................................................................................................56
Presetting stations ....................................................................................................................................56
Simple preset tuning ................................................................................................................................56
Changing Audio mode (Auto/Mono).......................................................................................................58
SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
Receiving a channel .................................................................................................................................65
Presetting channels ..................................................................................................................................66
Displaying information ............................................................................................................................68
Multi-channel, multi-format playback
Sound field effect selection......................................................................................................................43
Playback without sound field effects .......................................................................................................44
Stereo playback........................................................................................................................................44
Compressed-music playback ...................................................................................................................46
Front panel information display/on-screen display (OSD) on the TV screen
Switching information on the front panel display ...................................................................................10
Operating this unit using the on-screen display.......................................................................................12
Volume adjustment functions
Easy listening at low volumes < Adaptive DRC> ...................................................................................53
Adjusting volume between input sources <Volume Trim> .....................................................................54
Remote control operation
External component operation with this unit’s remote control..............................................................105
Playing back the audio source in another room
Using the internal amplifier for playback ................................................................................................18
Using the external amplifier for playback .............................................................................................115
Configuring the settings for another room.............................................................................................115
Controlling the external component in another room............................................................................116
Other features
Standby mode after a specific amount of time <Sleep timer>.................................................................11
Charging the iPod/iPhone when this unit is in standby mode <iPod Standby Charge> ..........................80
Tagging songs for subsequent preview and purchase on iTunes <iTunes Tagging> ...............................61
Features and capabilities
Most of this unit’s functions can be operated by following instructions displayed on the TV screen.
Refer to “Using the TV OSD to operate the unit” on the following pages for information on
functions that can be controlled using the on-screen display.
INTRODUCTION
En 5
This unit features a sophisticated on-screen display (OSD) for the TV screen. The OSD is designed to enable visual guidance that simplifies operations. The OSD mainly displays the ON SCREEN and
OPTION menus, as well as the Content window that displays the content of current input sources.
Select an input source, SCENE and sound program
Select an input source ..............................................................................................................................49
Select a SCENE .......................................................................................................................................50
Select a sound program............................................................................................................................50
View or modify content for the current input source <Content
window>
Operate the AM/FM tuner or SIRIUS Satellite Radio
Display a list of preset stations/channels for selection ......................................................................59, 70
Display information on the station/channel currently received .........................................................58, 69
Perform operations such as searching for and registering stations/channels using the Utility
<Utility>.............................................................................................................................................58, 69
Display the list of iPod music sources
Display the list of iPod music sources for selection ................................................................................72
Perform operations such as play, stop and pause using the TV screen <Menu browse control> ............72
Perform basic playback functions such as play, stop and pause
via the remote control <Simple remote control> .....................................................................................74
Configuring settings for this unit <ON SCREEN menu>
Display the ON SCREEN menu on the TV screen..................................................................................49
Select and configure an input source
Select an input source ..............................................................................................................................49
Play the audio/video signal from the selected input source.....................................................................41
Change the input source name <Rename/Icon Select> ...........................................................................79
Select the audio input jack separately from the video input jack <Audio In>.........................................80
Specify a format for digital audio signals <Decoder Mode>...................................................................80
Enhance the sound of compressed audio <Enhancer>.............................................................................80
Output a video signal input from another input source
while playing a multi-channel audio signal <Video Out> .......................................................................81
Charge the iPod/iPhone when this unit is in standby mode <Standby Charge>......................................80
Select and customize a SCENE
Select a SCENE .......................................................................................................................................50
Register or clear settings for a selected SCENE <Save>, <Reset> .........................................................83
Turn on a Yamaha BD/DVD player or CD player connected to this unit automatically
when a SCENE is selected <SCENE IR>................................................................................................83
Select and adjust a sound program (sound program)
Select a sound program............................................................................................................................50
Adjust sound program parameters ...........................................................................................................85
Display settings information for this unit
Display audio signal information <Audio Signal>................................................................................104
Display video signal information <Video Signal> ................................................................................104
Display HDMI signal information <HDMI - Monitor Info.>................................................................104
Adjust acoustic parameters to match your speakers and listening environment
Specify speaker acoustic parameters automatically
(Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer - YPAO).......................................................................33
Set up this unit’s speaker configuration simply <Power Amp Assign> ..................................................91
Specify settings for each speaker <Configuration>.................................................................................92
Control volume control for each speaker <Level> ..................................................................................93
Apply speaker distance settings <Distance> ...........................................................................................93
Control equalizer sound quality <Parametric EQ>..................................................................................94
Adjust test tone speaker <Test Tone> ......................................................................................................94
Adjust audio signals output from this unit
Correct lag between audio and video signals <Lipsync> ........................................................................95
Select a dynamic range adjustment method <Dynamic Range> .............................................................95
Specify the maximum volume <Max Volume>.......................................................................................95
Specify the initial volume <Initial Volume>............................................................................................96
Adjust DSP effect and volume level <Adaptive DSP Level>..................................................................96
Using the TV OSD to operate the unit
Continues to the
next page
INTRODUCTION
Using the TV OSD to operate the unit
En 6
Adjust video signals output from this unit
Convert analog video signal to another type of signal <Analog to Analog Conversion> .......................96
Specify the resolution and aspect ratio of analog video signal converted to HDMI or specify
upscaling resolution for 480i/576i- or 480p/576p-HDMI output signal <Processing>...........................97
HDMI settings
Assign the audio input source for the TV <TV Audio Input>.................................................................98
Listen to TV audio with HDMI cable connection <ARC (Audio Return Channel)>..............................98
Transmit HDMI audio/video to the TV during standby mode <Standby Through> ...............................99
Change the output destination of HDMI input audio signals <Audio Output>.......................................99
Enable listening in multiple rooms (multi-zone function)
Adjust Zone2 volume <Zone2 Set>.......................................................................................................100
Specify other functions for this unit
Enter standby mode automatically when no operations are performed <Auto Power Down>..............101
Adjust the brightness of the front panel display <Dimmer> .................................................................101
Change the wall paper displayed on the TV screen <Wall Paper>........................................................101
Specify the function of the TRIGGER OUT jack for controlling external components
<Trigger Output> ...................................................................................................................................102
Prohibit changes to settings <Memory Guard> .....................................................................................103
Select a language
Change the language displayed on the TV screen <Language>............................................................103
Adjust settings for each input source <OPTION menu>
Display the OPTION menu on the TV screen .........................................................................................51
Select the 5.1-channel signal playback method <Extended Surround>...................................................53
Adjust bass and treble levels <Tone Control> .........................................................................................52
Enable low-volume background music <Adaptive DRC>.......................................................................53
Adjust the volume of input sources <Volume Trim>...............................................................................54
Adjust the vertical position of dialogues <Dialogue Lift> ......................................................................53
En 7
INTRODUCTION
Using the TV OSD to operate the unit
About this manual
Supplied accessories
Check that you received all of the following parts.
Remote control
Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) x 2
YPAO microphone
AM loop antenna
Indoor FM antenna
VIDEO AUX input cover
Some features are not available in certain regions.
This manual is created prior to production. Design and
specifications are subject to change in part as a result of
improvements, etc. In case of differences between the manual and
product, the product has priority.
dHDMI1” (example) indicates the name of the parts on the
remote control. Refer to the “Remote control” (
p. 11) for the
information about each position of the parts.
J
1 indicates that the reference is in the footnote. Refer to the
corresponding numbers on the bottom of the page.
indicates the page describing the related information.
Click on the “ ” at the bottom of the page to display the
corresponding page in “Part names and functions.
Front panel
Rear panel
Front panel display
Remote control
Attaching the VIDEO AUX input cover (supplied)
To protect against dust, attach the supplied VIDEO AUX input
cover to the VIDEO AUX jacks when you do not use the jacks.
To remove the cover, push the left section of it.
Attach the cover
PUSH
Remove the cover
Installing batteries in the remote control
When inserting batteries in the remote control, remove the
battery compartment cover from the reverse side of the remote
control, and insert two AAA batteries into the battery
compartment so that they match with the polarity markings (+
and -).
Replace the batteries with new ones if the remote control can
only be operated within a narrow range.
NOTE
If there are remote control codes for external components
registered to the remote control, removing the batteries for more
than 2 minutes, or leaving exhausted batteries in the remote
control, may clear the remote control codes. If this should occur,
replace the batteries with new ones, and set the remote control
codes.
a
c
b
Battery compartment
cover
Battery compartment
INTRODUCTION
En 8
Front panel
a MAIN ZONE A (Power)
Switches this unit between on and standby mode.
b HDMI Through/iPod Charge indicator
Lights up in any of the following cases while the unit is in standby
mode.
When the Standby Through function is enabled and audio/video from
an external component connected with HDMI is output to a TV
during standby mode (
p. 99).
When an iPod/iPhone, which is placed in the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone, is charging while the unit is in standby mode (
p. 74).
This indicator also lights up when the Yamaha iPod wireless receiver
is connected to this unit (
p. 74).
c ZONE2
Switches to enable/disable the audio output to Zone2 (
p. 116).
d ZONE CONTROL
Switches to Zone2 operation mode. This unit, or its remote control,
can be used to select input sources or adjust volume for an external
amplifier in another room or the built-in amplifier for speakers in
another room (
p. 116).
e INFO
Changes the information displayed on the front panel display
(
p. 10).
f MEMORY
Registers FM/AM stations as preset stations (
p. 56) or SIRIUS
channels as preset channels (
p. 66). J1
g PRESET j / i
Selects an FM/AM preset station (
p. 58) or a SIRIUS preset channel
(
p. 67). J1
h FM/AM (CATEGORY l / h)
Sets the FM/AM tuner band to FM or AM (
p. 56). J1
Selects a channel category for a SIRIUS (
p. 66).
i Front panel display
Displays information on this unit (
p. 10).
j TUNING/CH jj / ii
Changes FM/AM tuner frequencies (
p. 56) or SIRIUS Satellite
Radio channels (
p. 66). J1
k PURE DIRECT
Switches this unit to Pure Direct mode (
p. 46).
l INPUT selector
Selects an input source from which to playback. Rotate this selector to
cycle through the input sources in order.
m PHONES jack
For plugging headphones in. Sound effects applied during playback
can also be heard through the headphones.
n YPAO MIC jack
Connect the supplied YPAO microphone and adjust the speaker balance
automatically (
p. 33).
o TONE CONTROL
Adjusts high-frequency/low-frequency output of speakers/headphones
(
p. 42).
p SCENE
Switches the input source, the sound program, and the HDMI OUT
with a single button (
p. 43, p. 82). When this unit is in standby
mode, press this key to switch on.
q PROGRAM selector
Selects a sound program (
p. 43). Rotate this selector to cycle
through sound programs.
r STRAIGHT
Changes a sound program to straight decoding mode (
p. 44).
s VIDEO AUX jacks
For connecting game consoles to this unit temporarily (
p. 29).
Attach the supplied VIDEO AUX input cover when not using this jack
(
p. 7).
t VOLUME
Adjusts the volume level.
Part names and functions
VIDEO
AUX
PHONES
YPAO MIC
SILENT
CINEMA
TONE
CONTROL
STRAIGHT
VOLU ME
TV
BD
DVD
CD
RADIO
INPUT
PROGRAM
SCENE
VIDEO
AUDI O
HDMI IN
L
R
INFO
ZONE
CONTROL
ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
CATEGORY
TUNING/CH
PURE DIRECT
rm n q
a
olts
ic f g ked h jb
p
JJ
1 : Usable when you have selected TUNER or SIRIUS input.
En 9
INTRODUCTION
Part names and functions
Rear panel
a DOCK jack
For connecting an optional Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (such as
YDS-12), iPod wireless receiver (YID-W10), or Bluetooth wireless
audio receiver (YBA-10) (
p. 71, p. 74, p. 76).
b ANTENNA jacks
For connecting AM and FM antennas (
p. 32).
c HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks
For connecting an HDMI - compatible TV to output audio/video
signals (
p. 23).
d MONITOR OUT jacks
e REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting an external component that supports the remote
control function (
p. 30).
f HDMI1-5 jacks
For connecting external components equipped with HDMI-
compatible outputs to receive audio/video signals (
p. 25).
g RS-232C terminal
This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult
your dealer for details.
h SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting the front, center, surround and surround back speakers
(
p. 17). Connect the presence speakers (p. 17) or the speakers for
Zone2 (
p. 18) to the EXTRA SP jacks.
i Power cable
For connecting this unit to an AC wall outlet.
j SIRIUS jack
For connecting a SiriusConnect tuner (sold separately) (
p. 64).
k AV1-6 jacks
For connecting to external components equipped with audio/video
outputs to receive audio/video signals (
p. 26).
l AV OUT jacks
For outputting audio/video signals received when analog inputs (AV3-
6 or AUDIO1-2) are selected (
p. 31).
m AUDIO1-2 jacks
For connecting external components equipped with analog audio
outputs to input sound into this unit (
p. 28).
n TRIGGER OUT jack
For connecting an external component that supports the trigger
function to operate it linked with operation of this unit (
p. 31).
o MULTI CH INPUT jacks
For connecting a player that supports a multi-channel output
(
p. 29).
p AUDIO OUT jacks
For outputting audio signals received when analog jacks, such as the
AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are selected (
p. 31).
q ZONE2 OUT jacks
Outputs sound of this unit to an external amplifier set in a different
room. (
p. 115).
r PRE OUT terminals
For connecting a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or an external
power amplifier (
p. 20, p. 30).
VIDEO jack For connecting a TV capable of receiving video
input, and outputting video signals to it (p. 23).
COMPONENT
VIDEO jacks
For connecting TV that are compatible with
component video signals, using three cables to
output video signal (p. 23).
AV
OUT
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE2
OUT
SURROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
1
2
FRONT
CENTERSINGLE
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
(
TV
)
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUD
IO 1
AUD
IO 2
MULTI CH INPUT
O
PTI
C
AL
(
BD
/
DV
D
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
HDMI 4 HDMI 5
C
ENTER
SU
RR
OU
N
D
SU
RR
OU
ND BA
C
K
/
BI
-
AMP
S
INGL
E
F
R
O
N
T
SUBWOOFE
R
SU
R.BA
CK
SU
RR
OU
ND
TRIGGER OUT
+12V
0
.1
A
MAX.
FR
O
NT
CENTE
R
IN
REMOTE
O
U
T
S
PEAK
E
SPEAKE
NTENNA
FM
o
GN
D
AM
7
5
RS
-2
3
2
C
Distinguishing the input and output jacks
The area around the audio/video output jacks is marked
in white to prevent connection errors. Use these jacks to
output audio/video signals to a TV or other external
component.
Output jacks
DOCK
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDI O 2
MULTI CH INPUT
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
VIDEO
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 2 HDMI 3
HDMI 4 HDMI 5
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK/
BI-AMP
SINGLE
EXTRA SP
FRONT
AV
OUT
SUBWOOFER
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE2
OUT
SUR.BACK
SURROUND
SURROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
1
2
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
+12V
0.1A MAX.
FRONT
CENTER
IN
REMOTE
OUT
CENTERSINGLE
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
SPEAKERSSPEAKERS
ANTENNA
FM
HD Radio
GND
AM
75
OPTICAL
AV 1
AV 2
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
SIRIUS
RS-232C
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
ZONE2/PRESENCE
adcfg ihe
pqjklmo r
b
n
En 10
INTRODUCTION
Part names and functions
Front panel display
a HDMI indicator
Lights up during normal HDMI communication when any of the
HDMI1-5 inputs are selected.
OUT 1/OUT 2 indicators
Lights up which outputs audio/video signals from the HDMI OUT
jack (
p. 23).
b SIRIUS indicator
Lights up when a SiriusConnect tuner is selected as an input source.
c HD indicator
Lights up when this unit is tuned into the HD Radio station (
p. 60).
d TAG indicator
Lights up when the selected HD Radio program (or song being
played) supports iTunes Tagging (
p. 61).
e CINEMA DSP indicator
Lights up when a sound field effect that uses CINEMA DSP
technology is selected.
f ENHANCER indicator
Lights up when the Compressed Music Enhancer mode is turned on
(
p. 46).
g CINEMA DSP 3D indicator
Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D is activated (
p. 45).
h Tuner indicator
Light up according to the status of a received station (
p. 56).
i SLEEP indicator
Lights up when the sleep timer is on (
p. 11).
j ZONE2 indicator
Lights up when the audio output to Zone2 is enabled (
p. 116).
k MUTE indicator
Flashes when audio is muted.
l VOLUME indicator
Displays the current volume level.
m Cursor indicators
Light up if corresponding cursors on the remote control are available
for operations.
n Multi information display
Displays a range of information on menu items and settings.
o Speaker indicators
Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBRSB
PR
PL
Front speaker L
Surround speaker L
Subwoofer
Front speaker R
Surround speaker R
Center speaker
Surround back
speaker L
Surround back
speaker R
Surround back
speaker J1
Presence speaker L
Presence speaker
R
Switching information on the front panel display
The front panel can display sound programs and surround
decoder names as well as the active input source.
Press INFO Key repeatedly to cycle through input source J2
sound program surround decoder in order.
SWSW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
STRAIGHT
HDMI1
VOL.
Input source name
Sound program (DSP program)
STEREO
SLEEP
VOL.
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
MUTE
ENHANCER
OUT 1 OUT 2
3
ZONE
2
SBL SBRSB
PR
PL
TAG
HD
SIRIUS
mn om
aefc dgbhilkj
J
1 : “SB” is displayed when using a 6.1-channel configuration only.
J
2 : During FM/AM reception, the frequency is displayed instead of the input source. During SIRIUS Satellite Radio signals reception, the channel is displayed instead of the input source.
En 11
INTRODUCTION
Part names and functions
Remote control
a Remote control signal transmitter
Transmits infrared signals.
b MAIN/ZONE2
Switches the zone to be operated by the remote control between the
Main zone and Zone2 (
p. 116).
c SOURCE A (SOURCE Power)
Switches an external component on and off.
d Input selector
Select an input source on this unit from which to playback.
e Radio control keys
Operates the FM/AM tuner. These keys are used when using the tuner
input.
f INFO
Cycles the information displayed on the front panel display (the name
of the currently selected input source, the sound program, the
surround decoder, the FM/AM tuner frequency, etc.).
g SLEEP
Switches this unit to standby mode automatically after a specified
period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press this key repeatedly to
set the time for the sleep timer function.
The SLEEP indicator lights up when the sleep timer is on.
h PARTY
Switches the party mode on and off (
p. 116).
i SCENE
Switch the input source and the sound program with a single button
(
p. 43). When this unit is in standby mode, press this key to switch on.
j ON SCREEN
Turns on and off the ON SCREEN menu.
k Cursor B / C / D / E, ENTER, RETURN
l External component operation keys
Operate recording, playback, and menu displays etc. for external
components (
p. 105). J1
m Numeric keys
Enter numbers.
n TV control keys
Operate a monitor such as a TV.
o CODE SET
Sets remote control codes for external component operations
(
p. 106).
p SOURCE/RECEIVER
Switches remote control key function to operate this unit or an
external component (
p. 105). Operate an external component when
this key glows green, or this unit when this key glows orange.
q RECEIVER A (RECEIVER Power)
Switches this unit between on and standby mode.
r HDMI OUT
Switches the output jack connected to an HDMI compatible TV (
p. 41).
s Sound selection keys
Switch between the sound field effect (sound program) you are using
and the surround decoder (
p. 43).
t OPTION
Turns on and off the OPTION menu (
p. 51).
u VOLUME +/-
Adjust the volume level (
p. 41).
v MUTE
Turns the mute function of the sound output on and off (
p. 41).
w HD Radio keys
SCENE
RETURN
VOLUME
ENHANCER
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHTSLEEP PURE DIRECT
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
1234
125
V-AU X
FM
INFO
MEMORY
AM
PRESET
PART Y
MOVIE MUSIC
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADIO
MUTE
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
REC
ENT
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVER
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI OUT
MULTI
OPTION
ON SCREEN
5
1234
6
[ A ]
SIRIUSTUNER
TUN./CH
CATEGORY
TAGHOLD
PRG SELECT
a
c
b
e
i
j
t
u
v
m
n
k
f
l
g
h
p
q
r
o
d
s
w
HDMI1-5 HDMI1-5 jacks
V-AUX Front panel VIDEO AUX jacks
AUDIO1-2 AUDIO1-2 jacks
AV1-6 AV1-6 jacks
[A] Changes the external component to operate with
the lExternal component operation keys
without changing inputs. J1
MULTI CH INPUT MULTI CH INPUT jacks
DOCK A Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone, iPod wireless
receiver, or Bluetooth wireless audio receiver
connected to the DOCK jack.
TUNER FM/AM tuner
SIRIUS A SIRIUS tuner connected to the SIRIUS jack.
FM Sets the FM/AM tuner band to FM.
AM
(CATEGORY D / E)
Sets the FM/AM tuner band to AM.
Selects a channel category for a SIRIUS.
MEMORY Presets radio stations.
PRESET F / G Selects a preset station.
TUN./CH H / I Changes tuning frequencies or SIRIUS Satellite
Radio channels.
Sleep 120min. Sleep 90min.
Sleep 60min.Sleep 30min.Sleep Off
Cursor B / C / D / E Select menu items and change settings when
menus, etc, are displayed.
ENTER Confirms a selected item.
RETURN Returns to the previous screen when menus are
displayed, or close the menu.
TAG Stores “tag” data to the iPod or internal memory
of this unit (p. 61).
PRG SELECT Selects an HD Radio audio program (p. 60).
J
1 : You can use lExternal component operation keys for each input source to operate registered components. Remote control codes must be registered for each input
in advance if you want to operate external components (
p. 106).
INTRODUCTION
Part names and functions
En 12
On-screen display
When a TV is connected to this unit, the supplied remote control can be used to specify and verify this
unit’s settings via menus and options displayed on the TV screen.
The following displays are available in the on-screen display.
Displaying the following menus or viewing the current status of this unit on the
TV screen
ON SCREEN menu
Press ON SCREEN to display the ON SCREEN menu.
OPTION menu
Press OPTION to display the OPTION menu.
Content window
Press Input selector to display the Content window.
ON SCREEN menu
Detailed settings for this unit can be
configured. Use this menu to select desired
settings, change their values, or check the
current status of this unit.
Refer to “SETUP” (
p. 78) for details.
OPTION menu
Configure the optional settings for each input
source. Settings such as “Tone Control” and
“Volume Trim” are applied to this unit
regardless of the input source.
Refer to “Configuring settings specific to an
individual input source (OPTION menu)”
(
p. 51) for details.
Content window
Includes the Content browse view and the
Now Playing view. The Now Playing view
displays the status of the source from which
music is currently played back. Adjust settings
for music content from the Content browse
view.
Refer to “Confirming and operating input
sources from the Content window” (
p. 55)
for details.
En 13
CONNECTIONS
This unit uses acoustic field effects and sound decoders to bring you the impact of a real movie theater or concert hall. These effects will be brought to you with ideal speaker positioning and
connections in your listening environment.
Speaker channels and functions
Front left and right speakers
The front speakers are used for the front channel sounds (stereo
sound) and effect sounds.
Front speaker layout:
Place these speakers at an equal distance from the ideal listening
position in the front of the room. When using a projector screen,
the appropriate top positions of the speakers are about 1/4 of the
screen from the bottom.
Center speaker
The center speaker is for the center channel sounds (dialog, vocals,
etc.).
Center speaker layout:
Place it halfway between the left and right front speakers. When
using a TV, place the speaker just above or just under the center of
the TV with the front surfaces of the TV and the speaker aligned.
When using a screen, place it just under the center of the screen.
Surround left and right speakers
The surround speakers are for effect and vocal sounds with the 5.1-
channel speakers providing rear-area sounds. When used with 6.1/
7.1-channel (including surround back channel), sound for right and
left rear-area is output.
Surround speaker layout:
Place the speakers at the rear of the room on the left and right sides
facing the listening position. They should be placed between 60
degrees and 80 degrees from the listening position and with the
speaker tops at a height of 4.9 – 5.9 ft. (1.5 – 1.8 m) from the floor.
Presence left and right speakers
The presence speakers are used for front effect sounds. When used
in combination with the sound programs (
p. 43), a sound with a
richer and more spatial presence is possible.
Presence speaker layout:
Place the left and right presence speakers 1.6 – 3.3 ft. (0.5 – 1 m) to
the outside of the left and right front speakers respectively. The
tops of the presence speakers should be 5.9 ft. (1.8 m) above the
floor.
Surround back left and right speakers
Outputs the rear effect. When used with 6.1ch sound, sound from
the left and right sound surround back speakers is mixed and output
from a single speaker. When used with 5.1ch sound, sound from
surround back speakers is distributed between the left and right
surround speakers.
Surround back speaker layout:
When used with 7.1ch sound, arrange the left and right speakers
towards the listening position, to the rear of the listening position.
Arrange the left and right speakers at least 1 ft. (30 cm) apart. The
same separation as with the front left and right speakers is
optimum.
When used with 6.1ch sound, arrange these to the rear of the
listening position.
Subwoofer
The subwoofer speaker is used for bass sounds and low-frequency
effect (LFE) sounds included in Dolby Digital and DTS. Use a
subwoofer that is equipped with built-in amplifier.
Subwoofer speaker layout:
Place it to the outside of the front left and right speakers facing
slightly inward to reduce echoes from the wall.
Connecting speakers
Ex.
Ex.
Ex.
Ex.
Ex.
Ex.
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 14
Speaker layout
Enjoying the 7.1 channel audio source
7.1-channel speaker layout
(7 speakers + subwoofer)
Connections of speakers
Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the
speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back
speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker
connection” for details on connecting speakers (
p. 17).
Assigning a speaker configuration
A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the
speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the
appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker
configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the
default “Power Amp Assign” setting (
p. 91).
Adding the presence speakers for a richer
sound field effect
Presence speaker layout
(7 speakers + subwoofer + presence speakers)
Connections of speakers
Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the
speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back
speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker
connection” for details on connecting speakers (
p. 17).
Assigning a speaker configuration
A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the
speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the
appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker
configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the
default “Power Amp Assign” setting (
p. 91).
Audio from a 7.1-channel audio source can be played back with
no degradation with this speaker configuration.
Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER
EXTRA SP jack No used
Front speaker L
Front speaker R
Subwoofer
Center speaker
Surround speaker L
Surround
speaker R
Surround back speaker RSurround back speaker L
12 in (30 cm)
or more
Power Amp Assign 7ch Normal (Default)
This unit automatically selects the presence speakers or
surround back speakers to output sounds according to the
selected sound program.
When the sound program is changed, the speakers that output
the sound are switched between the presence speakers and
surround back speakers automatically.
Front
speaker L
Front speaker R
Subwoofer
Center speaker
Surround speaker L
Surround
speaker R
Presence speaker R
Presence
speaker L
Surround back speaker RSurround back speaker L
12 in (30 cm)
or more
Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER
EXTRA SP jack Presence L/R speaker
Power Amp Assign 7ch Normal (Default)
Continues to the
next page
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 15
Enjoying the 7.1 channel audio source
without surround back speakers
5.1-channel speaker layout
(5 speakers + subwoofer)
Connections of speakers
Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the
speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back
speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker
connection” for details on connecting speakers (
p. 17).
Assigning a speaker configuration
A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the
speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the
appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker
configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the
default “Power Amp Assign” setting (
p. 91).
Using the front speakers that support bi-
amp connections for a high quality sound
5.1-channel speaker layout
(Front speakers (Bi-amp) + 3 speakers)
Connections of speakers
Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the
speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back
speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Bi-amp connection” for
details on connecting speakers (
p. 17, p. 18).
Assigning a speaker configuration
Use the “Power Amp Assign” function which can easily apply the
appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker
configuration (
p. 91).
This unit can mix 7.1-channel audio source down to 5.1-channel
sound. This enables 7.1-channel sound without surround back
speakers.
Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SUBWOOFER
EXTRA SP jack No used
Front speaker L
Front speaker R
Subwoofer
Center speaker
Surround speaker L
Surround
speaker R
Power Amp Assign 7ch Normal (Default)
Using the front speakers that support bi-amp connections
reproduces a high quality sound.
Front speaker L
(Bi-amp connection)
Front speaker R
(Bi-amp connection)
Center speaker
Surround speaker L
Surround
speaker R
Subwoofer
Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER
EXTRA SP jack No used
Power Amp Assign 5ch BI-AMP
Continues to the
next page
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 16
Using speakers in two rooms (Zone2
function)
7.1-channel speaker layout + Zone2
(7 speakers (in main zone) + subwoofer (in main
zone) + front speakers (in secondary zone))
Main zone
Zone2
Connections of speakers
Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the
speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back
speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Multi-zone audio system
using the internal amplifier of this unit” for details on connecting
speakers (
p. 17, p. 18).
Assigning a speaker configuration
Use the “Power Amp Assign” function which can easily apply the
appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker
configuration (
p. 91).
Front speaker L
Front speaker R
Center speaker
Subwoofer
Surround
speaker R
Surround speaker L
Surround back speaker L Surround back speaker R
12 in (30 cm) or
more
Front
speaker R
Front speaker L
In addition to the main room, speakers in another room can also
be controlled.
When the built-in amplifier for the speakers in another room is
turned on, the speakers that output the sound are switched from
the surround back speakers to the speakers in another room
automatically. J1
Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER
EXTRA SP jack Zone2 speaker
Power Amp Assign 7ch + 1ZONE
J
1 : Sound cannot be output from both the surround back speakers and the speakers
in the second zone at the same time.
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 17
Connecting speakers and subwoofer
Connect your speakers to their respective terminals on the rear panel.
Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and
Subwoofer connection
Presence speaker connection
When using the presence speakers, connect the speakers to the
EXTRA SP jacks as shown in the diagram below.
The presence speakers (PL/PR) that output front effect sounds can
be connected to this unit. With the sound programs (
p. 47),
sound with a richer and more spatial presence can be created.
CAUTION
Remove the AC power cable of this unit from the power outlet before connecting the speakers.
Generally speaker cables consist of two parallel insulated cables. One of these cables is a different color, or has a line running along it, to indicate different polarity. Insert the different colored (or lined) cable into the “+”
(positive, red) terminal on this unit and the speakers, and the other cable into the “–” (negative, black) terminal.
Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come into contact with the metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “CHECK SP
WIRES!” will appear on the front panel display when this unit is switched on.
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK/
BI-AMP
SINGLE
FRONT
1
MULTI CH INPUT
MI
1
DVD
)
HDMI
2
HDMI
3
HDMI 4
HDMI
5
E
XTRA
SP
SU
BW
OO
FE
R
A
U
DI
O
OUT
ZO
NE2
OU
T
SU
R.BA
C
K
SU
RR
OU
ND
SURROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE OU
T
W
OOFE
R
2
F
RONT
T
RI
GG
ER
OUT
+12V
0
.1A MAX.
C
ENTE
R
IN
REM
O
TE
OU
T
C
ENTER
S
IN
G
LE
SPEAKERS
SPEAKERS
R
S
-232
C
Z
O
NE2
/
PRE
S
EN
CE
SubwooferCenter speaker
Front speaker Surround
speaker
Surround back
speaker
RL
RL RL
EXTRA SP
ZONE2/PRESENCE
M
I
5
SU
RR
OU
N
D
S
URROUND BACK/
BI
-
AMP
S
IN
G
LE
S
URROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE
OU
T
S
UBWOOFE
R
1
2
C
ENTER
S
IN
G
LE
S
PE
A
SPEA
RS-232
C
Presence speaker
RL
Connection of presence speakers is recommended to take full
advantage of the effects of CINEMA DSP sound programs.
Although you can connect both surround back speakers and
presence speakers to this unit, you cannot output sounds from
those speakers at the same time.
0.5 – 1 m 0.5 – 1 m
PL PR
FL FR
1.8 m 1.8 m
Continues to the
next page
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 18
Bi-amp connection
This unit can be connected to speakers that support bi-amp
connections. When connecting speakers, connect the FRONT jacks
and the SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP jacks as in the diagram
below. Configure the bi-amp settings to activate connections.
Multi-zone audio system using the internal
amplifier of this unit
Connect the speakers in the second zone to the EXTRA SP jacks as
in the diagram below.
Changing speaker impedance
This unit is configured for 8 Ω speakers at the factory setting.
When connecting to 6 Ω speakers, carry out the following
procedure to switch to 6 Ω. When this unit is configured for 6 Ω
speakers, 4 Ω speakers can also be used as the front speakers.
1
Switch this unit to the standby mode.
2
Press MAIN ZONE A while pressing and holding
STRAIGHT on the front panel.
Release the keys when “ADVANCED SETUP” is displayed on
the front panel display.
After approximately a few seconds, the top menu item is
displayed. J1
NOTES
Before making bi-amplification connections, remove any
brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to
the instruction manuals of speakers for details. When not making
bi-amplification connections, make sure that the brackets or
cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables.
If connecting a bi-amp, then surround back speakers cannot be
used.
FRONT
SINGLE
SURROUND BACK/
BI-AMP
CAUTION
The EXTRA SP jacks of this unit should not be connected to a
Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or more than one loudspeaker
per channel.
Connection to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or multiple
speakers per channel could create an abnormally low impedance
load resulting in amplifier damage. See this owner’s manual for
correct usage.
Compliance with minimum speaker impedance information for all
channels must be maintained at all times. This information is found
on the back panel of this unit.
DOCK
(
TV
)
A
V
3
A
V
4
A
V
5
A
V
6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
M
U
L
T
I
C
H
IN
P
U
T
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
VIDEO
HDMI 1
(
BD/DVD
)
HDMI 2 HDMI 3
HDMI 4 HDMI 5
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND BACK/
BI-AMP
SINGLE
EXTRA SP
FRONT
AV
OUT
SUBWOOFER
AUDIO
OUT
ZONE2
OUT
SUR.BACK
SURROUND
SURROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
1
2
FRONT
TRIGGER OUT
+12V
0.1A MAX.
FRONT
CENTER
IN
REMOTE
OUT
CENTERSINGLE
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
SPEAKERSSPEAKERS
ANTENNA
FM
HD Radio
GND
AM
75
OPTICAL
A
V
1
A
V
2
COAXIAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
SIRIUS
RS-232C
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
ZONE2/PRESENCE
ZONE2/PRESENCE
EXTRA SP
Zone2
PHONES
YPAO MIC
SILENT
CINEMA
TONE
CONTROL
STRAIGHT
TV
BD
DVD
CD
RADIO
INPUT
PROGRAM
SCENE
H
INFOZONE
CONTROL
ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
CATEGORY
MAIN ZONE A
STRAIGHT
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : Refer to the “Extended functionality that can be configured as needed
(Advanced Setup menu)” (
p. 108) for details on the Advanced Setup menu.
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 19
3
Check that “SP IMP.” is displayed on the front panel.
4
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select a “6ΩMIN.
5
Switch this unit to the standby mode, and then
switch it on again.
The power turns on, when the settings you made has been
configured.
Connecting speakers
This type of jack can connect to the following speakers or
connection.
1
Remove approximately 0.4 in. (10 mm) of insulation
from the ends of the speaker cables, and twist the
bare wires of the cables together firmly so that they
will not cause short circuits.
2
Loosen the speaker terminals.
3
Insert the bare wire of the speaker cable into the gap
on the side of the terminal.
4
Tighten the terminal.
SPIMP.-8MIN
Front L/R speakers
Center speaker
Surround L/R speakers
Surround back L/R speakers
Bi-amp connection (Front speaker L/R speakers)
FRONT
2
2
3
1
4
4
Connecting the banana plug
Tighten the knob, and then insert the banana plug into the end of
the terminal.
FRONT
Banana plug
CONNECTIONS
Connecting speakers
En 20
Connecting the subwoofer
1
Connect the subwoofer input jack to the
SUBWOOFER 1 or 2 jack on this unit with an audio
pin cable.
2
Set the subwoofer volume as follows.
Volume: Set to approximately half volume (or slightly less than
half).
Crossover frequency (if available): Set to maximum.
NOTE
After connection, applying this setting to this unit is required to
activate all speaker connections. With using “Power Amp
Assign” function, you can easily apply the speaker
configuration.
Refer to “Power Amp Assign” (
p. 91) for details on using
“Power Amp Assign” function.
VOLUME
MIN MAX
CROSSOVER/
HIGH CUT
MIN MAX
Subwoofer examples
CONNECTIONS
En 21
Cable plugs and jacks
This unit is equipped with the following input/output jacks. Use jacks and cables appropriate for
components that you are going to connect.
Audio/Video jacks
HDMI jacks
Digital video and digital sound are transmitted through a single jack.
Only use an HDMI cable.
Analog video jacks
Audio jacks
Connecting external components
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo.
We recommend using a cable less than 16.4 ft. (5.0 m) long to prevent signal quality degradation.
When a TV that supports HDMI functions and Audio Return Channel function is connected, audio
output from the TV can be input to this unit (
p. 113).
When a player and TV that support the 3D video format are connected to this unit, 3D content can be
played back.
If you connect this unit to a component that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is required.
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
The signal is separated into three components:
luminance (Y), chrominance blue (P
B), and chrominance red (PR).
Use component video pin cables with three plugs.
HDMI cable
Component video pin cable
VIDEO jacks
These jacks transmit conventional analog video
signals.
Use video pin cables.
OPTICAL jacks
These jacks transmit optical digital audio signals.
Use fiber-optic cables for optical digital audio
signals.
COAXIAL jacks
These jacks transmit coaxial digital audio signals.
Use pin cables for digital audio signals.
AUDIO jacks
These jacks transmit conventional analog audio
signals.
Use stereo pin cables, connecting the red plug to
the red R jack, and the white plug to the white L
jack.
Video pin cable
Digital audio fiber-optic cable
Digital audio pin cable
Stereo pin cable
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
En 22
Connecting a TV monitor
This unit is equipped with the following three types of output jack for connection to a TV.
HDMI OUT 1-2, COMPONENT VIDEO or VIDEO. Select the proper connection according to the
input signal format supported by your TV.
When connecting to an HDMI compatible TV
Video signal such as component video and video received by this unit is converted to HDMI and output to
the TV. Just select HDMI input on the TV to view video from any external source connected to this unit. J1
When connecting to a non-HDMI compatible TV
Connect to the TV using the same type of connection that you used to connect to the external
component, and change the inputs on your TV to match that of the external component you are using
for playback. If the external component and TV are equipped with different types of analog video
jacks, this unit will convert the video signal to component video signal, or vice-versa, according to the
type of video input jacks used by the TV. J2, J3
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
D
OCK
VIDE
O
HDMI
1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
HDM
I
TRI
GG
ER
OUT
+
12
V
0
.1
A
MAX
.
IN
R
EM
O
T
E
OUT
ANTENNA
FM
H
D R
ad
i
o
GN
D
A
M
75
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
SIRIUS
HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
(MONITOR OUT)
VIDEO jack
(MONITOR OUT)
HDMI
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
VIDEO
Input Output
HDMI input
Through
Converted
TV
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
VIDEO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
HDMI
VIDEO
Input Output
Video input
Through
Component
video input
TV
Converted
J
1 : You can change the resolution and aspect ratio when converting to HDMI to suit your requirements (p. 97).
J
2 : Set “Analog to Analog Conversion” to “On” (p. 96).
J
3 : Analog to analog conversion is available only for 480i/576i-resolution video signal.
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
En 23
Connecting an HDMI video monitor
Connect the HDMI cable to one of the HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks.
Connecting a component video monitor
Connect the component video cable to the COMPONENT VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jacks.
Connecting a video monitor
Connect the video pin cable to the VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jack.
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo.
We recommend using a cable less than 16.4 ft. (5.0 m) long to prevent signal quality degradation.
When a TV that supports the HDMI function and Audio Return Channel function is connected, audio
output from the TV can be input to this unit (
p. 113).
When a player and TV that support the 3D video format are connected to this unit, 3D content can be
played back.
This unit is equipped with HDMI OUT 1 and 2 jacks. The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be selected
(
p. 41). The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be registered with the SCENE function (p. 43).
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
D
OC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
O
PTICAL
V
IDEO
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DVD
)
AV
OUT
S
URRO
U
TRI
GG
FRON
T
IN
R
E
O
U
T
A
NTENN
A
FM
H
D R
ad
i
o
G
ND
AM
75
O
PTI
C
A
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
CO
MP
O
NENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
M
O
NIT
O
R
O
U
T
P
R
P
B
Y
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI input
TV
Projector
J1
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
DOC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDIO 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
A
L
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
OUT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
F
R
O
NT
IN
RE
O
UT
H
DMI OUT
1
2
ARC
A
R
C
S
ELECTABLE
ANTENNA
F
M
HD Rad
io
G
ND
AM
7
5
OPTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
CO
MP
O
NENT
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
V
IDE
O
O
R
O
UT
COMPONENT
VIDEO
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Component video input
TV
J1
DOC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDI O 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
HDMI
O
U
T
1
2
A
RC AR
C
S
ELECTABL
E
ANTENNA
F
M
HD Rad
io
G
ND
AM
7
5
OPTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
C
OMPONEN
T
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
P
R
P
B
Y
VIDEO
V
V
Video input
TV
J
1 : When connecting to a TV that supports HDMI input, the video signal for the COMPONENT VIDEO/VIDEO jacks is
converted and output from HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. When connecting to a TV via the HDMI jack, you do not need to use these
jacks.
En 24
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Listening to TV audio
To transmit sound from the TV to this unit, connect as followings according to the TV:
When using a TV that supports the Audio Return Channel function and HDMI
Control function
When your TV supports both HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link) and Audio Return
Channel functions, audio/video output from the unit to the TV and audio output from the TV to the
unit are possible using a single HDMI cable.
The input source is switched automatically to match operations carried out on the TV, and that
makes TV sound control easier to use.
For the connections and settings, refer to “Single HDMI cable input to TV audio with Audio Return
Channel function” (
p. 113).
When using a TV that supports the HDMI Control functions
When using a TV that supports HDMI Control functions (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link), if HDMI
Control functions are enabled on the unit, then input source can be switched automatically to match
operations carried out on the TV.
For the connections and settings, refer to “Switching the input source on this unit automatically
when listening to TV audio” (
p. 112).
When using other TVs
To transmit sound from the TV to this unit, connect AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 jacks to the TV’s audio
output jacks.
Select the input source connected via TV’s audio output jack to enjoy the TV sound.
If the TV supports optical digital audio output, we recommend that you connect the TV audio output
to the receiver’s AV4 jack.
Connecting to AV4 allows you to switch the input source to AV4 with just a single key operation
using the SCENE function (
p. 43).
You can control your TV using the receiver’s remote control by entering the TV’s remote control
code (p. 106).
TV audio output Connection
Optical digital audio output Connect to the OPTICAL jack of the AV1 or AV4 with a fiber-optic cable.
Coaxial digital audio output Connect to the COAXIAL jack of the AV2 or AV3 with a digital audio pin
cable.
Analog stereo output Connect to one of the AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2 with a stereo pin
cable.
(
TV
)
AV
3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O
1
AUDI O
2
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
AV 1
AV 2
COAXIAL
DOCK
MULT
V
IDE
O
H
DMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
AV
OU
T
S
URR
OU
TRI
GG
FR
O
NT
IN
RE
OUT
H
DMI OU
T
1
2
A
R
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
FM
HD R
adio
GN
D
AM
75
CO
MP
O
NENT
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
SIRIU
S
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
V
IDE
O
M
O
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
OPTICALCOAXIALAUDIO
Audio output
(Optical, coaxial, or analog)
TV
Available input jacks
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
En 25
Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices
This unit has the following input jacks. Connect them to the appropriate output jacks on
the playback devices such as BD/DVD players.
Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with
HDMI
Connect the device with an HDMI cable to one of the HDMI1-5 jacks. The HDMI IN
jack on the front panel can also be used.
Select the HDMI input (HDMI1-5 or VIDEO AUX) that the playback device is
connected to for playback.
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
Input Video input Audio input
HDMI1 HDMI HDMI
HDMI2 HDMI HDMI
HDMI3 HDMI HDMI
HDMI4 HDMI HDMI
HDMI5 HDMI HDMI
AV1 Component video Optical digital
AV2 Component video Coaxial digital
AV3 Video Coaxial digital
AV4 Video Optical digital
AV5 Video Analog (Stereo)
AV6 Video Analog (Stereo)
AUDIO1 Analog (Stereo)
AUDIO2 Analog (Stereo)
VIDEO AUX HDMI/Video HDMI/Analog (Stereo)
(
BD/DVD
)
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULTI CH INPUT
C
ENTER
SURROUN
D
F
RONT
A
V
OU
T
S
UBW
OO
FE
R
AU
DI
O
OUT
ZO
NE
2
OU
T
S
UR.BA
CK
S
URR
O
UND
S
URROUN
D
SUR.BA
C
P
RE
OU
FRONT
T
RIGGER OUT
+12
V
0
.1
A
MAX.
FR
O
N
T
CENTER
IN
REM
O
TE
OU
T
S
INGL
E
H
DMI
OU
T
2
AR
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABLE
GND
A
M
R
S
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDE
O
V
IDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
OU
T
P
R
P
B
Y
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI output
BD/DVD player
Receiving video signals from the HDMI jack and audio signals
from a jack other than HDMI
This unit can use the AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 input jacks to receive audio signals from
other input jacks.
For example, if a playback device cannot produce audio signals from an HDMI jack,
use the following method to change the audio input.
1
Press jON SCREEN to display the ON SCREEN menu.
2
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Input,” and then press
kENTER. J1
3
Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select the desired HDMI input
source, and then press kCursor B.
4
Press kCursor C repeatedly to select “Audio In,” and then press k
ENTER.
5
Press kCursor B / C to select the audio input source.
6
Once you have completed the setup, press jON SCREEN to close
the menu.
J
1 : Refer to the “Configuring input sources (Input menu)” (p. 78) for details on selecting the input source.
(
BD/DVD
)
OPTICAL
DOCK
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUD
IO
1
AUD
IO
2
MULTI CH IN
(
CD
)
COAXIA
L
OPTICAL
V
IDE
O
H
AV
OU
T
SU
SU
RR
OU
N
D
TRI
GG
ER
O
U
T
+12V
0
.1A MA
X
FR
O
NT
I
N
REMOTE
OUT
H
DMI OUT
1
2
A
R
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
FM
H
D R
adio
GND
AM
75
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
CO
MP
O
NENT
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
COMPONENT
V
IDE
O
V
IDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
U
T
P
R
P
B
Y
HDMI
OPTICAL
HDMI
HDMI
O
O
HDMI/Audio (Optical)
output
BD/DVD player
En 26
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with component
video cables
Connect the device with a component video cable to one of the AV1-2 input jacks.
Using optical digital audio output sources
Select the AV1 input to which the playback device is connected for playback.
Using coaxial digital audio output sources
Select the AV2 input to which the playback device is connected for playback.
OPTICAL
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
DOCK
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
A
L
VIDE
O
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
AV
OU
T
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
F
R
O
NT
IN
RE
O
U
T
HDMI
OUT
1
2
A
R
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
F
M
H
D Rad
io
G
N
D
AM
7
5
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
S
IRI
US
C
OMPONEN
T
V
IDEO
V
IDE
O
M
O
NIT
O
R
O
U
T
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
O
OPTICAL
O
Component video / Audio (Optical)
output
BD/DVD player
COAXIAL
DOC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
OUT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
HDMI
OUT
1
2
A
R
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TAB L
E
ANTENNA
F
M
HD Rad
io
G
ND
AM
7
5
OPTICA
L
AV 1
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
C
OMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
COAXIAL
Y
P
R
C
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
C
Component video / Audio (Coaxial)
output
BD/DVD player
Component connections to analog audio output devices
The video input from the AV1-2 jacks can be used in combination with the audio input from other
AV inputs or AUDIO1-2.
When connecting these devices, select the AV input jacks or the AUDIO1-2 jacks as the audio input
for AV1 or AV2. Refer to “Receiving video signals from the HDMI jack and audio signals from a
jack other than HDMI” (
p. 25) for detailed setup guidance.
For playback of the connected device, select the AV input source (AV1-2) to which the device is
connected with the component video cable.
COMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
D
OCK
(
TV
)
A
V
3
A
V
4
A
V
5
A
V
6
AUD
IO 2
M
ULTI CH
IN
(
C
D
)
COAXIA
L
O
PTI
C
A
L
VIDE
O
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
H
AV
OUT
S
U
SURROUND
TRI
GG
ER
OU
T
+12V
0
.1
A
MAX
F
RON
T
I
N
REMOTE
OUT
H
DMI
OUT
1
2
AR
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TABLE
ANTENN
A
FM
H
D R
ad
i
o
G
ND
AM
7
5
O
PTI
C
A
L
A
V
1
A
V
2
CO
AXIA
L
S
IRI
US
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
AUDIO
COMPONENT
VIDEO
R
L
R
L
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
Component video / Audio
output
Game console
En 27
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with video cables
Connect the playback device with a video pin cable to one of the AV3-6 input jacks.
Using optical digital audio output sources
Select the AV4 input to which the playback device is connected for playback.
Using coaxial digital audio output sources
Select the AV3 input to which the playback device is connected for playback.
Using analog stereo audio output sources
Select the AV5 or AV6 input to which the playback device is connected for playback.
OPTICAL
DOCK
AV 3
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDIO 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
VIDE
O
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
AV
OU
T
SU
RR
OU
TRI
GG
F
R
O
NT
IN
RE
O
U
T
H
DMI OUT
1
2
AR
C
ARC
SELECTABLE
ANTENNA
F
M
H
D Rad
i
o
G
N
D
AM
7
5
O
PTICAL
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
CO
MP
O
NENT
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
C
OMPONEN
T
V
IDEO
V
IDE
O
M
O
NIT
O
R
O
U
T
P
R
P
B
Y
VIDEO
OPTICAL
V
V
O
O
Video / Audio (Optical)
output
BD/DVD player
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
VIDEO
D
OC
K
(
TV
)
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDI O 2
MULT
O
PTI
C
AL
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
H
DMI OUT
1
2
ARC
A
R
C
S
ELECTABLE
ANTENNA
FM
H
D Rad
io
G
ND
AM
75
OPTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
VIDEO
COAXIAL
V
V
C
C
Video / Audio (Coaxial)
output
BD/DVD player
D
OC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDI O 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
TRI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
H
DMI
OU
T
1 2
ARC
A
R
C
S
ELECTABLE
ANTENNA
FM
H
D Rad
io
G
ND
AM
75
OPTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
R
L
V
V
Video / Audio
output
BD/DVD player
En 28
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Connecting CD players and other audio devices
Using analog stereo output sources
Select the audio input (AUDIO1-2) to which the playback device is connected for playback.
Using optical digital output sources
Select the AV input (AV1 or AV4) to which the playback device is connected for playback.
Using coaxial digital output sources
Select the AV input (AV2 or AV3) to which the playback device is connected for playback.
D
OC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
H
DMI
O
UT
1
2
ARC
A
R
C
S
ELECTABLE
ANTENNA
FM
H
D Rad
io
G
ND
AM
75
OPTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
AUDIO
R
L
R
L
Audio output
CD player
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
D
OC
K
AV 3
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDI O 2
MULT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
HDMI
OUT
1
2
A
R
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
FM
H
D Rad
io
G
ND
AM
75
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
O
O
OPTICAL
CD player
Audio (Optical) output
We recommend connecting audio devices with a coaxial digital output to the AV3 coaxial digital
jack on this unit. This connection allows you to switch to the AV input 3 just by pressing the “CD”
SCENE key (
p. 43).
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
COAXIAL
D
OC
K
(
TV
)
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDI O 2
MULT
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
AV
O
UT
SU
RR
OU
T
RI
GG
FR
O
N
T
IN
R
E
O
UT
H
DMI
OU
T
1
2
AR
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABLE
ANTENNA
FM
H
D Rad
io
G
ND
AM
75
OPTICA
L
AV 1
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
COMPONENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
C
C
COAXIAL
Audio (Coaxial) output
CD player
En 29
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Connecting game consoles
Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to temporarily connect devices such as a game console to
the receiver.
Select the V-AUX input to use these connected devices.
When connecting an HDMI compatible device
Connect the HDMI output of the device to the HDMI IN jack of this unit.
When connecting an non-HDMI compatible device
Connect the video and audio outputs of the device to the VIDEO and AUDIO jacks of this unit.
Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder
This unit has 8 sets of input jacks (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SUR. BACK and
SUBWOOFER) to input multi-channel analog sound signals. If your playback component, such as a
DVD player or SACD player, has multi-channel analog output capability, you can enjoy up to 7.1-
channel multi-channel sound. To output multi-channel sound, connect the audio output jacks of your
playback component to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit, and set the input source of this unit to
“MULTI CH.
Be sure to turn down the volume when connecting this unit and the other devices.
When both the HDMI connection and the analog video/audio connection are performed between the
HDMI compatible device and this unit, only the HDMI signal will be input.
VIDEO
AUX
STRAIGHT
RADIO
VIDEO
AUDIO
HDMI IN
LR
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI output
Game console
VIDEO
AUX
STRAIGHT
RADIO
VIDEO
AUDIO
HDMI IN
LR
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
V
V
RL
Video output
Analog audio output
Game console
When you select “MULTI CH” as the input source, the digital sound field processor and tone control are
automatically disabled.
Since this unit does not redirect signals input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for
missing speakers, connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system when using this feature.
When the input source is switched to “MULTI CH, images input from a component connected to the
HDMI1-5, AV1-6, or VIDEO AUX jacks can be displayed on a video monitor (
p. 81). If your DVD
player does not support multi-channel digital output, connect it to these input jacks.
M
UL
TI CH INPUT
SUBWOOFER
SUR.BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
CENTER
RL RL RL
Surround out
Front out
Subwoofer out
Center out
Multi-format player/External decoder
(7.1-channel output)
Surround back out
En 30
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Connecting an external amplifier
The same channel signals are output from the jacks of the PRE OUT terminals as from their
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. When connecting an external power amplifier (pre-main
amplifier) to enhance speaker output, connect the input terminals of the power amplifier to the PRE
OUT terminals of this unit.
Connecting a SCENE link playback-compatible device
When the components are the Yamaha products and have the capability of the transmission of the
remote control signals, connect the REMOTE IN and REMOTE OUT jacks to the remote control input
and output jack with the monaural analog mini cable as follows.
NOTE
When a component is connected to the PRE OUT terminals, do not connect speakers to the
SPEAKERS terminals corresponding to those PRE OUT terminals.
a FRONT (PRE OUT) jacks
Front channel output jacks.
b SURROUND (PRE OUT) jacks
Surround channel output jacks.
c SUR. BACK (PRE OUT) jacks
Surround back output jacks. When you only connect one external amplifier for the surround back channel,
connect it to the SUR. BACK (SINGLE) jack.
d SUBWOOFER (PRE OUT) 1/2 jack
Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier. When two subwoofers are connected, the same sound is
output from them.
e CENTER (PRE OUT) jack
Center channel output jack.
SURROUND
SUR.BACK
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
1
2
FRONT
CENTERSINGLE
abc d e
When a Yamaha component that supports the SCENE link playback function is connected via the
REMOTE OUT jack, playback begins automatically when the SCENE function is used (
p. 43).
If the component connected to the REMOTE OUT jack is not a Yamaha product, set “SCENE IR” in the
SCENE menu to “Off” (
p. 83).
IN
OUT
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDI O 2
MULTI CH INPUT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
OPTICA
L
VIDEO
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
FR
O
N
T
A
V
OUT
SU
BW
OO
FER
A
U
DI
O
OUT
SUR.BACK
S
URROUN
D
TRI
GG
ER
OUT
+
12V
0
.1A MAX.
FRON
T
C
ENTE
R
HDMI
O
U
T
1
2
A
R
C
ARC
SELECTABL
E
ANTENNA
F
M
H
D R
ad
i
o
G
ND
AM
75
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NENT
V
IDE
O
VIDE
O
M
O
NIT
O
R
O
U
T
P
R
P
B
Y
Remote control out
Remote control in
Infrared signal receiver or
Yamaha component
Yamaha component
(CD or DVD player, etc.)
En 31
CONNECTIONS
Connecting external components
Using the Trigger function to link external component power
When this unit is connected to a Yamaha subwoofer that supports the system connection or the
component with TRIGGER IN jack, you can turn on and off the component by using this unit.
When connecting a Yamaha subwoofer
When connecting a component with the TRIGGER IN jack
Connecting audio/video recording devices
This receiver can transmit selected incoming analog audio/video signals to external components
through the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks. You can record these input audio and video signals to
VCRs or similar devices, or send them to other TVs or external components.
Using the AV OUT jacks
Connect this jacks to the external component’s video input jack and analog audio input jacks.
Using the AUDIO OUT jacks
Connect this jack to the external component’s analog audio input jacks.
Functions of the TRIGGER OUT jack can be specified (
p. 102).
+12V
0.1A MAX.
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULTI CH INPUT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
F
R
O
NT
AV
OUT
SU
BW
OO
FE
R
A
UDIO
O
U
T
SU
R.BA
CK
SU
RR
OU
ND
F
R
O
NT
C
ENTER
IN
R
EMOTE
O
UT
H
DMI
O
UT
1
2
A
R
C
ARC
SELECTABL
E
ANTENNA
F
M
HD Rad
io
G
ND
AM
7
5
C
OMPONEN
T
VIDE
O
V
IDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
System connection input
Yamaha subwoofer
that supports the system
connection
+12V
0.1A MAX.
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MULTI CH INPUT
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
F
R
O
NT
AV
OUT
SU
BW
OO
FE
R
A
UDIO
O
U
T
SU
R.BA
CK
SU
RR
OU
ND
F
R
O
NT
C
ENTER
IN
R
EMOTE
O
UT
H
DMI
OU
T
1
2
A
R
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
F
M
HD Rad
io
G
ND
AM
7
5
C
OMPONEN
T
VIDE
O
V
IDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
TRIGGER IN
Trigger input
Component with the
TRIGGER IN jack
(Power amplifier or
DVD player, etc.)
HDMI audio/video signals, component video signals, and digital audio signals cannot be transmitted
from these jacks.
AV
OUT
AUDIO
OUT
DOC
K
(
TV
)
AV 3
AV 4
AV 5
AV 6
AUDI O 1
AUDIO 2
MULTI CH INPUT
(
CD
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
PTICAL
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DVD
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
F
R
O
NT
SU
BW
OO
FE
R
S
UR.BAC
K
SURROUND
T
RI
GG
ER
OU
T
+12
V
0.1A MAX
.
FRON
T
C
ENTER
IN
REMOTE
O
UT
H
DMI
OU
T
1
2
AR
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABLE
A
NTENN
A
F
M
HD R
ad
i
o
G
ND
AM
75
O
PTI
C
A
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
CO
MP
O
NENT
VIDE
O
VIDEO
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
AUDIO
VIDEO
R
L
V
AUDIO
R
L
R
L
V
R
L
Audio recorder
Audio input
VCR
Video / Audio
input
CONNECTIONS
En 32
An indoor FM antenna and an AM loop antenna are supplied with this receiver. Connect these antennas
properly to their respective jacks.
Assembling the AM loop antenna
Connecting the FM/AM antennas
FM
HD Radio
GND
AM
75
D
OC
K
VIDEO
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
F
R
O
N
T
TRI
GG
ER
OUT
+12V
0
.1A MAX.
IN
REMOTE
O
U
T
HDMI
OUT
1
2
A
R
C
AR
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
CO
MP
O
NENT
VIDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
O
UT
P
R
P
B
Y
Indoor FM antenna
AM loop antenna
Position the AM antenna away from the receiver. The
wires of the AM antenna have no polarity.
You can connect either wire to the AM jack or the
GND jack.
Connecting the AM loop antenna
ReleaseInsertPress and hold
Improving FM reception
We recommend using an outdoor antenna. For more information, consult the nearest authorized
dealer.
Improving AM reception
Connect this unit to an outdoor antenna with a 16.4 – 32.8 ft. (5 – 10 m) vinyl-coated wire. Make
sure the AM loop antenna is still connected.
Connecting the GND jack can reduce noise. Connect the jack to a store-bought ground bar or copper
plate with a vinyl-covered wire and bury this new attachment in moist ground.
The GND jack is not to be connected to the ground socket of an electrical outlet.
CONNECTIONS
En 33
This unit is equipped with a Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) that adjusts the status, size, and volume balance of the speakers in order to provide an optimal sound field. Using
YPAO allows you to automatically configure settings, such as adjusting speaker output and acoustic parameters to suit your listening room (the room in which this unit is placed). J1
1
Check the following before using YPAO.
This unit
The headphones are removed.
TV
This unit is connected to the TV correctly.
The power is turned on.
The video input to which the video output from this unit has been
selected.
Subwoofer
The power is turned on.
Volume is set to approximately half, and the cross-over frequency (if
present) is set to maximum.
2
Place the supplied YPAO microphone at ear height in
your listening position.
Face the head of the YPAO microphone upwards.
3
Switch this unit on.
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
The amount of time for measurement varies from about two to
ten minutes according to settings. Be aware of the following
when using YPAO.
The test tone is output at high volume. Refrain from using this
function at night when it may be a nuisance to others.
Take care that the test tone does not frighten small children.
YPAO operations can be viewed on the front panel display or
TV screen.
VOLUME
MIN MAX
CROSSOVER/
HIGH CUT
MIN MAX
Subwoofer examples
When positioning the microphone, we recommend that you use
equipment that allows you to adjust the height (such as a tripod)
as a microphone stand. When using a tripod, use the tripod
screws to fix the microphone in place.
YPAO microphone
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : When you have changed the number of speakers or the locations in which they
are installed, first use YPAO to adjust the speaker balance.
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 34
4
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO
MIC jack on the front panel.
“Mic On. View ON SCREEN” appears on the front
panel display, and the following display appears on the
front panel display or TV screen.
5
Press kCursor B / C to select the “Multi
Position” and press kENTER to set the
number of listening positions to measure.
To measure at the multiple listening positions (up to 8),
press
kCursor B / C to select “Yes” and press
kENTER.
To measure at one listening position, press
kCursor B / C to select “No” and press kENTER.
kCursor B / C
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
PHONES
YPAO MIC
SILENT
CINEMA
TONE
CONTROL
TV
BD
DVD
PROG
R
SCE
N
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
PR
PL
ENTER to Start
YPAO
VOL.
“Multi Position” is set to “Yes” at initial factory
settings. It is not necessary to perform step 5 when
measuring at the multiple listening positions.
VOL.
MLT.Position>
YPAO
VOL.
This completes preparation. To achieve more accurate
results, take note of the following when measuring
acoustics.
It takes a few minutes to accurately measure acoustics
for one position. Keep the room as quiet as possible
while acoustics are measured.
Wait in a corner of the room, or leave it entirely, while
acoustics are measured to avoid creating an
obstruction between the speakers and the YPAO
microphone.
Continues to the
next page
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 35
6
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
the “Measure” and press
kENTER to start measurement.
Auto measurement starts in 10 seconds.
Display during measurement
When “Multi Position” is set to “No” in step 5
The following display appears when measurement
finishes without any problems.
Go to step 8.
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes” in step 5
The following display appears when measurement at the
first position finishes without any problems.
Go to step 7.
7
Replace the optimizer microphone at your
choosing position and press kENTER to
restart the automatic measurement.
Auto measurement restarts in 10 seconds.
Repeat step 7 until the measurement at all listening
positions are made.
kCursor B / C
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
D
I
S
PLA
Y
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
C
ODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
To start the measurement immediately, press
kENTER again.
To cancel the automatic setup and return to the
previous screen, press
kRETURN and then
kENTER.
VOL.
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
PR
PL
Progress 0%
YPAO
VOL.
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Save/Exit
YPAO
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
>Yes No
YPAO
VOL.
The following illustration shows how to place the
optimizer microphone to optimize the setup of this
unit for seven listening positions for example.
6 7
4 5
12 3
Continues to the
next page
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 36
The following display appears again when
measurement at the last position finishes without any
problems.
8
Press kCursor B / C to select “Save/Exit”
and press kENTER.
9
Press kCursor D / E to select “SAVE”
and press kENTER.
10
Press kENTER.
YPAO is automatically terminated. Disconnect the
YPAO microphone.
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
NOTE
If a problem occurs, an error message or report is
displayed either during or after acoustic measurement.
Refer to “When an error message is displayed during
measurement” (
p. 38), or “When a warning
message is displayed after measurement” (
p. 38) to
resolve the problem and measure acoustics with
YPAO again.
Result Displays the results of automatic
acoustics measurement. Refer to
“Reviewing and reloading automatic
setup parameters” for details (p. 37).
Save/Exit Applies the result to the speaker setup and
finishes the automatic measurement.
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Save/Exit
YPAO
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Select:Save
YPAO
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Disconnect Mic
YPAO
VOL.
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat. When you
have finished measuring, store the microphone out of
direct sunlight, and away from locations that may
experience high temperatures, such as on top of AV
equipment.
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 37
Reviewing and reloading automatic
setup parameters
The results of automatic acoustics measurement can be
reviewed once measurement is complete. Automatic
setup parameters can also be reloaded if you are not
satisfied with manually configured speaker setup and
sound adjustments.
1
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Result” and press kENTER immediately
after the automatic measurement.
The results of acoustics measurement are displayed.
a
List of menu items
Menu items available in the Result menu are displayed.
b Number of measurement
Indicates the number of measurements for multiple
listening positions.
c Diagram
Shows the speaker setup and sound adjustment as diagram.
d Message
Displays warning or error messages.
2
Select the desired menu item (or enable a
function) using kCursor B / C / D / E and
kENTER.
3
Press kRETURN to finish “Result” menu.
k
Cursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
ENTER
SCENE
R
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
NOTE
When automatic setup parameters are reloaded,
manually configured settings are cleared. To save
manually configured settings before reloading
automatic setup parameters, see “Prohibiting setting
changes” (
p. 103).
The “Result” menu can also be viewed from the
display shown after the YPAO microphone is
connected.
a
c
b
d
Wiring Displays the polarity of each connected
speaker.
“Normal” is displayed when the
polarity of the connected speaker is
normal.
Size Displays the size of the connected
speakers.
“Large” is displayed when the
connected speaker has the ability to
reproduce the low-frequency signals
effectively.
“Small” is displayed when the
connected speaker does not have the
ability to reproduce the low-frequency
signals effectively.
Distance Displays the distance from the listening
position to speakers. The unit for distance
can be switched between “ft” (feet) and
“m” (meter) by pressing kCursor D / E.
Level Displays the result of the adjustment of
each connected speaker output level.
Setup Reload Applies “Result” menu settings to this
unit.
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 38
When an error message is
displayed during measurement
See “Error messages” (p. 39) for instructions on
resolving the problem and measure acoustics again.
Check the error code displayed and use YPAO to
measure acoustics again as described below.
When “E-1,” “E-2,” “E-3,” “E-4” or “E-6” is
displayed
1
Press kENTER.
2
Press kCursor E to select “EXIT.
3
Press kENTER to terminate YPAO, and
switch the unit to standby mode.
4
Check that the speakers are properly
connected.
5
Turn on the unit and use YPAO again.
When “E-5,” “E-7,” “E-8” or “E-9” is displayed
1
Press kENTER.
2
Check that the environment is suitable for
accurate measurement.
3
Press kCursor E to select “RETRY.
4
Press kENTER to use YPAO again.
When “E-10” is displayed
1
Press kENTER.
2
Press kCursor E to select “EXIT.
3
Press kENTER to terminate YPAO.
4
Switch the unit to standby mode.
5
Turn on the unit and use YPAO again.
When a warning message is
displayed after measurement
See “Warning messages” (p. 40) for instructions on
resolving the problem. The speaker causing the problem
can be confirmed from the TV screen display.
To exit YPAO with some options
1
Use kCursor B / C to select “Save/Exit”
and press kENTER.
2
Use kCursor D / E to select one of the
following options and press kENTER.
SAVE:
Exits YPAO applying the results of measurement.
CANCEL:
Returns to the previous screen (warning message
screen).
EXIT:
Exits YPAO without saving the results.
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
ENTER
SCENE
R
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
NOTE
Although the results of acoustics measurement can be
applied when a warning message is displayed, optimal
sound will not be achieved. Resolving the problem
and using YPAO to measure acoustics again is
recommended.
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 39
Message list
When a warning message is displayed before
measurement
Error messages
NOTE
If the following messages appear, resolve the problems that have
occurred and carry out the measurement process again.
Connect MIC! The YPAO microphone is
not connected.
Connect the YPAO
microphone to the YPAO
MIC jack on the front
panel.
Unplug HP! The headphones are
connected.
Remove the headphones.
Memory Guard! The settings of this unit
are protected.
Set “Memory Guard” in
the Setup menu to “Off”
(p. 103).
E-1:
No Front SP
The unit was not able to
find the front channel.
Check that the left and
right front speakers are
connected correctly.
E-2:
No Sur. SP
The unit was only able to
find one of side of the
surround channels.
Check that the left and
right surround speakers
are connected correctly.
E-3:
No F.PRNS SP
The unit was only able to
find one of side of the
presence channels.
Check that the left and
right presence speakers
are connected correctly.
E-4:
SBRSBL
Only one surround back
speaker is connected and
only the right side
surround back channel
sound is detected.
When only one surround
back speaker is
connected, connect to the
left side (SINGLE)
terminal.
E-5:
Noisy
The noise is too loud,
preventing accurate
measurements from
being taken.
Measure again in quiet
surroundings. Turn off any
devices in the room that
may be emitting noise, or
place them further away
from the YPAO
microphone.
When this message is
displayed, selecting
“PROCEED” will allow
you to continue measuring.
However, we recommend
resolving the problem and
measuring again, as
continuing measurement
without doing so will not
give accurate results.
E-6:
Check Sur.
Even though surround
left and right speakers are
not connected, only the
surround back speakers
are connected.
When using surround back
speakers, connection of the
surround left/right
speakers is necessary.
E-7:
No MIC
The YPAO microphone
has been removed.
While measuring, take
care not to touch the
YPAO microphone.
E-8:
No Signal
The YPAO microphone
could not distinguish a
test tone.
Check that the YPAO
microphone has been
installed correctly.
Check that each speaker
has been connected and
installed correctly.
The YPAO microphone
or the YPAO MIC jack
may be broken. Inquire at
the retailer where you
purchased this unit, or the
nearest Yamaha service
center.
E-9:
User Cancel
You have carried out an
operation that has
cancelled the measuring
process.
Carry out the measuring
process again. Do not
operate this unit by, for
example, adjusting the
volume.
E-10:
Internal Error
An internal error has
occurred.
Carry out the measuring
process again. Contact a
Yamaha service center if
“E-10” is displayed
again.
CONNECTIONS
Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO)
En 40
Warning messages
W-1:
Out of Phase
The speakers displayed
are connected with the
opposite polarity.
Depending on the type of
speakers you are using
and the environment in
which you have them
installed, this message
may occur even if the
speakers are connected
correctly.
Depending on the type of
speakers, “W-1” may
display even if the
speakers are connected
correctly.
Check that the speaker
polarity + (positive), and
- (negative) are correct. If
these are connected
correctly, you can use the
speakers normally even
this message appears.
W-2:
Over 24m/80ft
The speakers displayed
are separated from the
listening position by
more than 24 m, and
cannot be adjusted
correctly.
Install the speakers with
24 m of the listening
position.
W-3:
Level Error
Volume level varies
greatly for individual
channels, and cannot be
adjusted correctly.
Check that all speakers
are installed in the same
surroundings.
Check that the speaker
polarity + (positive), and
- (negative) are correct.
We recommend the same
speakers or speakers with
as similar specifications
as possible.
Adjust the volume of the
subwoofer.
If “W-2” or “W-3” appears, you can apply measurement results,
but they will not give optimal results. We recommend that you
resolve the problem and carry out the measurement process
again.
En 41
PLAYBACK
1
Turn on external components (TV, DVD
player, etc.) connected to this unit.
2
Use the dInput selector to select the input
source.
The name of the selected input source is displayed for
a few seconds. J1
When DOCK, TUNER, or SIRIUS is selected, the
Content window is displayed (
p. 55).
3
Play the external component that you have
selected as the source input, or select a
radio station on the tuner.
Refer to the instruction manuals provided with the
external component for details on playback.
For details on the following operations, refer to the
corresponding pages:
“FM/AM tuning” (p. 56)
“Listening to Satellite Radio” (
p. 64)
“Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™”
(
p. 71)
“Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components”
(
p. 76)
4
Press uVOLUME +/- to adjust the volume.
To mute the output.
Press vMUTE to mute the audio output.
Press vMUTE again to unmute.
Selecting the active HDMI OUT jack
Use this function to select the HDMI OUT jack(s) used
to output signal.
Press rHDMI OUT repeatedly to select setting.
The HDMI output setting changes as follows.
Basic playback procedure
dInput selector
rHDMI OUT
uVOLUME +/-
vMUTE
VOLUME
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
1234
125
V-AUX
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI OUT
MULTI
5
1234
6
SIRIUSTUNER
SCENE
RETURN
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
ENTER
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
u
d
v
r
HDMI OUT 1+2 Outputs the signal at both the HDMI
OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks
simultaneously.
HDMI OUT 1 Outputs the signals at the HDMI OUT 1
jack.
HDMI OUT 2 Outputs the signals at the HDMI OUT 2
jack.
HDMI OUT OFF Any signals are not output at the HDMI
OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. Select
this setting when you do not use the video
monitor connected to one of the HDMI
OUT jacks.
The HDMI OUT jack that utilizes the HDMI Control
function can be selected with “Control Select”
(
p. 98).
The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be registered with
the SCENE function (
p. 43).
HDMI OUT 1+2
HDMI OUT OFF
HDMI OUT 1
HDMI OUT 2
J
1 : You can change the input source name displayed on the front
panel display as necessary (
p. 79).
En 42
PLAYBACK
Basic playback procedure
Adjusting high/low-frequency sound (Tone
control)
You can adjust the balance of the high-frequency range (Treble)
and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds output from the front
left and right speakers to obtain desired tone.
1
Press TONE CONTROL on the front panel repeatedly
to select “Treble” or “Bass.
The current setting is displayed on the front panel display.
2
Rotate PROGRAM selector to adjust the output level
in those frequency ranges.
The display returns to the previous display soon after you release
the key.
The tone control of the speakers or headphones can be set
separately. Set the headphone tone control with the headphones
connected.
PHONES
YPAO MIC
SILENT
CINEMA
TONE
CONTROL
STRAIGHT
TV
BD
DVD
CD
RADIO
INPUT
PROGRAM
SCENE
H
INFOZONE
CONTROL
ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
CATEGORY
TONE CONTROL
PROGRAM selector
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Treble +0.5dB
TONE
VOL.
Adjustable range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB
The tone control settings are not effective when this unit is in the
Pure Direct mode or “MULTI CH” is selected as an input source.
If you set the balance extremely off, sounds may not match those
from other channels well.
The tone control can also be adjusted in the OPTION menu
(
p. 52).
PLAYBACK
En 43
This unit has a SCENE function that allows you switch this unit on and change input sources, sound programs, and HDMI OUT with one key.
Four scenes are available for different uses, such as
playing movies or music. The following input sources,
sound programs, and HDMI OUT are provided as the
initial factory settings.
Registering input sources/sound
program/HDMI OUT
1
Use dInput selector to select the input
source you want to register.
2
Use the sSound selection keys to select
the sound program, Compressed Music
Enhancer mode, or HDMI OUT you want to
register.
3
Press the iSCENE key until “SET
Complete” appears on the front panel
display.
This unit is also equipped with a Yamaha digital sound field processing (DSP) chip. Multi-channel playback from almost any audio source can be enjoyed using a variety
of sound decoders and various sound field effect programs stored on the chip. Sound field effect programs built into this unit are called “sound programs.
Selecting sound programs and
sound decoders
This unit offers sound programs in many different
categories suitable for movies, music and other uses.
Choose a sound program that sounds best with the
source you are playing back, rather than relying on the
name or explanation of the program.
Changing input settings with a single key (SCENE function)
dInput selector
iSCENE
sSound selection keys
SCENE
ENHANCER
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
1234
125
V-AUX
MOVIE MUSIC
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADIO
DOCK
MULTI
5
1234
6
SIRIUSTUNER
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
SLEEP
PART Y
MU
T
E
ENTER
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
HDMI
OUT
[
A
]
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
i
s
SCENE Input
Sound
program
Compressed
Music
Enhancer
mode
HDMI
OUT
BD/
DVD
HDMI1 Drama Off HDMI
OUT 1+2
TV AV4 STRAIGHT On HDMI
OUT 1+2
CD AV3 STRAIGHT Off HDMI
OUT 1+2
RADIO TUNER STRAIGHT On HDMI
OUT 1+2
When changing “SCENE,” also change the external
component that the remote control operates (
p. 105).
Selecting a scene and editing the scene function are
also available in the SCENE menu (
p. 82).
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SET Complete
SCENE1
VOL.
SBL SBR
Release the key when “SET Complete” is displayed
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
Sound programs are stored for each input source.
When you change the input source, the sound program
previously selected for that input source is applied
again.
When you playback DTS Express sources or audio
signals with sampling frequency of higher than
96 kHz, the straight decoding mode (
p. 44) is
automatically selected.
When you playback DTS-HD sources with CINEMA
DSP, the DTS decoder is automatically selected.
Continues to the
next page
PLAYBACK
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
En 44
Selecting sound program (p. 47):
MOVIE category: Press sMOVIE repeatedly
MUSIC category: Press sMUSIC repeatedly
Selecting stereo reproduction:
Press sMUSIC repeatedly
Selecting surround decoder:
Press sSUR. DECODE repeatedly
Turning on Straight decoding mode:
Press sSTRAIGHT
Turning on Pure Direct mode (p. 46):
Press sPURE DIRECT
Turning on Compressed Music Enhancer
mode (
p. 46):
Press sENHANCER repeatedly
Enjoying unprocessed playback
(Straight decoding mode)
Use straight decoding mode when you want to playback
sound without sound field processing. You can playback
as follows in straight decoding mode.
2-channel sources such as CD
Stereo sound plays through the front left and right
speakers.
Multi-channel playback sources such as BD/
DVD
Plays back audio from a playback source without
applying sound field effects, using an appropriate
decoder to split the signal into multiple channels.
Press sSTRAIGHT to enable the straight
decoding mode.
Enjoying stereo playback
Select “2ch Stereo” from the sound programs when you
want to playback 2-channel stereo sound (from the front
speakers only), regardless of the playback source.
Selecting “2ch Stereo” will playback as follows for the
playback of CD and BD/DVD sources.
2-channel sources such as CD
Stereo sound plays back through the front speakers.
Multi-channel sources such as BD/DVD
Playback channels other than the front channels in the
playback source are mixed with the front channels and
played back through the front speakers.
Press sMUSIC repeatedly to select “2ch
Stereo.
s
Sound selection keys
sMOVIE
sMUSIC
sENHANCER
sSUR. DECODE
sSTRAIGHT
sPURE DIRECT
ENHANCER
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT
MOVIE MUSIC
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
SLEEP
PART Y
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
ENTER
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
s
You can use the speaker indicators on the front panel
display to check what speakers are currently
outputting sound (
p. 10).
You can adjust sound field elements (sound field
parameters) for each of the programs (
p. 85).
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Sci-Fi
MOVIE
VOL.
SBL SBR
Sound program categories
Program
To disable straight decoding mode, press
sSTRAIGHT again.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Straight
VOL.
SBL SBR
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Sci-Fi
MOVIE
VOL.
SBL SBR
Previously selected program
To disable stereo playback, press any of the
sSound selection keys to select a sound program
other than “2ch Stereo.
SW
L
R
2ch Stereo
MUSIC
VOL.
PLAYBACK
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
En 45
Enjoying sound programs without
surround speakers
This unit allows you to use virtual surround speakers to enjoy
sound field surround effects, even without any surround speakers
(Virtual CINEMA DSP mode). You can even enjoy surround sound
presence with just a minimal configuration of the front speakers
only.
This unit will switch to Virtual CINEMA DSP mode automatically
when surround speakers are unavailable. J1
Enjoying sound programs with
headphones
Even when headphones are connected, you can enjoy the
reproduction sound field presence with ease (SILENT CINEMA
mode). J2
Enjoying more spatial sound fields
(CINEMA DSP 3D mode)
CINEMA DSP 3D mode creates an intensive and accurate
stereoscopic sound field in the listening room.
Connection of presence speakers is recommended to take full
advantage of the effects of CINEMA DSP 3D mode. Do the
following steps. J3
Connect the presence speakers to the EXTRA SP jacks and set the
speakers to use (
p. 14).
Enable CINEMA DSP 3D in the OPTION menu (
p. 52).
When a sound program runs in CINEMA DSP 3D mode, the
CINEMA DSP 3D indicator on the front panel lights up.
Enjoying sound programs without
presence speakers
This unit allows you to use virtual presence speakers to create an
intensive and accurate stereoscopic sound field, even when no
presence speakers are connected (Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D
mode). You can even enjoy surround sound presence with front
speakers, center speaker, and surround speakers.
This unit automatically switches to Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D
mode when presence speakers are not available.
Do the following steps.
Connect the front speakers, center speaker, and surround speakers.
Enable center speaker and surround speakers in “Configuration”
(p. 92).
Enable CINEMA DSP 3D in the OPTION menu (
p. 52).
PL PR
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
3
Hall in Vienna
MUSIC
VOL.
SBL SBR
Lights up
J
1 : However, Virtual CINEMA DSP mode is not available under the following
conditions:
When headphones are connected to this unit.
When a “7ch Stereo” or “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected.
When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected.
J
2 : However, SILENT CINEMA mode is not available under the following
conditions:
When a “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected.
When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected.
J
3 : However, CINEMA DSP 3D mode is not available under the following
conditions:
When headphones are connected to this unit.
When a “7ch Stereo” or “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected.
When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected.
PLAYBACK
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
En 46
Enjoying Hi-Fi Sound Quality
(Pure Direct mode)
Use Pure Direct mode to enjoy the pure high fidelity
sound of the selected source. When Pure Direct mode is
enabled, this unit plays back the selected source with the
least circuitry. J1
Press sPURE DIRECT to turn Pure Direct mode
on. J2
Enjoying enhanced compression
artifacts (Compressed Music
Enhancer mode)
Compressed Music Enhancer mode improves the sound
enhancer near to the original depth and width of
compression artifacts. J3
This mode can be used along with any other DSP modes.
Press sENHANCER to turn Compressed Music
Enhancer mode on.
s
ENHANCER
sPURE DIRECT
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
ENTER
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
s
To disable Pure Direct mode, press
sPURE DIRECT again.
To disable Compressed Music Enhancer mode, press
sENHANCER again.
SW
C
L
SL SR
ENHANCER
R
Enhancer On
VOL.
SBL SBR
Lights up
J
1 : The following features are disabled in Pure Direct mode.
sound program, tone control, YPAO PEQ, and Adaptive DRC
displaying and operating the OPTION menu and Setup menu
J
2 : While Pure Direct mode is on, the front panel display screen turns
off in order to reduce noise. When turning Pure Direct mode off,
the screen returns on.
J
3 : However, Compressed Music Enhancer mode is not available in
the following audio:
Signals of which sampling rate is over 48kHz
High Definition stream
PLAYBACK
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
En 47
Sound programs
Category: MOVIE
Sound programs optimized for viewing video sources such as movies, TV programs, and games.
in the table indicates the sound program for CINEMA DSP.
Standard This program creates a sound field emphasizing the surround feeling without disturbing the
original acoustic positioning of multi-channel audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has
been designed with the concept of an ideal movie theater, in which the audience is
surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right and rear.
Spectacle This program represents the spectacular feeling of large-scale movie productions. It
reproduces a broad theater sound field that matches cinemascope and wider-screen movies
with an excellent dynamic range providing everything from very small sound effects to
large, impressive sounds.
Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest science
fiction and special effects-featuring movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically
created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialog, sound effects and
background music.
Adventure This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of action and adventure
movies. The sound field restrains reverberations but puts emphasis on reproducing a
powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The reproduced depth is also
restrained relatively to ensure the separation between audio channels and the clarity of the
sound.
Drama This sound field features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from
serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest but offer an
optimum 3D feeling, reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically
around clear words and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even
after long hours of viewing.
Mono Movie This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources such as a classic movie in
an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program produces the optimum expansion
and reverberation to the original audio to create a comfortable space with a certain sound
depth.
Sports This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety
programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts, the voices of the commentator and
sportscaster are positioned clearly at the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands
in an optimal space to offer the listeners a feeling of presence in the stadium.
Action Game This sound field is suitable for action games such as car racing, fighting games and FPS
games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are
right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration.
Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer mode for a more
dynamic sound field.
Roleplaying Game This sound field is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth
to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects
and dialog from a wide variety of scenes.
Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer mode for a more
dynamic sound field.
Music Video This sound field offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz
music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot live space thanks to the presence sound field
that emphasizes the vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments,
and to the surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.
PLAYBACK
Enjoying the desired sound field effect
En 48
Category: MUSIC
This sound field is suitable when listening to music sources such as CDs.
Category: SUR.DEC (Surround decode mode)
Select this program to playback sources with selected decoders. You can playback 2-channel audio
sources in up to 7-channels using a surround decoder.
Hall in Munich This sound field simulates a concert hall with approximately 2500 seats in Munich, using
stylish wood for the interior finishing as normal standards for European concert halls. Fine,
beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual
seat is at the center left of the arena.
Hall in Vienna This is an approximately 1700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is
traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections from
all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound.
Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a
palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber
music.
Cellar Club This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic,
live sound field features powerful sound as if the listener is in a row in front of a small stage.
The Roxy Theatre This is the sound field of a rock music live house in Los Angeles, with approximately 460
seats. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall.
The Bottom Line This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once.
The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant
sound.
2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2-channels. When multi-channel
signals are input, they are down mixed to 2-channels and output from the front left and right
speakers.
7ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you playback multi-channel
sources, this unit down-mixes the source to 2-channels, and then outputs the sound from all
speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at
parties, etc.
q Pro Logic Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic decoder. This is suitable for all kinds of audio
sources.
q PLIIx Movie /
q PLII Movie
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is
suitable for movies. J1
q PLIIx Music /
q PLII Music
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is
suitable for music. J1
q PLIIx Game /
q PLII Game
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is
suitable for games. J1
Neo:6 Cinema Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for movies.
Neo:6 Music Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for music.
J
1 : You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder in the following conditions:
When “Surround Back” is set to “None” (
p. 92).
When headphones are connected.
PLAYBACK
En 49
This unit features a sophisticated on-screen display (OSD) that helps you to control the amplifier function of this unit. With the OSD, you can view information of the
signals being input and the status of this unit. Visual guidance simplifies operations for menus.
Basic operations via the TV screen
display
This section describes basic operations for configuring
“Input,” “Scene” and “Sound Program” using the OSD.
Press jON SCREEN.
The ON SCREEN menu is displayed on the TV screen.
Selecting an input source
1
Use kCursor B / C to select “Input” and
press kENTER.
Input source icons are displayed at the bottom of the
TV screen.
2
Use kCursor D / E to select a Input source
press kENTER.
The input source is selected.
Using the TV display to control this unit
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
A TV screen is required to display the ON SCREEN
or OPTION menu. Refer to “Connecting a TV
monitor” for instructions on connecting a TV screen
(
p. 22).
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Press
kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON
SCREEN menu.
In addition to selecting an input source, detailed
settings for each input source can be configured. Refer
to “Configuring input sources (Input menu)” (
p. 78)
for details.
PLAYBACK
Using the TV display to control this unit
En 50
Selecting a scene
1
Use kCursor B / C to select “Scene” and
press kENTER.
Scene icons are displayed at the bottom of the TV
screen.
2
Use kCursor D / E to select a scene and
press kENTER.
The scene is selected.
Selecting a sound program
1
Use kCursor B / C to select “Sound
Program” and press kENTER.
Sound program icons are displayed at the bottom of the
TV screen.
2
Use kCursor D / E to select a sound
program and press kENTER.
The sound program is selected.
RETURN
ENTER
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
1
0
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
PO
P-U
P
MENU
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SET
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
T
UN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Press
kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON
SCREEN menu.
Refer to “Changing input settings with a single key
(SCENE function)” (
p. 43) for details on the default
scene settings.
Detailed SCENE function settings can be edited. Refer
to “Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu)”
(
p. 82) for details.
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Press
kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON
SCREEN menu.
Refer to “Enjoying the desired sound field effect”
(
p. 43) for various sound programs.
You can configure the detailed settings for each sound
program. Refer to “Setting sound program parameters
(Sound Program menu)” (
p. 85) for details.
NOTES
Menus can be operated and the status of this unit
confirmed from the following three main displays.
ON SCREEN menu (
p. 78)
OPTION menu (
p. 51)
Content window (
p. 55)
These menus and status features can be used to
configure more various functions in addition to
selecting “Input,” “Scene” and “Sound Program.
Refer to each references for details on menus and
status.
PLAYBACK
En 51
This unit has a unique OPTION menu for each input source. OPTION menus can be used to enable features such as volume trim for compatible input sources or to display
audio/video data.
OPTION menu display and setup
OPTION menu operations are displayed on the front
panel display or TV screen. TV display is used here to
explain operation.
1
Use dInput selector to select an input
source to which options will be applied.
2
Press tOPTION.
The OPTION menu is displayed.
The displayed OPTION menu settings differ
depending on the input source.
For more information, refer to the “OPTION menu” on
the next page.
3
Use kCursor B / C to select the desired
setting and press kENTER.
Parameters of the selected item are displayed.
4
Use kCursor B / C / D / E to select the
desired item (or enable a function).
5
Press tOPTION to close the OPTION menu.
Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)
dInput selector
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
tOPTION
RETURN
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
1234
125
V-AUX
ENTER
DOCK
MULTI
OPTION
5
1234
6
SIRIUSTUNER
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
HDMI
OUT
O
N
SC
REE
N
[
A
]
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
t
d
k
OPTION menu
Press kRETURN to display the previous screen or
close the OPTION menu.
The OPTION menu may close automatically when
some functions are enabled.
The keys on the remote control may not respond for a
few seconds after the OPTION menu is closed.
Should this occur, select the input source again.
PLAYBACK
Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)
En 52
OPTION menu
The following items are provided for each input source. J1
Adjusting high/low-frequency sound
Tone Control
Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH
You can adjust the balance of the high-frequency range (Treble)
and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds output from the front
left and right speakers to obtain desired tone.
HDMI1-5 Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Extended
Surround
Volume Trim
AV1-4 Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Extended
Surround
Volume Trim
AV5-6 Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Vo l u m e Tr i m
AUDIO1-2 Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Vo l u m e Tr i m
V-AUX Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Extended
Surround
Volume Trim
TUNER Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Vo l u m e Tr i m
SIRIUS Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim
DOCK
(iPod)
Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Shuffle J3
Repeat J3
DOCK
(Bluetooth)
Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D
Mode
Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Pairing
Connect/
Disconnect
MULTI CH Volume Trim
Adjustable range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB
The tone control of the speakers or headphones can be set
separately. Set the headphone tone control with the headphones
connected.
TONE CONTROL
on the front panel can also be used (p. 42).
J
1 : When “Tone Control,” “Adaptive DRC,” “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode,
“Dialogue Lift,” or “Extended Surround” is adjusted for an input source, the
same value is applied to other input sources and “ALL” is displayed on the
front panel display. When settings specific to a certain input source are
selected, the input source name is displayed on the front panel display. If the
name of the input source has been changed (
p. 79), the original name of the
input source is displayed.
J
2 : “Dialogue Lift” can be adjusted only when the presence speakers are available.
J
3 : Not available for Yamaha iPod wireless receiver.
PLAYBACK
Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)
En 53
Auto-adjusting the sound level to make
even low volumes more audible
Adaptive DRC
Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH
Adjusts the dynamic range in conjunction with the volume level
(from minimum to maximum). When you play audio at night or at
low volumes, it is a good idea to set parameter to “On.J1
When “On” is selected, the dynamic range is adjusted as follows.
If the volume level is low, the dynamic range is narrow.
If the volume level is high, the dynamic range is wide.
Enjoying more spatial sound fields
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode
Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH
When CINEMA DSP 3D is enabled, set whether to use sound
programs in CINEMA DSP 3D mode (
p. 45).
Adjusts the vertical position of dialogues
Dialogue Lift
Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH
Adjusts the vertical position of center sound such as dialogues
when presence speakers are used. Increasing this parameter raises
the position.
If the dialog seems to come out from a lower position than the
video monitor screen, increase this parameter.
“0” (default) corresponds to the lowest position and “5” to the
highest position.
Selecting the 5.1-channel signal playback
method
Extended Surround
Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-4, V-AUX J2
Selects whether to reproduce 5.1-channel input signals in 6.1- or
7.1-channel when surround back speakers are used.
On Adjusts the dynamic range automatically.
Off (Default) Does not adjust the dynamic range automatically.
On
Off
On
Off
Input Level Input Level
Volume: low Volume: high
Output Level
Output Level
“Dialogue Lift” can be adjusted only when the presence speakers
are available.
You cannot move the dialog position lower than the default
setting.
The ideal dialog
position
Move up to the ideal
dialog position
Auto (Default) Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if a
flag for reproducing surround back channel is present,
and reproduces the signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel.
q PLIIx Movie Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie decoder whether or not
surround back channel signals are contained. You can
select this parameter when two surround back
speakers are connected.
q PLIIx Music Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel
using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music decoder whether
or not surround back channel signals are contained.
You can select this parameter when one or two
surround back speakers are connected.
EX/ES Automatically selects the most suitable decoder for
input signals whether or not the flag for reproducing
surround back channel is present, and always
reproduces signals in 6.1-channel.
Off Always reproduces original channels whether or not
the flag for reproducing surround back channel is
present.
J
1 : “Adaptive DRC” is also effective when you use headphones.
J
2 : AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are also available when “Audio Return Channel” is on,
and the input source is used for “TV Audio Input.
PLAYBACK
Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)
En 54
Adjusting volume between input sources
Volume Trim
Input source: All
Reduces any change in volume when switching between input
sources by correcting volume differences in each input source. You
can adjust this parameter for each input source.
Shuffle playback with iPod/iPhone
Shuffle
Input source: DOCK (iPod) J1
Plays back songs or albums in random order. When the shuffle
function is enabled, “ ” appears on the TV screen.
Repeat playback with iPod/iPhone
Repeat
Input source: DOCK (iPod) J1
Plays songs or albums repeatedly. When the repeat function is
enabled, “ (One)” or “ (All)” appears on the TV screen.
Connect / Disconnect Bluetooth
component
Connect
Disconnect
Input source: DOCK (Bluetooth)
Switches communication with a Bluetooth component on and off
(
p. 76).
Pairing Bluetooth component
Pairing
Input source: DOCK (Bluetooth)
Performs pairing of this unit and a Bluetooth component (p. 76).
Adjustable range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB
Default setting 0.0 dB
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB steps
Off The shuffle function is turned off.
Songs Plays songs back in random order.
Albums Plays albums back in random order.
Off The repeat function is turned off.
One Plays a song back repeatedly.
All When all songs have completed playback, returns to
the start and repeats playback.
J
1 : Not available for Yamaha iPod wireless receiver.
PLAYBACK
En 55
When DOCK, TUNER, or SIRIUS is selected, the Content window is displayed on the TV screen. Playback style for iPod, functions for FM/AM tuner, and SIRIUS
Satellite Radio tuner can be set in the Content window.
Displaying the Content window on
the TV screen
Press dDOCK, dTUNER or dSIRIUS to display
the Content window.
The Content window consists of two main displays, the
Now Playing view and the Content browse view.
Below is the example of the Now playing view for TUNER.
a Image display
Icon for each input source or album art is displayed.
b Information display
Information on the current input source is displayed.
c Screen button area
Buttons to operate each input source are displayed here.
These buttons vary depending on the selected input. For
details on operations for each input, see the following.
FM/AM tuner (
p. 58)
HD Radio tuner (
p. 60)
SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner (
p. 64)
iPod (
p. 72)
Switching the display between the
Now Playing view and the Content
browse view
You can switch the display between the Now Playing
view and the Content browse view by the following
methods.
Press lDISPLAY to cycle between the Now Playing
view and the Content browse view.
In the Now Playing view, press
kENTER and use
kCursor B / C to select the icon. Then press
kENTER to switch to the Content browse view.
In the Content browse view, press
kCursor E and use
kCursor B / C to select the icon. Then press
kENTER to switch to the Now Playing view.
Confirming and operating input sources from the Content window
dDOCK
dTUNER
dSIRIUS
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
lDISPLAY
ENTER
DISPLAY
DOCK
SIRIUSTUNER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
k
l
A TV screen is required to display the Content
window. Refer to “Connecting a TV monitor” for
instructions on connecting a TV monitor (
p. 22).
bac
In the Now playing view, press kENTER and use
kCursor B / C to select the button. Then press
kENTER to execute the selection.
In the Content browse view, press
kCursor E and
use
kCursor B / C to select the button. Then press
kENTER to execute the selection.
Press
kRETURN repeatedly to exit from the
operation.
Now playing view
Content browse view
or
lDISPLAY
or
lDISPLAY
PLAYBACK
En 56
Selecting a frequency for reception
(Normal tuning)
1
Press dTUNER to switch to the tuner input.
2
Press eFM or eAM to select a band to
receive.
3
Use eTUN./CH H / I to set a frequency to
receive.
eTUN./CH H
Increases the frequency. Press and hold this key for
longer than a second to search automatically for a station
on a higher frequency than the current one. J1
e
TUN./CH I
Decreases the frequency. Press and hold this key for
longer than a second to search automatically for a station
on a lower frequency than the current one. J1
FM/AM tuning
dTUNER
eFM
eAM
eMEMORY
eTUN./CH H / I
mNumeric keys
wPRG SELECT
FM
MEMORY
AM
7856
90
1234
TUNER
TUN./CH
PRG SELECT
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
10
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
I
NF
O
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
CATEGORY
d
m
w
e
When using the FM/AM tuner, adjust the direction of
the FM/AM antenna connected to this unit to get the
best reception.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
FM87.5 MHz
VOL.
SBL SBR
Entering a frequency number
In normal tuning mode, use the mNumeric keys to
enter a frequency. Leave the decimal point out when
entering a number. J2
For example, enter as follows to select a station on
98.5 MHz.
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
FM98.5 MHz
STEREO
TUNED
HD
VOL.
Lights up when a broadcast
is received from a station
Lights up when a stereo
broadcast is received
Lights up when a broadcast is received from
a HD Radio station (p. 60)
9 8
5
Registering stations manually (Manual
Preset)
Select stations manually and register them as presets
individually.
1
Tune in to the station you want to
register, referring to “Selecting a
frequency for reception (Normal
tuning).J3
2
Use one of the following methods to
register the station you are currently
receiving.
Registering to a preset number to which
no station is registered
Press eMEMORY for 3 seconds or longer.
The station will be registered automatically to the
lowest open preset number (or the next number after
the one registered most recently).
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
01:FM98.5 MHz
MEMORY
VOL.
SBL SBR
Registered frequencies
J
1 : When searching for a station, release the key once the search has
started.
J
2 : “Wrong Station!” appears on the front panel display when you
enter a frequency that is out of receivable range. Make sure that
the frequency entered is correct.
J
3 : When registering a sub-audio program “HD2” to “HD8” of the
FM HD Radio station, press
wPRG SELECT to select the
desired audio program.
PLAYBACK
FM/AM tuning
En 57
eMEMORY
ePRESET F / G
mNumeric keys
MEMORY
PRESET
7856
90
1234
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
ENTER
10
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
AM
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
m
e
Designating a preset number for
registration
Press eMEMORY once, to display “Manual Preset”
on the front panel display. After a small wait, the
preset number that the station has been registered to
will appear.
Press ePRESET F / G to select the preset number
to register the station to, and then press eMEMORY
to register.
To select a registered station, press
ePRESET F / G to select the preset number
of the station. J1
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
01:Empty
985
VOL.
SBL SBR
Preset number
The newly registered frequency
Empty, or the frequency
registered most previously
Blinks
J
1 : To select a station by selecting a preset number, use the
mNumeric keys to enter the preset number of the station you
want to listen. When an invalid number is entered, “Wrong Num.”
appears on the front panel display. Check that you have entered
the correct number.
PLAYBACK
FM/AM tuning
En 58
Confirming and operating the
FM/AM tuner from the Content
window
The station currently received can be confirmed from the
menu displayed on the TV screen. Various FM/AM tuner
operations can be performed from the Content window
rather than controls on the front panel display. The
Content window is displayed when dTUNER is
pressed.
You can operate the FM/AM tuner from the Now Playing
view or the Content browse view.
Operating from the Now playing
view
a Tuned indicator
Lights up when a station is received.
b Stereo indicator
Lights up when a stereo broadcast is received. When
“Audio Mode” is set to “Mono,” the indicator does not
light.
c Preset number
The selected preset number is displayed.
d Band
The selected band (FM or AM) is displayed.
e Frequency
The frequency currently received is displayed.
f Frequency guide
The frequency currently received is displayed as a cursor
on the bar.
g Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Now playing view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Now playing view
To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select
the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER.
Manual Tuning
You can tune in to a desired FM/AM station by
specifying its frequency.
Preset Select
You can call preset stations.
Utility
Scroll
Switches the scroll target.
Browse
Switches the display to the Content browse view.
d
TUNER
kCursor B / C
kENTER
ENTER
TUNER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
k
a b
e
f
d
c
g
FM Switches a band to FM.
AM Switches a band to AM.
Tuning - Decreases the frequency.
Tuning + Increases the frequency.
Auto - Automatically searches for a station on a
lower frequency than the current station.
Auto + Automatically searches for a station on a
higher frequency than the current station.
Direct Selects the frequency manually.
Memory Registers the station currently received as
a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations
can be registered.
PRESET - Selects the previous preset number.
PRESET + Selects the next preset number.
Preset -8 Returns the previous page.
Preset +8 Goes to the next page.
Direct Selects a station directly by entering the
preset number.
Memory Registers the station currently received as
a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations
can be registered.
FM Mode Selects “Stereo” or “Mono” when
receiving the FM station.
Continues to the
next page
PLAYBACK
FM/AM tuning
En 59
Operating from the Content browse
view
a Preset station list
The list of preset stations is displayed.
b Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Content browse view
To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then
select the desired one with kCursor B / C and
kENTER.
Utility
1 Page Up
1 Page Down
Scrolls the list to the next or previous page.
Now Playing
Switches the display to the Now playing view.
k
Cursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
Auto Preset Detects stations with a strong signal and
automatically registers up to 40 stations,
beginning with the next number after the
current number.
Clear Preset Clears registration of the preset station
currently selected.
Clear All Preset Clears registration of all preset stations.
b
a
PLAYBACK
En 60
HD Radio technology is a new technology that enables FM and AM radio stations to broadcast programs digitally. Digital broadcasting provides listeners with radically
improved audio quality and reception as well as new data services. Furthermore, supplemental program services allow listeners to select from up to 8 HD Radio programs
multicast on a single FM HD Radio channel. For further information on HD Radio technology, visit “http://www.ibiquity.com/”.
This unit is equipped with an HD Radio reception feature, facilitating CD quality FM broadcasts as well as analog FM stereo quality AM broadcasts. In addition, this unit
can receive both audio and data (such as song titles, artist names, program types, and comments) from all HD Radio programs (HD1 to HD8).
Selecting HD Radio™ audio
programs
The HD indicator lights up in the front panel display
when this unit is tuned into an HD Radio station. In this
state, you can select the desired audio program if the
selected FM HD Radio station provides multiple audio
programs (up to 8).
When multiple audio programs are
provided
Press wPRG SELECT b / a repeatedly to
select the desired audio programs.
Audio programs can also be selected using
mNumeric keys (1-8) and mENT when this unit is in
the automatic or manual tuning mode. When the selected
audio program is not available currently, “HDx Off” (“x”
indicates the program number) appears.
When only one audio program is
provided
If this unit is tuned into an FM HD Radio station
including only one audio program or an AM HD Radio
station, you cannot select audio programs.
Behavior of the display
This unit automatically shows the HD Radio information
(call sign, etc) on the front panel display after 3 seconds.
You can switch HD Radio information to be displayed
(
p. 61).
Using HD Radio™ features
mNumeric keys
mENT
wPRG SELECT b / a
7856
90
1234
ENT
PRG SELECT
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
10
R
EC
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
m
w
The tuning method for HD Radio stations are same as
analog FM/AM radio stations; however, you only tune
into the analog part of a hybrid HD Radio station
while this unit is in the monaural tuning mode
(
p. 63).
This unit is capable of receiving both hybrid and all-
digital HD Radio station signals. However, this unit
may not automatically receive all-digital FM station
signals and the automatic tuning operation may stop.
In this case, enter the frequency of the desired all-
digital FM HD Radio station directly by using
mNumeric keys (p. 56).
When reception for an audio program ceases, the HD
indicator disappears from the front panel display and
HD1 is automatically selected after approximately 20
seconds.
Some audio programs may not contain data programs
depending on the broadcasting station and the time
period.
VOL.
SW
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
LR
SL SR
SBL SBR
FM88.9MHz1
HD 1/3
HD
Audio program number (absolute)
Lights up
Audio program number (relative/total)
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
STEREO
TUNED
FM87.5MHz
HD
VOL.
SBL SBR
HD
HD
Lights up
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
STEREO
TUNED
WXYZ-FM
889-1
VOL.
SBL SBR
HD
Frequency
Audio program number
Call Sign
PLAYBACK
Using HD Radio™ features
En 61
Using the iTunes Tagging
This unit is equipped with the iTunes Tagging that
enables HD Radio listeners to “tag” songs for
subsequent preview and purchase on iTunes. For details
on the iTunes Tagging, visit “http://www.ibiquity.com/”.
1
Tune into an HD Radio station and select
HD Radio audio program (if available).
If the selected HD Radio program (or song being
played)
supports the iTunes Tagging, the TAG
indicator lights up on the front panel display.
2
While a song you want to tag is being
played back, press wTAG.
If a song is tagged, “StorageSuccess” and the number
of stored iTunes Tagging information files (up to 50)
appear in the front panel display.
This unit transmits the “tag” data to the iPod/iPhone if an
iPod/iPhone that supports iTunes Tagging is placed in
the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12, sold
separately) connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit.
Otherwise, this unit stores the “tag” data (up to 50) in the
internal memory and will transmit it next time your iPod/
iPhone is placed in the dock.
Displaying the HD Radio™
information
You can display the HD Radio information on the front
panel display. J
1
Press fINFO repeatedly to toggle the HD Radio
information display modes as shown below.
Back toCall Sign
Display example (DSP Program)
f
INFO
wTAG
INFO
TAG
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
f
w
“Insufficient Data” is displayed on the front panel
display if tagging is not possible.
If a status or error message is displayed on the front
panel, see “iTunes Tagging” (
p. 121).
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
STEREO
TUNED
WXYZ-FM
889-1
TAG
VOL.
SBL SBR
HD
TAG
Li
g
ht
s up
Call Sign
Call sign, frequency, audio program number (absolute)
Category
Program category, frequency, audio program number
(absolute)
Artist / Song
Artist name, song title, frequency, audio program
number (absolute)
Album
Album title, frequency, audio program number (absolute)
Tag Info
The number of iTunes Tagging information files stored
in the internal memory, frequency, audio program
number (absolute)
DSP Program
Current sound field program (p. 47), frequency,
audio program number (absolute)
Audio Decoder
Current audio decoder (p. 48), frequency, audio
program number (absolute)
Frequency
Frequency, audio program number (absolute), audio
program number (relative/total)
STEREO
TUNED
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
Straight
889-1
VOL.
SBL SBR
HD
J
1 : If the HD Radio information contains a character that cannot be
recognized by this unit, the character will be displayed with a
space.
When an information is unavailable, “––––” appears.
PLAYBACK
Using HD Radio™ features
En 62
Confirming and operating the
HD Radio™ tuner from the Content
window
A HD Radio station currently received can be confirmed
from the menu displayed on the TV screen. Various HD
Radio operations can be performed from the Content
window rather than controls on the front panel display.
The Content window is displayed when dTUNER is
pressed.
You can operate the HD Radio from the Now Playing
view or the Content browse view.
Operating from the Now playing
view
a HOLD indicator
Lights up when
lHOLD is pressed to activate the hold
function. The artist name and song title currently received
will remain displayed. Press
lHOLD again to cancel the
hold function.
b TAG indicator
Lights up when the selected station supports the iTunes
Tagging.
c Preset number
The selected preset number is displayed.
d Band
The selected band (FM or AM) is displayed.
e HD Radio indicator
Lights up when receiving the HD Radio station.
f Tuned indicator
Lights up when a station is received.
g Stereo indicator
Lights up when a stereo broadcast is received. When
Audio mode” is set to “Mono,” the indicator does not
light.
h Frequency
The frequency currently received is displayed.
i Frequency guide
The frequency currently received is displayed as a cursor
on the bar.
j Channel Name
The channel name currently received is displayed.
k Channel Category
The category of the channel is displayed.
l Artist Name
The artist name of the current song is displayed.
m Song Title
The title of the current song is displayed.
n Album Name
The album name of the current song is displayed.
You can operate the HD Radio from the Now Playing view
or the Content browse view.
o Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Now Playing view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Now Playing view
To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select
the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER.
Manual Tuning
You can tune in to a desired FM/AM station by
specifying its frequency.
Preset Select
You can call preset stations registered.
d
TUNER
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
lHOLD
ENTER
TUNER
HOLD
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
k
l
b
d
g
i
f
h
j
k
l
m
n
c
e
a
o
FM Switches a band to FM.
AM Switches a band to AM.
Tuning - Decreases the frequency.
Tuning + Increases the frequency.
Auto - Automatically searches for a station on a
lower frequency than the current station.
Auto + Automatically searches for a station on a
higher frequency than the current station.
Direct Selects the frequency manually.
Memory Registers the station currently received as
a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations
can be registered.
Program - Select the previous program of the HD
Radio.
Program + Select the next program of the HD Radio.
Hold Activate the hold function. The artist
name and song title currently received
will remain displayed.
Tag Applies the iTunes Tagging.
Preset - Selects the previous preset number.
Preset + Selects the next preset number.
Preset -8 Returns the previous page.
Preset +8 Goes to the next page.
Direct Selects a station directly by entering the
preset number.
Memory Registers the station currently received as
a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations
can be registered.
Hold Activate the hold function. The artist
name and song title currently received
will remain displayed.
Tag Applies the iTunes Tagging.
Continues to the
next page
PLAYBACK
Using HD Radio™ features
En 63
Utility
Scroll
Switches the scroll target.
Browse
Switches the display to the Content browse view.
Operating from the Content browse
view
a Preset station list
The list of preset stations is displayed.
b Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Content browse view
To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then
select the desired one with kCursor B / C and
kENTER.
Utility
1 Page Up
1 Page Down
Scrolls the list to the next or previous page.
Now Playing
Switches the display to the Now Playing view.
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
Audio mode Selects “Auto” or “Mono” when receiving
the FM (or HD Radio) station.
Auto: Stereo reception. HD radio
program is received by priority.
Automatically switches to
monaural reception when a
monaural station is received.
Mono: Monaural reception. Reception is
better in monaural mode. HD
Radio program is not received.
b
a
Auto Preset Detects the stations with strong signals
and register up to 40 stations
automatically to the next number after the
one being received.
Clear Preset Clears registration for a preset station
currently selected.
Clear All Preset Clears registration for all preset stations.
PLAYBACK
En 64
To listen to Satellite Radio, you’ll need to connect a SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner (sold separately) to your Sirius-Ready receiver. SIRIUS Satellite Radio is available to residents of the US (except
Alaska and Hawaii) and Canada.
Satellite Radio delivers a variety of commercial-free music from categories ranging from Pop, Rock, Country, R&B, Dance, Jazz, Classical and many more plus coverage of all the top professional and
college sports including play by play games from select leagues and teams. Additional programming includes expert sports talk, uncensored entertainment, comedy, family programming, local traffic
and weather and news from your most trusted sources.
Once you’ve purchased a SIRIUS tuner you’ll need to activate it and subscribe to begin enjoying the service. Easy to follow installation and setup instructions are provided with the SIRIUS tuner. There
are a variety of programming packages available, including the option of adding “The Best of XM” programming to the SIRIUS service. The “Best of XM” service is not available to SIRIUS Canada
subscribers at this time. Please check with SIRIUS Canada for any updates using the numbers and web address below.
Family friendly packages are also available to restrict channels featuring content that may be inappropriate for children.
To subscribe to SIRIUS, U.S. and Canadian customers can call 1-888-539-SIRI (1-888-539-7474) or visit sirius.com (US) or siriuscanada.ca (Canada).
Connecting the SiriusConnect™ tuner
Connect the SiriusConnect tuner (sold separately) to the SIRIUS
jack on the rear panel of this unit. For details, see the instruction
manuals provided with the SiriusConnect tuner.
Listening to Satellite Radio
SIRIUS Radio Legal
SIRIUS and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. All other marks and logos are the property of their respective owners. All rights reserved. SIRIUS
subscription sold separately. Taxes and a one-time activation fee may apply. SIRIUS tuner required (sold separately) to receive the SIRIUS service. All programming and fees subject to change. It is prohibited
to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, hack, manipulate or otherwise make available any technology or software incorporated in receivers compatible with the SIRIUS Satellite Radio System.
Service not available in Alaska or Hawaii.
SIRIUS
DOC
K
(
TV
)
A
V
3
A
V 4
A
V 5
A
V 6
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
O
PTI
C
AL
V
IDE
O
A
V
OU
T
H
DMI
OU
T
1
2
A
R
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABLE
ANTENNA
FM
HD Radio
G
ND
AM
7
5
O
PTI
C
A
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
SiriusConnect Tuner and the antenna
(sold separately)
To the AC wall outlet
To ensure optimal reception of the SIRIUS Satellite Radio
signals, the antenna of the SiriusConnect tuner must be placed at
or near a window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. The
orientation of the antenna for the best reception differs depending
on the area. Refer to the instruction manuals provided with the
SiriusConnect tuner for the installation of the antenna. You can
mount it indoors or outdoors.
Use the Antenna information on the front panel display or the
SIRIUS information screen on the TV screen (
p. 69) to check
the antenna reception level and adjust the orientation of the
antenna.
You need to connect the SiriusConnect tuner to the AC wall
outlet.
NOTES
If “CHECK SR TUNER” orANTENNA ERROR” appears on
the front panel display, the connection of the SiriusConnect tuner
or antenna is incorrect. In such cases, check the connection of the
SiriusConnect tuner and the antenna.
If “NOT SUPPORTED” appears on the front panel display, this
unit does not support the connected SiriusConnect tuner.
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 65
Activating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
subscription
Before using the SIRIUS Satellite Radio feature, you
need to activate your SIRIUS Satellite Radio
subscription. To activate the subscription you need the
Sirius ID which is uniquely assigned to the
SiriusConnect tuner. Sirius ID is 12-digit number which
is indicated on the package of the SiriusConnect tuner
and on the label of the SiriusConnect tuner. Sirius ID is
also configured on the front panel display when you tune
into the SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel “0.
Displaying the Sirius ID of your
SiriusConnect tuner
1
Press dSIRIUS.
2
Press m0 and then mENT to display the
Sirius ID of your SiriusConnect tuner.
“000 Sirius ID” and “xxxxxxxxxxxx”
(“xxxxxxxxxxxx” indicates the 12-digit Sirius ID of
your SiriusConnect tuner) appears alternately on the
front panel display.
Write down the Sirius ID in the space provided below.
ID:________________________________________
3
Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to activate
your subscription.
SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
operations
1
Press dSIRIUS to select “SIRIUS” as the
input source.
The SIRIUS indicator lights up on the front panel
display and the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information
(such as channel number, channel name, category,
artist name, or song title) for the currently selected
channel appears on the front panel display. J1
2
Search for a channel by using one of the
SIRIUS Satellite Radio search modes.
All channel search mode
Selects a channel from the all channel list (
p. 66).
Category search mode
Selects a channel by category (
p. 66).
Direct number access mode
Selects a channel directly by entering the channel
number (
p. 66).
Preset search mode
Selects a channel from the preset channels (
p. 67).
You can preset channels by registering them to specific
numbers, and later just select those numbers to tune in.
dSIRIUS
m0
mENT
0
ENT
SIRIUS
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
m
SIRIUS Satellite Radio online information
Contact for activation
URL: https://activate.siriusradio.com/
Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-7474)
Status messages appear on the front panel display and
the TV screen during the activation. For details, see
“SIRIUS Satellite Radio™” (
p. 121). Once the
activation is finished, “SUB UPDATED” appears.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
184Weather
ALL
VOL.
SBL SBR
Channel number Channel name
NOTES
Before activating your subscription, you can only
select “184” or “000.
If a status message or an error message appears on the
front panel display or TV screen, refer to
“SIRIUS
Satellite Radio™” (
p. 121).
SIRIUS Satellite Radio information can be displayed
on the front panel display and the TV screen (
p. 69).
If you tune into a channel that you do not subscribe,
“CALL SIRIUS on the front panel display” or “CALL
888-539-SIRIUS TO SUBSCRIBE” appears on the
TV screen.
J
1 : When you select “SIRIUS” as the input source, this unit
automatically calls the previously selected channel.
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 66
All channel search mode
Press eTUN./CH H / I repeatedly to search for
a channel within all channels.
Category search mode
1
Press eCATEGORY D / E to select the
channel category.
When you select the category, the first channel in the
category is selected.
2
While “CAT” is displayed on the front panel
display, press eTUN./CH H / I repeatedly
to search for a channel within the selected
channel category.
Direct number access mode
Press the mNumeric keys to enter the desired
three-digit channel number.
For example, to enter the number 123, press “1,” “2” and
then “3” of the mNumeric keys.
Registering and recalling the
SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ channels
Up to 40 SIRIUS Satellite Radio channels can be
registered as preset channels.
Registering preset channels
1
Search for a channel to be registered.
For details on searching channels, refer to the
following pages.
All channel search mode (p. 66)
Category search mode (
p. 66)
Direct number access mode (
p. 66)
2
Use one of the following methods to
register the channel currently received.
Registering to a preset number for which
no channel has been registered
Press and hold eMEMORY for at least 2 second.
The channel will be automatically registered to the
lowest available preset number (or the next number after
the last to which a channel was registered).
e
TUN./CH H / I
eCATEGORY D / E
eMEMORY
mNumeric keys
mENT
FM
MEMORY
AM
7856
90
1234
ENT
TUN./CH
CATEGORY
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
10
R
EC
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
H
DMI
O
UT
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
I
NF
O
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
e
m
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and
holding
eTUN./CH H / I.
You can skip channels to the previous or next category
by pressing
eCATEGORY D / E.
If you don’t operate within 10 seconds, the category
search mode returns to “ALL (All Channel Search).
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and
holding eTUN./CH H / I.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
001Hits 1
ALL
VOL.
SBL SBR
All channel search mode
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
Pop
CAT001
VOL.
SBL SBR
Category
search mode
The first channel in the category
Category name
NOTE
This unit skips the following channels in all channel
search mode or category search mode. This is not a
malfunction.
channels that are locked (p. 69)
channels that are not currently in service
channels that you do not subscribe to
When entering a one-digit or two-digit channel
number, enter the number using the
mNumeric
keys and then press
mENT to confirm your entry.
This unit automatically accepts your entry if you do
not press
mENT within a few seconds after entering
the number.
If the selected channel is locked, “PIN:___” appears
on the front panel display. Enter the 4-digit Parental
Lock code number by using the
mNumeric keys or
press
mENT to cancel (p. 69).
If the selected channel is not available, an advisory
message may appear. For details, refer to “SIRIUS
Satellite Radio™” (
p. 121).
If this unit is in preset search mode, a preset number is
selected instead of a channel number when you press
the
mNumeric keys. To switch to direct number
access mode, press
eTUN./CH H / I.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
P01:001Preset
MEMORY
VOL.
SBL SBR
Preset number Registered channel
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 67
Designating a preset number for
registration
Press eMEMORY once.
Press ePRESET F / G to select the preset number to
which the channel will be registered and then press
eMEMORY to register.
Recalling a preset channel (Preset
Search mode)
Specify preset numbers to recall registered channels.
Press ePRESET F / G to change the preset
numbers (1 to 40).
eMEMORY
ePRESET F / G
kRETURN
mNumeric keys
RETURN
MEMORY
PRESET
7856
90
1234
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
10
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
AM
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
e
m
To cancel registration, press kRETURN or do not
operate the remote control for about 30 seconds.
Preset numbers to which no channel has been
registered are skipped.
Preset numbers can also be selected by pressing
mNumeric keys.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
P01:--- << 001
MEMORY
VOL.
SBL SBR
Preset number Channel to be
registered
Previously
registered channel
(or “---” if no
channel has been
registered)
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SIRIUS
001Hits1
P01
VOL.
SBL SBR
Preset number
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 68
Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio™ information
You can display the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information
on the front panel display. J
1
Front panel display
Press fINFO repeatedly to toggle the SIRIUS
Satellite Radio information display modes as
shown below.
Signal reception level
Signal reception is shown in four levels.
Back toChannel
fINFO
INFO
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
f
NOTE
If a status message or an error message appears on the
front panel display or TV screen, see “SIRIUS
Satellite Radio™” (
p. 121).
Channel
Channel number, channel name
Category
Channel category, channel number
Artist/Song
Artist name, song title, channel number
Composer
Composer name, channel number
Antenna
Antenna reception level, channel number
DSP Program
Current sound program (
p. 47), channel number
Audio Decoder
Current Audio Decoder (
p. 43), channel number
SIRIUS
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
Antenna
ALL008
VOL.
Signal reception level
Channel number
Search mode
J
1 : If the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information contains a character
that cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be
displayed with a space.
When an information is unavailable, “––––” appears.
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 69
Confirming and operating SIRIUS
Satellite Radio™ from the Content
window
The Sirius channel currently received can be confirmed
from the menu displayed on the TV screen. Various
Sirius Satellite Radio operations can be performed from
the Content window rather than controls on the front
panel display. The Content window is displayed when
dSIRIUS is pressed.
You can operate the Sirius Satellite Radio from the Now
playing view or the Content browse view.
Operating from the Now playing
view
a HOLD indicator
Lights up when
lHOLD is pressed to activate the hold
function. The artist name and song title currently received
will remain displayed. Press
lHOLD again to cancel the
hold function.
b Signal reception level
Indicates the signal reception level.
c Preset number
The selected preset number is displayed.
d Channel number
The channel number currently received is displayed.
e Channel Name
The channel name currently received is displayed.
f Channel Category
The category of the channel is displayed.
g Artist Name
The artist name of the current song is displayed.
h Song Title
The title of the current song is displayed.
i Composer Name
The composer name of the current song is displayed.
j Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Now Playing view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Now playing view
To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select
the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER.
Radio Control
Select a channel for reception.
Utility
When the parental lock function is enabled for a
particular channel, that channel is skipped in all channel
search mode and category search mode.
1
Use kCursor D / E to select a number, and
press kENTER to enter the selected
number.
2
Repeat step 1 to enter the desired 4-digit
code number.
3
Use kCursor C to select “Enter,” and press
kENTER to confirm the 4-digit code
number.
Selecting “Clear” and pressing kENTER clears all
the code entered.
4
Use kCursor B / C to select the category
and press kENTER.
dSIRIUS
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
lHOLD
ENTER
TUNER
HOLD
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
k
l
b
e
c
d
a
f
g
h
i
j
Weak signal
Strong signal
Memory Register the current channel as a preset
number. Up to 40 channels can be
registered.
Preset - Select the previous preset number.
Preset + Select the next preset number.
CAT - Select the previous category.
CAT + Select the next category.
CH - Scan channels downwards from the
current channel.
CH + Scan channels upwards from the current
channel.
Direct Specify a specific channel by manually
entering the channel number.
Hold Activate the hold function. The artist
name and song title currently received
will remain displayed.
Parental Lock Restricts the access to specified channel.
Continues to the
next page
PLAYBACK
Listening to Satellite Radio
En 70
5
Use kCursor B / C to select the channel to
be locked and press kENTER.
When kENTER is pressed, the selected channel is
received for confirmation. Each time
kENTER is
pressed after that, lock switches between on and off.
To lock channels in other categories, press
kRETURN to display the category selection screen,
and follow the procedure described above.
Receiving locked channels
Use direct number access mode (p. 66) or preset
search mode (
p. 67) to receive locked channels. When
a locked channel is received, “Locked” is displayed
followed by the parental lock code input screen. Use
mNumeric keys to enter the 4-digit code number,
select OK and then press mENT.
Scroll
Switches the scroll target (channel name, channel
category, artist name, song title, or composer name).
Browse
Switches the display to the Content browse view.
Operating from the Content browse
view
a Preset station list
The list of preset stations is displayed.
b Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details.
Screen buttons on the Content browse view
To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then
select the desired one with kCursor B / C and
kENTER.
Utility
1 Page Up
1 Page Down
Scrolls the list to the next or previous page.
Now Playing
Switches the display to the Now playing view.
k
Cursor B / C / D / E
kRETURN
kENTER
mNumeric keys
mENT
RETURN
ENTER
7856
90
1234
ENT
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
10
R
EC
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
m
NOTES
If a code number is already registered and the different
code number is entered, “Wrong Number” appears.
Use
kCursor B / C to select Parental Lock and
press
kENTER, and then enter the correct number.
If you forget the parental lock code or want to change
it, reset it using “SR PIN” (
p. 109).
Check mark
Parental Lock Restricts the access to specified channel.
Clear Preset Clears registration of the preset station
currently selected.
Clear All Preset Clears registration of all preset stations.
PLAYBACK
En 71
Once you have connected a Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (such as the YDS-12, sold separately) to this unit, you can enjoy playback of your iPod/iPhone using the
remote control supplied with this unit. When playing back from an iPod/iPhone, you can also use the compressed music enhancer sound programs to give compressed
audio formats such as MP3 a sharper, more dynamic sound (
p. 46). A Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10, sold separately) can also be connected to this unit to
play back iPod/iPhone with wireless connection.
Connecting the Universal Dock for
iPod/iPhone
Use the dedicated cable to connect the dock to the
DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit. Refer to the
operating instructions of the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone for information on how to connect your iPod/
iPhone.
Switch this unit on and place your iPod/iPhone in the
dock. The unit is now ready for playback.
When this unit is in standby mode, iPod/iPhone can be
charged automatically (
p. 80).
Controlling an iPod™/iPhone™
After setting your iPod/iPhone in your dock, just press
dDOCK to switch to DOCK input to play your iPod/
iPhone.
The iPod/iPhone can be operated in the following two
ways.
Menu browse control:
Plays the iPod/iPhone while viewing the menu displayed
on the TV. Refer to “Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu
screen (Menu browse control)” (
p. 72).
Simple remote control:
Plays audio and video through this unit while viewing
the menu displayed on the iPod/iPhone screen. Refer to
“Operating basic playback functions via the remote
control (Simple remote control)” (
p. 74).
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™
dDOCK
fINFO
INFO
DOCK
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
FM
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
f
When playing back iPod/iPhone with wired
connection
Refer to “Connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone.
When playing back iPod/iPhone with
wireless connection
Refer to “Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with wireless
connection” (
p. 74).
iPod touch, iPod (4th Gen/5th Gen/Classic), iPod
nano, iPod mini, iPhone, iPhone 3G, and iPhone 3GS
are supported (As of March 2010).
When connecting iPhone, iPhone 3G and iPhone 3GS,
use a YDS-12.
Some features may not be compatible depending on
the model or the software version of your iPod/iPhone.
Some functions may not be available for some
Universal Dock for iPod
/iPhone models. This
explanation focuses on the YDS-12.
When an iPod that supports iTunes Tagging is
connected to this unit, this unit transmits iTunes
Tagging information to the iPod (
p. 61).
CAUTION
To prevent accidents, switch this unit to standby mode
before connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
iPodconnected
DOCK
VOL.
DOCK
(
TV
AV
3
AV
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
OPTI
VIDEO
A
NT
E
F
H
D R
ad
i
o
75
O
PTI
C
A
L
AV
1
AV
2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
Universal Dock
for iPod/iPhone
Locate the dock at the distance as far as from
the unit.
Song information (artist, album, song) is displayed on
the front panel. Press
fINFO repeatedly to display
subsequent/previous information.
The Yamaha logo is displayed on the iPod screen
when iPod stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone (does not apply to the iPod touch or iPhone).
Manual control of the iPod/iPhone is not possible
while the iPod stationed in the Universal Dock for
iPod/iPhone.
PLAYBACK
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™
En 72
Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu
screen (Menu browse control)
The iPod/iPhone can be operated from the menu
displayed on the TV screen.
You can operate the iPod/iPhone from the Now playing
view or the Content browse view.
Operating from the Content browse
view
a Input name / List name
b Menu items
c Input icon
d Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details.
e Current menu number / Number of all menu items
Screen buttons on the Content browse view
To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then
select the desired one with kCursor B / C and
kENTER.
10 Pages Up
10 Pages Down
Goes to 10 pages forwards or backwards.
1 Page Up
1 Page Down
Scrolls the list to the next or previous page.
Now Playing
Switches the display to the Now playing view.
Close
Returns to the video playback, turning off the menu
display.
1
Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input.
2
Press kCursor B / C to select the content
(music or video) that you want to play, and
press kENTER. J1
3
Press kCursor B / C to select iPod/iPhone
menu items, and press kENTER to play.
The Now playing view appears during playback.
Operating from the Now playing
view
a Repeat icon
b Shuffle icon
c Play icon
d Album image
e Artist name
f Album title
g Screen button area
Buttons for available operations are displayed. See
“Screen buttons on the Now playing view” for details.
h Song title
i Remaining time
j Progress bar
k Elapsed time
Screen buttons on the Now playing view
To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select
the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER.
ENTER
DOCK
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
k
dDOCK
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
a
e
d
b
c
b ca
j
i
d
e
f
h
k
g
J
1 : Videos will not be displayed when your iPod or Universal Dock
for iPod/iPhone do not support the browser function for browsing
video files.
PLAYBACK
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™
En 73
Play Control
Operates the basic playback functions of iPod/iPhone.
Scroll
Switches the scroll target (artist name, album name, or
song name).
Browse
Switches the display to the Content browse view.
Close
Returns to the video playback, turning off the menu
display.
k
ENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
p (Play) Starts playback.
s (Stop) Stops playback.
e (Pause) Stops playback temporarily.
b (Skip -) Skips to the beginning of the currently
playing song. Press kENTER at the
beginning of the song to skip to a
previous song.
a (Skip +) Skips to the beginning of the next song.
w (Scan -) Searches backwards.
f (Scan +) Searches forwards.
PLAYBACK
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™
En 74
Operating basic playback functions
via the remote control (Simple
remote control)
Use the following remote control keys to operate
(playback, stop, skip, etc.) your iPod/iPhone.
Press lREC to enable the Simple remote control.
Press lREC again to return to the Menu browse
control.
Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with
wireless connection
A Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10, sold
separately) can be connected to this unit to play back
iPod/iPhone with wireless connection. The iPod/iPhone
can be used as the remote control. J1
Connecting the Yamaha iPod
wireless transmitter and playing
back iPod/iPhone
Use the dedicated cable to connect the wireless receiver
to the DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit. Refer to
the operating instructions of the YID-W10 for more
information.
Place the iPod/iPhone in the wireless transmitter. Setup
is complete.
When this unit is in standby mode, iPod/iPhone can be
charged automatically, if “Standby Charge” is set to
“Auto” (
p. 80) or “Power & Input” of “iPod Interlock”
is set to “On” (
p. 81).
dDOCK
kCursor B / C
kENTER
kRETURN
lREC
ls
le
lp
lw
lf
l b
la
RETURN
ENTER
REC
DOCK
TAGHOLD
PRG SELECT
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
l
k
dDOCK Switches to the DOCK (iPod) input.
kCursor B / C Move the cursor up and down to different
fields.
kRETURN Returns to the previous menu.
kENTER Enables the selected menu.
lw Searches backwards while held down.
lf Searches forwards while held down.
lb Skips to the beginning of the currently
playing song. Pressing repeatedly skips
one song backwards with each press.
la Skips to the beginning of the next song.
ls Stops playback.
le Switches between playback and pause.
lp Switches between playback and pause.
CAUTION
To prevent accidents, unplug the power cable of this
unit before connecting the iPod wireless receiver.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
iPodconnected
DOCK
VOL.
DOCK
AV
3
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIA
L
O
VIDE
O
A
N
H
D R
ad
i
o
O
PTI
C
AL
AV
1
AV
2
CO
AXIAL
CO
MP
O
NENT
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
A
B
1
2
3
Yamaha iPod
wireless receiver
Position the wireless receiver as far as possible
from the unit.
J
1 : Video signals cannot be transmitted wirelessly.
PLAYBACK
Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™
En 75
Use iPod/iPhone to start playback.
This unit, which is placed in the main zone, functions as
follows when iPod/iPhone controls are used to start
playback.
The input source switches to DOCK (iPod) when this
unit is turned on.
When this unit is in standby mode when iPod/iPhone
playback starts, this unit turns on and the input source
switches to DOCK (iPod). J1
This unit automatically enters standby mode when the
following operations are performed.
iPod/iPhone is removed from the YID-W10
iPod/iPhone is not operated for a while after playback
is stopped
Adjusting volume control on the iPod/iPhone also adjusts
the volume (max 0.0 dB) of this unit.
dDOCK
DOCK
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
ENTER
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
Pressing dDOCK also switches the input source to
DOCK (iPod).
When a menu is operated, this function is not
activated.
When “iPod Interlock”
“Power & Input” in the
Input menu is set to “Off,” the power and the input
source do not switch automatically (
p. 81).
When “iPod Interlock” “Volume” in the Input
menu is set to “Off,” the volume of this unit is not
adjusted when iPod/iPhone volume controls are
adjusted
(p. 81).
CAUTION
When iPod/iPhone controls are used to adjust volume,
playback volume may be unexpectedly loud. This
could result in damage to this unit or the speakers. If
the volume suddenly increases during playback,
immediately remove the iPod/iPhone from the
Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone. “Max Volume” can
be used to specify the maximum volume level to
prevent excessively loud playback (
p. 95).
J
1 : This function is also activated when sound of application is
reproduced or ringtone is received.
PLAYBACK
En 76
You can connect a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver (such as the YBA-10, sold separately) to this unit and enjoy wireless playback from Bluetooth-compatible
portable music players. J1
Connecting a Yamaha Bluetooth
wireless audio receiver
Use the dedicated cable to connect the dock to the
DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit.
The Bluetooth wireless audio receiver connection will be
complete when this unit is turned on.
Pairing Bluetooth™ components
Be sure to carry out pairing when connecting a Bluetooth
component for the first time, or when settings have been deleted.
Refer to the operating instructions of your Bluetooth
component as necessary when carrying out pairing.
1
Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input.
2
Turn on the Bluetooth component you want
to pair with and set it to pairing mode.
3
Press tOPTION to display the OPTION
menu and use kCursor B / C to select
“Pairing.
4
Press kENTER to start pairing.
Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components
NOTE
When playing back from a Bluetooth component for the first time, you must first pair the devices (register the Bluetooth components). When establishing a wireless connection
you must carry out pairing on both this unit and on the Bluetooth component.
dDOCK
eMEMORY
kCursor B / C
kENTER
kRETURN
tOPTION
RETURN
MEMORY
ENTER
DOCK
OPTION
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
d
e
t
CAUTION
To prevent accidents, switch this unit to standby mode
before connecting a Bluetooth wireless audio receiver.
DOCK
(
TV
AV
3
AV
(
C
D
)
CO
AXIAL
OPTI
VIDEO
A
NT
E
F
H
D R
ad
i
o
75
O
PTI
C
A
L
AV
1
AV
2
CO
AXIA
L
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
VIDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
Yamaha Bluetooth
wireless audio receiver
The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver can be
paired with up to eight Bluetooth components. When
the ninth device is paired, the pairing settings for the
device which has not been used for the longest period
of time will be deleted.
To cancel pairing, press kRETURN.
You can also press and hold
eMEMORY on the front
panel to begin pairing.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
Pairing
OPTION
VOL.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
Searching...
DOCK
VOL.
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : This unit supports A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile)
of the Bluetooth profile.
PLAYBACK
Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components
En 77
5
Make sure the Bluetooth component
recognizes the Bluetooth wireless audio
receiver.
When the device is recognized, it will appear in the
Bluetooth component list, for example as “YBA-10
YAMAHA.
6
Select the Bluetooth wireless audio receiver
from the Bluetooth component list, and
enter a pass key “0000” into the Bluetooth
component. J1
Using Bluetooth™ components
When pairing is complete, perform the following
procedure to achieve a wireless connection between this
unit and the Bluetooth component. When the wireless
connection is complete, Bluetooth components can be
played back.
1
Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input.
2
Press tOPTION to display the OPTION
menu.
3
Use kCursor B / C to select “Connect” and
press kENTER. J2
4
Operate the Bluetooth component for
playback.
d
DOCK
kCursor B / C
kENTER
tOPTION
ENTER
DOCK
OPTION
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
H
DMI
O
UT
MULTI
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
t
k
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
Completed
DOCK
VOL.
When pairing occurs correctly
Depending on Bluetooth components, a wireless
connection is established automatically or by
operating the Bluetooth components. In that case, it is
not necessary to carry out the following procedure.
“Not found” is displayed when there is an error
connecting. Check that the following conditions have
been satisfied, and try to establish a wireless
connection again.
Both this unit and the Bluetooth component are paired.
The Bluetooth component is switched on.
The Bluetooth component is within 32 ft. (10 m) of the
Bluetooth wireless audio receiver.
To disconnect a wireless connection, repeat the same
steps, and in step 3, select “Disconnect.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
BTconnected
DOCK
VOL.
When wireless connection is complete
J
1 : Depending on Bluetooth components, wireless connection is
carried out right after the pairing. In this case, “BT connected” is
displayed instead of “Completed.
J
2 : “Disconnect” is displayed when a Bluetooth component has been
connected.
En 78
SETUP
Settings, such as the name of an input source or the icon displayed for an input source can be changed from the Input menu.
Configuring input sources
The name of an input source and its icon, as well as other
input source settings, can be changed from the Input
menu displayed on the TV screen.
1
Press jON SCREEN.
2
Use kCursor B / C to select “Input” and
press kENTER.
3
Use kCursor D / E to select an input source
to be configured and press kCursor B.
4
Use kCursor B / C to select an item and
press kENTER.
5
Use kCursor B / C to adjust the setting.
6
Press jON SCREEN to close the menu.
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
If the selected item contains additional items, use
kCursor B / C to select the desired item and press
kENTER.
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Repeat steps 4 to 5 to adjust multiple settings.
SETUP
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
En 79
Input menu
Changing an input source name or
icon
Rename/Icon Select
Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-6, AUDIO1-2, V-AUX, DOCK
(iPod), DOCK (Bluetooth), MULTI CH
Changes the input source name (up to nine characters)
and icon displayed on the front panel display or TV
screen.
1
Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Rename/Icon Select” and press kENTER.
2
Use kCursor D / E to choose an icon and
press kCursor C.
3
Press kENTER, and then press
kCursor B / C / D / E to edit the new input
name.
4
Press kENTER and press kCursor C to
select “OK” and press kENTER.
Confirm the new input name.
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
HDMI1-5 Rename/
Icon Select
Audio In Decoder
Mode
Enhancer
AV 1 - 2 Rename/
Icon Select
Audio In Decoder
Mode
Enhancer
AV 3 - 4 Rename/
Icon Select
Decoder
Mode
Enhancer
AV 5 - 6 Rename/
Icon Select
Enhancer
AUDIO1-2 Rename/
Icon Select
Enhancer
V-AUX Rename/
Icon Select
Decoder
Mode
Enhancer
TUNER Enhancer
SIRIUS Enhancer
DOCK (iPod) Rename/
Icon Select
Enhancer Standby
Charge
iPod
Interlock J1
DOCK (Bluetooth) Rename/
Icon Select
Enhancer
MULTI CH Rename/
Icon Select
Video Out
J
1 : Not available when playing back iPod/iPhone with wired
connection.
SETUP
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
En 80
Combining HDMI/AV1-2 input source
video and audio
Audio In
Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-2
Combines video from HDMI or AV input sources with analog/
digital audio inputs in situations such as:
an playback device is connected with an HDMI cable but cannot
transmit audio through HDMI
an playback device with component video output and analog
audio output (such as certain game consoles) are connected to the
system
To change assignments, select an input source (HDMI1-5 or AV1-2)
as the video input first, and then select audio input jacks in this
menu.
Set as follows according on the desired combination of audio input
jacks.
Setting the format of digital audio signals
Decoder Mode
Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-4, V-AUX J1
Sets the format of digital audio to playback to DTS. For example, if
the format is not automatically detected correctly even during
playback of DTS format audio, this item can be used to set the
playback format to DTS.
Selecting the sound program suitable for
listening to compressed audio, such as
MP3
Enhancer
Input source: All input sources other than MULTI CH
Turns on/off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode.
Charging an iPod™/iPhone™ in standby
mode
Standby Charge
Input source: DOCK (iPod)
Charges an iPod/iPhone stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod /
iPhone or iPod wireless receiver while the receiver is in standby
mode.
Audio inputs Settings method
Optical digital audio
input
Select AV1 or AV4. Connect the external component
audio cable to the optical digital jack for the selected
input.
Coaxial digital audio
input
Select AV2 or AV3. Connect the external component
audio cable to the coaxial digital jack for the selected
input.
Analog audio input Select one of AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2.
Connect the external component audio cable to the
audio jack for the selected input.
Auto (Default) The audio format is automatically selected to match
the format of the input audio.
DTS Selects DTS signals only. Other input signals are not
reproduced.
Off (Default) Turns off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode.
On Turns on the Compressed Music Enhancer mode.
Auto (Default) This unit charges iPod/iPhone when this unit is in
standby mode. While charging an iPod/iPhone, the
HDMI Through/iPod Charge indicator lights. When
HDMI Through function is off, the indicator goes out
after the charging is complete.
Off This unit does not charge iPod/iPhone.
J
1 : AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are also available when “Audio Return Channel” is on,
and the input source is used for “TV Audio Input.
En 81
SETUP
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
Setting the interlock functions with iPod/
iPhone (when a Yamaha iPod wireless
receiver is connected)
iPod Interlock
Input source: DOCK (iPod)
This unit can be automatically operated in conjunction with
operations on iPod when the iPod wireless receiver is connected to
this unit.
Outputting a video signal input from
another input source while playing a
multi-channel audio signal
Video Out
Input source: MULTI CH
When “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source, a video signal
input from another terminal can be output to the video monitor. For
example, even if an audio and video component such as a DVD
player that does not support a multi-channel digital audio output,
the video signal can be output to the video monitor while
reproducing a multi-channel analog audio signal.
Power & Input Starting playback of iPod/iPhone turns on this unit
and switches the input source to DOCK (iPod)
automatically when this item is set to “On.” This unit
automatically enters standby mode when iPod/iPhone
is not operated for a while after playback is stopped.
This interlock function is disable with “Off.
Volume Adjusting the volume on the iPod/iPhone also adjusts
the volume of this unit when this item is set to “On.
This interlock function is disable with “Off.
SETUP
En 82
The SCENE function (p. 43) can be edited from the SCENE menu displayed on the TV screen.
Editing a scene
Various settings, such as the name of a scene or the icon
displayed for a scene, can be changed from the SCENE
menu.
1
Press jON SCREEN.
2
Use kCursor B / C to select “Scene” and
press kENTER.
3
Use kCursor D / E to select a scene to be
edited and press kCursor B.
4
Use kCursor B / C to select an item and
press kENTER.
5
Use kCursor B / C / D / E to adjust the
setting.
6
Press jON SCREEN to close the menu.
Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu)
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
When the Utility is available in the selected item, use
kCursor B / C to select the Utility and press
kENTER.
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to adjust multiple
settings.
En 83
SETUP
Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu)
SCENE menu
Registering SCENE function settings
Save
Registers the settings currently applied to this unit for each
SCENE.
Adjusting settings registered with the
SCENE function
Load
Loads input sources or sound programs that have been registered
with the SCENE function, or specifies whether or not an external
component registered as the input source is automatically turned on
when a scene is selected.
SCENE IR
Specify whether or not a Yamaha BD/DVD player or CD player
connected to this unit turns on automatically.
Detail
Display details of settings registered with the SCENE function.
Items indicated with a check mark in “Setting” are loaded.
SCENE1
SCENE2
SCENE3
SCENE4
Save
Load
Rename/Icon Select
Reset
Save
Load
Rename/Icon Select
Reset
Save
Load
Rename/Icon Select
Reset
Save
Load
Rename/Icon Select
Reset
Ok Loads items indicated with a check mark in “Setting.
Cancel Cancels settings applied with “Setting.
DETAIL Specifies “SCENE IR” function and displays settings
registered with the SCENE function in detail.
Foe more information, see “SCENE IR” and “Detail”
at right.
Off Disables the SCENE IR function.
Yamaha BD/DVD
Player1
Select this when a Yamaha BD/DVD player is
connected to this unit.
Yamaha BD/DVD
Player2
Select this if the player dose not turn on when
“Yamaha BD/DVD Player1” is selected.
Yamaha CD Player Select this when a Yamaha CD player is connected to
this unit.
Input Displays “Input” and “Audio Select” settings
registered with the SCENE function.
Mode Displays the sound program registered with the
SCENE function.
Enhancer Displays the “Enhancer” setting registered with the
SCENE function.
SETUP
Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu)
En 84
Changing a scene name and icon
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front
panel display or TV screen.
1
Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Rename/Icon Select” and press kENTER.
2
Use kCursor D / E to choose an icon and
press kCursor C.
3
Press kENTER, and then press
kCursor B / C / D / E to edit the new scene
name.
4
Press kENTER and press kCursor C to
select “OK” and press kENTER.
Confirm the new scene name.
Resetting a scene
Reset
Restores all settings to their default values.
k
Cursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
H
DMI
O
UT
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
SETUP
En 85
Sound effects can be adjusted from the Sound Program menu.
Editing sound programs
Adjust sound field elements (sound program parameters)
to achieve sound effects suited to the acoustics of audio/
video sources or rooms if you are not satisfied with the
results achieved with default sound program settings.
Follow the procedure described below to adjust sound
program parameters.
1
Press jON SCREEN.
2
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Sound Program” and press kENTER.
3
Use kCursor D / E to select a sound
program and press kCursor B.
4
Use kCursor B / C to select a parameter
and press kENTER.
5
Use kCursor D / E to adjust the parameter
and press kRETURN. J1
6
Press jON SCREEN to close the Sound
Program menu.
Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
H
DMI
O
UT
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
Sound programs
Sound program parameters
Choices
When there are multiple parameters in the selected
sound program, repeat steps 4 and 5 to adjust other
parameters.
To initialize sound program parameters
To set the parameters of the sound program back to
their default settings, use kCursor B / C repeatedly
to select “Reset” in step 4 and press kENTER.
When the following message is displayed, select
“OK” and press kENTER to initialize.
To cancel initializing, select “CANCEL” and press
kENTER when the message above is displayed.
J
1 : An asterisk (*) appears on the left of the sound field parameter
name displayed on the TV when you change the parameter from
its default setting.
En 86
SETUP
Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)
CINEMA DSP parameters
DSP Level
Change the effect level (level of the sound field effect to be added).
You can adjust the level of the sound field effect while checking the
sound effect.
Initial Delay
Surround Initial Delay
Surround Back Initial Delay
Initial delay. Presence, surround, and surround back sound field
initial delay. Changes the apparent size of the sound field by
adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection
heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the smaller the sound
field seems to the listener.
Room Size
Surround Room Size
Surround Back Room Size
Room size. Presence, surround, and surround back room size.
Adjusts the apparent size of the sound field. The larger the value,
the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the sound is
repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer
the time between the original reflected sound and the subsequent
reflections. By controlling the time between the reflected sounds,
you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing
this parameter from one to two doubles the apparent length of the
room.
Adjustable range -6 dB to +3 dB
Default setting 0 dB
Adjust “DSP Level” as follows:
The effect sound is too soft.
There are no differences between effects of the sound programs.
Increase the effect level.
The sound is dull.
The sound field effect is added too much.
Reduce the effect level.
Adjustable range 1 to 99 ms (Initial Delay)
1 to 49 ms (Surround Initial Delay and Surround Back
Initial Delay)
When you adjust the initial delay parameters, we also
recommend that you adjust the corresponding room size
parameters likewise.
Source sound
Delay
Audio source
Level
Early
reflections
Time
Large value = 99 ms
Reflection face
Time
Delay
Level
Time
Delay
Small value = 1 ms
Level
Adjustable range 0.1 to 2.0
When you adjust the room size parameters, we also recommend
that you adjust the corresponding initial delay parameters
likewise.
Level
Time
Level
Time
Level
Time
A
udio source
Early
reflections
Large value = 2.0Small value = 0.1
Source sound
En 87
SETUP
Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)
Liveness
Surround Liveness
Surround Back Liveness
Liveness. Surround and surround back liveness. Adjusts the
reflectivity of the virtual walls in the hall by changing the rate at
which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of an audio
source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent
wall surfaces than in one which has highly reflective surfaces. A
room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to as “dead,
while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live.
This parameter lets you adjust the early reflection decay rate and
thus the “liveness” of the room.
Reverb Time
Reverberation time. Adjusts the amount of time taken for the
dense, subsequent reverberation sound to decay by 60 dB at 1 kHz.
This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment over an
extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time to get more
sustaining reverberation sound, and set a shorter time to get
articulate sound.
Reverb Delay
Reverberation delay. Adjusts the time difference between the
beginning of the direct sound and the beginning of the
reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the
reverberation sound begins. A later reverberation sound makes you
feel as if you are in a larger acoustic environment.
Adjustable range 0 to 10
Level
Time
Level
Time
Level
Time
Large value = 10
Small value = 0
Source sound
Small reflected
sound
Large reflected
sound
Dead
Live
Adjustable range 1.0 to 5.0 s
Small value = 1.0 s
Reverberation Reverberation
Source sound
Early reflections
60 dB 60 dB 60 dB
Rev. Time Rev. Time Rev. Time
Audio source
Short
reverberation
Long
reverberation
Large value = 5.0 s
Time Time Time
Adjustable range 0 to 250 ms
Rev. Delay
Source sound
(dB)
60 dB
Reverberation
Time
Rev. Time
Level
SETUP
Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)
En 88
Reverb Level
Reverberation level. Adjusts the volume of the reverberation
sound. The larger the value, the stronger the reverberation
becomes.
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder to be used with a sound program in the
MOVIE category. J1
Parameters usable in certain sound
programs
2ch Stereo only
Direct
Automatically bypasses the DSP circuit and tone control circuit
depending on the condition of tone control etc., when an analog
audio source is played back. You can enjoy a higher quality sound.
7ch Stereo only
Center Level
Adjusts the center channel volume. J2
Surround L Level
Adjusts the volume of the surround L channel. J2
Surround R Level
Adjusts the volume of the surround R channel. J2
Surround Back L Level
Adjusts the volume of the surround back L channel. J2
Surround Back R Level
Adjusts the volume of the surround back R channel. J2
Front Presence L Level
Adjusts the volume of the front presence L channel. J2
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
PLIIx Movie
PLII Movie
Selects the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie (or
Dolby Pro Logic II Movie) decoder.
Neo:6 Cinema Selects the Neo:6 (Cinema) decoder.
Level
Source sound
Time
Rev. Level
Auto (Default) Outputs sound by bypassing the DSP circuit and tone
control circuit when both tone controls of “Bass” and
“Treble” are set to 0 dB.
Off Does not bypass the DSP circuit and tone control
circuit.
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 100%
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 100%
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 100%
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 35% (7.1-channel configuration)
50% (6.1-channel configuration)
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 35% (7.1-channel configuration)
50% (6.1-channel configuration)
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 33%
J
1 : Surround decoders cannot be changed when used with the following MOVIE
sound programs.
Mono Movie
Sports
Action Game
Roleplaying Game
J
2 : Not displayed when speakers are set to be inactive.
SETUP
Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)
En 89
Front Presence R Level
Adjusts the volume of the front presence R channel. J1
Parameters usable in surround decoder
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder.
Dolby PLIIx Music and Dolby PLII Music only
Panorama
Adjusts the soundscape of the front sound field. Sends front left/
right channels sounds to the surround speakers as well as the front
speakers for a wraparound effect.
Center Width
Spreads the center channel sound to the front left and right
speakers to suit your needs or preferences. Set this parameter to 0
for outputting the center sound from the center speaker only, or to 7
for outputting it from the front left/right speaker only.
Dimension
Adjusts the difference in level between the front sound field and
the surround sound field. You can adjust the difference in level
created by the software being played back to obtain the preferred
sound balance.
The surround sound gets stronger as you make the value more
negative, and the front sound gets stronger as you make the value
more positive.
When Neo:6 Music is selected
Center Image
Adjusts the front left and right channel output relative to the center
channel to make the center channel more or less dominant as
necessary.
Adjustable range 0 to 100%
Default setting 33%
Pro Logic Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic
decoder. This is suitable for all kinds of audio sources.
PLIIx Movie /
PLII Movie
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or
Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for
movies. J2
PLIIx Music /
PLII Music
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or
Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for
music. J2
PLIIx Game /
PLII Game
Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or
Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for
games. J2
Neo:6 Cinema Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This
is suitable for movies.
Neo:6 Music Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This
is suitable for music.
Off (Default) Disables the effect.
On Enables the effect.
Adjustable range 0 to 7
Default setting 3
Adjustable range -3 to +3
Default setting 0
Adjustable range 0.0 to 1.0
Default setting 0.3
J
1 : Not displayed when speakers are set to be inactive.
J
2 : You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder in the following conditions:
When “Surround Back” is set to “None” (
p. 92).
When headphones are connected.
SETUP
En 90
Various settings, such as speaker volume or HDMI functions, can be changed from the Setup menu.
Operating the Setup menu
1
Press jON SCREEN.
2
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Setup” and press kENTER.
3
Use kCursor D / E to select a menu and
press kENTER.
Setup menu setting
4
Use kCursor B / C to select an item and
press kENTER.
5
Use kCursor B / C / D / E to adjust the
setting.
6
Press jON SCREEN to close the menu.
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
H
DMI
O
UT
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
Speaker Adjusts parameters for speakers, such as
speaker status, and volume adjustment for
each speaker (p. 91).
Sound Sets functions related to audio output,
such as adjustment of maximum volume
and of dynamic range (p. 95).
Video Sets video output functions, such as video
conversion settings (resolution and aspect
ratio) (p. 96).
HDMI Sets HDMI functions, such as the HDMI
Control function and output destination
for HDMI sound (p. 97).
Multi Zone Sets multi-zone functions, such as
volume adjustment for speakers in the
secondary zone (p. 100).
Function Sets functions such as the Auto Power
Down function, that make the unit easier
to use (p. 100).
Language Selects the language of the menus and
messages displayed on TV screen
(p. 103).
When the selected item contains detailed ones, use
kCursor B / C to select the detailed item and press
kENTER.
Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu
screen. Repeat steps 4 to 5 to adjust multiple settings.
En 91
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
Setup menu Manages settings for speakers
Speaker Setup items
Automatic speaker setup
Auto Setup
Optimizes the speaker configuration automatically using YPAO
(
p. 33).
Manual speaker setup
Manual Setup
The following parameters can be specified manually.
Power Amp Assign
In addition to the 7.1-channel speaker connection, various speaker
configurations are possible using the presence speakers connection,
bi-amp connection or Zone2 function (
p. 17, p. 18).
Auto Setup
Manual Setup
Lipsync
Dynamic Range
Max Volume
Initial Volume
Adaptive DSP Level
Analog to Analog Conversion
Processing
Zone2 Set
Party Mode Set
Auto Power Down
Display Set
Trigger Output
Memory Guard
Speaker
Sound
Video
Multi Zone
Function
Language
HDMI Control
Control Select
ARC (Audio Return Channel)
TV Audio Input
Audio Output
Standby Through
HDMI
Auto Setup Optimizes the speaker configuration automatically.
Manual Setup Manually adjusts parameters for speakers.
Power Amp Assign Adds the extra speakers to the 7.1-channel speaker
connection.
Configuration Manually manages speaker configuration, such as
speaker size (sound production capacity), and bass
audio processing.
Distance Manually adjusts the output of each speaker based on
distance to the listening position.
Level Manually adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Parametric EQ Selects an equalizer to adjust speaker output
characteristics.
Test Tone Generates test tones.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 92
Configuration
Adjusts the output characteristics of the speakers based on
manually set parameters.
Front
Selects the size (sound reproduction capacity) of the front
speakers. J1
Center
Selects the size of the center speakers.
Surround
Selects the size of the surround speakers.
Surround Back
Selects the size of the surround back speakers.
Front Presence
Specify connection of front presence speakers.
In the “Configuration,” you can select the speaker size
characteristic (Large or Small). Select the size (sound
reproduction capacity) that matches your speakers.
When speaker size is set to “Small,” low-frequency components
of the speakers that you configured are produced from the
subwoofer (or from the front speakers if there is no subwoofer).
Woofer diameter
6-1/4 in (16 cm) or larger Large
6-1/4 in (16 cm) or smaller Small
Large Select this for large speakers. The front speakers will
produce all of the front channel frequency
components.
Small (Default) Select this for small speakers. The subwoofer will
produce front channel low-frequency
components. J2
Large Select this when a large center speaker is connected.
Small (Default) Select this when a small center speaker is connected.
None Select this when there is no center speaker. The front
speakers will produce center channel audio.
Large Select this when the surround speakers are large.
Small (Default) Select this when the surround speakers are small.
None Select this when no surround speakers are connected.
The front speakers will produce surround channel
audio signals.
When set to “None,” no sound is produced from the surround
back speaker even if that speaker is connected.
When set to “None,” the sound programs will change to Virtual
CINEMA DSP mode.
Largex1 Select when one large surround back speaker is
connected.
Largex2 Select when two large surround back speakers are
connected.
Smallx1 Select when one small surround back speaker is
connected.
Smallx2 (Default) Select when two small surround back speakers are
connected.
None Select this when no surround back speakers are
connected.
When there are no surround speakers are connected, the setting
will automatically change to “None.
You can set surround back audio signals, including from the
playback source, to be mixed down and produced from a single
speaker (6.1-channel layout) or produced from left and right
surround speakers (5.1-channel layout).
Use (Default) Select this when front presence speakers are
connected.
None Select this when front presence speakers are not
connected.
J
1 : When “Subwoofer” is set to “None,” you can only choose “Large.” If the front
speaker setting is “Small” and you change “Subwoofer” to “None,” it will
automatically change to “Large.
J
2 : You can set the low-frequency components of audio signals transmitted from
the front speakers to the subwoofer by using “Bass Cross Over.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 93
Subwoofer
Confirms the subwoofer.
Phase
Sets the phase of the subwoofer if the bass audio is lacking or
unclear.
Extra Bass
Allows the front channel low-frequency components to be
produced exclusively by the subwoofer, or by both the subwoofer
and the front speakers.
Bass Cross Over
Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component which is
produced from speakers of which the size is set to “Small.
A frequency sound which is lower than the specified frequency will
be produced from the subwoofer or the front speakers. J2
Distance
Adjusts the timing at which the speakers produce audio so that
sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same
time.
Selecting adjustment units
Use kCursor B / C to select the unit for distance (meters or
feet), and press kENTER.
Setting distances for each speaker
Use kCursor B / C to select the speaker you want to configure,
and press kENTER. Then use kCursor D / E to set the distance
from the speaker to your listening position.
Level
Separately adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Use kCursor B / C to select the desired speaker, and press
kENTER. Then use kCursor D / E to adjust the volume for the
selected speaker.
Use (Default) Select this when subwoofer is connected. During
playback, the subwoofer will produce audio from the
LFE (low-frequency effect) channel and bass audio
from other channels. J1
None Select this when subwoofer is not connected. The
front speakers will produce audio from the LFE (low-
frequency effect) channel and bass frequency audio
from other channels.
Normal (Default) Does not change the subwoofer phase.
Reverse Reverses the subwoofer phase.
Off (Default) Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the
front speakers or the subwoofer produce the front
channel low-frequency components.
On The subwoofer and the front speakers produce the
front channel low-frequency components.
When “Subwoofer” is set to “None” or “Front” is set to “Small,
“Extra Bass” is disabled.
40Hz 110Hz
60Hz 120Hz
80Hz (Default) 160Hz
90Hz 200Hz
100Hz
Adjustable range 1.0 ft to 80.0 ft (0.30 m to 24.0 m)
Default setting 10.0 ft (3.00 m) (Front L/Front R/Center/Surround L/
Surround R/Surround Back L/Surround Back R/
Front Presence L/Front Presence R/Subwoofer)
Adjustment
increments
0.2 ft (0.05 m)
Adjustable range -10.0 dB to +10.0 dB
Default setting 0.0 dB (Front L/Front R/Center/Surround L/
Surround R/Surround Back L/Surround Back R/
Front Presence L/Front Presence R/Subwoofer)
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB
J
1 : Enabling “Extra Bass” allows both the subwoofer and the front speakers to
produce bass audio.
J
2 : If your subwoofer has a volume control or a crossover frequency control, set
the crossover frequency to maximum and the volume to half (or slightly less).
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 94
Parametric EQ
Adjusts sound quality of tone using a parametric
equalizer.
PEQ Select
Select an equalizer type.
PEQ Data Copy
Select 1 of the 3 parametric equalizer types acquired with
automatic setup and manually copy that information to the
manual adjustments.
Front L / Front R / Center / Surround L / Surround R /
Surround Back L / Surround Back R / Front Presence L /
Front Presence R
The parametric equalizer can be used to manually adjust
sound quality for individual speakers.
Set “PEQ Select” to “Manual” and use “PEQ Data
Copy” to copy information acquired with automatic
setup. This information can be used as a basis for
performing manual adjustments.
1
Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Band / Gain,” “Freq. / Gain,” or “Q / Gain”
and press kENTER.
2
Use kCursor D / E repeatedly to adjust the
parameter and use kCursor B / C
repeatedly to adjust the gain.
3
Press kENTER to exit the edit window.
4
Repeat steps 1 to 3 to configure other
parameters.
5
Press jON SCREEN to close the menu.
Test Tone
Turns the test tone generator on or off.
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
Manual Manually adjust equalizer sound.
Flat Adjust individual speakers to achieve the
same characteristics. Select this option if
speakers offer the same quality.
Front Adjust individual speakers to achieve the
same characteristics as the front left and
right speakers. Select this option if front
left and right speakers offer significantly
greater quality than other speakers.
Natural Adjust all speakers to achieve a natural
sound. Select this if high-frequency
sounds seem too strong when “PEQ
Select” is set to “Flat.
Through (Default) Disable the equalizer.
Flat > Manual Copy the “Flat” parametric equalizer
information acquired with automatic
setup.
Front > Manual Copy the “Front” parametric equalizer
information acquired with automatic
setup.
Natural > Manual Copy the “Natural” parametric equalizer
information acquired with automatic
setup.
To reset all parameter settings for the selected
speaker, select “Reset to Flat” and press kENTER.
Off (Default) Does not generate test tones.
On Generates test tones. While “On” is
selected, test tones are produced
constantly.
You can use the test tone in a variety of
circumstances. For example, you can adjust the
volume balance settings for each speaker, or whenever
you adjust the settings on the internal parametric
equalizer, you can listen to the actual effect while
operating this unit. Turn the test tone off when you
have finished making adjustments.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 95
Setting the audio output function of this
unit
Sound Setup items
Synchronizing audio/video output
Lipsync
Adjusts the delay between audio and video output (Lipsync
function).
Mode
Selects a compensation method for the delay between audio and
video output.
Delay
Auto-adjusting Dolby Digital and DTS
dynamic range
Dynamic Range
Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for audio bitstream
(Dolby Digital and DTS) signal playback.
Setting the maximum volume
Max Volume
Specify the maximum volume level so that sound is not too loud.
The default setting of +16.5 dB produces the highest volume.
Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output.
Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for
Dolby Digital and DTS playback.
Max Volume Sets the maximum volume for this receiver.
Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned
on.
Adaptive DSP Level Adjusts the level of DSP effect in conjunction with the
volume level.
Auto (Default) J1 When connecting to a TV via HDMI, automatically
adjusts output timing if the TV supports an automatic
lipsync function.
Manual Manually adjusts the correction time. Select this when
the monitor does not support the automatic lipsync
function.
Adjustable range 0 ms to +250 ms
Default setting 0 ms
Adjustment
increments
1 ms
MAX (Default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range.
STD Adjusts the dynamic range for optimum volume for
regular home use.
MIN/AUTO (MIN) Sets the dynamic range suitable for low
volume or a quiet environment, such as at night, for
bitstream signals except for Dolby TrueHD signals.
(AUTO) Adjusts the dynamic range for Dolby
TrueHD signals based on input signal information.
Adjustable range -30.0 dB to +16.5 dB (maximum volume)
Default setting +16.5 dB
Adjustment
increments
5.0 dB
J
1 : This setting is effective at the HDMI OUT jack selected by using
rHDMI OUT.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 96
Setting the startup volume
Initial Volume
Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. When
this parameter is set to “Off,” the volume is set at the level when the
receiver last entered standby mode. J1
Adjusting DSP effect and volume level
Adaptive DSP Level
Automatically adjust the level of DSP effect in conjunction with
the volume level.
Setting this unit’s video output function
Video Setup items
Analog-to-analog video conversion
Analog to Analog Conversion
Enables or disables video conversion between analog video jacks.
Adjustable range Off, Mute, -80 dB to +16.5 dB
Default setting Off
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB
Off Disables automatic adjustment of the level of DSP
effect.
On (Default) Adjusts the degree of DSP effect in conjunction with
volume level. The higher the volume level, the less the
DSP effect applied. The lower the volume level, the
greater the DSP effect applied.
Analog to Analog
Conversion
Enable or disable video conversion between analog
video jacks.
Processing Enable or disable adjustment of resolution and aspect
ratio for video signal converted to HDMI video.
Off Disables video conversion between analog video
jacks.
On (Default) Enables video conversion between analog video jacks.
Analog-to-HDMI video conversion is always possible unless
video signals are being input at the HDMI input jacks or 1080p-
resolution analog video signals are being input (
p. 126).
This unit does not convert 480 line video signals and 576 line
video signals interchangeably.
480p-, 576p-, 1080i- and 720p-resolution video signals can not
be output at the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack (
p. 126).
The converted video signals are only output at the MONITOR
OUT jacks.
When composite video signals from a VCR are converted into
component video signals, the picture quality may suffer
depending on your VCR.
Unconventional signals input at the composite video jacks cannot
be converted or may be output abnormally. In such cases, set
“Analog to Analog Conversion” to “Off.
J
1 : When you set “Max Volume” at a lower level than “Initial Volume,” “Max
Volume” has priority.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 97
Adjusting resolution and aspect ratio with
conversion of video signal to HDMI
Processing
Adjust resolution and aspect ratio with conversion of video input to
HDMI video (upscaling).
Resolution
Aspect
Setting HDMI functions
HDMI Setup items
Off (Default) Resolution and aspect ratio are not adjusted with
processing.
On Resolution and aspect ratio are adjusted with
processing.
Auto (Default) Automatic upscaling in accordance with TV
resolution.
480p Upscaling to 480p (576p).
720p Upscaling to 720p.
1080i Upscaling to 1080i.
1080p Upscaling to 1080p.
Through No upscaling.
The 720p-, 1080i- and 1080p-resolution video signals cannot be
upscaled (
p. 126).
When a TV is connected to this unit via the HDMI jack, this unit
automatically detects a resolution that the TV supports. Only the
detected resolution can be selected.
If this unit cannot detect the resolution that the TV supports, set
“MON.CHK” in the Advanced Setup menu to “SKIP” (
p. 110)
and try again.
Through (Default) The aspect ratio of HDMI video signal sources is not
adjusted.
16:9 Normal Transmits 4:3 aspect ratio video signals to a 16:9 TV
with black bands on either side of the screen.
The Aspect setting is automatically disabled when “Resolution”
is set to “Through.
The Aspect setting is automatically disabled for video input with
aspect ratios other than 4:3.
Changing the aspect ratio of 720p, 1080i, or 1080p has no effect.
HDMI Control Turns the HDMI Control on or off.
Control Select Choose an HDMI OUT jack on which HDMI
Control function is enabled.
ARC (Audio Return
Channel)
Turns the Audio Return Channel function on or
off.
TV Audio Input Chooses automatically selected audio input in
conjunction with TV operation when the
HDMI Control is turned on.
Audio Output Specifies whether or not audio signal is output
through this unit and a TV connected via the
HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks.
Standby Through J1 Turns the Standby Through function on or off.
J
1 : This item appears depending on “HDMI Control.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 98
Receiver operation via TV (HDMI Control)
HDMI Control
Set the HDMI Control function to “On” to operate devices
connected via HDMI. If the TV or other external components
support HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link), you can use
the remote controls of those devices to operate some of this unit’s
functions, and to synchronize this unit with the operation of those
devices.
Refer to “Using the HDMI Control function” (
p. 111) for setting
instructions.
Selecting an HDMI OUT jack for the HDMI
Control function
Control Select
Select the HDMI OUT jack that utilizes the HDMI Control
function.
Refer to “Using the HDMI Control function” (
p. 111) for setting
instructions.
Listening to TV audio via single HDMI
cable (Audio Return Channel)
ARC (Audio Return Channel)
You can enable or disable the Audio Return Channel function.
When using a TV that supports Audio Return Channel function and
the function is enabled, the TV’s audio output is transmit to this
unit via an HDMI cable.
The TV audio input to this unit is regarded as the input source
selected in “TV Audio Input.J2
By means of this function, you do not need to connect the TV’s
audio output (digital audio output or analog audio output) to the
unit.
When the TV audio is input to the unit using Audio Return
Channel, “TV” is displayed on the front panel display.
Selecting an input source to assign audio
input for the TV
TV Audio Input
Select the input source that receives audio signals from TV while
the HDMI Control function is on.
When using a TV that supports Audio Return Channel function and
the function is enabled, the audio input for the TV is assigned to
the input source selected here. J2
TV1
TV2
Off (Default) Sets HDMI Control to “Off.
On Sets HDMI Control to “On.J1
If this unit is connected to HDMI devices that do not support the
HDMI Control function, these functions will not operate.
Out1(TV1) Applies the HDMI Control function for the HDMI
OUT 1 jack.
Out2(TV2) Applies the HDMI Control function for the HDMI
OUT 2 jack.
Off (Default) Sets the Audio Return Channel to “Off.
On Sets the Audio Return Channel to “On.
“ARC (Audio Return Channel)” is enabled only for the HDMI
OUT 1 or 2 jack selected with “Control Select.
Refer to “Single HDMI cable input to TV audio with Audio
Return Channel function” (
p. 113) for setting instructions.
SW
C
L
SL SR
R
SBL SBR
AV4
TV
VOL.
Audio input AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2
Default setting AV 4
Audio input AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2
Default setting AV 1
“TV Audio Input” is enabled only for the HDMI OUT 1 or 2 jack
selected with “Control Select.
Refer to “Switching the input source on this unit automatically
when listening to TV audio” (
p. 112) for instructions.
J
1 : When the HDMI Control is “On,the Standby Through function is
automatically enabled. When this unit enters standby mode, the audio and
video signals from the last-selected HDMI input source will continue to be
transmitted to the TV. The HDMI input source can only be changed using the
remote control.
J
2 : While the Audio Return Channel function is on, the jack selected for the input
source cannot be used.
En 99
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
Specify whether or not audio signal is
output through this unit and a TV
Audio Output
Choose whether audio is played back through this unit or through a
TV.
Amp
Specify whether or not audio signal is output through this unit.
OUT1
Specify whether or not audio signal is output through a TV
connected via the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
OUT2
Specify whether or not audio signal is output through a TV
connected via the HDMI OUT 2 jack.
Transmitting HDMI audio/video to the TV
during standby mode (Standby Through)
Standby Through
This function allows audio/video signals from HDMI inputs to
continue to be transmitted to a TV when this unit is in standby
mode.
When the Standby Through function is “On,” audio/video signals
continue to be output to the TV from the last
HDMI input source
before this unit enters standby mode.
The HDMI input source can be
selected using dHDMI1-5 or dV-AUX in standby mode.
Off Audio is not output through this unit.
On (Default) Audio is output through this unit. When this setting is
selected, audio from the external component is output
in a format compatible with this unit.
Off (Default) Audio is not output through a TV connected via the
HDMI OUT 1 jack.
On Outputs audio through a TV connected via the HDMI
OUT 1 jack. When this setting is selected, audio from
the external component is output in a format
compatible with the TV.
Off (Default) Audio is not output through a TV connected via the
HDMI OUT 2 jack.
On Outputs audio through a TV connected via the HDMI
OUT 2 jack. When this setting is selected, audio from
the external component is output in a format
compatible with the TV.
Off (Default) Sets Standby Through to “Off.
On Transmits audio/video signals from the selected
HDMI input source to the TV.
When “HDMI Control” is “On,” Standby Through function is
automatically enabled and “Standby Through” is not displayed.
When the Standby Through function is on, the HDMI Through/
iPod Charge indicator on the front panel lights during the standby
mode. This unit consumes approximately 3 W of power.
En 100
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
Setting this unit’s multi-zone function
Multi Zone Setup items
Adjusting Zone2 volume
Zone2 Set
Max Volume
Specify the maximum volume level in Zone2 so that sound is not
too loud.
Initial Volume
Specify the initial volume level in Zone2 when this unit is turned on.
Setting the party mode
Party Mode Set
In party mode, the main zone sources can be played in Zone2
simultaneously (
p. 116). Select “Zone2,and then select
“Enable” or “Disable.
Making the receiver easier to use
Function Setup items
Zone2 Set Adjusts Zone2 volume level.
Party Mode Set Enable or disable the party mode function.
Adjustable range -30.0 dB to +16.5 dB (maximum volume)
Default setting +16.5 dB
Adjustment
increments
5.0 dB
Adjustable range Off, Mute, -80 dB to +16.5 dB
Default setting Off
Adjustment
increments
0.5 dB
Enable (Default) Enables the party mode function.
Disable Disables the party mode function.
Auto Power Down This unit enters standby mode if no operations are
performed.
Display Set Specifies menu items displayed on TV screen and the
front panel.
Trigger Output Specifies TRIGGER OUT jack function.
Memory Guard Protects some settings against accidental
modification.
En 101
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
Goes enter standby mode automatically
when you leave it without operating
Auto Power Down
If you do not operate this unit or use the remote control for an
extended period of time, it will automatically go into standby mode
(Auto Power Down function). This function’s default setting is
“Off.” When you want to enable this function, set the amount of
time to pass before this unit will enter standby.
Specifying menu display
Display Set
Specify front panel display brightness and TV screen wall paper.
Front Panel Display
Specify front panel display brightness and message scroll pattern.
Wall Paper
Specify the wall paper displayed on the TV screen when no video
signal is input. Select one that you prefer.
4hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated
this unit for four hours.
8hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated
this unit for eight hours.
12hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated
this unit for twelve hours.
Off (Default) Auto Power Down function is disabled.
This unit starts a countdown of 30 seconds before entering the
standby mode. Pressing any key of the remote control during the
countdown cancels entering the standby mode and reset the
timer.
Dimmer Adjustable range: -4 - 0
Reduce brightness of the front panel display. As the
value is lowered, the panel display darkens.
Scroll Selects the manner in which display scrolls when the
total number of characters exceeds the display area on
the front panel display.
Select “Continue” for continuous scrolling of all
characters.
Select “Once” to scroll through all characters once
and then halt scrolling for display of only the first 14
characters.
Picture Displays an image on the TV screen when there is no
video signal.
Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when
there is no video signal.
En 102
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
Setting TRIGGER OUT functions
Trigger Output
Sets the TRIGGER OUT jack to function synchronized with power
status of each zone or input switching.
Trigger Mode
Specify the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function.
Target Zone
Specify the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions
synchronized.
Target Source
Specify the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with
each input switching.
Manual
Manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission.
This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the
external component connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack.
Power (Default) The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized
with the power status of the zone specified with
“Target Zone.
Source The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized
with the input switching in the zone specified with
“Target Zone.
Electronic signal is transmitted according to the
setting made in “Target Source.
Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for
electronic signal transmission with “Manual.
Main (Default) When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with power status
of the main zone.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source, electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with input
switching in the main zone.
Zone2 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with power status
of Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source, electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with input
switching in Zone2.
All When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with power status
of the main zone or Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source, electronic
signal transmission is synchronized with input
switching in the main zone or Zone2.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you
switch to the input source specified in this option.
High (Default) Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the
input source specified in this option.
This setting is available only when “Trigger Mode” is set to
“Source.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission.
High (Default) Transmits the electronic signal.
This setting is available only when “Trigger Mode” is set to
“Manual.
SETUP
Setting various functions (Setup menu)
En 103
Prohibiting setting changes
Memory Guard
Prohibits setting changes to prevent careless changes being made
to the settings on Setup menu.
Language
Select the language used for display of menus and messages. J1
Choices: English (English), (Japanese), (French),
(German), (Spanish),
(Russian)
Off (Default) Settings are not protected.
On Prohibits changes to the settings on Setup menu until
it is returned to “Off.
While set to “On,” the unit displays “Memory
Guard!” when an attempt is made to change the
settings.
J
1 : Content window information is displayed in the language in which that
information was released.
SETUP
En 104
A variety of information for this unit can be displayed.
Selecting information
1
Press jON SCREEN.
2
Use kCursor B / C to select “Information”
and press kENTER.
3
Use kCursor D / E to select an Information
menu and press kENTER.
Audio information
Displays information on the current audio signal.
Video information
Displays information on the current video signal.
HDMI monitor
Displays information on the TV screen connected to this
unit’s HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks.
System information
Displays information on the current settings of “Remote
ID,” “TV Format” and “Speaker Impedance.
Zone information
Displays information on Zone2 settings.
Confirming information of this unit (Information menu)
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
MU
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOC
K
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
OPTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
Format Signal format. When this unit is unable to
detect a digital signal, it automatically
switches to analog input.
Sampling The number of samples taken per second
from a continuous signal to make a
discrete signal.
Channel The number of source channels in the
input signal (front/surround/LFE). For
example, a multi-channel soundtrack with
3 front channels, 2 surround channels and
LFE is displayed as “3/2/0.1”.
Bitrate The number of bits passing a given point
per second.
Dialogue The dialogue normalization level preset
to the current input bitstream signal.
“___” is displayed when this unit cannot display the
corresponding information.
Some high-definition audio bitstream contents may not
include the discrete surround back left and right
channel signals, but are encoded at a bitrate of 192
kHz.
Even when direct bitstream output settings are applied,
some players convert the Dolby TrueHD or Dolby
Digital Plus bitstreams to the Dolby Digital bitstreams,
while converting DTS-HD Master Audio or DTS-HD
High Resolution Audio bitstreams to DTS bitstreams.
HDMI signal Source video signal type and video signal
output to this unit’s HDMI OUT 1-2
jacks.
HDMI Resolution Input signal (analog or HDMI) and output
signal (HDMI) resolution.
Analog Resolution Resolution of the source video signal and
the analog video signal output to this
unit’s COMPONENT MONITOR OUT
jacks.
HDMI Error Error message for HDMI sources or
connected HDMI devices (p. 117).
Interface Displays information on the current
connection interface.
Video Resolution Displays the frequency for each video
resolution of the TV currently connected.
SETUP
En 105
You can operate an external component such as TV and DVD player with the remote control of this unit by setting the code for external component (remote control code).
The remote control code can be set for each input source. Individual setting allows you to switch external components seamlessly depending on the selected input source.
Selecting input source connected to DVD
player
Selecting input source connected to CD
player
Keys connecting external
components
cSOURCE A
Switches an external component on and off.
k
Cursor, kENTER, kRETURN
Operates the menus of external components.
l
DISPLAY
Switches an external component display.
l
External component operation keys
Functions as a recording or playback key of an external
component, or a menu display key.
mNumeric keys
Functions as numeric keys of an external component.
nTV control keys J1
Controlling other components with the remote control
cSOURCE A
dInput selector
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
kRETURN
lExternal component
operation keys
lDISPLAY
mNumeric keys
nTV control keys
nINPUT
nMUTE
nTV VOL +/-
nTV CH +/-
nA
pSOURCE/RECEIVER
RETURN
HDMI
AV
AUDIO
1234
125
V-AUX
ENTER
7856
90
10
1234
REC
TV
TV VOL TV CH
TOP
MENU
POP-UP
MENU
DISPLAY
SOURCE
RECEIVER
INPUT
MUTE
DOCK
MULTI
5
1234
6
[ A ]
SIRIUSTUNER
TAGHOLD
PRG SELECT
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENT
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
CODE SE
T
HDMI
OUT
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
m
l
d
p
c
k
n
Playback/Stop
DVD player
CD player
If you are unable to operate this unit after operating
an external component, light up
pSOURCE/RECEIVER in orange by pressing it,
and then try operating the remote control again.
Playback/Stop
DVD player
CD player
The remote control keys for controlling external
components are available only when the external
components have corresponding control keys.
nINPUT Switches video inputs of TV.
nMUTE Mutes TV volume temporarily.
nTV VOL +/- Controls the volume of TV.
nTV CH +/- Switches TV channels.
nA Turns on and off TV.
J
1 : When remote control codes for external components are
registered with
dInput selector or nA (nTV control
keys), the following operations are possible.
When a TV remote control code is registered with
dInput
selector, the
kCursor, mNumeric keys and nTV
control keys can be used to control the TV selected with
dInput selector.
When a remote control code for a device other than a TV is
registered with
dInput selector, keys including the
kCursor and mNumeric keys can be used to control
external components, and the
nTV control keys can be used
to control the TV registered with
nA.
When a TV remote control code is registered with nA, only
nTV control keys can be used to control the TV.
SETUP
Controlling other components with the remote control
En 106
Default remote control code
settings
The following remote control codes are assigned to input
sources as factory default settings. For a complete list of
available remote control codes, refer to “Remote Control
Code Search” in the CD-ROM.
Registering remote control codes
for external component operations
The following section describes how to register remote
control code using an example of the registration of the
remote control codes of a Yamaha BD player connected
to HDMI2 jack.
1
Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-
ROM to search the available remote control
codes from the category or manufacturer of
external components.
“2064” can be used for a Yamaha BD player.
2
Press oCODE SET using a pointed object
such as the tip of a ballpoint pen.
3
Press dHDMI2 to switch the input source to
HDMI2. J2
Perform the following steps to register the selected
input source here to the remote control code.
dHDMI2
nTV control keys
nA
oCODE SET
2
TV
TV VOL TV CH
CODE SET
INPUT
MUTE
SC
ENE
RET
U
R
N
V
OLUME
ENHAN
C
E
R
SU
R. DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
S
LEEP
PU
RE DIRE
C
T
P
ART
Y
MO
VI
E
MUS
I
C
BD
D
V
D
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUTE
ENTER
7
8
5
6
9
0
1
0
1
2
3
4
R
E
C
EN
T
TOP
MEN
U
PO
P-
UP
MENU
DI
S
PLAY
SOU
R
C
E
MAIN
ZONE 2
RECEIVE
R
O
PTI
O
N
ON SCREE
N
FM
I
NF
O
M
EMORY
AM
P
RE
S
ET
HDMI
AV
AU
DI
O
1
3
4
1
2
5
V
-A
UX
D
OC
K
H
DMI OUT
MU
LT
I
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
SIRIU
S
TUNER
TUN.
/CH
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
o
n
d
Input Category Manufacturer
Remote
control code
HDMI1 Blu-ray player/
recorder
Yamaha 2064
HDMI2 ——
HDMI3 ——
HDMI4 ——
HDMI5 ——
AV1 ——
AV2 ——
AV3 CD player Yamaha 5095
AV4 ——
AV5 ——
AV6 ——
AUDIO1 ——
AUDIO2 ——
V-AUX ——
A J1 ——
DOCK ——
TUNER ——
SIRIUS ——
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Settings will be automatically stopped if more than 1
minute passes since the last operation. To reset, repeat
from step 2.
Remote control code of an external component cannot
be set from the name or model number of a unit. Use
Remote Control Code Search
” in the CD-ROM to
search the available remote control codes from the
category or manufacturer of external components.
If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first
code in the list, if it does not work then try the other
codes.
SOURCE
RECEIVER
CODE SET
MAI
N
ZO
NE
2
HDM
I
1
2
3
4
blinks twice
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : Use A for external component operations only. Set these keys to
remote control codes if you want to perform external component
operations without linking to input source selection of this unit.
For example, it may be convenient to assign remote control codes
for devices such as TVs.
J
2 : When you want to register a remote control code to the
nTV control keys, press nA (nTV control keys) in step
3.
SETUP
Controlling other components with the remote control
En 107
4
Enter a remote control code “2064” using
mNumeric keys. J1
Once the remote control code is registered successfully
pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice.
5
To switch between BD player linked to
scene selections, press iSCENE and at the
same time press dHDMI2 and hold it for
approximately 3 seconds.
Then you can operate the external components by
switching the input source to HDMI2, or selecting
HDMI2 in the registered scene.
Same steps for operating other external components,
press
iSCENE and at the same time press the input
source key selected in step 3 and hold it for
approximately 3 seconds.
Resetting all remote control codes
Resetting all remote control codes for external
components to the initial factory settings.
1
Press oCODE SET using a pointed object
such as the tip of a ballpoint pen.
2
Press pSOURCE/RECEIVER on the remote
control.
3
Enter “9981” using mNumeric keys.
d
HDMI2
iSCENE
mNumeric keys
oCODE SET
pSOURCE/RECEIVER
SCENE
2
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADIO
7856
90
1234
SOURCE
RECEIVER
CODE SET
RETURN
V
OLUME
ENHAN
C
E
R
SU
R. DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
S
LEEP
PU
RE DIRE
C
T
P
ART
Y
MO
VI
E
MUS
I
C
MUTE
ENTER
1
0
R
EC
EN
T
TOP
MEN
U
PO
P-
UP
MENU
DI
S
PLAY
MAIN
ZONE 2
INPUT
MUTE
HDMI
AV
AU
DI
O
1
3
4
1
2
5
V
-A
UX
D
OC
K
H
DMI OUT
MU
LT
I
O
PTI
O
N
ON SCREE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
FM
I
NF
O
M
EMORY
AM
P
RE
S
ET
[
A
]
SIRIU
S
TUNER
TUN.
/CH
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
m
o
p
i
d
If the registration fails, repeat from step 2.
In case of an external component with multiple remote
control codes, the other remote control codes may be
supported. Repeat from step 2 with the other remote
control codes.
2 0
6
4
SOURCE
RECEIVER
MAI
N
ZO
NE
2
C
ODE SE
T
HDM
I
1
2
3
4
Registration successful: blinks twice
Registration failed: blinks 6 times
Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute.
Settings will be automatically stopped if more than 1
minute passes since the last operation. To reset, repeat
from step 1.
SOURCE
RECEIVER
CODE SET
MAI
N
ZO
NE
2
HDM
I
1
2
3
4
blinks twice
Once the remote control code is reset successfully
pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice.
If setup fails, repeat from step 1.
9 9
8
1
SOURCE
RECEIVER
MAI
N
ZO
NE
2
C
ODE SE
T
HDM
I
1
2
3
4
Reset successful: blinks twice
Reset failed: blinks 6 times
J
1 : When you want to register a remote control code to the
nTV control keys, enter the TV remote control code in step 4.
SETUP
En 108
The Advanced Setup menu can be used for unit initialization and other useful extended functions. The Advanced Setup menu can be operated as follows.
Displaying/Setting the Advanced Setup
menu
1
Switch this unit to the standby mode.
2
Press MAIN ZONE A while pressing and holding
STRAIGHT on the front panel.
Release STRAIGHT when “ADVANCED SETUP” is displayed
on the front panel display.
After a few seconds, the top menu items are displayed.
3
Rotate PROGRAM selector to select the item to be
set from the following items.
In the Advanced Setup menu, you can set the following settings.
4
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select the value you
want to change.
5
Switch this unit to the standby mode, and then
switch it on again.
The settings become effective and the unit is powered on.
Setting the impedance of speakers
Changes the unit settings depending on the impedance of the
speakers connected. J1
Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu)
PHONES
YPAO MIC
SILENT
CINEMA
TONE
CONTROL
STRAIGHT
TV
BD
DVD
CD
RADIO
INPUT
PROGRAM
SCENE
INFOZONE
CONTROL
ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
MEMORY
PRESET
FM AM
CATEGORY
STRAIGHT
PROGRAM selector
MAIN ZONE A
SP IMP. Sets the impedance of speakers.
REMOTE ID Changes the remote control ID of a receiver.
SR PIN Resets the parental lock code for the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio tuner.
TV FORMAT Specifies the TV’s color encoding format.
MON.CHK Removes the up-scaling limitation on HDMI video
output.
INIT Initializes various settings for this unit.
6ΩMIN Select the impedance when 6 Ω speakers are
connected.
8ΩMIN (Default) Select the impedance when speakers above 8 Ω are
connected.
SPIMP.-8MIN
J
1 : For detailed procedures of speaker impedance settings, refer to “Changing
speaker impedance” (
p. 18).
SETUP
Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu)
En 109
Avoiding crossing remote control
signals when using multiple
Yamaha receivers
The remote control of the unit can only receive signals
from a receiver which has an identical ID (remote
control ID). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers,
you can set each remote control with a unique remote
control ID for its corresponding receiver.
On the contrary, if you are setting the same remote
control ID for all receivers, you can use one remote
control to operate 2 receivers.
Resetting the SIRIUS Satellite
Radio™ parental lock code
Reset the SIRIUS Satellite Radio parental lock code to
the factory default setting. If you forget the code, it can
be reset.
m
Numeric keys
oCODE SET
pSOURCE/RECEIVER
7856
90
1234
SOURCE
RECEIVER
CODE SET
SC
ENE
RETURN
V
OLUME
ENHAN
C
E
R
SU
R. DE
CO
DE
S
TRAI
G
HT
S
LEEP
PU
RE DIRE
C
T
P
ART
Y
MO
VI
E
MUS
I
C
BD
D
V
D
TV
CD
RADI
O
MUTE
ENTER
10
R
EC
EN
T
TOP
MEN
U
PO
P-
UP
MENU
FM
I
NF
O
M
EMORY
AM
P
RE
S
ET
HDMI
AV
AU
DI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-A
UX
DI
S
PLAY
MAIN
ZONE 2
INPUT
MUTE
D
OCK
HDMI OU
T
MU
LT
I
O
PTI
O
N
ON SCREE
N
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
SIRIU
S
TUNER
TUN.
/CH
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
o
p
m
ID1 (Default) Receives the remote control signals set in
ID1.
ID2 Receives the remote control signals set in
ID2.
ID1 is set for both remote control and receiver by
default. To avoid crossing remote control, change the
remote control ID for both remote control and
receiver.
REMOTEID-ID1
To change the remote control ID
1
Press oCODE SET using a pointed
object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen.
2
Press pSOURCE/RECEIVER.
3
Enter the desired remote control ID code.
To switch to ID1:
Enter “5019” using
mNumeric keys.
To switch to ID2:
Enter “5020” using
mNumeric keys.
Once the remote control code is registered successfully
pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice.
Perform each of the following steps within
1 minute. Settings will be automatically stopped if
more than 1 minute passes since the last operation.
To reset, repeat from step 1.
SOURCE
RECEIVER
MAI
N
ZO
NE
2
C
ODE SE
T
HDM
I
1
2
3
4
Registration successful: blinks twice
Registration failed: blinks 6 times
If setup fails, repeat from step 1.
Returns to ID1 after the remote control code is
initialized (
p. 107).
RESET Resets the code to the factory default
setting.
CANCEL (Default) Cancels resetting of the parental lock
code.
SRPIN-CANCEL
En 110
SETUP
Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu)
Changing TV format
Change the color encoding format of OSD to PAL or NTSC
(default), to match the format used by the TV connected via the
HDMI OUT 1-2 or VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jack.
Removing HDMI video output up-scaling
limits
Removes the up-scaling limitation on video resolution when this
unit and a TV are connected via HDMI jacks.
If a resolution supported by the monitor cannot be detected when
configuring the up-scaling settings, this setting will remove the
output limitation.
Initializing various settings for this unit
Initializes various settings stored in this unit and sets it back to
default.
Select the items to be initialized from the following.
When an option other than CANCEL is selected, the applicable
default settings will be restored when the unit switches to standby
mode.
YES (Default) Video output signals of a resolution not supported by
the TV will not be transmitted.
SKIP This unit ignores the TV’s support capability and
transmits input video signals to the TV.
TVFORMAT-NTSC
MON.CHK-YES
DSP PARAM Initializes all parameters for the sound programs.
VIDEO Resets video conversion settings (resolution/aspect
ratio) in the Setup menu.
ALL Resets this unit to default factory settings.
CANCEL (Default) Does not initialize.
INIT- CANCEL
SETUP
En 111
This unit supports the HDMI Control function, which allows you to
operate external components via HDMI. If devices that support
HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link-compatible TVs,
DVD/Blu-ray Disc players, etc.) are connected J1, remote
controls for those devices can be used to perform the following
operations:
Power synchronization (on/standby)
Volume control, including Mute
Changing the volume of the audio output signal device (either the
TV or this unit)
1
Connect the TV that supports the HDMI Control
function to this units HDMI output jack.
2
Connect the DVD recorder that supports the HDMI
Control function to this unit’s HDMI input jack.
3
Turn on the TV and this unit.
Refer to the TV’s instruction manual on how to operate external
components.
4
Set the TV and this unit’s HDMI Control function to
“On.
5
Turn the TV off.
Other synchronized HDMI Control devices are turned off with the
TV. If they are not synchronized, turn them off manually.
6
Turn the TV on.
Confirm that this unit has turned on in conjunction with the TV. If
it is still off, turn it on manually.
7
Change the TV’s input setting to the input jack that
is connected to this unit (e.g., HDMI1).
8
If DVD/BD player that supports the HDMI Control
function are connected to this unit, turn them on.
9
Confirm that this unit is properly synchronized with
the TV through the following operations by using the
TV remote control.
Power On/Off
Volume Control
Switching between audio output devices
Using the HDMI Control function
NOTE
The following is an example of how to connect this unit, a TV,
and a DVD/BD player. Follow the instructions in your TV and
DVD/BD player manuals, as well as the ones written below.
Set the TV’s HDMI Control function to “On”
Follow the AV amplifier connection instructions, and connect
this unit to the TV
HDMI
Control signal
(such as volume control)
Remote control of TV
This unit
TV
HDMI connection
This unit Confirm that “HDMI Control” is set to “On” (p. 98)
and select the HDMI OUT jack connected to the TV
in “Control Select” (p. 98). J2
TV and DVD/BD
player
Check the instruction manuals for those devices.
This unit Confirm that the input source for the DVD/BD players
has been selected. If a different input source has been
selected, change it manually.
TV and DVD/BD
player
Confirm that the video signal from the player is being
properly received by the TV.
Operations 1-8 will not be required more than twice.
If this unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations,
check that the HDMI Control function is set to “On” for both
devices.
If they will not properly synchronize, unplugging and re-
plugging the devices and turning them on and off may solve the
problem.
J
1 : We recommend that you use TVs and DVD/BD players from the same
manufacturer whenever possible.
J
2 : The default setting for the HDMI Control function is “Off.
SETUP
Using the HDMI Control function
En 112
Switching the input source on this
unit automatically when listening
to TV audio
When the HDMI Control (p. 111) is operating
properly, the input source of this unit is automatically
changed to match operations carried out on the TV.
When the TV is connected with HDMI OUT 1, the
default input jack is AV4. If the AV4 optical digital jack
is connected to the TV’s audio output jack, then you can
enjoy TV sound through this unit right away.
When the TV is connected with HDMI OUT 2, the
default input jack is AV1. If the AV1 optical digital jack
is connected to the TV’s audio output jack, then you can
enjoy TV sound through this unit right away.
To use other jacks to input audio signals from TV, carry
out the following procedure.
1
Connect this unit and the TV with an HDMI
cable.
2
Connect TV’s audio output to this unit.
The input jacks listed below are available to input TV’s
audio signals. Use the same jack type as used for the
TV.
3
Press jON SCREEN. J1
4
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Setup” and press kENTER.
5
Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select
“HDMI” and press kENTER.
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
OPTICAL
D
OC
K
A
V 3
AV 5
AV 6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
MU
(
CD
)
CO
AXIAL
V
IDE
O
(
B
D
/
DVD
)
AV
OUT
S
URR
TR
F
R
O
N
T
IN
R
O
U
T
H
DMI
O
UT
1
2
ARC
A
R
C
SELECTABLE
ANTENNA
FM
H
D R
adio
G
ND
AM
75
O
PTICA
L
AV 1
AV 2
CO
AXIAL
COMPONENT
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRIU
S
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
OU
T
P
R
P
B
Y
OPTICAL
O
O
Audio output
(Optical)
TV
TV output jack Input jack
Optical digital audio output AV1 or AV4 (Default)
Coaxial digital audio output AV2 or AV3
Analog stereo output AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2
(
TV
)
A
V
3
A
V
4
A
V
5
A
V
6
AUDIO 1
AUDIO 2
(
CD
)
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
OPTICAL
A
V
1
A
V
2
COAXIAL
D
OCK
MULTI CH INPUT
VIDE
O
HDMI 1
(
BD
/
DV
D
)
HDMI 2
HDMI
3
HDMI 4
HDMI 5
C
ENTER
SU
RR
O
FR
O
N
T
AV
OUT
S
UBWOOFE
R
AU
DI
O
OUT
ZO
NE2
O
UT
SU
R.BA
C
K
SU
RR
OU
ND
SUR
F
R
O
N
T
TRIGGER OUT
+12V
0
.1
A
MAX.
FR
O
NT
C
ENTE
R
IN
REMOTE
O
U
T
HDMI OU
T
1
2
A
R
C
A
R
C
S
ELE
C
TABL
E
ANTENNA
FM
H
D R
ad
i
o
GN
D
AM
7
5
C
OMPONENT
VIDEO
P
R
P
B
Y
S
IRI
US
CO
MP
O
NEN
T
V
IDE
O
VIDE
O
MO
NIT
O
R
OUT
P
R
P
B
Y
Available input jacks
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : Refer to the “Setting various functions (Setup menu)” (p. 90)
for details on the Setup menu.
SETUP
Using the HDMI Control function
En 113
6
Make sure that “HDMI Control” is “On”
When “HDMI Control” is set to “Off,” press
kENTER and kCursor B / C to set to “On.
7
Press kCursor C to select “Control Select”
and press kENTER.
8
Use kCursor B / C to select the HDMI OUT
jack connected to the TV.
9
Press kCursor C to select “TV Audio
Input” and press kENTER.
10
Use kCursor B / C to select the input
jack connected in step 2.
11
Press jON SCREEN when you have
finished changing the settings.
If the TV hereafter transmits audio output signals,
this unit will automatically switch to the input
source chosen in step 10.
Single HDMI cable input to TV
audio with Audio Return Channel
function
When using a TV that supports HDMI functions and
Audio Return Channel function, audio/video output
from this unit to the TV or audio output from the TV to
this unit can be transmitted through a single HDMI cable
(Audio Return Channel function). Audio signals
transmitted from the TV to this unit can be assigned to
any input source.
1
Connect this unit and the TV with an HDMI
cable.
2
Press jON SCREEN. J1
3
Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select
“Setup” and press kENTER.
4
Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select
“HDMI” and press kENTER.
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C / D / E
kENTER
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
k
j
HDMI OUT
12
ARC ARC
SELECTABLE
V
IDE
O
HDMI 1
(
B
D
/
DV
D
)
HDMI
2
HDMI 3
HDMI 4
C
ENTE
R
F
R
O
NT
IN
R
EM
O
TE
O
U
T
ANTENNA
FM
HD R
ad
i
o
G
N
D
AM
75
NT
CO
MP
O
NENT
V
IDE
O
V
IDE
O
P
R
P
B
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
TV
TV audio
output
Video / Audio
output
Continues to the
next page
J
1 : Refer to the “Setting various functions (Setup menu)” (p. 90)
for details on the Setup menu.
SETUP
Using the HDMI Control function
En 114
5
Make sure that “HDMI Control” is “On.
When “HDMI Control” is set to “Off,” press
kENTER and kCursor B / C to set to “On.
6
Press kCursor C to select “Control Select”
and press kENTER.
7
Use kCursor B / C to select the HDMI OUT
jack connected to the TV.
8
Press kCursor C to select “TV Audio
Input” and press kENTER.
9
Use kCursor B / C to select the input
source to which the HDMI audio signals will
be assigned, and press kRETURN.
10
Press kCursor C to select “ARC (Audio
Return Channel)” and press
kENTER. J1
11
Press kCursor C to select “On.
The Audio Return Channel function will turn on.
12
Press jON SCREEN to close the Setup
menu.
If the TV hereafter transmits audio output signals,
this unit will automatically switch to the input
source chosen in step 9.
jON SCREEN
kCursor B / C
kENTER
kRETURN
RETURN
ENTER
ON SCREEN
SCENE
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHTSLEEP
P
URE DIRECT
PART Y
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
A
UDI
O
1
2
3
4
1
2
5
V
-
AUX
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
M
AIN
Z
O
NE 2
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
5
1
2
3
4
6
[
A
]
S
IRI
US
TU
NER
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
j
k
JJ
1 : While the Audio Return Channel function is on, the jack selected
for the input source cannot be used.
SETUP
En 115
This unit allows you to configure a multi-zone audio system. The Zone2 feature allows you to set this unit to reproduce separate input sources in the main zone and the second zone (Zone2). You can
control this unit from the second zone using the supplied remote control.
Connecting Zone2
You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-zone functions of this unit:
An infrared signal receiver in the second zone.
An infrared signal emitter in the main zone. This emitter transmits infrared signals from the remote control
to a CD player or a DVD player, etc. in the main zone via the infrared signal receiver in the second zone.
An amplifier and speakers in the second zone.
Using the external amplifier
An amplifier located in the secondary zone can be connected to this unit as shown below.
Using the internal amplifier of this unit
Connect the speakers in the second zone to the EXTRA SP jacks directly (p. 18).
Using REMOTE IN/OUT jacks for multi-zone components
This unit is equipped with REMOTE IN and REMOTE OUT jacks. You can use these jacks to control
this unit and other components from Zone2 (
p. 30).
Using multi-zone configuration
Only analog signal can be sent to Zone2. If you want to output sound from Zone2, connect an
external component to AV5-6, AUDIO1-2, or VIDEO AUX by analog connection. For example, if
you want to output sound from an HDMI DVD player in Zone2, you must connect the component to
this unit by both HDMI and analog connections.
Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-zone configuration, we
recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center about the
Zone2 connections that best meet your requirements.
To the REMOTE IN jack
Infrared signal
emitter
DVD player (etc.)
Amplifier
Remote control
Second zone
(Zone2)
This unit
From the ZONE2 OUT jacks
Infrared signal
receiver
From the REMOTE OUT jack
Main zone
To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS.
Some Yamaha models can be directly connected to the REMOTE jacks of this unit. These models
may not require an infrared signal emitter. Up to 6 Yamaha components can be connected as shown
below.
ZONE2
OUT
HDMI
3
HDMI 4
HDMI
5
C
ENTE
R
SU
RR
OU
ND
S
URROUND BACK
/
BI
-
AMP
S
IN
G
LE
FR
O
N
T
WOO
FER
AUDI
O
OU
T
SU
RR
OU
ND
SU
R.BA
C
K
PRE
OU
T
SU
BW
OO
FE
R
1
2
F
R
O
N
T
N
TE
R
EXTRA
SP
CENTERSINGLE
S
PEAKER
S
SPEAKERS
RS
-2
3
2
C
Z
ONE2/PRESENCE
AUDIO
R
L
R
L
Amplifier
Second Zone
(Zone2)
Audio input
REMOTE
IN
Infrared signal
receiver
This unit Yamaha
component
REMOTE
OUT IN
REMOTE
OUT
SETUP
Using multi-zone configuration
En 116
Controlling Zone2
The remote control can be used to select and control
Zone2 devices. The available operations are as follows:
Selecting the input source of Zone2.
Tuning into FM or AM when “TUNER” is selected as the
input source of Zone2.
Tuning into SIRIUS Satellite Radio when “SIRIUS” is
selected as the input source of Zone2.
Adjust the volume of Zone2 devices (when connected via
the built-in amplifier).
Activating the Zone2 operation
mode
Set bMAIN/ZONE2 to ZONE2 before attempting to
use the remote control to control Zone2 devices.
Operating Zone2
To enable and disable the audio output to Zone2
Press qRECEIVER A.
To select an input source for Zone2
Press dInput selector.
To enable the sleep timer for Zone2
Automatically switch the Zone2 device to standby mode
after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer).
Press gSLEEP repeatedly to specify a time for the
sleep timer function.
Using the party mode
Use this feature to play main zone sources in Zone2
simultaneously. This feature is useful when you want to
play back main sources as background music in a home
party, etc. When using the party mode, set “Party Mode
Set” to “Enable” (
p. 100).
Press hPART Y to turn on or off the party mode.
“PARTY MODE ON” or “PARTY MODE OFF” appears
on the front panel display or the TV screen.
While this unit is in the party mode, the ZONE2
indicators turn on in the front panel display.
b
MAIN/ZONE2
dInput selector
gSLEEP
hPART Y
qRECEIVER A
SLEEP
AUDIO
12
V-AUX
PART Y
MAIN
ZONE 2
5
6
SIRIUSTUNER
SCENE
RETURN
VO
L
U
ME
ENHANCE
R
S
UR. DE
CO
DE
STRAIGHT
P
URE DIRECT
M
OVI
E
M
USI
C
BD
DVD
TV
CD
RADI
O
M
U
T
E
ENTER
7
8
5
6
9
0
10
1
2
3
4
R
EC
ENT
TOP
MENU
P
OP-U
P
M
EN
U
DI
S
PLAY
SO
UR
C
E
RE
C
EIVE
R
CODE SE
T
I
NP
U
T
MUTE
FM
I
NF
O
M
EM
O
RY
AM
P
RESET
H
DMI
AV
1
2
3
4
5
DOCK
HDMI
O
U
T
MULTI
O
PTION
O
N
SC
REE
N
1
2
3
4
[
A
]
TUN./C
H
C
ATE
GO
R
Y
d
q
b
h
g
Sleep 120min. Sleep 90min.
Sleep 60min.Sleep 30min.Sleep Off
Input audio signals are mixed down to 2ch Stereo and
output at the analog ZONE2 OUT jacks.
En 117
APPENDIX
Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly.
If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below, or if the instructions below do not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service
center.
General
Troubleshooting
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
The power will not
turn on.
The protection circuitry operated
3 times consecutively.
As a safety precaution, when the protection
circuitry operates 3 times consecutively, the
capability to turn on the power is disabled.
Contact your nearest Yamaha dealer or
service center to request repair.
The unit enters
standby mode soon
after the power is
turned on.
The power cable is not completely
inserted.
Connect the power cable properly to an AC
wall outlet.
(When this unit is turned back on
and “CHECK SP WIRES!” is
displayed.) The protection
circuitry has been activated
because this unit was turned on
while a speaker cable was shorted.
Make sure that all speaker cables between
this unit and speakers are connected
properly.
19
This unit cannot be
turned off or does
not work properly.
The internal microcomputer is
hung-up due to an external electric
shock (such as lightning or
excessive static electricity) or by a
drop in power supply voltage.
Disconnect the power cable from the AC
wall outlet, wait about 30 seconds and then
plug it in again.
The batteries in the remote control
may have lost their charge.
Replace all batteries. 7
The unit enters
standby mode.
The protection circuitry has been
activated because of a short circuit,
etc.
Check that the speaker with an impedance
of at least 6 Ω.
Check that the speaker impedance settings
are correct.
18
Check that the speaker wires are not
touching each other, then turn the unit back
on.
The sleep timer has turned off the
unit.
Turn on the unit, and play the source again.
After display of a
countdown on the
front panel, the unit
goes into standby
mode.
If you do not use take any action,
the Auto Power Down function
operates.
Turn on the unit, and play the source again.
In the Setup menu “Auto Power Down”
(“Function “Auto Power Down”),
increase the time until switching to standby
mode, or turn off the Auto Power Down
function.
101
No sound. Incorrect input or output cable
connections.
Connect the cables properly. If the problem
persists, the cables may be defective.
25
Speaker connections are not
secure.
Secure the connections. 19
The HDMI components connected
to the unit do not support the
HDCP copy protection standards.
Connect HDMI components that support the
HDCP copy protection standards.
The audio input into the device is
set to playback through the TV.
In the Setup menu, set the “Amp” of “Audio
Output” (“HDMI” “Audio Output”
“Amp”) to “On.
99
No appropriate input source has
been selected.
Select an appropriate input source with
Input selector.
41
The volume is turned down or
muted.
Turn up the volume.
Signals that this unit cannot
reproduce are being input from a
source component, such as a CD-
ROM.
Use an input source that has signals that can
be reproduced on this unit.
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
En 118
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
No picture. The video signal output from this
unit is not supported by a monitor
connected to this unit via the
HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks.
Displays the Advanced Setup menu and
select “VIDEO” in “INIT” to reset the video
parameters.
110
Displays the Advanced Setup menu and set
“MON.CHK” to “YES.
110
An appropriate video input is not
selected on the TV.
Select an appropriate video input on the TV.
No sound is output
from a specific
speaker.
The speaker is malfunctioning.
Check the Speaker indicators on
the front panel display. If the
corresponding indicator lights up,
connect another speaker and check
if sound is output.
If sound is not output, the unit may be
malfunctioning.
10
The playback component or
speakers are not connected
properly.
Connect the cables properly. If the problem
persists, the cables may be defective.
19, 25
Output from that speaker is
disabled.
Check the Speaker indicators on the front
panel display. If the corresponding indicator
is turned off, try the following.
1) Change to a different input source.
2) With the selected sound program, sound
is not output from that speaker. Select
another sound program.
3) “None” may have been selected for that
speaker on this unit. Display “Speaker” in
the Setup menu, and set respective
parameters to enable output from that
speaker (“Speaker” “Manual Setup”
“Configuration”).
10, 91
The volume of that speaker is set
to the minimum in “Speaker” in
the Setup menu.
Display “Speaker” in the Setup menu and
adjust the volume (“Speaker” “Manual
Setup” “Level”).
93
(If hardly any sound comes from
one channel)
Speaker output balance is not set
correctly.
Balance the volume of each speaker from
“Level” in the Setup menu (“Speaker”
“Manual Setup” “Level”).
93
Sound may not be output from
certain channels, depending on the
input source or sound program.
Try another sound program. 43
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
Only the center
speaker outputs
substantial sound.
When a monaural source sound
program is applied, for some
surround decoders, sound from all
channels is output from the center
speaker.
Try another sound program. 43
No sound is heard
from the presence
speakers.
This unit is in straight decoding
mode and a monaural source is
being played back.
Press STRAIGHT to exit straight decoding
mode.
44
Sound may not be output from
certain channels depending on
input sources or sound programs.
Try another sound program. 43
No sound is heard
from the surround
speakers.
This unit is in straight decoding
mode and a monaural source is
being played back.
Press STRAIGHT to exit straight decoding
mode.
44
Sound may not be output from
certain channels depending on
input sources or sound programs.
Try another sound program. 43
No sound is heard
from the surround
back speakers.
“Extended Surround” in the
OPTION menu is set to “OFF,” or
an input signal does not contain a
surround back flag with “Extended
Surround” set to “Auto.
Set “Extended Surround” other than “OFF
or “Auto.”
53
No sound is heard
from the subwoofer.
A subwoofer is not connected, or it
is inactive.
Check that a subwoofer is connected
correctly, and from the Setup menu
“Subwoofer” (“Speaker” “Manual
Setup” “Configuration”
“Subwoofer”), set the subwoofer to “Use.
20, 93
The subwoofer is turned off. Turn the subwoofer power on.
If the subwoofer includes an Auto Power
Off function, then lower the Auto Power Off
sensitivity settings.
The source does not contain LFE
(p. 125) or low frequency
signals.
The right
combination of audio
/ video jacks to
connect cannot be
found.
Combine input connected to the
external component video output
with another input audio jack.
Display the Input menu for the connected
video output, select “Audio In” and select
the jack to use for audio input.
80
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
En 119
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
HDMI™
The audio input
sources cannot be
played in the desired
digital audio signal
format.
The connected component is not
set to output the desired digital
audio signals.
Set the playback component properly
referring to its instruction manual.
There is noise
interference from
digital or radio
frequency
equipment.
This unit is too close to other
digital or radio frequency
equipment.
Move this unit further away from such
equipment.
Noise/hum noise is
heard.
Incorrect cable connection.
Connect the audio cables properly.
If the problem persists, the cables may be
defective.
A DTS-CD is being played back. 1) When only noise is output
If a DTS bitstream signal is not properly
input to this unit, only noise is output.
Connect the playback component to this
unit by digital connection and playback the
DTS-CD. If the condition is not improved,
the problem may results from the playback
component. Consult the manufacturer of the
playback component.
2) When noise is output during playback or
skip operation
Before playing back the DTS-CD, display
the Input menu after selecting the input
source and set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS.
The volume cannot
be increased, or the
sound is distorted.
The component connected to the
output jacks of this unit is not
turned on.
When the component connected to the
output jacks of this unit is not turned on, the
sound may be distorted, or the volume may
decreased due to the nature of AV receivers.
Turn on all components connected to this
unit.
“Max Volume” is set to a low
value.
Set it to a higher value. 95
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
The front panel
display HDMI
indicator is flashing.
An error with the HDMI
connection has occurred.
Try re-inserting the HDMI cable.
Confirm that HDMI video that is not
supported by the unit is not being input
(Information menu “Video
information”).
104
No picture or sound. The number of components is over
the limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI components.
The connected HDMI component
does not support high-bandwidth
digital copyright protection
(HDCP).
Connect an HDMI component that supports
HDCP.
(When using HDMI
Control function)
TV sound is not
output from this unit
when operating the
remote control of the
TV.
The TV audio output is not
connected to this unit, or the
setting to match operations carried
out on TV is not set.
Connect the TV audio output to this unit,
and then select the connected input source
in “TV Audio Input” (Setup menu HDMI
TV Audio Input).
98
(When using Audio Return
Channel function)
The Audio Return Channel
function is not working.
Make sure that your TV supports Audio
Return Channel.
Set the Audio Return Channel function to
on (Setup menu HDMI ARC (Audio
Return Channel)).
98
En 120
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
Tuner (FM/AM)
FM
AM
HD Radio™ Reception
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
FM stereo reception
is noisy.
You are too far from the station
transmitter, or the input from the
antenna is weak.
Check the antenna connections. 32
Switch to monaural mode. 58
Replace the outdoor antenna with a more
sensitive multi-element antenna.
There is distortion,
and clear reception
cannot be obtained
even with a good FM
antenna.
There is multi-path interference. Adjust the antenna height or orientation, or
place it in a different location.
The desired station
cannot be tuned into
with the automatic
tuning method.
You are in an area far from a
station, or input from the antenna
is weak.
Replace the outdoor antenna with a more
sensitive multi element antenna.
Use TUN./CH H / I to manually select the
station.
56
“No Presets” is
displayed.
No preset stations are registered. Register stations you want to listen to as
preset stations before operation.
56
“Wrong Station” is
displayed.
An invalid FM/AM frequency has
been input.
Input a frequency that can be received.
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
The desired station
cannot be tuned into
with the automatic
tuning method.
The signal is weak, or the antenna
connections are loose.
Adjust the AM loop antenna orientation. 32
Use the manual tuning method. 56
Automatic station
preset does not
work.
Automatic station preset is not
available for AM stations.
Use manual station preset. 56
Continuous
crackling and
hissing noises are
heard.
The supplied AM loop antenna is
not connected.
Connect the AM loop antenna correctly
even if you use an outdoor antenna.
32
The noises may be caused by
lightning, fluorescent lamps,
motors, thermostats, or other
electrical equipment.
It is difficult to completely eliminate noise,
but it can be reduced by installing and
properly grounding an outdoor AM antenna.
32
Buzzing and whining
noises are heard.
A TV set is being used nearby. Move this unit away from the TV set.
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
This unit cannot
receive the HD Radio
signals of the
selected radio
station.
The radio station provides analog
FM/AM radio service only.
Select other radio stations that provides the
HD Radio service.
60
The signal is too weak. Adjust the antenna position.
Use a high-quality FM/AM antenna.
Audio Mode” in the Option menu
is set to “Mono.
Set “Audio Mode” toAuto. 63
This unit cannot
select other audio
programs than the
main program.
The radio station provides one
audio program only.
HD Radio
information does not
appear.
The radio station does not provide
the information.
There is no sound
immediately after a
station is received.
After an HD Radio station is
received, about 5 seconds passes
before sound can be heard.
HD Radio
information is not
displayed properly.
The hold function is enabled. Press HOLD to disable the hold function. 62
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
En 121
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
iTunes Tagging SIRIUS Satellite Radio™
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
Tag data cannot be
transferred to your
iPod when it is
station in the
Universal Dock for
iPod/iPhone
(YDS-10).
“YDS-10” does not support tag
file transfer.
Use “YDS-12” or “YDS-11” to transfer tag
data from this unit to your iPod.
Status message Cause Remedy
See
page
Insufficient Data Tag data is not saved because of
invalid data.
The selected HD Radio program (or song
being played) does not support the iTunes
Tagging feature.
Tag Already Stored Tag data for the same content has
been already saved.
Tag Storage full Tag data cannot be stored because
the internal memory of this unit is
full.
Station your iPod/iPhone in the Universal
Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12) connected
to the DOCK terminal of this unit.
iPod full
Tags cannot be
stored
Tag data cannot be stored on your
iPod/iPhone because the HDD
space of your iPod/iPhone is full.
Delete unnecessary data from your iPod/
iPhone with iTunes to make room and try
again.
Transferring Failed Tag data cannot be transferred to
your iPod/iPhone.
Check if the iPod/iPhone is stationed in the
Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12)
properly.
Storing Tag Tag data is being stored in the
internal memory of this unit.
Transferring Tag data is being transferred to
your iPod/iPhone.
Tag(s)Sent Tag data has been transferred to
your iPod/iPhone.
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
SIRIUS Satellite
Radio information is
not displayed
properly.
The hold function is enabled. Press HOLD to disable the hold function. 69
Display Cause Remedy
See
page
ANTENNA ERROR The antenna is not connected to
the SiriusConnect tuner properly.
Check the connection of the antenna and
SiriusConnect tuner.
64
SIRIUS LOADING This unit is communicating with
the SiriusConnect tuner.
The message disappears normally within
several tens of seconds.
CHECK SR TUNER The SiriusConnect tuner is not
connected to the SIRIUS jack of
this unit correctly.
Check the connection of the SiriusConnect
tuner and this unit.
64
The SiriusConnect tuner is not
connected to the AC wall outlet.
Connect the power cable of the
SiriusConnect tuner to the AC wall outlet.
NOT SUPPORTED This unit does not support the
connected SIRIUS Satellite Radio
tuner.
Connect the SiriusConnect tuner that this
unit supports,
ACQUIRING The signal is too weak. Adjust the orientation of the antenna of the
SiriusConnect tuner. Check the antenna
reception level from the Antenna
information on the front panel display, or
the SIRIUS Information screen on the TV
screen.
68, 69
UPDATING The SiriusConnect tuner is
updating the channel list.
Wait until the updating is complete.
The period of the subscription is
end.
Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to renew the
subscription.
F/W UPDATING The SiriusConnect tuner is
updating the firmware.
Wait until the updating is complete.
En 122
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
iPod™/iPhone™
CALL SIRIUS
(CALL 888-539-
SIRIUS TO
SUBSCRIBE)
The selected channel is not
subscribed.
Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to subscribe
the selected channel.
URL: https://activate.siriusradio.com/
Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-
7474)
Select another channel. 65
SUB UPDATED The subscription information is
updated.
LOCK The parental lock function is
enabled.
Use Numeric keys to enter the 4-digit code,
select OK and then press ENT.
70
Reset the SIRIUS Satellite Radio parental
lock code to the factory default setting.
109
INVALID The selected channel is currently
out of service.
Select another channel. 65
Not Available The operation you made is not
available.
Display Cause Remedy
See
page
Display Cause Remedy
See
page
Loading... The unit is in the process of
recognizing the connection with
your iPod/iPhone.
The unit is in the middle of
acquiring song lists from your
iPod/iPhone.
Connect error There is a problem with the signal
path from your iPod/iPhone to the
unit.
Turn off the unit and reconnect the
Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone to the
DOCK jack of the unit.
71
Remove your iPod/iPhone from the
Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone and then
place it back in the dock.
71
Unknown iPod The iPod/iPhone being used is not
supported by the unit.
Connect an iPod/iPhone supported by the
unit.
iPod connected Your iPod/iPhone is properly
placed in the Universal Dock for
iPod/iPhone.
Your iPod/iPhone is properly
placed in the Yamaha iPod
wireless transmitter and connected
with this unit via wireless
transmission.
74
Disconnected Your iPod/iPhone is removed from
the Universal Dock for iPod/
iPhone.
Your iPod/iPhone is disconnected
with this unit via wireless
transmission.
Unable to play The unit cannot playback the
songs currently stored on your
iPod/iPhone.
Check that songs are currently stored on
your iPod/iPhone.
En 123
APPENDIX
Troubleshooting
Bluetooth™ Remote control
Display Cause Remedy
See
page
Searching... The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless
audio receiver and the Bluetooth
component are in the process of
pairing.
The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless
audio receiver and the Bluetooth
component are in the process of
establishing a connection.
Completed The pairing is completed.
Canceled The pairing is canceled.
BT connected The connection between the
Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio
receiver and the Bluetooth
component is established.
Disconnected The Bluetooth component is
disconnected from the Yamaha
Bluetooth wireless audio receiver.
Not found The Bluetooth component is not
found.
During pairing:
pairing must be performed on the
Bluetooth component and this unit
simultaneously. Check if the Bluetooth
component is in pairing mode.
During connecting:
check if the Bluetooth component is
turned on.
check if the Bluetooth component is
within 32 ft. (10 m) of the Yamaha
Bluetooth wireless audio receiver.
Pairing may not have been
achieved.
Try pairing again. 76
Problem Cause Remedy
See
page
The remote control
does not work or
function properly.
Wrong distance or angle. The remote control will function within a
maximum range of 20 ft. (6 m), and no
more than 30 degrees off-axis from the front
panel.
Direct sunlight or lighting (from
an inverter type of fluorescent
lamp, strobe light, etc.) is striking
the remote control sensor of this
unit.
Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition this
unit.
The batteries are weak. Replace all batteries. 7
The remote control ID of the
remote control and this unit do not
match.
Match the remote control ID of this unit and
the remote control.
106
External components
cannot be controlled
using the remote
control.
The remote control code is not
correctly set.
Set the remote control code correctly using
Remote control code search” on the CD-
ROM.
Try setting another code for the same
manufacturer using “Remote control code
search” on the CD-ROM.
If this unit does not work when you press
Cursor B / C / D / E, do the following.
When the key does not work during DVD
disc menu operation: press the Input
selector again.
When there is no response with remote
control operation of the OPTION menu/
Setup menu: press SOURCE/RECEIVER
(it should glow orange) and try operating the
remote control again.
Even if the remote control code is
correctly set, there are some
models that do not respond to the
remote control.
APPENDIX
En 124
Audio information
Audio and video synchronization (Lipsync)
Lip sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a technical term that
involves both a problem, and the capability of maintaining audio and video
signals synchronized during post-production and transmission.
Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex end-user
adjustment, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates an automatic audio and video
syncing capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization
automatically and accurately without user interaction.
Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp)
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. One
amplifier is connected to the woofer section of a loudspeaker while the
other is connected to the combined mid and tweeter section. With this
arrangement each amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range. This
restricted range presents each amplifier with a much simpler job and each
amplifier is less likely to influence the sound in some way.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely
independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front channels (front L/R and
center), and 2 surround stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range
audio channels. With an additional channel especially for bass effects,
referred to as LFE (Low-Frequency Effect), the system has a total of 5.1-
channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the
surround speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and surround sound
environments are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic
range from maximum to minimum volumes that are reproduced by the 5
full-range channels, and the precise sound orientation generated using
digital sound processing provides listeners with unprecedented excitement
and realism. With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a
5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment.
Dolby Pro Logic II
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast numbers
of existing Dolby Surround sources. This new technology enables a discrete
5-channel playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center channel,
and 2 surround left and right channels, instead of only 1 surround channel
for conventional Pro Logic technology. There are three modes available:
“Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and
“Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multichannel
playback from 2-channel or multi-channel sources. There are three modes
available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie
sources (for 2-channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game sources.
Dolby Surround
Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system to reproduce
realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left and right channels (stereo),
a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a surround channel for special
sound effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces sound within a
narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all
video tapes and laser discs, as well as in many TV and cable broadcasts.
The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital signal
processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel
to enhance moving sound effects and directionality.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for
high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an
optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers sound
that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition
home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 18.0 Mbps, Dolby
TrueHD can carry up to 8 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio
simultaneously. Dolby TrueHD also remains fully compatible with the
existing multichannel audio systems and retains the metadata capability of
Dolby Digital, allowing dialog normalization and dynamic range control.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for multichannel
sound on DVD video, and is fully backward-compatible with all DTS
decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical
48 kHz sampling rate. “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/24 offers
sound quality transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1-
channel sound with full-quality full-motion video for music programs and
motion picture soundtracks on DVD video.
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of
movies with a 5.1-channel digital sound track, and is now rapidly gaining
popularity in movie theaters around the world. DTS, Inc. has developed a
home theater system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural
spatial representation of DTS Digital Surround in your home. This system
produces practically distortion-free 5.1-channel sound (technically, left,
right and center channels, 2 surround channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as
a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1-channels). This unit incorporates a DTS-ES
decoder that enables 6.1-channel reproduction by adding the surround back
channel to the existing 5.1-channel format.
DTS Express
This is an audio format for next-generation optical discs such as Blu-ray
discs. It uses optimized low bit rate signals for network streaming. In the
case of a Blu-ray disc, this format is used with secondary audio, enabling
you to enjoy the commentary of the movie producer via the Internet while
playing the main program.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a high resolution audio technology
developed for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc.
Selected as an optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology
delivers sound that is virtually indistinguishable from the original, offering
a high-definition home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps for Blu-ray Disc, DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz
audio simultaneously.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio also remains fully compatible with the
existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital
Surround.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio technology developed
for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an
optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers sound
that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition
home theater experience.
Supporting bitrates up to 24.5 Mbps for Blu-ray Disc, DTS-HD Master
Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio
simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the
optical disc players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD
Master Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel
audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround.
Glossary
APPENDIX
Glossary
En 125
DSD
Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio signals on digital
storage media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using DSD, signals are stored as
single bit values at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while
noise shaping and oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common
occurrence with very high quantization of audio signals. Due to the high
sampling rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered by the
PCM format used for normal audio CDs. The frequency is equal to or
higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This unit can
transmit or receive DSD signals via the HDMI jack.
LFE 0.1 channel
This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals, and has a frequency
range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is counted as 0.1, because it only
enforces a low-frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by
the other 5-channels in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1-channel systems.
Neo:6
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-channel playback
by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the full-range channels
with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There are
two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode”
for movie sources.
PCM (Linear PCM)
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is
digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any compression. This is
used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses
a technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of
time. Standing for “Pulse Code Modulation,” the analog signal is encoded
as pulses and then modulated for recording.
Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is
sampled per second is called the sampling frequency, while the degree of
accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the
number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is
determined based on the sampling rate, whereas the dynamic range
representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of
quantized bits. In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider
the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number
of quantized bits, the more accurately the sound level can be reproduced.
Sound program information
CINEMA DSP
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for
use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in a theater having many
speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as
room size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can differ so
widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that is heard.
Based on a wealth of actually measured data, Yamaha CINEMA DSP uses
Yamaha’s original DSP technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby
Digital, and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual experience of a movie
theater in the listening room of your own home.
Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances your
listening experience by regenerating the missing harmonics in compression
artifacts. As a result, it compensates for flattened complexity due to the loss
of high-frequency fidelity as well as lack of bass due to the loss of low-
frequency bass, providing improved performance for the overall sound
system.
SILENT CINEMA
Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for
headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound
program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be
enjoyed on headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Yamaha has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you
to enjoy DSP surround effects even without any surround speakers, by
using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual
CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker system that does not include a
center speaker.
CINEMA DSP 3D
The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the
height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D feature achieves the
reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates
the accurate and intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room.
Video information
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into
the Y signal for luminance and the P
B and PR signals for chrominance.
Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of
these signals is independent. The component signal is also called the “color
difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted from the color
signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to output
component signals.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, the video signal comprises the
three basic elements of a video picture: color, brightness and
synchronization data. A composite video jack on a video component
transmits these three elements combined.
Deep Color
Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in displays, up from the
24-bit depths in previous versions of the HDMI specification. This extra bit
depth allows HDTVs and other displays increase from millions of colors to
billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal
transitions and subtle gradations between colors. The increased contrast
ratio can represent many times more shades of gray between black and
white. Additionally, Deep Color increases the number of available colors
within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space.
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first industry
supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video interface. Providing an
interface between any sources (such as set-top boxes or AV receivers) and
audio/video monitors (such as digital televisions), HDMI supports
standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as multichannel digital
audio using a single cable. HDMI transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and
supports 8-channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to accommodate
future enhancements and requirements.
When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection), HDMI provides a secure audio/video interface that meets the
security requirements of content providers and system operators. For
further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://
www.hdmi.org/.
APPENDIX
Glossary
En 126
“x.v.Color”
A color space standard supported by HDMI version 1.3. It is a more
extensive color space than sRGB, and allows the expression of colors that
were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color
gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and can
thus produce more vivid, natural images. It is particularly effective for still
pictures and computer graphics.
Video conversion
Analog-to-HDMI video conversion is performed according to resolution of video signals as shown below. Analog-to-analog video conversion is also possible when “Analog to Analog Conversion” is
set to “On” (
p. 96).
: available conversion
HDMI output COMPONENT VIDEO output VIDEO output
Resolution 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i 1080p 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i 1080p 480i/576i
HDMI input
480i/576i ✓✓✓✓✓
480p/576p ✓✓✓✓
720p
1080i
1080p
COMPONENT
VIDEO input
480i/576i ✓✓✓✓✓✓
480p/576p ✓✓✓✓
720p
1080i
VIDEO input 480i/576i ✓✓✓✓✓✓
APPENDIX
En 127
HDMI signal compatibility
Audio signals
If the input source component can decode the bitstream audio signals of audio commentaries, you can playback the audio
sources with the audio commentaries mixed down by using the digital audio input (optical or coaxial) connections.
Refer to the supplied instruction manuals of the input source component, and set the component appropriately.
Video signals
This unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions:
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent No’s:
5,451,942;5,956,674;5,974,380;5,978,762;6,226,616;6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents
issued & pending. DTS is a registered trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD
Master Audio are trademark of DTS, Inc. © 1996-2007 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
iPod™, iPhone™
“iPod” is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. “iPhone” is a trademark
of Apple Inc.
HD Radio™ Technology Manufactured Under License From iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and Foreign
Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD Radio logo are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.
Bluetooth™
Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG and is used by Yamaha in accordance with a
license agreement.
“HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
SIRIUS, XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and its
subsidiaries. All rights reserved. Service not available in Alaska and Hawaii.
Information on HDMI™
Audio signal types Audio signal formats Compatible media
2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32-192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio, etc.
Multi-ch Linear PCM 8ch, 32-192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, Blu-ray Disc, HD DVD,
etc.
DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD, etc.
Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video, etc.
Bitstream (High definition audio) Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,
DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD
High Resolution Audio, DTS Express
Blu-ray Disc, HD DVD, etc.
NOTES
When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video and audio signals may not be output,
depending on the type of the DVD player.
This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI components.
Refer to the supplied instruction manuals for details.
To decode audio bitstream signals on this unit, set the input source component appropriately so that the
component outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the
component).
This unit is not compatible with the audio commentary features (for example, the special audio contents
downloaded via Internet) of Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD. This unit does not playback the audio
commentaries of the Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD content.
480i/60 Hz
576i/50 Hz
480p/60 Hz
576p/50 Hz
720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
About trademarks
APPENDIX
En 128
Input jacks
Analog audio
Audio x 5 (AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, AUDIO2, V-AUX)
MULTI CH INPUT x 1 (8ch Input)
Digital audio
Optical x 2 (AV1, AV4)
Coaxial x 2 (AV2, AV3)
•Video
Composite x 5 (AV3, AV4, AV5, AV6, V-AUX)
Component x 2 (AV1, AV2)
HDMI input
HDMI (Front Panel) x 1 (V-AUX)
HDMI (Rear Panel) x 5 (HDMI 1-5)
•Other
DOCK x 1 (AUDIO, VIDEO [Composite])
Output jacks
Analog Audio
Speaker out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R
*1
, EXTRA SP L/R
*2
)
*1 Note: assignment is possible. [SURROUND BACK, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)]
*2 Note: assignment is possible. [ZONE2, PRESENCE]
Pre Out x 7 [FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R]
Subwoofer out x 2 (MONO, SUBWOOFER)
AV O U T x 1
AUDIO OUT x 1
ZONE2 OUT x 1
•Video
MONITOR OUT
- Component x 1
- Composite x 1
AV O U T
- Composite x 1
HDMI Output
HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1-2)
Remote jacks
•REMOTE IN x 1
REMOTE OUT x 1
TRIGGER OUT x 1
HDMI
HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lips Sync,
ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D
Video Format (Repeater Mode)
- VGA
- 480i/60 Hz
- 576i/50 Hz
- 480p/60 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
- 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz
Analog up Conversion
- 480i/60 Hz (NTSC)
- 576i/50 Hz (PAL)
- 480p/60 Hz
- 576p/50 Hz
- 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
- 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
Up-Scaling
- 480i 480p/720p/1080i/1080p
- 480p 720p/1080i/1080p
- 576i 576p/720p/1080i/1080p
- 576p 720p/1080i/1080p
•Audio Format
- Dolby Digital
- DTS
- DSD 6ch
- Dolby Digital Plus
- Dolby TrueHD
- DTS-HD
- PCM 2ch-8ch (Max 192 kHz/24 bit)
Content Protection: HDCP compatible
TUNER
Analog Tuner
FM/AM x 1 (TUNER)
Satellite Radio Ready [U.S.A. model]
SIRIUS Radio x 1 (SIRIUS)
HD Radio tuner [U.S.A. model]
HD Radio tuner with iTunes Tagging x1 (TUNER)
Compatible Decoding Formats
Decoding Format
- Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus
- DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution, DTS Express
- Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX
- DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1
Post Decoding Format
- Dolby Pro Logic
- Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic II Game
- Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie,
Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game
- DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema
AUDIO SECTION
Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround
(20-20 kHz, 0.08% THD, 8 Ω)
FRONT L/R ................................................................... 95 W+95 W
CENTER................................................................................... 95 W
SURROUND L/R ..........................................................95 W+95 W
SURROUND BACK L/R ..............................................95 W+95 W
Dynamic Power (IHF)
Front Speakers 8/6/4/2 Ω ...................................130/165/195/240 W
Dynamic Headroom
8 Ω ........................................................................................ 1.36 dB
Specifications
APPENDIX
Specifications
En 129
Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance
AV5, etc. ....................................................................200 mV/47 kΩ
MULTI CH IN ...........................................................200 mV/47 kΩ
Maximum Input Voltage
AV5, etc. (1 kHz 0.5% THD) ..................................... 2.3 V or more
Rated Output Voltage/Output Impedance
AUDIO OUT ............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ
PRE OUT......................................................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
SUBWOOFER (2ch Stereo & Front: Small)................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ
ZONE2 OUT ............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ
Headphone Jack Rated Output/Impedance
AV5, etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 Ω) ..................................100 mV/560 Ω
Frequency Response
AV5 to FRONT ..................................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, +0/-3 dB
Total Harmonic Distortion
AV5, etc. to FRONT (PURE DIRECT)
(20-20 kHz, 50 W, 8 Ω) ............................................ 0.06% or less
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
[U.S.A. model]
AV5, etc. (PURE DIRECT). Input Shorted
(250 mV to Front Speakers)...................................100 dB or more
[Other models]
PHONO Input Shorted (5 mV to Front Speakers)......81 dB or more
AV5, etc. (PURE DIRECT). Input Shorted
(250 mV to Front Speakers)...................................100 dB or more
Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Front Speakers ............................................................150 µV or less
Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz)
AV5, etc. (5.1 kΩ shorted)...............................60 dB/45 dB or more
Volume Control ...................................... MUTE / -80 dB to +16.5 dB
Tone Control (Front Speakers)
Bass Boost/Cut ..............................................±6 dB/0.5 dB at 50 Hz
Bass Turnover Frequency ...................................................... 350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut..........................................±6 dB/0.5 dB at 20 kHz
Treble Turnover Frequency .................................................. 3.5 kHz
Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back)............. 12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) ............................................................ 24 dB/oct.
VIDEO SECTION
Video Signal Type...................................................................... NTSC
Video Conversion...............................................................NTSC/PAL
Signal Level
Composite ..................................................................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Component ...................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Y), 0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω (P
B/PR)
Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off) .......1.5 Vp-p or more
Signal to Noise Ratio .................................................... 50 dB or more
Frequency Response [MONITOR OUT]
Component (Video Conversion Off) ............ 5 Hz to 60 MHz, -3 dB
FM SECTION
Tuning Range......................................................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
50 dB Quieting Sensitivity (IHF)
Mono ...................................................................... 3.0 µV (20.8 dB)
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
[U.S.A. model]
Mono/Stereo/HD ................................................ 74 dB/70 dB/80 dB
[Other models]
Mono/Stereo.................................................................. 74 dB/70 dB
Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)
[U.S.A. model]
Mono/Stereo/HD .........................................................0.3/0.3/0.03%
[Other models]
Mono/Stereo........................................................................0.3/0.3%
Antenna Input (unbalanced)......................................................... 75 Ω
AM SECTION
Tuning Range.............................................................530 to 1710 kHz
GENERAL
Power Supply............................................................ AC 120 V, 60 Hz
Power Consumption .....................................................400 W/500 VA
Standby Power Consumption
HDMI Control off / Standby Through off ....................0.2 W or less
HDMI Control on/ Standby Through on
(Input: HDMI1, when no HDMI signal is input) ... 2.7 W (typical)
Dimensions (W x H x D)
435 x 171 x 367.5 mm (17-1/8 x 6-3/4 x 14-1/2 in)
Weight
11.2 kg (24.7 lbs)
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.
APPENDIX
En 130
Numerics
5 channel speaker layout.............................................................. 15
5.1-channel speaker layout........................................................... 15
7.1-channel speaker connection ................................................... 17
7.1-channel speaker layout........................................................... 14
A
Adaptive DRC, OPTION menu ................................................... 53
Advanced Setup menu ............................................................... 108
All channel search mode.............................................................. 66
AM antenna connection ............................................................... 32
AM tuning .................................................................................... 56
Analog to Analog Conversion, Video Setup................................ 96
ARC (Audio Return Channel), HDMI Setup............................... 98
Aspect, Processing, Video Setup ................................................. 97
Audio information, Information menu....................................... 104
Audio Input, Input menu.............................................................. 80
AUDIO jack ................................................................................. 21
Audio Output, HDMI Setup......................................................... 99
Audio Return Channel function ................................................. 113
Auto Power Down, Function Setup ........................................... 101
Auto Preset................................................................................... 59
Auto Setup, Speaker Setup .......................................................... 91
B
BD player connection .................................................................. 25
Bi-amp connection, speaker......................................................... 18
Bluetooth™ component playback................................................ 76
C
Cable plug .................................................................................... 21
Category search mode.................................................................. 66
Center Image, Sound Program menu ........................................... 89
Center Level, Sound Program menu............................................ 88
Center speaker.............................................................................. 13
Center Width, Sound Program menu ........................................... 89
Changing speaker impedance ...................................................... 18
CINEMA DSP 3D mode.............................................................. 45
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode, OPTION menu.................................. 53
CINEMA DSP indicator ............................................................. 10
Clear All Preset ..................................................................... 59, 70
Clear Preset ........................................................................... 59, 70
COAXIAL jack ........................................................................... 21
COMPONENT VIDEO jack....................................................... 21
Compressed Music Enhancer mode ............................................ 46
Configuration, Manual Setup, Speaker Setup ............................. 92
Connect, OPTION menu ............................................................. 54
Connecting speakers.................................................................... 17
Connections................................................................................. 13
Content browse view................................................................... 55
Content window .......................................................................... 55
Control Select, HDMI Setup ....................................................... 98
Cursor indicators ......................................................................... 10
D
Decode Type, Sound Program menu .................................... 88, 89
Decoder Mode, Input menu......................................................... 80
Dialogue Lift, OPTION menu..................................................... 53
Dimension, Sound Program menu .............................................. 89
Direct number access mode ........................................................ 66
Direct, Sound Program menu...................................................... 88
Disconnect, OPTION menu ........................................................ 54
Display Set, Function Setup ...................................................... 101
Distance, Speaker Setup.............................................................. 93
DSP Level, Sound Program menu .............................................. 86
DVD player connection............................................................... 25
Dynamic Range, Sound Setup..................................................... 95
E
Enhancer, Input menu ................................................................. 80
Extended Surround, OPTION menu ........................................... 53
External component connection.................................................. 21
External decoder connection....................................................... 29
F
FM antenna connection ............................................................... 32
FM Mode..................................................................................... 58
FM tuning .................................................................................... 56
Front panel..................................................................................... 8
Front panel display ...................................................................... 10
Front Presence L Level, Sound Program menu........................... 88
Front Presence R Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 89
Front speaker ............................................................................... 13
Function Setup........................................................................... 100
G
Game connection......................................................................... 29
H
HD Radio™ reception................................................................. 60
HDMI Control function............................................................. 111
HDMI Control, HDMI Setup ...................................................... 98
HDMI indicator ........................................................................... 10
HDMI jack................................................................................... 21
HDMI monitor, Information menu............................................ 104
HDMI Setup ................................................................................ 97
High-frequency sound adjustment............................................... 42
I
Information menu ...................................................................... 104
INIT, Advanced Setup menu..................................................... 110
Initial Delay, Sound Program menu ............................................ 86
Initial Volume, Sound Setup ....................................................... 96
Input menu................................................................................... 78
iPhone™ playback ...................................................................... 71
iPod Interlock, Input menu.......................................................... 81
iPod wireless system ................................................................... 74
iPod™ playback .......................................................................... 71
iTunes Tagging............................................................................ 61
J
Jack.............................................................................................. 21
Index
APPENDIX
Index
En 131
L
Language.................................................................................... 103
Level, Speaker Setup ................................................................... 93
Lipsync, Sound Setup .................................................................. 95
Liveness, Sound Program menu .................................................. 87
Load, SCENE menu..................................................................... 83
Low-frequency sound adjustment................................................ 42
M
Manual Preset............................................................................... 56
Manual Setup, Speaker Setup ...................................................... 91
Manual Tuning....................................................................... 58, 62
Max Volume, Sound Setup .......................................................... 95
Memory Guard, Function Setup ................................................ 103
Menu browse control ................................................................... 72
MON.CHK, Advanced Setup menu........................................... 110
Multi information display ............................................................ 10
Multi Zone ................................................................................. 100
Multi-format player connection ................................................... 29
Multi-zone function ................................................................... 115
MUTE indicator ........................................................................... 10
N
Normal tuning .............................................................................. 56
Now playing view ........................................................................ 55
O
ON SCREEN menu...................................................................... 49
On-screen display......................................................................... 12
OPTICAL jack ............................................................................. 21
OPTION menu ............................................................................. 51
P
Pairing, OPTION menu ............................................................... 54
Panorama, Sound Program menu................................................. 89
Parametric EQ, Speaker Setup ..................................................... 94
Party Mode Set, Multi Zone....................................................... 100
PHONES jack ................................................................................ 8
Portable audio player connection................................................. 29
Power Amp Assign, Manual Setup, Speaker Setup .................... 91
PREOUT connection................................................................... 30
Presence speaker ......................................................................... 13
Presence speaker layout .............................................................. 14
Preset Select .......................................................................... 58, 62
Pure Direct mode......................................................................... 46
R
Radio Control .............................................................................. 69
Rear panel...................................................................................... 9
Remote control ............................................................................ 11
Remote control battery installation ............................................... 7
Remote control connection ......................................................... 30
Remote control, Controlling other components........................ 105
REMOTE ID, Advanced Setup menu....................................... 109
Rename/Icon Select, Input menu ................................................ 79
Rename/Icon Select, SCENE menu ............................................ 84
Repeat, OPTION menu ............................................................... 54
Reset, SCENE menu ................................................................... 84
Resolution, Processing, Video Setup .......................................... 97
Reverb Delay, Sound Program menu.......................................... 87
Reverb Level, Sound Program menu .......................................... 88
Reverb Time, Sound Program menu........................................... 87
Room Size, Sound Program menu .............................................. 86
S
Satellite Radio ............................................................................. 64
Save, SCENE menu .................................................................... 83
SCENE function.......................................................................... 43
SCENE menu .............................................................................. 82
Setup menu.................................................................................. 90
Shuffle, OPTION menu .............................................................. 54
SILENT CINEMA mode ............................................................ 45
Simple remote control ................................................................. 74
SIRIUS Satellite Radio ............................................................... 64
SiriusConnect™ tuner................................................................. 64
Sound program ............................................................................ 43
Sound Program menu.................................................................. 85
Sound Setup ................................................................................ 95
SP IMP., Advanced Setup menu ............................................... 108
Speaker connection...................................................................... 13
Speaker indicators ....................................................................... 10
Speaker layout ............................................................................. 14
Speaker setting ............................................................................ 33
Speaker Setup .............................................................................. 91
SR PIN, Advanced Setup menu ................................................ 109
Standby Charge, Input menu....................................................... 80
Standby Through, HDMI Setup .................................................. 99
Straight Decoding Mode ............................................................. 44
Subwoofer ................................................................................... 13
Supplied accessories...................................................................... 7
Surround Back Initial Delay, Sound Program menu................... 86
Surround Back L Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 88
Surround Back Liveness, Sound Program menu......................... 87
Surround Back R Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 88
Surround Back Room Size, Sound Program menu ..................... 86
Surround back speaker ................................................................ 13
Surround Initial Delay, Sound Program menu ............................ 86
Surround L Level, Sound Program menu.................................... 88
Surround Liveness, Sound Program menu.................................. 87
Surround R Level, Sound Program menu ................................... 88
Surround Room Size, Sound Program menu............................... 86
Surround speaker......................................................................... 13
T
Test Tone, Speaker Setup............................................................ 94
Tone control ................................................................................ 42
Tone Control, OPTION menu ..................................................... 52
Trigger connection ...................................................................... 31
Trigger Output, Function Setup................................................. 102
Tuner indicator ............................................................................ 10
TV Audio Input, HDMI Setup .................................................... 98
TV FORMAT, Advanced Setup menu...................................... 110
TV monitor connection ............................................................... 22
V
VIDEO AUX input cover.............................................................. 7
Video information, Information menu ...................................... 104
VIDEO jack................................................................................. 21
Video Out, Input menu................................................................ 81
APPENDIX
Index
En 132
Video Setup.................................................................................. 96
Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D mode ................................................. 45
Virtual CINEMA DSP mode ....................................................... 45
VOLUME ...................................................................................... 8
VOLUME indicator ..................................................................... 10
Volume Trim, OPTION menu ..................................................... 54
Y
YPAO........................................................................................... 33
Z
Zone2 Set, Multi Zone ............................................................... 100
© 2010 Yamaha Corporation
YC710A0/OMEN1
- 1 -
TV
A.R. Systems 0320
Acme 0342
Acura 0323, 0343
ADC 0337
Admiral 0054, 0178, 0336,
0337, 0339, 0346,
0347
Advent 0158
Adventura 0057
Adyson 0277, 0282, 0342
Agashi 0277, 0282
Agazi 0337
Aiko 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0342, 0343
Aim 0320
Aiwa 0078, 0379
Akai 0050, 0055, 0109,
0159, 0181, 0277,
0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0343, 0349,
0350
Akiba 0320, 0340
Akura 0320, 0323, 0337,
0340
Alaron 0277
Alba 0161, 0277, 0320,
0323, 0340, 0342,
0343, 0344, 0349,
0351, 0372, 0382
Albatron 0140
Alcyon 0171
Alleron 0059
Allorgan 0282
Allstar 0320, 0350
America Action 0179
AMOi 0276
Amplivision 0161, 0282, 0321,
0342
Amstrad 0320, 0323, 0337,
0340, 0343
Amtron 0058
Anam 0179, 0343
Anam National 0052, 0058
Anglo 0323, 0343
Anitech 0171, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0343
Ansonic 0161, 0168, 0320,
0323, 0341, 0343
AOC 0008, 0026, 0050,
0053
Apex 0039, 0111, 0217
Arcam 0277, 0282
Arcam Delta 0342
Aristona 0320, 0349, 0350
Arthur Martin 0321
ASA 0339, 0347
Asberg 0171, 0320, 0350
Astra 0343
Asuka 0277, 0282, 0337,
0340, 0342
Atlantic 0277, 0320, 0342,
0349, 0350
Atori 0323, 0343
Auchan 0321
Audiosonic 0161, 0282, 0320,
0340, 0342, 0343,
0349, 0350
AudioTon 0161, 0282, 0342
Audiovox 0058, 0179, 0194
Ausind 0171
Autovox 0171, 0282, 0337,
0339, 0342
Aventura 0051
Awa 0277, 0282
Axion 0156
Baird 0282
Bang & Olufsen 0180, 0339
Basic Line 0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0343, 0350
Bastide 0282, 0342
Baur 0320, 0349
Bazin 0282
Beko 0161, 0269, 0294,
0302, 0311, 0320,
0328, 0351
Belcor 0008
Bell & Howell 0019, 0054
Benq 0097, 0242, 0361
Beon 0320, 0349, 0350
Best 0161
Bestar 0161, 0320, 0350
Binatone 0282, 0342
Blue Sky 0320, 0340
Blue Star 0348
Boots 0282, 0342
BPL 0320, 0348
Bradford 0058, 0179
Brandt 0322, 0345
Brillian 0182
Brinkmann 0320
Brionvega 0320, 0339, 0349,
0350
Britannia 0277, 0282, 0342
Brockwood 0008
Broksonic 0109, 0179
Bruns 0339
BTC 0340
Bush 0269, 0282, 0283,
0304, 0320, 0323,
0328, 0332, 0340,
0343, 0344, 0346,
0348, 0349, 0350,
0372, 0382, 0463,
0470, 0472
Candle 0008, 0026, 0050,
0057
Capsonic 0337
Carena 0320
Carnivale 0050
Carrefour 0344
Carver 0010
Cascade 0320, 0323, 0343
Casio 0367
Cathay 0320, 0349, 0350
CCE 0183, 0282
Celebrity 0055, 0107
Celera 0039
Centurion 0320, 0349, 0350
Century 0339
CGE 0161, 0171
Changhong 0039
Chimei 0273
Cimline 0323, 0343
Citizen 0007, 0008, 0026,
0050, 0058
City 0323, 0343
Clarion 0179
Clarivox 0349
Clatronic 0161, 0171, 0282,
0320, 0323, 0337,
0340, 0342, 0343,
0350, 0351
CMS 0277
CMS Hightec 0282
Coby 0197
Colortyme 0008, 0026
Commercial Solutions
0021
Concerto 0008, 0026
Concorde 0323, 0343
Condor 0161, 0277, 0320,
0323, 0342, 0350,
0351
Contec 0179, 0277, 0323,
0342, 0343, 0344
Contec/Cony 0012, 0058
Continental Edison
0345
Cosmel 0323, 0343
Craig 0058, 0179
Crosley 0010, 0037, 0171,
0339
Crown 0058, 0161, 0171,
0179, 0320, 0323,
0343, 0349, 0350,
0351
CS Electronics 0277, 0340, 0342
CTC Clatronic 0341
CTX 0205
Curtis Mathes 0007, 0008, 0010,
0019, 0021, 0026,
0049, 0050, 0178
CXC 0058, 0179
Cybertron 0340
Cytron 0152
Daewoo 0007, 0008, 0026,
0037, 0053, 0167,
0266, 0275, 0277,
0282, 0315, 0320,
0323, 0331, 0335,
0342, 0343, 0350,
0381, 0465
Dainichi 0277, 0340
Dansai 0277, 0282, 0320,
0337, 0349, 0350
Dantax 0161, 0349
Dawa 0320
Daytron 0007, 0008, 0026,
0323, 0343
De Graaf 0346
Decca 0282, 0320, 0342,
0349, 0350
Dell 0145, 0245
Denver 0358, 0362
Desmet 0320, 0349, 0350
Diamant 0320
Diamond 0277
DiamondVision 0135, 0143
Dimensia 0049
Disney 0219
Dixi 0282, 0320, 0323,
0343, 0349, 0350
Dream Vision 0461, 0498
DTS 0323, 0343
Dual 0282, 0320, 0342
Dual-Tec 0342, 0343
Dumont 0008, 0030, 0062,
0282, 0339, 0341,
0342
Durabrand 0031, 0051, 0179,
0215
Dux 0349
Dwin 0178
Dynatron 0320, 0349, 0350
Dynex 0228, 0231
Elbe 0161, 0168, 0282,
0320
Elcit 0339
Electa 0348
ELECTRO TECH
0343
Electroband 0055, 0107
Electrograph 0176
Electrohome 0008, 0026, 0052,
0055
Element 0230
Elin 0277, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0349, 0350
Elite 0320, 0340, 0350
Elman 0341
Elta 0277, 0323, 0343
Emerson 0000, 0007, 0008,
0012, 0013, 0019,
0026, 0031, 0037,
0051, 0058, 0059,
0161, 0179, 0320,
0339
Emprex 0154
Envision 0008, 0026, 0050
Epson 0155, 0206, 0359
Erres 0320, 0349, 0350
ESA 0051
ESC 0282
Etron 0343
Eurofeel 0282
Euro-Feel 0337
Euroline 0349
Euroman 0161, 0277, 0282
Euromann 0320, 0337, 0342,
0350
Europhon 0277, 0282, 0320,
0341, 0342, 0350
Expert 0321
Exquisit 0320
Fenner 0323, 0343
Ferguson 0322, 0345, 0349
Fidelity 0277, 0320, 0342,
0346
Filsai 0282
Finlandia 0346
Finlux 0171, 0282, 0320,
0339, 0341, 0342,
0349, 0350
FIRST LINE 0342, 0343, 0350
Firstline 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323
Fisher 0019, 0161, 0282,
0339, 0342, 0344,
0351
Flint 0320, 0350
Formenti 0171, 0277, 0336,
0339, 0342, 0349
Formenti/Phoenix
0277
Fortress 0336, 0339
Fraba 0161, 0320
Friac 0161
Frontech 0282, 0323, 0337,
0343, 0346, 0347
Fujitsu 0059, 0069, 0074,
0075, 0282
Fujitsu General 0282
Fujitsu Siemens 0504, 0505, 0507,
0510, 0511
Funai 0051, 0058, 0059,
0112, 0113, 0115,
0118, 0119, 0179,
0337
Futuretech 0058, 0179
Galaxi 0320, 0351
Galaxis 0161, 0320
Gateway 0176, 0177, 0241
GBC 0323, 0343, 0344
GE 0008, 0021, 0023,
0026, 0027, 0031,
0034, 0049, 0052,
0056, 0209
Geant Casino 0321
GEC 0282, 0320, 0342,
0347, 0349, 0350
Geloso 0323, 0343, 0346
General Technic 0323, 0343
List of remote control codes
Liste des codes de commande
Liste der Fernbedienungscodes
Lista över fjärrstyrningskoder
Elenco dei codici di telecomando
Lista de códigos de mando a distancia
Lijst met afstandsbedieningscodes
- 2 -
Genexxa 0320, 0340, 0347,
0350
GFM 0128, 0227
Giant 0282
Gibralter 0008, 0030, 0050,
0062
GoldHand 0277
Goldline 0320
GoldStar 0007, 0008, 0012,
0026, 0031, 0050,
0053, 0161, 0277,
0282, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0343, 0346,
0349, 0350
Goodmans 0246, 0272, 0282,
0320, 0323, 0337,
0343, 0344, 0349,
0350, 0462, 0473,
0477
Gorenje 0161, 0351
GPM 0340
GPX 0129
Gradiente 0240
Graetz 0347
Granada 0171, 0282, 0320,
0321, 0342, 0344,
0346, 0349, 0350
Grandin 0340, 0343, 0348,
0349
Gronic 0282
Grundig 0160, 0161, 0171,
0310, 0320
Grunpy 0058, 0059, 0179
Haier 0157, 0233
Halifax 0277, 0282, 0337,
0342
Hallmark 0008, 0026, 0031
Hampton 0277, 0282, 0342
Hanseatic 0161, 0168, 0282,
0320, 0323, 0342,
0343, 0344, 0349,
0350
Hantarex 0320, 0323, 0343
Hantor 0320
Harman/Kardon 0010
Harvard 0058, 0179
Harwood 0320, 0323
Havermy 0178
HCM 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0342, 0343,
0348
Hema 0282, 0323
Hewlett Packard 0192
Higashi 0277
HiLine 0320
Hinari 0320, 0323, 0340,
0343, 0344, 0349,
0350
Hisawa 0321, 0340, 0348
Hisense 0247
Hitachi 0008, 0012, 0026,
0066, 0084, 0092,
0093, 0120, 0172,
0173, 0255, 0270,
0271, 0282, 0320,
0335, 0338, 0342,
0344, 0346, 0347,
0365, 0382, 0448,
0456, 0467
Hornyphon 0320, 0350
Hoshai 0340
Huanyu 0277, 0342
Hygashi 0277, 0282, 0342
Hyper 0277, 0282, 0323,
0342, 0343
Hypson 0282, 0320, 0321,
0337, 0342, 0348,
0349, 0350
Hyundai 0141
Iberia 0320
ICE 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0340,
0342, 0343, 0350
ICeS 0277
Ilo 0148, 0153
IMA 0058
Imperial 0161, 0171, 0320,
0347, 0350, 0351
Indiana 0320, 0349, 0350
Infinity 0010
InFocus 0250, 0327, 0363,
0479, 0508
Ingelen 0347
Ingersol 0323, 0343
Initial 0153
Inno Hit 0171, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0340, 0342,
0343, 0349, 0350
Innovation 0337, 0343
Insignia 0131, 0228, 0236,
0238
Inteq 0030
Interactive 0161
Interbuy 0323, 0343
Interfunk 0161, 0320, 0339,
0347, 0349, 0350
International 0277
Intervision 0161, 0282, 0320,
0337, 0341, 0342
Irradio 0171, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0343, 0349,
0350
Isukai 0320, 0340
ITC 0282, 0342
ITS 0277, 0320, 0340,
0348, 0350
ITT 0343, 0347
ITV 0320, 0343, 0349
Janeil 0057
JBL 0010
JC Penney 0007, 0008, 0026,
0027, 0049, 0053,
0056
JCB 0055, 0107
Jensen 0008, 0026
JVC 0012, 0014, 0015,
0056, 0064, 0065,
0067, 0169, 0174,
0297, 0314, 0344,
0350, 0375
Kaisui 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0340, 0342,
0343, 0348
Kamosonic 0342
Kamp 0277, 0342
Kapsch 0347
Karcher 0161, 0320, 0342,
0343, 0349
Kawasho 0008, 0026, 0055,
0277
KEC 0179
Kendo 0161, 0320, 0341,
0346
Kenwood 0008, 0026, 0050
KIC 0282
Kingsley 0277, 0342
KLH 0039
Kloss Novabeam
0057, 0058
Kneissel 0161, 0168, 0320
Kolster 0320, 0350
Konka 0340
Korpel 0320, 0349, 0350
Korting 0161, 0339
Kosmos 0320
Koyoda 0343
KTV 0007, 0050, 0058,
0179, 0183, 0282,
0342
Kyoto 0277, 0282
Lasat 0161
Lenco 0323, 0343
Lenoir 0323, 0342, 0343
Leyco 0320, 0337, 0349,
0350
LG 0031, 0053, 0066,
0116, 0117, 0140,
0161, 0164, 0175,
0195, 0269, 0277,
0282, 0300, 0309,
0317, 0320, 0323,
0328, 0342, 0343,
0346, 0349, 0350,
0366, 0368, 0377,
0466, 0471, 0478
LG/GoldStar 0164
Liesenk 0349
Liesenkotter 0320
Life 0337, 0343
Lifetec 0320, 0323, 0337,
0343
Lloyds 0323
Loewe 0161, 0168, 0265,
0320, 0330, 0352
Loewe Opta 0339, 0349, 0350
Logik 0054
Luma 0320, 0323, 0346,
0349
Lumatron 0282, 0320, 0346,
0349, 0350
Lux May 0350
Luxman 0008, 0026
Luxor 0282, 0342, 0346
LXI 0010, 0019, 0021,
0026, 0027, 0031,
0049, 0111
M Electronic 0342, 0343, 0345,
0347, 0349, 0350
MAG 0096
Magnadyne 0339, 0341, 0349
Magnafon 0171, 0277, 0341,
0342
Magnavox 0008, 0009, 0010,
0013, 0026, 0032,
0033, 0048, 0050,
0128, 0211, 0212,
0224, 0226, 0239
Magnum 0337, 0343
Majestic 0054
Mandor 0337
Manesth 0282, 0320, 0337,
0342, 0349, 0350
Marantz 0008, 0010, 0026,
0050, 0204, 0320,
0349, 0350
Marelli 0339
Mark 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0349, 0350
Masuda 0282
Matsui 0282, 0320, 0323,
0342, 0343, 0344,
0346, 0349, 0350,
0455
Matsushita 0017
Maxent 0147, 0176
Mediator 0320, 0349, 0350
Medion 0320, 0337, 0343
Megapower 0140
Megatron 0026, 0031
MElectronic 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323
Melvox 0321
Memorex 0019, 0026, 0031,
0053, 0054, 0137,
0215, 0323, 0343
Memphis 0323, 0343
Mercury 0320, 0323
Metz 0339
MGA 0008, 0026, 0031,
0050, 0053
Micromaxx 0337, 0343
Microstar 0337, 0343
Midland 0007, 0021, 0023,
0027, 0030, 0056,
0062
Minerva 0171
Minoka 0320, 0350
Mintek 0153
Mitsubishi 0008, 0026, 0031,
0053, 0066, 0084,
0093, 0098, 0150,
0178, 0289, 0320,
0339, 0344, 0350,
0376
Mivar 0161, 0168, 0171,
0277, 0282, 0342
Monivision 0140
Montgomery Ward
0054
Motion 0171
Motorola 0052, 0178
MTC 0008, 0026, 0050,
0053, 0161, 0277
Multi System 0349
Multitech 0058, 0161, 0179,
0183, 0277, 0282,
0320, 0323, 0341,
0342, 0343, 0344,
0346, 0349
Murphy 0277, 0342
NAD 0026, 0031, 0111
Naonis 0346
NEC 0008, 0026, 0050,
0052, 0053, 0072,
0103, 0282, 0344
Neckermann 0161, 0282, 0320,
0339, 0342, 0346,
0349, 0350, 0351
NEI 0320, 0349, 0350
Net-TV 0176
Neufunk 0320, 0323
New Tech 0343, 0350
New World 0340
NewTech 0282, 0320, 0323
Nicamagic 0277, 0342
Nikkai 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0340,
0342, 0349, 0350
Nikko 0026, 0031, 0050
Nobliko 0171, 0277, 0341,
0342
Nokia 0347
Norcent 0201
Nordic 0282
Nordmende 0339, 0345, 0347,
0350
Nordvision 0349
Novatronic 0320
Oceanic 0321, 0347
Okano 0161, 0320, 0351
Olevia 0102, 0199, 0200,
0207, 0222
ONCEAS 0342
Onwa 0058, 0179
Opera 0320
Oppo 0130
Optimus 0017, 0019
Optoma 0144
Optonica 0178
Orbit 0320, 0350
Orion 0043, 0146, 0283,
0320, 0323, 0328,
0343, 0349, 0350
Orline 0320
Osaki 0282, 0320, 0337,
0340, 0342
Oso 0340
Otto Versand 0282, 0320, 0336,
0342, 0344, 0348,
0349, 0350
Pael 0277, 0342
Palladium 0161, 0282, 0320,
0342, 0351
Palsonic 0282
Panama 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0342,
0343
Panasonic 0016, 0017, 0020,
0022, 0023, 0035,
0052, 0056, 0084,
0085, 0133, 0163,
0193, 0284, 0286,
0290, 0292, 0320,
0325, 0347, 0356
Panavision 0320
Pathe Cinema 0161, 0168, 0277,
0321, 0342
Pausa 0323, 0343
Penney 0021, 0023, 0031,
0050, 0111
Perdio 0277, 0320
Perfekt 0320
Philco 0008, 0009, 0010,
0012, 0026, 0050,
0052, 0053, 0161,
0171, 0320, 0339
Philharmonic 0282, 0342
Philips 0008, 0009, 0010,
0011, 0012, 0032,
0048, 0049, 0052,
0122, 0128, 0134,
0186, 0187, 0213,
0221, 0224, 0226,
- 3 -
0239, 0256, 0257,
0259, 0261, 0263,
0267, 0280, 0281,
0287, 0296, 0299,
0301, 0303, 0305,
0313, 0319, 0320,
0324, 0333, 0339,
0342, 0349, 0350,
0353, 0357, 0360,
0380, 0383, 0452,
0459, 0460
Philips Magnavox
0011, 0032, 0033
Phoenix 0161, 0277, 0320,
0339, 0349, 0350
Phonola 0277, 0320, 0339,
0349, 0350
Pilot 0007, 0008, 0050
Pioneer 0008, 0026, 0094,
0095, 0161, 0320,
0345, 0347, 0349,
0350, 0458
Plantron 0320, 0323, 0337,
0350
Playsonic 0282
Polaroid 0039, 0142, 0202,
0234
Poppy 0323, 0343
Portland 0007, 0008, 0026,
0053
Prandoni-Prince
0171, 0346
Precision 0282, 0342
Prima 0157, 0243, 0323,
0343, 0347
Princeton 0140
Prism 0023, 0056
Profex 0323, 0343
Profi-Tronic 0320, 0350
Proline 0320, 0350
Proscan 0021, 0027, 0049
Prosonic 0161, 0277, 0282,
0320, 0342, 0349
Protech 0282, 0337, 0341,
0342, 0343, 0349,
0350
Proton 0008, 0012, 0026,
0031
Protron 0196
PROVIEW 0096, 0246
Provision 0320, 0349
Pulsar 0008, 0030, 0062
Pye 0256, 0320, 0349,
0350, 0378
Pymi 0323, 0343
Quandra Vision 0321
Quasar 0017, 0023, 0052,
0056
Quelle 0282, 0320, 0337,
0342, 0349, 0350
Questa 0344
Radialva 0320
RadioShack 0019, 0021, 0031,
0050, 0179, 0320
RadioShack/Realistic
0007, 0008, 0012,
0026, 0049, 0058
Radiola 0282, 0320, 0349,
0350
Radiomarelli 0320, 0339
Radiotone 0161, 0320, 0323,
0350
Rank 0344
RCA 0008, 0021, 0024,
0025, 0026, 0027,
0042, 0049, 0052,
0053, 0063, 0136,
0225
Realistic 0019, 0031, 0050,
0179
Recor 0320
Redstar 0320
Reflex 0320
Revox 0161, 0320, 0349,
0350
Rex 0337, 0346, 0347
RFT 0161, 0168, 0339
Rhapsody 0277
R-Line 0320, 0349, 0350
Roadstar 0323, 0337, 0340,
0343
Robotron 0339
Rowa 0277, 0282
Royal Lux 0161
RTF 0339
Runco 0030, 0050, 0062
Saba 0298, 0322, 0339,
0345, 0347
Saisho 0282, 0323, 0337,
0342, 0343
Salora 0346, 0347
Sambers 0171, 0341
Sampo 0007, 0008, 0026,
0050, 0176
Samsung 0004, 0005, 0006,
0007, 0008, 0012,
0026, 0031, 0036,
0050, 0053, 0076,
0077, 0079, 0114,
0124, 0125, 0126,
0127, 0139, 0161,
0183, 0185, 0190,
0191, 0258, 0264,
0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0334, 0337,
0342, 0343, 0349,
0350, 0351, 0373,
0453, 0468
Sandra 0277, 0282, 0342
Sansui 0043, 0109, 0320,
0350
Sanyo 0008, 0019, 0068,
0070, 0071, 0099,
0161, 0168, 0223,
0237, 0277, 0282,
0288, 0295, 0323,
0342, 0344, 0369,
0469
SBR 0320, 0349
Sceptre 0235, 0244
Schaub Lorenz 0347
Schneider 0282, 0316, 0318,
0320, 0333, 0340,
0342, 0349, 0350,
0382
Scotch 0026, 0031
Scott 0008, 0012, 0026,
0031, 0058, 0059,
0149, 0179
Sears 0008, 0010, 0019,
0021, 0026, 0027,
0031, 0049, 0051,
0059, 0111
SEG 0277, 0282, 0320,
0323, 0337, 0341,
0342, 0344, 0349,
0382
SEI 0320
SEI-Sinudyne 0339, 0341, 0347
Seleco 0344, 0346, 0347
Sencora 0323, 0343
Sentra 0323
Serino 0277
Sharp 0000, 0001, 0002,
0003, 0007, 0008,
0012, 0026, 0060,
0088, 0089, 0091,
0138, 0165, 0170,
0178, 0198, 0229,
0262, 0278, 0279,
0291, 0308, 0312,
0336, 0344, 0354,
0370, 0449, 0450,
0451, 0464, 0474,
0476
Sheng Chia 0178
Shogun 0008
Siarem 0320, 0339, 0341
Sierra 0320, 0350
Siesta 0161
Signature 0054
Silva 0277
Silver 0344
Singer 0321, 0339, 0341
Sinudyne 0320, 0339, 0341,
0349
Skantic 0347
Solavox 0347
Sonitron 0161, 0282
Sonoko 0282, 0320, 0323,
0337, 0342, 0343,
0349, 0350
Sonolor 0321, 0347
Sontec 0161, 0320, 0349,
0350
Sony 0038, 0044, 0045,
0047, 0055, 0104,
0105, 0107, 0110,
0123, 0184, 0220,
0248, 0249, 0251,
0252, 0254, 0326,
0343, 0344, 0371,
0374, 0457, 0475
Sound & Vision 0340, 0341
Soundesign 0008, 0026, 0031,
0058, 0059, 0179
Soundwave 0320, 0349, 0350
Squareview 0051
SSS 0008, 0058, 0179
Standard 0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0342, 0343,
0350
Starlite 0058, 0179, 0320,
0323, 0349
Stenway 0348
Stern 0346, 0347
Strato 0320, 0323
Stylandia 0282
Sunkai 0343
Sunstar 0320, 0323
Sunwood 0320, 0323, 0343,
0350
Superla 0277, 0282, 0342
Superscan 0013, 0178
SuperTech 0277, 0320, 0323
Supra 0323, 0343
Supre-Macy 0057
Supreme 0055, 0107
Susumu 0340
Sutron 0323, 0343
SVA 0151
Sydney 0277, 0282, 0342
Sylvania 0008, 0009, 0010,
0011, 0013, 0026,
0048, 0050, 0051,
0128, 0227, 0253
Symphonic 0051, 0058, 0062,
0128, 0179, 0215
Syntax 0199
Syntax-Brillian 0199
Sysline 0349
Sytong 0277
Tandy 0178, 0282, 0336,
0340, 0342, 0347
Tashiko 0277, 0282, 0342,
0344, 0346
Tatung 0052, 0177, 0282,
0320, 0342, 0349,
0350
TCM 0337, 0343
Teac 0282, 0320
Tec 0282, 0323, 0342,
0343
Technics 0017, 0023, 0056
TechniSat 0274, 0496, 0497,
0499
Techwood 0008, 0023, 0026,
0056
TEDELEX 0282
Teknika 0007, 0008, 0010,
0012, 0026, 0053,
0054, 0058, 0059,
0179
Teleavia 0345
Telecor 0282, 0320
Telefunken 0320, 0322, 0345,
0350
Telegazi 0320
Telemeister 0320
Telesonic 0320
Telestar 0320
Teletech 0320, 0323, 0343,
0349
Teleton 0282, 0342
Televideon 0277
Televiso 0321
Tensai 0282, 0320, 0323,
0340, 0343, 0350
Tesmet 0350
Tevion 0337, 0343
Texet 0277, 0282, 0323,
0342
Thomson 0162, 0188, 0189,
0285, 0320, 0322,
0342, 0345, 0350
Thorn 0320, 0349
TMK 0008, 0026, 0031
TNCi 0030
Tokai 0282, 0320, 0350
Tokyo 0277, 0342
Tomas hi 03 48
Toshiba 0018, 0019, 0040,
0041, 0046, 0073,
0100, 0103, 0108,
0109, 0111, 0121,
0132, 0166, 0208,
0210, 0214, 0217,
0260, 0268, 0282,
0283, 0293, 0304,
0306, 0307, 0329,
0344, 0355, 0454
Totevision 0007
Towada 0282, 0347
Trakton 0282
Trans Continens 0282, 0320
Transtec 0277
Trident 0282
Triumph 0320
Uher 0161, 0171, 0320,
0347, 0350
Ultravox 0277, 0320, 0339,
0341, 0342
Unic Line 0320
United 0349
Universum 0161, 0171, 0282,
0320, 0337, 0349,
0350, 0351
Univox 0320
Vector Research 0050
Vestel 0282, 0320, 0346,
0347, 0349, 0350,
0351
Vexa 0320, 0323, 0343,
0349
Victor 0015, 0344, 0350
VIDEOLOGIC 0277
Videologique 0277, 0282, 0340,
0342
VideoSystem 0320, 0350
Videotechnic 0277, 0282
Vidikron 0010
Vidtech 0008, 0026, 0031,
0053
Viewsonic 0176, 0203, 0232,
0364
Viking 0057
Viore 0148
Visiola 0277, 0342
Vision 0282, 0320, 0350
Vizio 0008, 0177, 0218,
0242, 0500, 0501,
0502, 0503, 0506
Vortec 0320, 0349, 0350
Voxson 0171, 0320, 0339,
0346, 0347, 0350
Waltham 0282, 0320, 0342
Wards 0008, 0009, 0010,
0026, 0031, 0048,
0049, 0050, 0053,
0054, 0059
Watson 0320, 0349, 0350
Watt Radio 0277, 0341, 0342
Waycon 0111
Wega 0320, 0339, 0344
Wegavox 0323
Weltblick 0282, 0320, 0349,
0350
Westinghouse 0107, 0216, 0220
White Westinghouse
0037, 0090, 0277,
0320, 0341, 0342,
0349
Wincom 0101, 0106
Xrypton 0320
- 4 -
Yamaha 0008, 0026, 0050,
0053, 0080, 0081,
0082, 0083, 0086,
0087
Yamishi 0282, 0320
Yok an 0 32 0
Yoko 0161, 0277, 0282,
0320, 0323, 0337,
0340, 0342, 0343,
0349, 0350
Yorx 0340
Zanussi 0282, 0346
Zenith 0008, 0028, 0029,
0030, 0031, 0054,
0061, 0062
VCR
ABS 1016
Adventura 1069
Adyson 1008
Aiwa 1024, 1026, 1027,
1069
Akai 1021, 1027
Akiba 1008, 1029
Akura 1008, 1027, 1029
Alba 1008, 1009, 1024,
1025, 1029, 1030
Alienware 1016
Ambassador 1030
American High 1068
Amstrad 1008, 1009, 1026
Anitech 1008, 1029
Apex 1088
ASA 1028, 1031
Asha 1070
Asuka 1008, 1026, 1028,
1029, 1031
Audio Dynamics 1064
Audiosonic 1009
Audiovox 1071
Baird 1009, 1025, 1026,
1027
Bang & Olufsen 1017
Basic Line 1008, 1009, 1024,
1025, 1029, 1030
Baur 1028
Beaumark 1070
Bell & Howell 1065
Bestar 1009, 1025, 1030
Black Panther Line
1009, 1025
Blaupunkt 1028
Bondstec 1008, 1030
Broksonic 1100
Bush 1008, 1009, 1024,
1025, 1029, 1049,
1051, 1063, 1217
Calix 1071
Candle 1070, 1071
Canon 1068
Cathay 1009
Catron 1030
CGE 1026, 1027
Cimline 1008, 1024, 1029
CineVision 1104
Citizen 1070, 1071
Clatronic 1008, 1030
Colortyme 1064
Condor 1009, 1025, 1030
Craig 1070, 1071
Crown 1008, 1009, 1025,
1029, 1030
Curtis Mathes 1064, 1068, 1070
Cybernex 1070
CyberPower 1016
Daewoo 1009, 1025, 1030,
1038, 1069, 1223
Dansai 1008, 1009, 1029
Dantax 1024
Daytron 1009, 1025
DBX 1064
De Graaf 1028
Decca 1026, 1027, 1028
Dell 1016
Denko 1008
DiamondVision 1096
DigiFusion 1014
DIRECTV 1019, 1105, 1110,
1111, 1113, 1116,
1122
Dish Network 1018
Dishpro 1018
Dual 1009, 1027, 1028
Dumont 1026, 1028
Durabrand 1114
Dynatech 1069
Echostar 1018
Elbe 1009
Elcatech 1008
Electrohome 1071
Electrophonic 1071
Elsay 1008
Elta 1008, 1009, 1029
Emerson 1008, 1020, 1068,
1069, 1071
ESC 1009, 1025
Etzuko 1008, 1029
Expressvu 1018
Ferguson 1027
Fidelity 1008, 1026
Finlandia 1028
Finlux 1026, 1027, 1028
Firstline 1008, 1024, 1029,
1031
Fisher 1065
Flint 1024
Formenti/Phoenix
1028
Frontech 1030
Fuji 1068
Fujitsu 1026
Funai 1026, 1069
Galaxy 1026
Garrard 1069
Gateway 1016
GBC 1029, 1030
GE 1068, 1070
GEC 1028
Geloso 1029
General 1030
General Technic 1024
GOI 1018
GoldHand 1008, 1029
Goldstar 1026, 1031, 1064,
1071
Goodmans 1008, 1009, 1025,
1026, 1029, 1030,
1031
Gradiente 1069
Graetz 1027
Granada 1028
Grandin 1008, 1009, 1025,
1026, 1029, 1030,
1031
Grundig 1028, 1029
Hanseatic 1009, 1028, 1031
Harley Davidson 1069
Harman/Kardon 1064
Harwood 1008
HCM 1008, 1029
Headquarter 1065
Hewlett Packard 1016
Hinari 1008, 1009, 1024,
1029
Hisawa 1024
Hitachi 1011, 1026, 1027,
1028, 1046, 1062
HNS 1110
Howard Computers
1016
HP 1016
HTS 1018
Hughes 1111, 1113, 1122
Hughes Network Systems
1110, 1116
Humax 1012, 1110, 1113
Hush 1016
Hypson 1008, 1009, 1024,
1029
iBUYPOWER 1016
Impego 1030
Imperial 1026
Inno Hit 1008, 1009, 1025,
1028, 1029, 1030
Innovation 1024
Instant Replay 1068
Interbuy 1008, 1031
Interfunk 1028
Intervision 1009, 1026
Irradio 1008, 1029, 1031
ITT 1027
ITV 1009, 1025, 1031
JC Penney 1064, 1065, 1068,
1070, 1071
JCL 1068
JVC 1007, 1018, 1027,
1039, 1064, 1065,
1066, 1067, 1078,
1089, 1092, 1093,
1094, 1095, 1113,
1208, 1209, 1212,
1213, 1215, 1218
Kaisui 1008, 1029
Karcher 1028
Kendo 1008, 1024, 1025,
1030
Kenwood 1027, 1064, 1065
Kodak 1068, 1071
Korpel 1008, 1029
Kyoto 1008
Lenco 1025
Leyco 1008, 1029
LG 1010, 1026, 1031,
1047, 1054, 1056,
1071, 1103, 1221
Lifetec 1024
Linksys 1016
Lloyd's 1069
Loewe Opta 1028, 1031
Logik 1008, 1029
Lumatron 1009, 1025
Luxor 1008
LXI 1071
M Electronic 1026
Magnavox 1020, 1068, 1114,
1126
Magnin 1071
Manesth 1008, 1029
Marantz 1028, 1064, 1065,
1068
Mark 1009
Marta 1071
Matsui 1024, 1031
Matsushita 1068
Media Center PC
1016
Mediator 1028
Medion 1024
MEI 1068
Memorex 1023, 1026, 1031,
1065, 1068, 1069,
1070, 1071, 1098,
1114
Memphis 1008, 1029
MGN Technology
1070
Micromaxx 1024
Microsoft 1016
Microstar 1024
Migros 1026
Mind 1016
Mitsubishi 1026, 1028, 1079
Motorola 1068
MTC 1070
Multitech 1008, 1026, 1028,
1029, 1030, 1069,
1070
Murphy 1026
NEC 1027, 1064, 1065
Neckermann 1027, 1028
NEI 1028
Nesco 1008, 1029
Nikkai 1008, 1009, 1030
Nikko 1071
Niveus Media 1016
Noblex 1070
Nokia 1009, 1027
Nordmende 1027
Northgate 1016
Oceanic 1026, 1027
Okano 1008, 1009, 1024
Olympus 1068
Optimus 1071
Orion 1023, 1024, 1051,
1115, 1217
Orson 1026
Osaki 1008, 1026, 1029,
1031
Otto Versand 1028
Palladium 1008, 1027, 1029,
1031
Panasonic 1000, 1022, 1044,
1055, 1068, 1072,
1085, 1090, 1091,
1120, 1121, 1214
Pathe Marconi 1027
Perdio 1026
Philco 1008, 1068
Philips 1006, 1013, 1028,
1035, 1040, 1045,
1046, 1050, 1058,
1059, 1061, 1068,
1076, 1101, 1110,
1113, 1116, 1117,
1122, 1126, 1210,
1211
Philips Magnavox
1076
Phonola 1028
Pilot 1071
Pioneer 1028, 1036
Polaroid 1088, 1099
Portland 1009, 1025, 1030
Prinz 1026
Profex 1029
Proline 1026
Proscan 1019
Prosonic 1009, 1024
Pulsar 1114
Pye 1028, 1102
Quarter 1065
Quartz 1065
Quasar 1068
Quelle 1026, 1028
Radialva 1008
RadioShack 1071
RadioShack/Realistic
1065, 1068, 1069,
1070, 1071
Radiola 1028
Radix 1071
Randex 1071
RCA 1019, 1068, 1070,
1075, 1110, 1113,
1122, 1125
Realistic 1065, 1068, 1069,
1070, 1071
ReplayTV 1022, 1123
Rex 1027
RFT 1008, 1028, 1030
Ricavision 1016
Roadstar 1008, 1009, 1025,
1029, 1031
Royal 1008
Runco 1114
Saba 1027
Saisho 1024, 1029
Samsung 1002, 1034, 1041,
1043, 1057, 1060,
1070, 1084, 1110,
1116, 1122, 1124,
1220, 1222
Samurai 1008, 1030
Sanky 1114
Sansui 1023, 1027, 1106,
1115
Sanyo 1032, 1065, 1070
Saville 1009
SBR 1028
Schaub Lorenz 1026, 1027
Schneider 1008, 1009, 1024,
1025, 1026, 1028,
1029, 1030, 1031
Sears 1065, 1068, 1071
SEG 1008, 1009, 1029
SEI-Sinudyne 1028
Seleco 1027
Sentra 1008, 1030
Sentron 1008, 1029
Sharp 1003, 1033, 1077,
1107, 1127, 1219
Shintom 1008, 1029
Shivaki 1031
Shogun 1070
Siemens 1031
Silva 1031
Silver 1009
Singer 1068
- 5 -
Sinudyne 1028
Solavox 1030
Sonic Blue 1022, 1123
Sonneclair 1008
Sonoko 1009, 1025
Sontec 1031
Sony 1001, 1016, 1048,
1053, 1073, 1074,
1080, 1081, 1082,
1083, 1108, 1118,
1216
Stack 1016
Stack 9 1016
Standard 1009, 1025
Stern 1009
STS 1068
Sunkai 1024
Sunstar 1026
Suntronic 1026
Sunwood 1008, 1029
Superscan 1020
Sylvania 1020, 1068, 1069,
1102, 1126
Symphonic 1008, 1069, 1126
Systemax 1016
Tagar Systems 1016
Taisho 1024
Tandberg 1009
Tandy 1065
Tashiko 1026, 1071
Tatung 1026, 1027, 1028
TCM 1015, 1024, 1042
Teac 1009, 1069
Tec 1008, 1009, 1030
Technics 1068
Teknika 1068, 1069, 1071
Teleavia 1027
Telefunken 1027
Teletech 1008, 1009
Tenosal 1008, 1029
Tensai 1008, 1026, 1029,
1031
Tevion 1024
Thomson 1005, 1027
Thorn 1027
Tivo 1108, 1110, 1111,
1113, 1117, 1118,
1119, 1122
TMK 1070
Tokai 1008, 1029, 1031
Tonsai 1029
Toshiba 1004, 1016, 1027,
1028, 1037, 1049,
1052, 1086, 1087,
1097, 1109, 1112,
1194
Totevision 1070, 1071
Touch 1016
Towada 1008, 1029
Towika 1008, 1029
TVA 1030
Uher 1031
UltimateTV 1019
Ultravox 1009
Unitech 1070
United Quick Star
1009, 1025
Universum 1026, 1028, 1031
Vector Research 1064
Video Concepts 1064
Videon 1024
Videosonic 1070
Viewsonic 1016
Voodoo 1016
Wards 1068, 1069, 1070,
1071
Weltblick 103 1
XR-1000 1068, 1069
Yamaha 1064, 1065
Yamishi 1008, 1029
Yokan 1008, 1029
Yoko 1008, 1029, 1030,
1031
Zenith 1114
ZT Group 1016
DVD
4Kus 2051
Accurian 2142
Advent 2155, 2251
AEG 2362
Airis 2364
Aiwa 2322
Akai 2145, 2177, 2179,
2248
Akura 2356
Alba 2064, 2165, 2186,
2337, 2346
Alco 2149
Alize 2361
Allegro 2133
Amitech 2362
Amphion MediaWorks
2195
AMW 2195, 2363
Apex 2030, 2124, 2125,
2126, 2127, 2130,
2131
Apple 2241
Arrgo 2138
Asono 2364
Aspire 2152, 2222
Astar 2240
ATACOM 2364
Audiovox 2061, 2149
Avious 2367
Awa 2 363
Axion 2249
Bang & Olufsen 2128
Baze 2367
BBK 2364
Bellagio 2363
Best Buy 2359
Blaupunkt 2131
Blue Parade 2157
Boghe 2382
Brainwave 2362
Brandt 2148, 2188
Broksonic 2145, 2146
Bush 2064, 2110, 2170,
2268, 2290, 2346,
2358, 2367, 2383
California Audio Labs
2151
Cambridge Audio
2354
CAT 2352, 2353
CAVS 2192
Centrum 2353
CGV 2354, 2362
Changhong 2140
Cinetec 2363
CineVision 2133, 2237
Clatronic 2358, 2367
Coby 2031, 2046, 2360
Conia 2383
Continental Edison
2363
Crown 2362
C-Tech 2355
Curtis Mathes 2139
CVG 2377
CyberHome 2022, 2098, 2138,
2187, 2336
Cytron 2244
Daenyx 2363
Daewoo 2001, 2133, 2276,
2298, 2330, 2362,
2363, 2377
Daewoo International
2363
Dalton 2357
Dansai 2362, 2381
Daytek 2184, 2195, 2363
Dayton 2363
DEC 2358
Decca 2362
Denon 2059, 2151, 2193,
2332
Denver 2356, 2358, 2360,
2370
Denzel 2380
Desay 2205
Diamond 2354, 2355
DiamondVision 2225, 2232
Disney 2010, 2028
DK Digital 2339
Dmtech 2176
Dual 2380
Durabrand 2136
DVX 2355
Easy Home 2359
Eclipse 2354
E-Dem 2364
Electrohome 2362
Elin 2362
Elta 2341, 2361, 2362
Emerson 2129, 2137, 2150
Enterprise 2129
Enzer 2380
Epson 2247
ESA 2137
Finlux 2354, 2362, 2367
Fintec 2377
Fisher 2134
Funai 2137
Gateway 2051
GE 2029, 2131, 2156
Gericom 2351
GFM 2226
Giec 2382
Global Solutions 2355
Global Sphere 2355
Go Video 2133, 2213
Goodmans 2165, 2280, 2291,
2358, 2371, 2376,
2382
GPX 2227
Gradiente 2151
Graetz 2380
Greenhill 2131
Grundig 2349
Grunkel 2362, 2366
GVG 2377
H&B 2358
H_her 2364
Haaz 2354, 2355
Haier 2254
Harman/Kardon 2047, 2135
HiMAX 2359
Hitachi 2062, 2090, 2115,
2274, 2282, 2316,
2359, 2380
Hiteker 2130
Home Tech Industries
2364
Hyundai 2366
Ilo 2245
Initial 2131, 2245
Innovation 2182
Insignia 2002, 2137, 2253
Integra 2157
Irradio 2053
iSymphony 2246
JBL 2135
JVC 2020, 2096, 2097,
2099, 2100, 2101,
2102, 2103, 2106,
2107, 2160, 2257,
2260, 2262, 2263,
2321, 2324, 2326,
2327, 2343, 2464,
2465, 2468, 2469,
2471
Jwin 2198
Kansai 2360
Kawasaki 2149
Kennex 2362
Kenwood 2041, 2151, 2348
KeyPlug 2362
Kiiro 2362
Kingavon 2358
Kiss 2380
KLH 2131, 2149
Koda 2358
Koss 2013, 2148, 2158
KXD 2359
Landel 2143
Lasonic 2132
Lawson 2355
Lecson 2381
Lenco 2358, 2362, 2367
Lenoxx 2136, 2153
LG 2002, 2033, 2038,
2057, 2129, 2133,
2189, 2191, 2223,
2238, 2270, 2288,
2335, 2373, 2375
Life 2182
Lifetec 2182
Limit 2355
Liquid Video 2158
Liteon 2043, 2051, 2142
Loewe 2320
LogicLab 2355
Magnavox 2025, 2050, 2137,
2150, 2159, 2224,
2230, 2358
Magnex 2367
Majestic 2360
Marantz 2328
Marquant 2362
Matsui 2148, 2378
McIntosh 2199
Mecotek 2362
Medion 2182
Memorex 2028, 2145, 2234
MiCO 2354, 2382
Micromaxx 2182
Microsoft 2156
Microstar 2182
Minoka 2362
Minowa 2367
Mintek 2131, 2245
Mitsubishi 2003
Mizuda 2358, 2359
Monyka 2380
Mustek 2186
Mx Onda 2354
Mystral 2366
Naiko 2362
Nesa 2131
Neufunk 2380
Nevir 2362
Next Base 2143
Nexxtech 2243
NU-TEC 2383
Onkyo 2159, 2368
Oopla 2051
Oppo 2196, 2255
Optim 2381
Optimus 2180
Orava 2358
Orbit 2363
Orion 2073, 2110
Oritron 2148, 2158
P&B 2358
Pacific 2355
Panasonic 2011, 2024, 2034,
2042, 2058, 2062,
2066, 2067, 2093,
2116, 2117, 2118,
2119, 2120, 2121,
2122, 2123, 2151,
2159, 2164, 2166,
2167, 2172, 2173,
2175, 2209, 2214,
2275, 2277, 2278,
2281, 2282, 2283,
2301, 2374, 2470
Parasound 2197
peeKTON 2364
Philips 2008, 2012, 2025,
2044, 2050, 2051,
2053, 2060, 2072,
2108, 2111, 2147,
2159, 2163, 2169,
2174, 2181, 2185,
2230, 2261, 2266,
2267, 2286, 2287,
2289, 2295, 2300,
2302, 2317, 2328,
2338, 2342, 2350,
2467
Phonotrend 2367
Pioneer 2016, 2017, 2018,
2019, 2035, 2092,
2094, 2095, 2109,
2157, 2180, 2190,
2212, 2269, 2272,
2299, 2304, 2305,
2306, 2307, 2308,
- 6 -
2309, 2310, 2311,
2344, 2345, 2347,
2379
Pointer 2362
Polaroid 2125, 2215, 2235
Portland 2362
Powerpoint 2363
Prima 2252
Proceed 2130
Proscan 2156
Prosonic 2360, 2377
Protron 2202
Provision 2358
Pye 2144
Qwestar 2148
Raite 2380
RCA 2021, 2029, 2104,
2105, 2131, 2149,
2156, 2157, 2229
RedStar 2356, 2360, 2362
Regent 2153
Reoc 2355
Rimax 2361
Rio 2133
Roadstar 2331, 2358
Ronin 2363
Rotel 2203
Rowa 2154, 2383
Rownsonic 2353
Saba 2148, 2188
Sabaki 2355
Saivod 2362
Sampo 2141
Samsung 2000, 2045, 2077,
2112, 2113, 2114,
2115, 2151, 2200,
2216, 2219, 2228,
2264, 2265, 2271,
2279, 2294, 2303,
2329, 2365
Sansui 2073, 2145, 2354,
2355, 2362
Sanyo 2134, 2145, 2217,
2292
ScanMagic 2186
Schaub Lorenz 2362
Schneider 2176
Scientific Labs 2355
Scott 2161, 2357
Seeltech 2364
SEG 2162, 2355, 2363,
2380
Sharp 2006, 2040, 2088,
2091, 2182, 2194,
2220, 2221, 2231,
2236, 2293, 2340
Shinsonic 2245
Sigmatek 2359, 2364
Silva 2356
Singer 2354, 2355
Skymaster 2325, 2355
Skyworth 2356
Slim Art 2362
SM Electronic 2355
Sonic Blue 2133
Sontech 2366
Sony 2004, 2005, 2007,
2009, 2014, 2015,
2023, 2026, 2027,
2052, 2068, 2069,
2070, 2071, 2074,
2075, 2084, 2085,
2087, 2168, 2171,
2208, 2210, 2211,
2258, 2273, 2284,
2285, 2312, 2313,
2314, 2315, 2318,
2319, 2466
Soundmaster 2355
Soundmax 2355
Spectra 2363
Spectroniq 2201
Standard 2355
Star Cluster 2355
Starmedia 2358, 2364
Sungale 2204
Sunkai 2362
Superscan 2150
Supervision 2355
Sylvania 2012, 2137, 2150,
2178, 2230, 2239
Symphonic 2108, 2230
Synn 2355
T.D.E. Systems 2366
Tatung 2001, 2362
TCM 2182, 2297
Teac 2149, 2333, 2355,
2383
Tec 2356
Technics 2151
Technika 2362, 2367
Telefunken 2353
Tensai 2362
Tevion 2182, 2355, 2357
Theta Digital 2157
Thomson 2183, 2188, 2334,
2372
Tokai 2356, 2380
Top Suxess 2364
Toshiba 2032, 2036, 2037,
2039, 2048, 2049,
2054, 2055, 2072,
2073, 2076, 2078,
2079, 2086, 2145,
2159, 2218, 2233,
2256, 2259, 2296,
2369
TRANScontinents
2363, 2367
Transonic 2367
Trio 2362
Trutech 2242
TruVision 2359
TSM 2364
Umax 2361
United 2367
Urban Concepts 2159
US Logic 2245
Venturer 2149
Viewmaster 2364
Vocopro 2206
VocoStar 2207
Waitec 2364
Welltech 2382
Westinghouse 2063, 2250
Wharfedale 2354, 2355
Woxter 2361, 2364
Xbox 2156, 2183
Xlogic 2355, 2362
XMS 2362
Xoro 2382
Yamada 2051, 2361, 2363
Yamaha 2056, 2064, 2065,
2080, 2081, 2082,
2083, 2089, 2118,
2151, 2323
Yamakawa 2363, 2380
Yukai 2186
Zenith 2002, 2129, 2133,
2159, 2223
Blu-ray Disc
LG 2033
Panasonic 2011, 2209, 2214
Pioneer 2212
Samsung 2045, 2113
Sharp 2194, 2220, 2221
Sony 2075
Yamaha 2064, 2474
DVR
Bush 2110
Hitachi 2090
Panasonic 2066, 2067, 2093,
2116, 2117, 2119,
2120, 2122, 2123
Philips 2108, 2111
Pioneer 2016, 2017, 2018,
2019, 2092, 2094,
2095, 2109
RCA 2105
Samsung 2113, 2219
Sharp 2088, 2091
Sony 2084, 2085, 2087
Toshiba 2086
Yamaha 2089, 2118
DVD Recorder
Aspire 2222
Astar 2240
Broksonic 2146
Go Video 2213
Hitachi 2062
Insignia 2002
Irradio 2053
JVC 2100, 2101, 2106,
2107
LG 2033, 2057, 2223,
2238
Liteon 2043
Panasonic 2011, 2034, 2058,
2062, 2116, 2117,
2119, 2120, 2121,
2123
Philips 2008, 2044, 2050,
2051, 2147
Pioneer 2017, 2035
Pye 2144
Samsung 2000, 2112, 2216
Sansui 2073
Sanyo 2217
Sony 2004, 2005, 2007,
2052, 2068, 2069,
2074, 2208, 2210,
2211
Sylvania 2239
Toshiba 2032, 2036, 2037,
2039, 2049, 2054,
2055, 2076
Yamaha 2056
Cable
ABC 3002, 3003, 3017,
3066, 3067, 3086,
3093, 3119, 3122
ADB 3020
Adelphia 3081
Alcatel 3016
Americast 3124
Amstrad 3022, 3098
Antronix 3065, 3070
Archer 3070
Arcon 3098
AT&T 3095
Axis 3098
Bell South 3124
Cable Vision 3092
Cabletenna 3065
Cabletime 3104
Cableview 3087
Clearmaster 3127
ClearMax 3127
Clyde Cablevision
3105
Colour Voice 3068
Comcast 3084, 3088, 3117
Comcrypt 3107
Comtronics 3069
Contec 3074
Coolmax 3127
COX 3084
Cryptovision 3110
Director 3084
Eastern 3075
Everquest 3123
Fidelity 3098
Filmnet 3107
Filmnet Cablecrypt
3111
Filmnet Comcrypt
3111
Finlux 3097
Focus 3126
Foxtel 3022
France Telecom 3100, 3101
Freebox 3023
GC Electronics 3070
GE 3066, 3093
GEC 3105
Gemini 3072, 3123
General Instrument
3017, 3025, 3066,
3084, 3090, 3096,
3117
Goldstar 3120
Gooding 3099
Grundig 3098, 3099
Hamlin 3073, 3078
Hirschmann 3097
Hitachi 3066
HomeChoice 3106
Humax 3021, 3080, 3083
ITT Nokia 3097
Jasco 3123
Jerrold 3017, 3018, 3025,
3066, 3072, 3084,
3090, 3096, 3119,
3123
JVC 3099
Kabel Deutschland
3024, 3027, 3121
Macab 3101
Magnavox 3079
Maspro 3099
Matsui 3099
MegaCable 3117
Memorex 3076, 3122
Minerva 3099
Mnet 3107
Motorola 3025, 3026, 3084,
3088, 3090, 3095,
3117
Movie Time 3077, 3109
Mr Zapp 3101
Multichoice 3107
Multitech 3127
NEC 3064
NET Brazil 3085
Nokia 3097
Noos 3101
NSC 3077
Oak 3074
Pace 3006, 3089, 3121
Palladium 3099
Panasonic 3112, 3118, 3122
Paragon 3122
Philips 3068, 3071, 3079,
3099, 3100, 3101,
3103
Pioneer 3001, 3006, 3094,
3098, 3114, 3116,
3120
Popular Mechanics
3126
Proscan 3066, 3093
Pulsar 3122
PVP Stereo Visual Matrix
3018
Quasar 3122
RadioShack 3123, 3127
RCA 3030, 3031, 3087,
3118
Realistic 3070
Recoton 3126
Regal 3078
Regency 3075
Rembrandt 3066
Runco 3122
Sagem 3101
Samsung 3069, 3089, 3114,
3120
SAT 3098
Scientific Atlanta
3000, 3001, 3002,
3003, 3006, 3028,
3029, 3081, 3086,
3089, 3094, 3095,
3108
Signal 3072, 3123
Signature 3066
Sony 3092, 3125
Sprucer 3118
Standard Component
3115
Starcom 3017, 3072, 3119,
3123
Stargate 3072, 3123
Starquest 3072, 3123
Supercable 3090
Supermax 3127
Tele+1 3107, 3111
Telepiu 3107
Thomson 3082, 3091
TIME WARNER
3084
- 7 -
Tocom 3067
Torx 3017
Toshiba 3122
Tristar 3127
Tudi 3102
Tusa 3072, 3123
TV86 3077
Unika 3065, 3070
United Cable 3018, 3119
Universal 3065, 3070
Universum 3097, 3099
V2 3127
Videoway 3019
View Star 3074, 3077, 3079
Viewmaster 3127
Vision 3127
Visiopass 3097, 3100, 3101
Vortex View 3127
Wittenberg 3098
Zenith 3113, 3122, 3124
Zentek 3126
Satellite
AB Sat 4216, 4217
AccessHD 4104
ADB 4220
AGS 4216
Akai 4053, 4055
Alba 4001, 4004, 4006,
4007, 4062, 4217
Aldes 4005, 4007, 4010
Allsat 4048, 4053, 4055
Allsonic 4005, 4008, 4024
Alltech 4217
Alpha 4053
Alpha Digital 4104
Alphastar 4077
Amitronica 4217
Amstrad 4011, 4035, 4217,
4218
Anglo 4217
Ankaro 4005, 4008, 4024,
4217
Anttron 4001, 4004
Apollo 4001
Armstrong 4011, 4053
Artec 4100
Asat 4053, 4055
ASLF 4217
Astacom 4216
Astra 4009, 4011, 4054,
4217, 4219
Astro 4004, 4008, 4010,
4015, 4024, 4213,
4218, 4219
AudioTon 4004, 4048
Aurora 4222
Austar 4222
Axiel 4216
Axis 4008, 4009, 4024,
4050
Best 4008, 4024
Blaupunkt 4015
Blue Sky 4217
Boca 4011, 4054, 4059,
4217
Boston 4216
Brain Wave 4013
Broadcast 4012
Broco 4217
BSkyB 4035, 4041
BT 4216
Bubu Sat 4217
Bush 4006, 4045
Cambridge 4218
Canal Satellite 4213
Canal+ 4213
CaptiveWorks 4099
Channel Master 4007, 4110
Chaparral 4075
CHEROKEE 4216
Chess 4212, 4217
CityCom 4006, 4215, 4219
Clatronic 4013
CNT 4010
Comag 4080, 4081, 4082,
4083, 4086
Commlink 4005
Comtech 4050
Condor 4008, 4024, 4219
Connexions 4014, 4024
Conrad 4024, 4215, 4218,
4219
Conrad Electronic
4217, 4219
Contec 4050
Coolsat 4096
Cosat 4048
Coship 4109
Crown 4011
Daeryung 4014
Daewoo 4057, 4217
DDC 4007
Delega 4007
Dew 4050
Diamond 4051
Digiality 4219
Digital Stream 4105
DIRECTV 4056, 4064, 4067,
4068, 4070, 4071,
4074, 4107, 4116,
4119, 4121, 4122,
4123, 4127, 4192,
4193, 4194, 4195,
4196, 4197, 4198,
4199, 4200, 4201,
4202, 4203, 4206,
4207, 4221
Discoverer 4212
Discovery 4216
Diseqc 4216
Dish Network 4018, 4065, 4089,
4092, 4094, 4095,
4117
Dishpro 4018, 4117
Distrisat 4053
Ditristrad 4048
DNT 4014, 4053, 4055
Drake 4072
DStv 4222
Dune 4024
Echostar 4014, 4018, 4065,
4089, 4117, 4217
Einhell 4001, 4005, 4011,
4217, 4218
Elap 4216, 4217
Elekta 4010
Elsat 4217
Elta 4001, 4008, 4024,
4048, 4053, 4055
Emanon 4001
Emme Esse 4008, 4024
Engel 4217
Ep Sat 4006
EURIEULT 4031
Eurodec 4052
Europa 4053, 4218, 4219
Europhon 4219
Eurosat 4011
Eurosky 4024, 4011, 4008,
4215, 4218, 4219
Eurostar 4011, 4215, 4219
Eutelsat 4217
Exator 4001, 4004
Expressvu 4117
Fenner 4024, 4212, 4217
Ferguson 4006, 4052, 4214
Fidelity 4218
Finlandia 4006
Finlux 4006
FinnSat 4050, 4052
Flair Mate 4217
Foxtel 4222
Freecom 4001, 4049, 4218
FTEmaximal 4024, 4217
Fuba 4024, 4001, 4008,
4014, 4015, 4055,
4215
Galaxis 4024, 4005, 4008,
4009, 4050, 4048,
4215, 4222
GE 4093, 4066, 4111,
4197
General Instrument
4073, 4019
GMI 4011
GOI 4117
Goldbox 4213
GoldStar 4049
Goodmans 4029, 4002, 4006
Goodmind 4111
Grandin 4031
Grothusen 4001, 4049
Grundig 4006, 4004, 4015,
4035, 4211, 4218,
4222
Hänsel & Gretel 4219
Hantor 4001, 4013
Hanuri 4010
Hauppauge 4044
Heliocom 4219
Helium 4219
Hinari 4007
Hirschmann 4024, 4015, 4210,
4218, 4219, 4216
Hisawa 4013
Hisense 4016
Hitachi 4114, 4006, 4199,
4203
Homecast 4087, 4084, 4085
Houston 4048
HTS 4117
Hughes 4064, 4068, 4194,
4192, 4196, 4202
Hughes Network Systems
4071
Humax 4097, 4025, 4030,
4060
Huth 4005, 4011, 4012,
4013, 4050, 4048,
4219, 4223
Hypson 4031
Ilo 4016
Imex 4031
Innovation 4008
Insignia 4107
Intertronic 4011
Intervision 4048, 4219
ITT Nokia 4006
Jerrold 4019
Johansson 4013
JOK 4216
JSR 4048
JVC 4089, 4065, 4117,
4029
Kamm 4217
Kathrein 4015, 4055, 4053,
4063, 4034, 4042,
4215, 4216, 4217
Kathrein Eurostar
4215
Klap 4216
Konig 4219
Kosmos 4049
KR 4004
Kreiselmeyer 4015
K-SAT 4217
Kyostar 4001
L&S Electronic 4024
Lasat 4024, 4010, 4008,
4054, 4215, 4212,
4219
Lasonic 4108
Lenco 4024, 4001, 4049,
4215, 4219, 4217
Leng 4013
Lennox 4048
Lenson 4218
Lexus 4053
LG 4103, 4107, 4049
Lifesat 4024, 4008, 4212,
4217
Lifetec 4008
Lorenzen 4219
Lorraine 4049
Lupus 4024, 4008
Luxor 4218
Lyonnaise 4052
Macab 4052
Magnavox 4127, 4101
Manata 4031, 4216, 4217
Manhattan 4006, 4010, 4048,
4216
Marantz 4055
Mascom 4010
Maspro 4006, 4217
Matsui 4216
Max 4219
Mediabox 4213
Mediamarkt 4011
Mediasat 4009, 4213, 4218
Medion 4024, 4008, 4217
Medison 4217
Mega 4055, 4053
Memorex 4127
Metronic 4031, 4028, 4001,
4004, 4005, 4010,
4217
Metz 4015
Micro electronic 4218, 4219, 4217
Micro Technology
4217
MicroGem 4106
Micromaxx 4024, 4008
Microstar 4008
Microtec 4217
Minerva 4015
Mitsubishi 4006, 4015, 4202
Mitsumi 4054
Morgan's 4011, 4054, 4055,
4053, 4217
Motorola 4090, 4091, 4088,
4019
Multichoice 4222
Multitec 4212
Muratto 4049
Mysat 4217
Navex 4013
Neuhaus 4009, 4048, 4218,
4219, 4217
Neusat 4217
Next Level 4019
NextWave 4223
Nikko 4011, 4217
Nokia 4006, 4040
Nordmende 4001, 4006, 4007,
4010, 4052
Nova 4222
Novis 4013
Oceanic 4051
Octagon 4001, 4004, 4050
Okano 4011
Optex 4048
Optus 4213, 4222, 4223
Orbitech 4001, 4212, 4213,
4218
OSat 4004
Otto Versand 4015
Pace 4006, 4015, 4035,
4043, 4047, 4216
Pacific 4051
Packsat 4216
Palcom 4007
Palladium 4011, 4218
Palsat 4212, 4218
Panasat 4222
Panasonic 4121, 4126, 4124,
4006, 4035, 4036,
4221, 4198
Panda 4006, 4219
Pansat 4125
Patriot 4216
Paysat 4127
PCT 4110
Philco 4101
Philips 4071, 4068, 4127,
4006, 4055, 4053,
4061, 4033, 4213,
4216, 4196, 4202,
4203, 4201, 4206
Phoenix 4050
Phonotrend 4006, 4005, 4048
Pioneer 4046, 4213
Polsat 4052
Predki 4013
Premiere 4048, 4213
Priesner 4011
Primestar 4076
Profile 4216
Promax 4006
Prosat 4007, 4005
Proscan 4093, 4066, 4122,
4197
Protek 4051
Proton 4016
Provision 4010
- 8 -
Quadral 4024, 4007, 4005,
4008, 4216
Quelle 4015, 4215, 4219
Quiero 4052
RadioShack 4019
Radiola 4055, 4053
Radix 4014, 4037
Rainbow 4004
RCA 4093, 4066, 4112,
4113, 4118, 4119,
4116, 4122, 4197,
4207
Realistic 4078
Redpoint 4009
Redstar 4024, 4008
RFT 4005, 4055, 4053
Roadstar 4217
Roch 4031
Rover 4024, 4217
Saba 4010, 4215, 4219,
4216
Sabre 4006
Sagem 4023, 4052
Sakura 4050
Samsung 4064, 4071, 4069,
4123, 4120, 4003,
4000, 4001, 4032,
4196, 4200
SAT 4007, 4218
Sat Cruiser 4223
Sat Partner 4001, 4004, 4010,
4013, 4049, 4218
Sat Team 4217
Satcom 4012, 4219
Satec 4217
Satelco 4024
Satford 4012
Satmaster 4012
Satplus 4212
Schneider 4008, 4212, 4216
Schwaiger 4051, 4212, 4219
SCS 4215
Seemann 4011, 4009, 4014
SEG 4024, 4001, 4008,
4013
Seleco 4048
Servi Sat 4031, 4217
Siemens 4015
Silva 4049
Skantin 4217
Skardin 4009
Skinsat 4218
SKR 4217
Skymaster 4017, 4022, 4005,
4212, 4217
Skymax 4055, 4053
SkySat 4212, 4218, 4219,
4217
Skyvision 4048
SM Electronic 4212, 4217
Smart 4215, 4217
Sony 4067, 4070, 4213
SR 4011, 4054
Star Choice 4019
Starland 4217
Starring 4013
Start Trak 4001
Strong 4024, 4001, 4004,
4008, 4049, 4222
STS 4115
STVI 4031
Sumida 4011
Sunny Sound 4024
Sunsat 4217
Sunstar 4024, 4011, 4054
Supermax 4223
Tandberg 4052
Tandy 4004
Tantec 4006
TCM 4008
Techniland 4012
TechniSat 4021, 4026, 4027,
4014, 4053, 4038,
4039, 4212, 4213,
4218
Technology 4222
Technosat 4223
Technowelt 4219
Teco 4011, 4054
Telanor 4007
Telasat 4215, 4219
Telecom 4217
Telefunken 4017, 4001, 4216
Teleka 4004, 4011, 4014,
4218, 4219
Telemaster 4010
Telesat 4219
Telestar 4212, 4213, 4218
Televes 4006, 4218
Telewire 4048
Tempo 4223
Tevion 4008, 4217
Thomson 4020, 4006, 4052,
4058, 4208, 4215,
4213, 4219, 4216,
4217
Thorens 4051
Thorn 4006
Tivax 4104
Tivo 4196
Tokai 4053
Tonna 4006, 4012, 4048,
4218, 4217
Toshiba 4194, 4202, 4203
Triad 4049
Triasat 4218
Triax 4015, 4215, 4218,
4217
Turnsat 4217
Tvonics 4214
Twinner 4031, 4217
UEC 4222
Uher 4212
UltimateTV 4070
Uniden 4079, 4127
Unisat 4011, 4050, 4053
Unitor 4013
Universum 4015, 4215, 4219
US Digital 4016
Variosat 4015
Vega 4024
Ventana 4055, 4053
Viewsat 4098
Visiosat 4013, 4048, 4216,
4217
Voom 4019
Vortec 4001
Welltech 4212
WeTeKom 4212, 4218
Wevasat 4006
Wewa 4006
Winersat 4013
Wisi 4006, 4014, 4015,
4218, 4219
Woorisat 4010
Worldsat 4216
Xrypton 4024
XSat 4217
Zehnder 4024, 4010, 4008,
4209, 4215
Zenith 4102, 4107, 4195
Zodiac 4004
CD
Yamaha 5082, 5095
CD Recorder
Yamaha 5083
MD
Yamaha 5080, 5081, 5086
Tape
Yamaha 5084, 5087
Tuner
Yamaha 5066, 5071, 5085,
5088, 5090, 5092,
5094
XM
Yamaha 5091, 5093
SIRIUS
Yamaha 5064, 5067
DOCK
Yamaha 5068, 5089
NET
Yamaha 5076, 5079
LD
Yamaha 2080
Amplifier
Yamaha 5019, 5020
© 2010 Yamaha Corporation YC513F0/RC

Transcripción de documentos

Owner’s Manual AV Receiver English for U.S.A. CONTENTS INTRODUCTION Connecting the FM/AM antennas .................................. 32 Features and capabilities ................................................... 4 Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO).............................................................................. 33 Using the TV OSD to operate the unit ............................. 5 View or modify content for the current input source <Content window> ........................................................... 5 Configuring settings for this unit <ON SCREEN menu>...................................................... 5 Adjust settings for each input source <OPTION menu> ............................................................. 6 About this manual............................................................. 7 Supplied accessories......................................................... 7 Part names and functions.................................................. 8 Front panel........................................................................ 8 Rear panel......................................................................... 9 Front panel display ......................................................... 10 Remote control ............................................................... 11 On-screen display ........................................................... 12 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers ........................................................ 13 Speaker channels and functions...................................... 13 Speaker layout ................................................................ 14 Connecting speakers and subwoofer .............................. 17 Connecting external components.................................... 21 Cable plugs and jacks ..................................................... 21 Connecting a TV monitor............................................... 22 Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices ............ 25 Connecting game consoles ............................................. 29 Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder .................................................... 29 Connecting an external amplifier ................................... 30 Connecting a SCENE link playback-compatible device ........................................... 30 Using the Trigger function to link external component power.............................................. 31 Connecting audio/video recording devices..................... 31 PLAYBACK Basic playback procedure ............................................... 41 Adjusting high/low-frequency sound (Tone control) ..... 42 Changing input settings with a single key (SCENE function) ............................................................ 43 Registering input sources/sound program/ HDMI OUT .................................................................... 43 Enjoying the desired sound field effect .......................... 43 Selecting sound programs and sound decoders.............. 43 Sound programs.............................................................. 47 Using the TV display to control this unit....................... 49 Basic operations via the TV screen display ................... 49 Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)................. 51 OPTION menu display and setup................................... 51 OPTION menu ............................................................... 52 Listening to Satellite Radio............................................. 64 Connecting the SiriusConnect™ tuner .......................... 64 Activating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ subscription ........ 65 SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ operations............................. 65 Registering and recalling the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ channels.......................................................................... 66 Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ information .. 68 Confirming and operating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ from the Content window .............................................. 69 Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ ........... 71 Connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone ........... 71 Controlling an iPod™/iPhone™ .................................... 71 Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu screen (Menu browse control)................................................... 72 Operating basic playback functions via the remote control (Simple remote control) ............. 74 Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with wireless connection ...... 74 Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components ...... 76 Connecting a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver................................................... 76 Pairing Bluetooth™ components ................................... 76 Using Bluetooth™ components ..................................... 77 Confirming and operating input sources from the Content window ............................................... 55 Displaying the Content window on the TV screen......... 55 Switching the display between the Now Playing view and the Content browse view ......................................... 55 FM/AM tuning ................................................................. 56 Selecting a frequency for reception (Normal tuning)..... 56 Confirming and operating the FM/AM tuner from the Content window............................................... 58 Using HD Radio™ features............................................. 60 Selecting HD Radio™ audio programs.......................... 60 Using the iTunes Tagging............................................... 61 Displaying the HD Radio™ information ....................... 61 Confirming and operating the HD Radio™ tuner from the Content window............................................... 62 En 2 SETUP Configuring input sources (Input menu) ....................... 78 Configuring input sources .............................................. 78 Input menu...................................................................... 79 Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu) ............... 82 Editing a scene................................................................ 82 SCENE menu.................................................................. 83 Avoiding crossing remote control signals when using multiple Yamaha receivers ........................ 109 Resetting the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ parental lock code......................................................... 109 Changing TV format .................................................... 110 Removing HDMI video output up-scaling limits......... 110 Initializing various settings for this unit....................... 110 Using the HDMI Control function ............................... 111 Using multi-zone configuration .................................... 115 Connecting Zone2 ........................................................ 115 Controlling Zone2 ........................................................ 116 Using the party mode ................................................... 116 Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) ................................................... 85 Editing sound programs.................................................. 85 CINEMA DSP parameters ............................................. 86 Parameters usable in certain sound programs ................ 88 Parameters usable in surround decoder .......................... 89 APPENDIX Setting various functions (Setup menu) ......................... 90 Operating the Setup menu .............................................. 90 Setup menu ..................................................................... 91 Manages settings for speakers ........................................ 91 Setting the audio output function of this unit ................. 95 Setting this unit’s video output function......................... 96 Setting HDMI functions ................................................. 97 Setting this unit’s multi-zone function ......................... 100 Making the receiver easier to use ................................. 100 Language ...................................................................... 103 Troubleshooting ............................................................. 117 General ......................................................................... 117 HDMI™ ....................................................................... 119 Tuner (FM/AM) ........................................................... 120 HD Radio™ Reception ................................................ 120 iTunes Tagging ............................................................. 121 SIRIUS Satellite Radio™............................................. 121 iPod™/iPhone™ .......................................................... 122 Bluetooth™ .................................................................. 123 Remote control ............................................................. 123 Confirming information of this unit (Information menu) ....................................................... 104 Selecting information ................................................... 104 Glossary .......................................................................... 124 Audio information ........................................................ 124 Sound program information ......................................... 125 Video information ........................................................ 125 Video conversion .......................................................... 126 Controlling other components with the remote control.................................................. 105 Keys connecting external components ......................... 105 Default remote control code settings............................ 106 Registering remote control codes for external component operations ............................... 106 Resetting all remote control codes ............................... 107 Information on HDMI™ ............................................... 127 About trademarks.......................................................... 127 Specifications.................................................................. 128 Index ............................................................................... 130 Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu)............................... 108 Displaying/Setting the Advanced Setup menu ............. 108 Setting the impedance of speakers .............................. 108 En 3 INTRODUCTION Features and capabilities ■ Built-in high-quality, high-power 7-channel amplifier ■ 6 HDMI input jacks (5 + 1 VIDEO AUX) supporting Audio Return Channel and 3D video signal ■ 2 HDMI output jacks – Selecting the HDMI OUT jack ................................................................................................................41 ■ 1-button input/sound program switching (SCENE function)................................43 ■ Speaker connections for 2- to 7.1-channel configurations – – – – – – Speaker impedance configuration............................................................................................................18 Speaker channels and functions ...............................................................................................................13 Speaker layout..........................................................................................................................................14 Speaker cable connection.........................................................................................................................17 Subwoofer cable connection ....................................................................................................................20 High quality playback using bi-amplification connections .....................................................................18 ■ Automatic settings for speaker acoustic parameters (YPAO - Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) ......................................33 ■ External component connection (max. 16 inputs) and playback – – – – – – – External component connection...............................................................................................................21 Protective cover for front panel jacks ........................................................................................................7 Configuring the settings specific for each input source <OPTION menu>.............................................51 Playback from external components........................................................................................................41 Playback from an iPod/iPhone with wired connection ............................................................................72 Playback from an iPod/iPhone with wireless connection ........................................................................74 Playback from a Bluetooth component (Bluetooth and components sold separately) ............................76 ■ FM/AM tuner – – – – – HD Radio digital broadcast listening.......................................................................................................60 Receiving an FM/AM broadcast ..............................................................................................................56 Presetting stations ....................................................................................................................................56 Simple preset tuning ................................................................................................................................56 Changing Audio mode (Auto/Mono).......................................................................................................58 ■ Multi-channel, multi-format playback – – – – Sound field effect selection......................................................................................................................43 Playback without sound field effects .......................................................................................................44 Stereo playback........................................................................................................................................44 Compressed-music playback ...................................................................................................................46 ■ Front panel information display/on-screen display (OSD) on the TV screen – Switching information on the front panel display ...................................................................................10 – Operating this unit using the on-screen display.......................................................................................12 ■ Volume adjustment functions – Easy listening at low volumes < Adaptive DRC> ...................................................................................53 – Adjusting volume between input sources <Volume Trim> .....................................................................54 ■ Remote control operation – External component operation with this unit’s remote control..............................................................105 ■ Playing back the audio source in another room – – – – Using the internal amplifier for playback ................................................................................................18 Using the external amplifier for playback .............................................................................................115 Configuring the settings for another room.............................................................................................115 Controlling the external component in another room ............................................................................116 ■ Other features – Standby mode after a specific amount of time <Sleep timer>.................................................................11 – Charging the iPod/iPhone when this unit is in standby mode <iPod Standby Charge> ..........................80 – Tagging songs for subsequent preview and purchase on iTunes <iTunes Tagging> ...............................61 Most of this unit’s functions can be operated by following instructions displayed on the TV screen. Refer to “Using the TV OSD to operate the unit” on the following pages for information on functions that can be controlled using the on-screen display. ■ SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ – Receiving a channel .................................................................................................................................65 – Presetting channels ..................................................................................................................................66 – Displaying information ............................................................................................................................68 En 4 INTRODUCTION Using the TV OSD to operate the unit This unit features a sophisticated on-screen display (OSD) for the TV screen. The OSD is designed to enable visual guidance that simplifies operations. The OSD mainly displays the ON SCREEN and OPTION menus, as well as the Content window that displays the content of current input sources. ■ Select an input source, SCENE and sound program – Select an input source ..............................................................................................................................49 – Select a SCENE .......................................................................................................................................50 – Select a sound program............................................................................................................................50 ■ Select and customize a SCENE – Select a SCENE .......................................................................................................................................50 – Register or clear settings for a selected SCENE <Save>, <Reset> .........................................................83 – Turn on a Yamaha BD/DVD player or CD player connected to this unit automatically when a SCENE is selected <SCENE IR>................................................................................................83 View or modify content for the current input source <Content window> ■ Select and adjust a sound program (sound program) ■ Operate the AM/FM tuner or SIRIUS Satellite Radio ■ Display settings information for this unit – Display a list of preset stations/channels for selection ......................................................................59, 70 – Display information on the station/channel currently received .........................................................58, 69 – Perform operations such as searching for and registering stations/channels using the Utility <Utility>.............................................................................................................................................58, 69 ■ Display the list of iPod music sources – Display the list of iPod music sources for selection ................................................................................72 – Perform operations such as play, stop and pause using the TV screen <Menu browse control> ............72 – Perform basic playback functions such as play, stop and pause via the remote control <Simple remote control> .....................................................................................74 Configuring settings for this unit <ON SCREEN menu> – Display the ON SCREEN menu on the TV screen..................................................................................49 ■ Select and configure an input source – – – – – – – Select an input source ..............................................................................................................................49 Play the audio/video signal from the selected input source.....................................................................41 Change the input source name <Rename/Icon Select> ...........................................................................79 Select the audio input jack separately from the video input jack <Audio In>.........................................80 Specify a format for digital audio signals <Decoder Mode>...................................................................80 Enhance the sound of compressed audio <Enhancer>.............................................................................80 Output a video signal input from another input source while playing a multi-channel audio signal <Video Out> .......................................................................81 – Charge the iPod/iPhone when this unit is in standby mode <Standby Charge>......................................80 – Select a sound program............................................................................................................................50 – Adjust sound program parameters ...........................................................................................................85 – Display audio signal information <Audio Signal>................................................................................104 – Display video signal information <Video Signal> ................................................................................104 – Display HDMI signal information <HDMI - Monitor Info.>................................................................104 ■ Adjust acoustic parameters to match your speakers and listening environment – Specify speaker acoustic parameters automatically (Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer - YPAO).......................................................................33 – Set up this unit’s speaker configuration simply <Power Amp Assign> ..................................................91 – Specify settings for each speaker <Configuration> .................................................................................92 – Control volume control for each speaker <Level> ..................................................................................93 – Apply speaker distance settings <Distance> ...........................................................................................93 – Control equalizer sound quality <Parametric EQ>..................................................................................94 – Adjust test tone speaker <Test Tone> ......................................................................................................94 ■ Adjust audio signals output from this unit – – – – – Correct lag between audio and video signals <Lipsync> ........................................................................95 Select a dynamic range adjustment method <Dynamic Range> .............................................................95 Specify the maximum volume <Max Volume> .......................................................................................95 Specify the initial volume <Initial Volume>............................................................................................96 Adjust DSP effect and volume level <Adaptive DSP Level>..................................................................96 Continues to the next page En 5 INTRODUCTION Using the TV OSD to operate the unit ■ Adjust video signals output from this unit – Convert analog video signal to another type of signal <Analog to Analog Conversion> .......................96 – Specify the resolution and aspect ratio of analog video signal converted to HDMI or specify upscaling resolution for 480i/576i- or 480p/576p-HDMI output signal <Processing>...........................97 ■ HDMI settings – – – – Assign the audio input source for the TV <TV Audio Input>.................................................................98 Listen to TV audio with HDMI cable connection <ARC (Audio Return Channel)>..............................98 Transmit HDMI audio/video to the TV during standby mode <Standby Through> ...............................99 Change the output destination of HDMI input audio signals <Audio Output>.......................................99 ■ Enable listening in multiple rooms (multi-zone function) – Adjust Zone2 volume <Zone2 Set>.......................................................................................................100 ■ Specify other functions for this unit – – – – Enter standby mode automatically when no operations are performed <Auto Power Down>..............101 Adjust the brightness of the front panel display <Dimmer> .................................................................101 Change the wall paper displayed on the TV screen <Wall Paper>........................................................101 Specify the function of the TRIGGER OUT jack for controlling external components <Trigger Output> ...................................................................................................................................102 – Prohibit changes to settings <Memory Guard> .....................................................................................103 ■ Select a language – Change the language displayed on the TV screen <Language> ............................................................103 Adjust settings for each input source <OPTION menu> – – – – – – Display the OPTION menu on the TV screen .........................................................................................51 Select the 5.1-channel signal playback method <Extended Surround>...................................................53 Adjust bass and treble levels <Tone Control> .........................................................................................52 Enable low-volume background music <Adaptive DRC>.......................................................................53 Adjust the volume of input sources <Volume Trim>...............................................................................54 Adjust the vertical position of dialogues <Dialogue Lift> ......................................................................53 En 6 INTRODUCTION Using the TV OSD to operate the unit About this manual • Some features are not available in certain regions. • This manual is created prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements, etc. In case of differences between the manual and product, the product has priority. • “dHDMI1” (example) indicates the name of the parts on the remote control. Refer to the “Remote control” (☞p. 11) for the information about each position of the parts. • J1 indicates that the reference is in the footnote. Refer to the corresponding numbers on the bottom of the page. • ☞ indicates the page describing the related information. • Click on the “ ” at the bottom of the page to display the corresponding page in “Part names and functions.” Front panel Rear panel Front panel display Remote control Supplied accessories ■ Attaching the VIDEO AUX input cover (supplied) ■ Installing batteries in the remote control To protect against dust, attach the supplied VIDEO AUX input cover to the VIDEO AUX jacks when you do not use the jacks. To remove the cover, push the left section of it. When inserting batteries in the remote control, remove the battery compartment cover from the reverse side of the remote control, and insert two AAA batteries into the battery compartment so that they match with the polarity markings (+ and -). a Battery compartment cover b Attach the cover Battery compartment Replace the batteries with new ones if the remote control can only be operated within a narrow range. NOTE PUSH Check that you received all of the following parts. • • • • • • Remote control Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) x 2 YPAO microphone AM loop antenna Indoor FM antenna VIDEO AUX input cover c Remove the cover If there are remote control codes for external components registered to the remote control, removing the batteries for more than 2 minutes, or leaving exhausted batteries in the remote control, may clear the remote control codes. If this should occur, replace the batteries with new ones, and set the remote control codes. En 7 INTRODUCTION Part names and functions Front panel e INFO a MAIN ZONE A (Power) f b c d Switches this unit between on and standby mode. HDMI Through/iPod Charge indicator Lights up in any of the following cases while the unit is in standby mode. • When the Standby Through function is enabled and audio/video from an external component connected with HDMI is output to a TV during standby mode (☞p. 99). • When an iPod/iPhone, which is placed in the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone, is charging while the unit is in standby mode (☞p. 74). This indicator also lights up when the Yamaha iPod wireless receiver is connected to this unit (☞p. 74). ZONE2 Switches to enable/disable the audio output to Zone2 (☞p. 116). ZONE CONTROL Switches to Zone2 operation mode. This unit, or its remote control, can be used to select input sources or adjust volume for an external amplifier in another room or the built-in amplifier for speakers in another room (☞p. 116). g h i j k l INPUT selector Changes the information displayed on the front panel display (☞p. 10). MEMORY Registers FM/AM stations as preset stations (☞p. 56) or SIRIUS channels as preset channels (☞p. 66). J1 PRESET j / i Selects an FM/AM preset station (☞p. 58) or a SIRIUS preset channel (☞p. 67). J1 FM/AM (CATEGORY l / h) Sets the FM/AM tuner band to FM or AM (☞p. 56). J1 Selects a channel category for a SIRIUS (☞p. 66). Front panel display Displays information on this unit (☞p. 10). TUNING/CH jj / ii Changes FM/AM tuner frequencies (☞p. 56) or SIRIUS Satellite Radio channels (☞p. 66). J1 PURE DIRECT Switches this unit to Pure Direct mode (☞p. 46). m n o p q r s a b c d e f g h ij k t Selects an input source from which to playback. Rotate this selector to cycle through the input sources in order. PHONES jack For plugging headphones in. Sound effects applied during playback can also be heard through the headphones. YPAO MIC jack Connect the supplied YPAO microphone and adjust the speaker balance automatically (☞p. 33). TONE CONTROL Adjusts high-frequency/low-frequency output of speakers/headphones (☞p. 42). SCENE Switches the input source, the sound program, and the HDMI OUT with a single button (☞p. 43, p. 82). When this unit is in standby mode, press this key to switch on. PROGRAM selector Selects a sound program (☞p. 43). Rotate this selector to cycle through sound programs. STRAIGHT Changes a sound program to straight decoding mode (☞p. 44). VIDEO AUX jacks For connecting game consoles to this unit temporarily (☞p. 29). Attach the supplied VIDEO AUX input cover when not using this jack (☞p. 7). VOLUME Adjusts the volume level. MAIN ZONE PURE DIRECT ZONE2 ZONE CONTROL INFO MEMORY PRESET TUNING/CH CATEGORY FM AM VOLUME INPUT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO PROGRAM PHONES YPAO MIC TONE CONTROL SILENT CINEMA l m VIDEO AUX STRAIGHT HDMI IN n op q r VIDEO s L AUDIO R t J 1 : Usable when you have selected TUNER or SIRIUS input. En 8 INTRODUCTION Part names and functions Rear panel e REMOTE IN/OUT jacks a DOCK jack f b c d For connecting an optional Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (such as YDS-12), iPod wireless receiver (YID-W10), or Bluetooth wireless audio receiver (YBA-10) (☞p. 71, p. 74, p. 76). ANTENNA jacks For connecting AM and FM antennas (☞p. 32). HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks For connecting an HDMI - compatible TV to output audio/video signals (☞p. 23). MONITOR OUT jacks VIDEO jack COMPONENT VIDEO jacks g h i For connecting a TV capable of receiving video input, and outputting video signals to it (☞p. 23). For connecting TV that are compatible with component video signals, using three cables to output video signal (☞p. 23). a b c d j k e HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 l AV OUT jacks For connecting an external component that supports the remote control function (☞p. 30). HDMI1-5 jacks For connecting external components equipped with HDMIcompatible outputs to receive audio/video signals (☞p. 25). RS-232C terminal This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details. SPEAKERS terminals For connecting the front, center, surround and surround back speakers (☞p. 17). Connect the presence speakers (☞p. 17) or the speakers for Zone2 (☞p. 18) to the EXTRA SP jacks. Power cable For connecting this unit to an AC wall outlet. SIRIUS jack For connecting a SiriusConnect tuner (sold separately) (☞p. 64). AV1-6 jacks For connecting to external components equipped with audio/video outputs to receive audio/video signals (☞p. 26). f HDMI 2 HDMI 3 g HDMI 4 HDMI 5 h SELECTABLE o p q r Distinguishing the input and output jacks The area around the audio/video output jacks is marked in white to prevent connection errors. Use these jacks to output audio/video signals to a TV or other external component. RS-232C (BD/DVD) n i 2 ARC m For outputting audio/video signals received when analog inputs (AV36 or AUDIO1-2) are selected (☞p. 31). AUDIO1-2 jacks For connecting external components equipped with analog audio outputs to input sound into this unit (☞p. 28). TRIGGER OUT jack For connecting an external component that supports the trigger function to operate it linked with operation of this unit (☞p. 31). MULTI CH INPUT jacks For connecting a player that supports a multi-channel output (☞p. 29). AUDIO OUT jacks For outputting audio signals received when analog jacks, such as the AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are selected (☞p. 31). ZONE2 OUT jacks Outputs sound of this unit to an external amplifier set in a different room. (☞p. 115). PRE OUT terminals For connecting a subwoofer with built-in amplifier or an external power amplifier (☞p. 20, p. 30). ARC SPEAKERS SIRIUS EXTRA SP ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM CENTER SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP ZONE2/PRESENCE REMOTE PR PR IN HDMI 1 1 OUT HDMI 2 HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 RS-232C (BD/DVD) HDMI OUT SINGLE 75 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC PB PB SPEAKE VIDEO VIDEO NTENNA o FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM CENTER SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP REMOTE Y Y PR +12V MONITOR OUT IN 0.1A MAX. SINGLE 75 TRIGGER OUT OUT CENTER SINGLE CENTER PB VIDEO Y +12V 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT CENTER OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT ZONE2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 j k l m n o pq r SINGLE CENTER 1 SUBWOOFER 2 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT ZONE2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 Output jacks En 9 INTRODUCTION Part names and functions i SLEEP indicator Front panel display a HDMI indicator b c d e f g h ■ Switching information on the front panel display Lights up when the sleep timer is on (☞p. 11). j ZONE2 indicator Lights up during normal HDMI communication when any of the HDMI1-5 inputs are selected. OUT 1/OUT 2 indicators Lights up which outputs audio/video signals from the HDMI OUT jack (☞p. 23). SIRIUS indicator Lights up when a SiriusConnect tuner is selected as an input source. HD indicator Lights up when this unit is tuned into the HD Radio station (☞p. 60). TAG indicator Lights up when the selected HD Radio program (or song being played) supports iTunes Tagging (☞p. 61). CINEMA DSP indicator Lights up when a sound field effect that uses CINEMA DSP technology is selected. ENHANCER indicator Lights up when the Compressed Music Enhancer mode is turned on (☞p. 46). CINEMA DSP 3D indicator Lights up when CINEMA DSP 3D is activated (☞p. 45). Tuner indicator Light up according to the status of a received station (☞p. 56). a b SIRIUS k l m n o Lights up when the audio output to Zone2 is enabled (☞p. 116). MUTE indicator Flashes when audio is muted. VOLUME indicator Displays the current volume level. Cursor indicators Light up if corresponding cursors on the remote control are available for operations. Multi information display Displays a range of information on menu items and settings. Speaker indicators Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output. Subwoofer Presence speaker L Front speaker L Surround speaker L Surround back speaker L Input source name HDMI1 VOL. STRAIGHT SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR Sound program (DSP program) Center speaker SW PL PR C L R SL SR SBL SB SBR Presence speaker R Front speaker R Surround speaker R Surround back speaker R Surround back speaker J1 c de f g h HD TAG ENHANCER STEREO 3 TUNED OUT 1 OUT 2 m The front panel can display sound programs and surround decoder names as well as the active input source. Press INFO Key repeatedly to cycle through input source J2 → sound program → surround decoder in order. i jk SLEEP ZONE 2 l VOL. MUTE SW PL PR C L R SL SR SBL SB SBR n m o J 1 : “SB” is displayed when using a 6.1-channel configuration only. J 2 : During FM/AM reception, the frequency is displayed instead of the input source. During SIRIUS Satellite Radio signals reception, the channel is displayed instead of the input source. En 10 INTRODUCTION Part names and functions a Remote control signal transmitter Remote control b a MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET b o p q SOURCE RECEIVER c c d HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 2 HDMI1-5 V-AUX AUDIO1-2 AV1-6 [A] 4 AUDIO d AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK HDMI1-5 jacks Front panel VIDEO AUX jacks AUDIO1-2 jacks AV1-6 jacks Changes the external component to operate with the lExternal component operation keys without changing inputs. J1 MULTI CH INPUT jacks A Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone, iPod wireless receiver, or Bluetooth wireless audio receiver connected to the DOCK jack. FM/AM tuner A SIRIUS tuner connected to the SIRIUS jack. HDMI OUT TUNER SIRIUS r [ A ] MULTI CH INPUT DOCK CATEGORY e FM AM f INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC g h SLEEP PARTY i BD DVD TV PRESET TUN./CH TUNER SIRIUS ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT s j t VOLUME ENTER k RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN RETURN u DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE v m HOLD TAG PRG SELECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 TV TV VOL MUTE k l External component operation keys m n o FM AM (CATEGORY D / E) MEMORY PRESET F / G TUN./CH H / I q Sets the FM/AM tuner band to FM. Sets the FM/AM tuner band to AM. Selects a channel category for a SIRIUS. Presets radio stations. Selects a preset station. Changes tuning frequencies or SIRIUS Satellite Radio channels. g Cycles the information displayed on the front panel display (the name of the currently selected input source, the sound program, the surround decoder, the FM/AM tuner frequency, etc.). SLEEP Switches this unit to standby mode automatically after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press this key repeatedly to set the time for the sleep timer function. Sleep 90min. Switch the input source and the sound program with a single button (☞p. 43). When this unit is in standby mode, press this key to switch on. ON SCREEN Turns on and off the ON SCREEN menu. Cursor B / C / D / E, ENTER, RETURN Cursor B / C / D / E Select menu items and change settings when menus, etc, are displayed. ENTER Confirms a selected item. RETURN Returns to the previous screen when menus are displayed, or close the menu. p Sleep 120min. INPUT n w ENT j Operates the FM/AM tuner. These keys are used when using the tuner input. f INFO REC l Switches the party mode on and off (☞p. 116). i SCENE e Radio control keys SCENE CD h PARTY Transmits infrared signals. MAIN/ZONE2 Switches the zone to be operated by the remote control between the Main zone and Zone2 (☞p. 116). SOURCE A (SOURCE Power) Switches an external component on and off. Input selector Select an input source on this unit from which to playback. r s t u v w Operate recording, playback, and menu displays etc. for external components (☞p. 105). J1 Numeric keys Enter numbers. TV control keys Operate a monitor such as a TV. CODE SET Sets remote control codes for external component operations (☞p. 106). SOURCE/RECEIVER Switches remote control key function to operate this unit or an external component (☞p. 105). Operate an external component when this key glows green, or this unit when this key glows orange. RECEIVER A (RECEIVER Power) Switches this unit between on and standby mode. HDMI OUT Switches the output jack connected to an HDMI compatible TV (☞p. 41). Sound selection keys Switch between the sound field effect (sound program) you are using and the surround decoder (☞p. 43). OPTION Turns on and off the OPTION menu (☞p. 51). VOLUME +/Adjust the volume level (☞p. 41). MUTE Turns the mute function of the sound output on and off (☞p. 41). HD Radio keys TV CH Sleep Off Sleep 30min. Sleep 60min. The SLEEP indicator lights up when the sleep timer is on. TAG PRG SELECT Stores “tag” data to the iPod or internal memory of this unit (☞p. 61). Selects an HD Radio audio program (☞p. 60). J 1 : You can use lExternal component operation keys for each input source to operate registered components. Remote control codes must be registered for each input in advance if you want to operate external components (☞p. 106). En 11 INTRODUCTION Part names and functions ■ Displaying the following menus or viewing the current status of this unit on the TV screen On-screen display When a TV is connected to this unit, the supplied remote control can be used to specify and verify this unit’s settings via menus and options displayed on the TV screen. • ON SCREEN menu Press ON SCREEN to display the ON SCREEN menu. • OPTION menu Press OPTION to display the OPTION menu. • Content window Press Input selector to display the Content window. The following displays are available in the on-screen display. Content window ON SCREEN menu Detailed settings for this unit can be configured. Use this menu to select desired settings, change their values, or check the current status of this unit. Refer to “SETUP” (☞p. 78) for details. Includes the Content browse view and the Now Playing view. The Now Playing view displays the status of the source from which music is currently played back. Adjust settings for music content from the Content browse view. Refer to “Confirming and operating input sources from the Content window” (☞p. 55) for details. OPTION menu Configure the optional settings for each input source. Settings such as “Tone Control” and “Volume Trim” are applied to this unit regardless of the input source. Refer to “Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu)” (☞p. 51) for details. En 12 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers This unit uses acoustic field effects and sound decoders to bring you the impact of a real movie theater or concert hall. These effects will be brought to you with ideal speaker positioning and connections in your listening environment. Speaker channels and functions ■ Surround left and right speakers ■ Surround back left and right speakers ■ Front left and right speakers The surround speakers are for effect and vocal sounds with the 5.1channel speakers providing rear-area sounds. When used with 6.1/ 7.1-channel (including surround back channel), sound for right and left rear-area is output. Outputs the rear effect. When used with 6.1ch sound, sound from the left and right sound surround back speakers is mixed and output from a single speaker. When used with 5.1ch sound, sound from surround back speakers is distributed between the left and right surround speakers. The front speakers are used for the front channel sounds (stereo sound) and effect sounds. Ex. Ex. Front speaker layout: Place these speakers at an equal distance from the ideal listening position in the front of the room. When using a projector screen, the appropriate top positions of the speakers are about 1/4 of the screen from the bottom. ■ Center speaker The center speaker is for the center channel sounds (dialog, vocals, etc.). Ex. Center speaker layout: Place it halfway between the left and right front speakers. When using a TV, place the speaker just above or just under the center of the TV with the front surfaces of the TV and the speaker aligned. When using a screen, place it just under the center of the screen. Surround speaker layout: Place the speakers at the rear of the room on the left and right sides facing the listening position. They should be placed between 60 degrees and 80 degrees from the listening position and with the speaker tops at a height of 4.9 – 5.9 ft. (1.5 – 1.8 m) from the floor. ■ Presence left and right speakers The presence speakers are used for front effect sounds. When used in combination with the sound programs (☞p. 43), a sound with a richer and more spatial presence is possible. Ex. Surround back speaker layout: When used with 7.1ch sound, arrange the left and right speakers towards the listening position, to the rear of the listening position. Arrange the left and right speakers at least 1 ft. (30 cm) apart. The same separation as with the front left and right speakers is optimum. When used with 6.1ch sound, arrange these to the rear of the listening position. ■ Subwoofer The subwoofer speaker is used for bass sounds and low-frequency effect (LFE) sounds included in Dolby Digital and DTS. Use a subwoofer that is equipped with built-in amplifier. Ex. Presence speaker layout: Place the left and right presence speakers 1.6 – 3.3 ft. (0.5 – 1 m) to the outside of the left and right front speakers respectively. The tops of the presence speakers should be 5.9 ft. (1.8 m) above the floor. Ex. Subwoofer speaker layout: Place it to the outside of the front left and right speakers facing slightly inward to reduce echoes from the wall. En 13 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers Speaker layout ■ Enjoying the 7.1 channel audio source ■ 7.1-channel speaker layout (7 speakers + subwoofer) Front speaker R Subwoofer Front speaker L Surround speaker R ■ Assigning a speaker configuration ■ Connections of speakers A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the default “Power Amp Assign” setting (☞p. 91). Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker connection” for details on connecting speakers (☞p. 17). Power Amp Assign ■ Adding the presence speakers for a richer sound field effect ■ Presence speaker layout (7 speakers + subwoofer + presence speakers) Front speaker R Center speaker Surround speaker L Surround back speaker L 12 in (30 cm) or more Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER EXTRA SP jack Presence L/R speaker 7ch Normal (Default) Front speaker L Presence speaker L Presence speaker R ■ Assigning a speaker configuration A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the default “Power Amp Assign” setting (☞p. 91). Subwoofer Surround speaker R Surround back speaker R Audio from a 7.1-channel audio source can be played back with no degradation with this speaker configuration. Power Amp Assign 7ch Normal (Default) Continues to the next page ■ Connections of speakers Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker connection” for details on connecting speakers (☞p. 17). Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER EXTRA SP jack No used Center speaker Surround speaker L Surround back speaker L 12 in (30 cm) or more Surround back speaker R This unit automatically selects the presence speakers or surround back speakers to output sounds according to the selected sound program. When the sound program is changed, the speakers that output the sound are switched between the presence speakers and surround back speakers automatically. En 14 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers ■ Enjoying the 7.1 channel audio source without surround back speakers ■ 5.1-channel speaker layout (5 speakers + subwoofer) Front speaker R ■ Assigning a speaker configuration ■ Connections of speakers A speaker configuration must be assigned to this unit to activate the speakers. Use the “Power Amp Assign” function to easily apply the appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker configuration. Speakers for this layout can be activated at the default “Power Amp Assign” setting (☞p. 91). Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Bi-amp connection” for details on connecting speakers (☞p. 17, p. 18). Subwoofer Front speaker L Power Amp Assign Surround speaker R ■ Using the front speakers that support bi- amp connections for a high quality sound ■ 5.1-channel speaker layout (Front speakers (Bi-amp) + 3 speakers) Front speaker R (Bi-amp connection) Center speaker Front speaker L (Bi-amp connection) This unit can mix 7.1-channel audio source down to 5.1-channel sound. This enables 7.1-channel sound without surround back speakers. Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Presence speaker connection” for details on connecting speakers (☞p. 17). Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SUBWOOFER EXTRA SP jack No used FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER EXTRA SP jack No used ■ Assigning a speaker configuration Use the “Power Amp Assign” function which can easily apply the appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker configuration (☞p. 91). Power Amp Assign Subwoofer Surround speaker R Surround speaker L ■ Connections of speakers Speaker jacks 7ch Normal (Default) 5ch BI-AMP Continues to the next page Center speaker Surround speaker L Using the front speakers that support bi-amp connections reproduces a high quality sound. En 15 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers ■ Using speakers in two rooms (Zone2 function) ■ 7.1-channel speaker layout + Zone2 (7 speakers (in main zone) + subwoofer (in main zone) + front speakers (in secondary zone)) In addition to the main room, speakers in another room can also be controlled. When the built-in amplifier for the speakers in another room is turned on, the speakers that output the sound are switched from the surround back speakers to the speakers in another room automatically. J1 Main zone ■ Connections of speakers Front speaker R Front speaker L Subwoofer Surround speaker R Connect the speakers to the following jacks according to the speaker layout. Refer to “Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection” and “Multi-zone audio system using the internal amplifier of this unit” for details on connecting speakers (☞p. 17, p. 18). Speaker jacks FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, SUBWOOFER EXTRA SP jack Zone2 speaker Center speaker ■ Assigning a speaker configuration Surround speaker L Surround back speaker L 12 in (30 cm) or more Surround back speaker R Use the “Power Amp Assign” function which can easily apply the appropriate speaker settings to this unit according to the speaker configuration (☞p. 91). Power Amp Assign Zone2 7ch + 1ZONE Front speaker R Front speaker L J 1 : Sound cannot be output from both the surround back speakers and the speakers in the second zone at the same time. En 16 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers Connecting speakers and subwoofer Connect your speakers to their respective terminals on the rear panel. CAUTION • Remove the AC power cable of this unit from the power outlet before connecting the speakers. • Generally speaker cables consist of two parallel insulated cables. One of these cables is a different color, or has a line running along it, to indicate different polarity. Insert the different colored (or lined) cable into the “+” (positive, red) terminal on this unit and the speakers, and the other cable into the “–” (negative, black) terminal. • Be careful that the core of the speaker cable does not touch anything or come into contact with the metal areas of this unit. This may damage this unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “CHECK SP WIRES!” will appear on the front panel display when this unit is switched on. ■ Front/Center/Surround/Surround back speaker and Subwoofer connection Front speaker R Surround speaker L R Surround back speaker L R ■ Presence speaker connection When using the presence speakers, connect the speakers to the EXTRA SP jacks as shown in the diagram below. The presence speakers (PL/PR) that output front effect sounds can be connected to this unit. With the sound programs (☞p. 47), sound with a richer and more spatial presence can be created. Presence speaker L R L 1.8 m MI 1 HDMI 2 HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 RS-232C DVD) MI 5 RS-232C SPEAKERS EXTRA SP FRONT CENTER SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP SPEA ZONE2/PRESENCE EXTRA SP SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP REMOTE IN SINGLE OUT SINGLE ZONE2/PRESENCE 0.5 – 1 m 0.5 – 1 m PL PR FL FR 1.8 m • Connection of presence speakers is recommended to take full advantage of the effects of CINEMA DSP sound programs. • Although you can connect both surround back speakers and presence speakers to this unit, you cannot output sounds from those speakers at the same time. +12V 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT CENTER SINGLE CENTER SINGLE SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT Center speaker ZONE2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT 1 CENTER WOOFER 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 Continues to the next page Subwoofer En 17 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers ■ Bi-amp connection This unit can be connected to speakers that support bi-amp connections. When connecting speakers, connect the FRONT jacks and the SURROUND BACK/BI-AMP jacks as in the diagram below. Configure the bi-amp settings to activate connections. ■ Changing speaker impedance ■ Multi-zone audio system using the internal amplifier of this unit Connect the speakers in the second zone to the EXTRA SP jacks as in the diagram below. 1 2 EXTRA SP ZONE2/PRESENCE Zone2 FRONT SURROUND BACK/ BI-AMP DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 RS-232C (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SPEAKERS SIRIUS EXTRA SP ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO SINGLE FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM CENTER SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP ZONE2/PRESENCE REMOTE PR PR This unit is configured for 8 Ω speakers at the factory setting. When connecting to 6 Ω speakers, carry out the following procedure to switch to 6 Ω. When this unit is configured for 6 Ω speakers, 4 Ω speakers can also be used as the front speakers. Switch this unit to the standby mode. Press MAIN ZONE A while pressing and holding STRAIGHT on the front panel. Release the keys when “ADVANCED SETUP” is displayed on the front panel display. After approximately a few seconds, the top menu item is displayed. J1 IN SINGLE 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT CENTER OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER SINGLE AUDIO OUT ZONE2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT CENTER 1 SUBWOOFER 2 CAUTION NOTES • Before making bi-amplification connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the instruction manuals of speakers for details. When not making bi-amplification connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables. • If connecting a bi-amp, then surround back speakers cannot be used. The EXTRA SP jacks of this unit should not be connected to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or more than one loudspeaker per channel. Connection to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or multiple speakers per channel could create an abnormally low impedance load resulting in amplifier damage. See this owner’s manual for correct usage. Compliance with minimum speaker impedance information for all channels must be maintained at all times. This information is found on the back panel of this unit. MAIN ZONE A MAIN ZONE ZONE2 ZONE CONTROL INFO MEMORY PRESET CATEGORY FM AM INPUT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO PROGRAM PHONES SILENT CINEMA YPAO MIC TONE CONTROL STRAIGHT H STRAIGHT Continues to the next page J 1 : Refer to the “Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu)” (☞p. 108) for details on the Advanced Setup menu. En 18 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers 3 Check that “SP IMP.” is displayed on the front panel. SPIMP.-8MIN 4 5 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select a “6ΩMIN.” ■ Connecting speakers This type of jack can connect to the following speakers or connection. • • • • • Front L/R speakers Center speaker Surround L/R speakers Surround back L/R speakers Bi-amp connection (Front speaker L/R speakers) 4 Tighten the terminal. Connecting the banana plug Tighten the knob, and then insert the banana plug into the end of the terminal. FR ON T Banana plug Switch this unit to the standby mode, and then switch it on again. The power turns on, when the settings you made has been configured. 2 3 FR ON T 1 4 1 Remove approximately 0.4 in. (10 mm) of insulation from the ends of the speaker cables, and twist the bare wires of the cables together firmly so that they will not cause short circuits. 2 3 Loosen the speaker terminals. Insert the bare wire of the speaker cable into the gap on the side of the terminal. En 19 CONNECTIONS Connecting speakers ■ Connecting the subwoofer 1 Connect the subwoofer input jack to the SUBWOOFER 1 or 2 jack on this unit with an audio pin cable. 2 Set the subwoofer volume as follows. Volume: Set to approximately half volume (or slightly less than half). Crossover frequency (if available): Set to maximum. VOLUME MIN MAX CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT MIN MAX Subwoofer examples NOTE After connection, applying this setting to this unit is required to activate all speaker connections. With using “Power Amp Assign” function, you can easily apply the speaker configuration. Refer to “Power Amp Assign” (☞p. 91) for details on using “Power Amp Assign” function. En 20 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components Cable plugs and jacks VIDEO jacks This unit is equipped with the following input/output jacks. Use jacks and cables appropriate for components that you are going to connect. These jacks transmit conventional analog video signals. Use video pin cables. ■ Audio/Video jacks Video pin cable HDMI jacks Digital video and digital sound are transmitted through a single jack. Only use an HDMI cable. HDMI cable ■ Audio jacks • Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. • We recommend using a cable less than 16.4 ft. (5.0 m) long to prevent signal quality degradation. • When a TV that supports HDMI functions and Audio Return Channel function is connected, audio output from the TV can be input to this unit (☞p. 113). • When a player and TV that support the 3D video format are connected to this unit, 3D content can be played back. • If you connect this unit to a component that has a DVI jack, an HDMI/DVI-D cable is required. ■ Analog video jacks OPTICAL jacks COAXIAL jacks These jacks transmit optical digital audio signals. Use fiber-optic cables for optical digital audio signals. These jacks transmit coaxial digital audio signals. Use pin cables for digital audio signals. Digital audio fiber-optic cable Digital audio pin cable AUDIO jacks COMPONENT VIDEO jacks The signal is separated into three components: luminance (Y), chrominance blue (PB), and chrominance red (PR). Use component video pin cables with three plugs. Component video pin cable These jacks transmit conventional analog audio signals. Use stereo pin cables, connecting the red plug to the red R jack, and the white plug to the white L jack. Stereo pin cable En 21 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components Connecting a TV monitor When connecting to a non-HDMI compatible TV This unit is equipped with the following three types of output jack for connection to a TV. HDMI OUT 1-2, COMPONENT VIDEO or VIDEO. Select the proper connection according to the input signal format supported by your TV. Connect to the TV using the same type of connection that you used to connect to the external component, and change the inputs on your TV to match that of the external component you are using for playback. If the external component and TV are equipped with different types of analog video jacks, this unit will convert the video signal to component video signal, or vice-versa, according to the type of video input jacks used by the TV. J2, J3 COMPONENT VIDEO jacks HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks (MONITOR OUT) DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI (BD/DVD) Input Output HDMI HDMI COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO Component video input 2 ARC SELECTABLE TV ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM VIDEO REMOTE PR PR IN VIDEO Video input 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT VIDEO jack (MONITOR OUT) Through Converted When connecting to an HDMI compatible TV Video signal such as component video and video received by this unit is converted to HDMI and output to the TV. Just select HDMI input on the TV to view video from any external source connected to this unit. J1 Input Output HDMI HDMI TV HDMI input COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO Through Converted J 1 : You can change the resolution and aspect ratio when converting to HDMI to suit your requirements (☞p. 97). J 2 : Set “Analog to Analog Conversion” to “On” (☞p. 96). J 3 : Analog to analog conversion is available only for 480i/576i-resolution video signal. En 22 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components ■ Connecting an HDMI video monitor ■ Connecting a component video monitor J1 Connect the HDMI cable to one of the HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. Connect the component video cable to the COMPONENT VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jacks. HDMI input Component video input HDMI HDMI DOCK 1 SELECTABLE COMPONENT VIDEO ARC SIRIUS HDMI PR ANTENNA TV HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) SELECTABLE HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO 2 ARC (BD/DVD) 2 ARC DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT GND FM COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR PR PB PB PB IN ARC 75 Y OUT PB SIRIUS ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM HDMI GND RE PR PR VIDEO VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO AM Y Y Y IN OR OUT TRIGG 75 TV OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT TRIGG OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) HDMI OPTICAL AV OUT ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 FRONT AUDIO 1 SURROU MULT AUDIO 2 HDMI OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT ■ Connecting a video monitor J1 Projector • Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. • We recommend using a cable less than 16.4 ft. (5.0 m) long to prevent signal quality degradation. • When a TV that supports the HDMI function and Audio Return Channel function is connected, audio output from the TV can be input to this unit (☞p. 113). • When a player and TV that support the 3D video format are connected to this unit, 3D content can be played back. • This unit is equipped with HDMI OUT 1 and 2 jacks. The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be selected (☞p. 41). The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be registered with the SCENE function (☞p. 43). Connect the video pin cable to the VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jack. HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS Video input ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR IN VIDEO 75 OUT PB PB V VIDEO Y Y MONITO TRIGG TV V OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT J 1 : When connecting to a TV that supports HDMI input, the video signal for the COMPONENT VIDEO/VIDEO jacks is converted and output from HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. When connecting to a TV via the HDMI jack, you do not need to use these jacks. En 23 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components ■ Listening to TV audio To transmit sound from the TV to this unit, connect as followings according to the TV: When using a TV that supports the Audio Return Channel function and HDMI Control function When your TV supports both HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link) and Audio Return Channel functions, audio/video output from the unit to the TV and audio output from the TV to the unit are possible using a single HDMI cable. The input source is switched automatically to match operations carried out on the TV, and that makes TV sound control easier to use. For the connections and settings, refer to “Single HDMI cable input to TV audio with Audio Return Channel function” (☞p. 113). When using a TV that supports the HDMI Control functions When using a TV that supports HDMI Control functions (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link), if HDMI Control functions are enabled on the unit, then input source can be switched automatically to match operations carried out on the TV. For the connections and settings, refer to “Switching the input source on this unit automatically when listening to TV audio” (☞p. 112). When using other TVs To transmit sound from the TV to this unit, connect AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 jacks to the TV’s audio output jacks. TV audio output Connection Optical digital audio output Connect to the OPTICAL jack of the AV1 or AV4 with a fiber-optic cable. Coaxial digital audio output Connect to the COAXIAL jack of the AV2 or AV3 with a digital audio pin cable. Analog stereo output Connect to one of the AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2 with a stereo pin cable. Select the input source connected via TV’s audio output jack to enjoy the TV sound. If the TV supports optical digital audio output, we recommend that you connect the TV audio output to the receiver’s AV4 jack. Connecting to AV4 allows you to switch the input source to AV4 with just a single key operation using the SCENE function (☞p. 43). Available input jacks Audio output (Optical, coaxial, or analog) DOCK COAXIAL HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 AUDIO (BD/DVD) 2 ARC OPTICAL SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR IN 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO TV Y Y MONITOR OUT OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 TRIGG SURROU MULT You can control your TV using the receiver’s remote control by entering the TV’s remote control code (☞p. 106). En 24 CONNECTIONS MAIN Connecting external components ZONE 2 CODE SET Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 This unit has the following input jacks. Connect them to the appropriate output jacks on the playback devices such as BD/DVD players. AUDIO 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] Input Video input Audio input HDMI OUT HDMI1 HDMI HDMI HDMI2 HDMI HDMI HDMI3 HDMI HDMI ■ Receiving video signals from the HDMI jack and audio signals from a jack other than HDMI This unit can use the AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 input jacks to receive audio signals from other input jacks. For example, if a playback device cannot produce audio signals from an HDMI jack, use the following method to change the audio input. CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE HDMI4 HDMI HDMI STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT HDMI5 HDMI HDMI H DOCK HDMI OUT 1 HDMI/Audio (Optical) output (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS HDMI ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM REMOTE PR PR j SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO AV1 Component video Optical digital AV2 Component video Coaxial digital IN 75 OUT PB PB HDMI VIDEO VIDEO OPTION ON SCREEN HDMI Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT OPTICAL VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE k AV3 Video Coaxial digital AV4 Video Optical digital O OPTICAL Video Analog (Stereo) AV6 Video Analog (Stereo) AUDIO1 — Analog (Stereo) AUDIO2 — Analog (Stereo) VIDEO AUX HDMI/Video HDMI/Analog (Stereo) HDMI Connect the device with an HDMI cable to one of the HDMI1-5 jacks. The HDMI IN jack on the front panel can also be used. Select the HDMI input (HDMI1-5 or VIDEO AUX) that the playback device is connected to for playback. RS (BD/DVD) 2 ARC GND SELECTABLE ARC COMPONENT VIDEO AM FRONT HDMI CENTER SURROUND REMOTE HDMI output PR IN OUT PB HDMI VIDEO HDMI Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT CENTER BD/DVD player AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER SINGLE AUDIO OUT COAXIAL AV 2 AV 3 ZONE2 OUT OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SU MULTI CH IN BD/DVD player ■ Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with HDMI OUT COAXIAL (CD) AV5 j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER 0.1A MAX TRIGGER OUT O FRONT SURROUND 1 2 3 4 5 6 Press jON SCREEN to display the ON SCREEN menu. Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Input,” and then press kENTER. J1 Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select the desired HDMI input source, and then press kCursor B. Press kCursor C repeatedly to select “Audio In,” and then press k ENTER. Press kCursor B / C to select the audio input source. Once you have completed the setup, press jON SCREEN to close the menu. SUR.BAC PRE OU J 1 : Refer to the “Configuring input sources (Input menu)” (☞p. 78) for details on selecting the input source. En 25 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components ■ Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with component video cables Connect the device with a component video cable to one of the AV1-2 input jacks. ■ Component connections to analog audio output devices Component video / Audio output Using optical digital audio output sources Select the AV1 input to which the playback device is connected for playback. COMPONENT VIDEO HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 H (BD/DVD) 2 ARC PR SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA PB Y HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO PR FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM REMOTE PR PR IN 75 Component video / Audio (Optical) output OUT AUDIO HDMI OUT 1 PB PB Y Y PB VIDEO VIDEO HDMI 1 DOCK L (BD/DVD) Y +12V MONITOR OUT 2 ARC SELECTABLE 0.1A MAX TRIGGER OUT R ARC L COMPONENT SIRIUS R ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR PR PB PB GND FM COMPONENT VIDEO AM PB OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) RE PR OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 2 SURROUND SU MULTI CH IN IN 75 OUT PB Y VIDEO VIDEO Y Game console Y Y MONITOR OUT OPTICAL TRIGG O O OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 2 AV 3 OPTICAL (CD) AV OUT ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 FRONT AUDIO 1 SURROU MULT AUDIO 2 BD/DVD player Using coaxial digital audio output sources Select the AV2 input to which the playback device is connected for playback. Component video / Audio (Coaxial) output HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC COMPONENT VIDEO The video input from the AV1-2 jacks can be used in combination with the audio input from other AV inputs or AUDIO1-2. When connecting these devices, select the AV input jacks or the AUDIO1-2 jacks as the audio input for AV1 or AV2. Refer to “Receiving video signals from the HDMI jack and audio signals from a jack other than HDMI” (☞p. 25) for detailed setup guidance. For playback of the connected device, select the AV input source (AV1-2) to which the device is connected with the component video cable. SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA PR HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR PR PB IN 75 OUT PB Y PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y Y MONITOR OUT COAXIAL TRIGG C C OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL (CD) AV 1 AV 3 OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT BD/DVD player En 26 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components ■ Connecting BD/DVD players and other devices with video cables Connect the playback device with a video pin cable to one of the AV3-6 input jacks. Using analog stereo audio output sources Select the AV5 or AV6 input to which the playback device is connected for playback. Using optical digital audio output sources Select the AV4 input to which the playback device is connected for playback. DOCK 1 Video / Audio output HDMI 1 HDMI OUT (BD/DVD) SELECTABLE ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM RE RE PR PB PB AUDIO Y MONITOR OUT TRIGG L OUT L PB VIDEO VIDEO V Y VIDEO V Y IN 75 PB V IN OUT VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO AM PR VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO AM 75 V GND FM GND PR ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO ARC SIRIUS VIDEO ARC SIRIUS Video / Audio (Optical) output SELECTABLE PR 2 ARC (BD/DVD) 2 ARC DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 R R Y MONITOR OUT OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 TRIGG OPTICAL (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT O O OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 OPTICAL AV OUT (CD) AV 5 AV 6 FRONT AUDIO 1 SURROU MULT AUDIO 2 BD/DVD player BD/DVD player Using coaxial digital audio output sources Select the AV3 input to which the playback device is connected for playback. DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS Video / Audio (Coaxial) output ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR IN 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO V V Y Y MONITOR OUT TRIGG COAXIAL C C OPTICAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 COAXIAL (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT BD/DVD player En 27 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components ■ Connecting CD players and other audio devices Using coaxial digital output sources Select the AV input (AV2 or AV3) to which the playback device is connected for playback. Using analog stereo output sources Select the audio input (AUDIO1-2) to which the playback device is connected for playback. HDMI 1 DOCK (BD/DVD) HDMI OUT 1 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) SIRIUS 2 ARC SELECTABLE ANTENNA ARC HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO SIRIUS FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR IN ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO GND FM COMPONENT VIDEO AM OUT RE IN 75 Audio (Coaxial) output OUT Y MONITOR OUT VIDEO VIDEO AUDIO VIDEO VIDEO Y PB PB PB PB PR PR Audio output 75 L MONITOR OUT TRIGG C COAXIAL Y Y C TRIGG L R OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL (CD) AV 1 OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT R OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 OPTICAL (CD) AV 5 FRONT AV OUT ( TV ) AV 4 AV 6 SURROU MULT CD player CD player We recommend connecting audio devices with a coaxial digital output to the AV3 coaxial digital jack on this unit. This connection allows you to switch to the AV input 3 just by pressing the “CD” SCENE key (☞p. 43). Using optical digital output sources Select the AV input (AV1 or AV4) to which the playback device is connected for playback. DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM RE PR PR IN 75 OUT PB PB Audio (Optical) output VIDEO VIDEO Y Y MONITOR OUT OPTICAL TRIGG O O OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 2 AV 3 OPTICAL (CD) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROU MULT CD player En 28 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components Connecting game consoles Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to temporarily connect devices such as a game console to the receiver. Select the V-AUX input to use these connected devices. This unit has 8 sets of input jacks (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SUR. BACK and SUBWOOFER) to input multi-channel analog sound signals. If your playback component, such as a DVD player or SACD player, has multi-channel analog output capability, you can enjoy up to 7.1channel multi-channel sound. To output multi-channel sound, connect the audio output jacks of your playback component to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit, and set the input source of this unit to “MULTI CH.” ■ When connecting an HDMI compatible device Connect the HDMI output of the device to the HDMI IN jack of this unit. CENTER RADIO VIDEO AUX STRAIGHT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK SUBWOOFER MULTI CH INPUT HDMI IN VIDEO L AUDIO R L R L R L R HDMI HDMI output HDMI HDMI Center out Subwoofer out Surround out Connect the video and audio outputs of the device to the VIDEO and AUDIO jacks of this unit. Front out ■ When connecting an non-HDMI compatible device Surround back out Game console RADIO VIDEO AUX STRAIGHT Multi-format player/External decoder (7.1-channel output) HDMI IN VIDEO L V L AUDIO R R Video output VIDEO V AUDIO L Analog audio output R Game console • When you select “MULTI CH” as the input source, the digital sound field processor and tone control are automatically disabled. • Since this unit does not redirect signals input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers, connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system when using this feature. • When the input source is switched to “MULTI CH,” images input from a component connected to the HDMI1-5, AV1-6, or VIDEO AUX jacks can be displayed on a video monitor (☞p. 81). If your DVD player does not support multi-channel digital output, connect it to these input jacks. • Be sure to turn down the volume when connecting this unit and the other devices. • When both the HDMI connection and the analog video/audio connection are performed between the HDMI compatible device and this unit, only the HDMI signal will be input. En 29 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components Connecting an external amplifier Connecting a SCENE link playback-compatible device The same channel signals are output from the jacks of the PRE OUT terminals as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. When connecting an external power amplifier (pre-main amplifier) to enhance speaker output, connect the input terminals of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT terminals of this unit. When the components are the Yamaha products and have the capability of the transmission of the remote control signals, connect the REMOTE IN and REMOTE OUT jacks to the remote control input and output jack with the monaural analog mini cable as follows. NOTE Remote control out When a component is connected to the PRE OUT terminals, do not connect speakers to the SPEAKERS terminals corresponding to those PRE OUT terminals. HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC ANTENNA HD Radio FM HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) 2 GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM PR Infrared signal receiver or Yamaha component IN 75 OUT PB VIDEO VIDEO Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT CENTER SINGLE COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 2 AV 3 (CD) FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT Remote control in CENTER OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT Yamaha component (CD or DVD player, etc.) 1 SUBWOOFER 2 abc d e a FRONT (PRE OUT) jacks Front channel output jacks. • When a Yamaha component that supports the SCENE link playback function is connected via the REMOTE OUT jack, playback begins automatically when the SCENE function is used (☞p. 43). • If the component connected to the REMOTE OUT jack is not a Yamaha product, set “SCENE IR” in the SCENE menu to “Off” (☞p. 83). b SURROUND (PRE OUT) jacks Surround channel output jacks. c SUR. BACK (PRE OUT) jacks Surround back output jacks. When you only connect one external amplifier for the surround back channel, connect it to the SUR. BACK (SINGLE) jack. d SUBWOOFER (PRE OUT) 1/2 jack Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier. When two subwoofers are connected, the same sound is output from them. e CENTER (PRE OUT) jack Center channel output jack. En 30 CONNECTIONS Connecting external components Using the Trigger function to link external component power Connecting audio/video recording devices When this unit is connected to a Yamaha subwoofer that supports the system connection or the component with TRIGGER IN jack, you can turn on and off the component by using this unit. This receiver can transmit selected incoming analog audio/video signals to external components through the AV OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks. You can record these input audio and video signals to VCRs or similar devices, or send them to other TVs or external components. ■ When connecting a Yamaha subwoofer Video / Audio input VIDEO V HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) System connection input AUDIO 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC L DOCK ANTENNA HD Radio GND FM 1 REMOTE PR HDMI 2 SELECTABLE R ARC SIRIUS OUT PB ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC IN 75 HDMI 1 HDMI OUT FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM REMOTE PR PR Y IN +12V 0.1A MAX. MONITOR OUT 75 OUT CENTER PB PB V Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT COAXIAL (CD) AV 3 OPTICAL AV OUT ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 FRONT AUDIO 1 SURROUND SUR.BACK SUBWOOFER 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT Audio input CENTER AUDIO OUT MULTI CH INPUT AUDIO 2 VCR VIDEO VIDEO Yamaha subwoofer that supports the system connection L L R R OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT AUDIO L R ■ When connecting a component with the TRIGGER IN jack Audio recorder HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) Trigger input 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC TRIGGER IN ANTENNA HD Radio FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM Using the AV OUT jacks Connect this jacks to the external component’s video input jack and analog audio input jacks. REMOTE PR Using the AUDIO OUT jacks IN 75 OUT Connect this jack to the external component’s analog audio input jacks. PB VIDEO VIDEO Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. CENTER COAXIAL (CD) AV 3 OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT Component with the TRIGGER IN jack (Power amplifier or DVD player, etc.) HDMI audio/video signals, component video signals, and digital audio signals cannot be transmitted from these jacks. Functions of the TRIGGER OUT jack can be specified (☞p. 102). En 31 CONNECTIONS Connecting the FM/AM antennas An indoor FM antenna and an AM loop antenna are supplied with this receiver. Connect these antennas properly to their respective jacks. AM loop antenna Position the AM antenna away from the receiver. The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity. You can connect either wire to the AM jack or the GND jack. Indoor FM antenna DOCK HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 ■ Improving FM reception We recommend using an outdoor antenna. For more information, consult the nearest authorized dealer. ■ Improving AM reception Connect this unit to an outdoor antenna with a 16.4 – 32.8 ft. (5 – 10 m) vinyl-coated wire. Make sure the AM loop antenna is still connected. Connecting the GND jack can reduce noise. Connect the jack to a store-bought ground bar or copper plate with a vinyl-covered wire and bury this new attachment in moist ground. The GND jack is not to be connected to the ground socket of an electrical outlet. HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO REMOTE PR PR IN 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT Connecting the AM loop antenna Press and hold Insert Release Assembling the AM loop antenna En 32 CONNECTIONS Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) This unit is equipped with a Yamaha Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) that adjusts the status, size, and volume balance of the speakers in order to provide an optimal sound field. Using YPAO allows you to automatically configure settings, such as adjusting speaker output and acoustic parameters to suit your listening room (the room in which this unit is placed). J1 The amount of time for measurement varies from about two to ten minutes according to settings. Be aware of the following when using YPAO. • The test tone is output at high volume. Refrain from using this function at night when it may be a nuisance to others. • Take care that the test tone does not frighten small children. YPAO operations can be viewed on the front panel display or TV screen. 1 Check the following before using YPAO. 2 Place the supplied YPAO microphone at ear height in your listening position. Face the head of the YPAO microphone upwards. This unit • The headphones are removed. YPAO microphone TV • This unit is connected to the TV correctly. • The power is turned on. • The video input to which the video output from this unit has been selected. Subwoofer • The power is turned on. • Volume is set to approximately half, and the cross-over frequency (if present) is set to maximum. VOLUME MIN MAX CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT MIN When positioning the microphone, we recommend that you use equipment that allows you to adjust the height (such as a tripod) as a microphone stand. When using a tripod, use the tripod screws to fix the microphone in place. MAX Subwoofer examples 3 Switch this unit on. Continues to the next page J 1 : When you have changed the number of speakers or the locations in which they are installed, first use YPAO to adjust the speaker balance. En 33 CONNECTIONS MAIN Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 4 HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel. AV 1 To measure at the multiple listening positions (up to 8), press kCursor B / C to select “Yes” and press kENTER. TV DOCK PROGR PHONES YPAO MIC TONE CONTROL CATEGORY AM MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY To measure at one listening position, press kCursor B / C to select “No” and press kENTER. SILENT CINEMA PRESET INFO Press kCursor B / C to select the “Multi Position” and press kENTER to set the number of listening positions to measure. SCEN BD DVD HDMI OUT FM 5 TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE YPAO STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT BD DVD TV CD VOL. RADIO Continues to the next page OPTION VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU k “Mic On. View ON SCREEN” appears on the front panel display, and the following display appears on the front panel display or TV screen. MUTE YPAO REC ENTER to Start 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 INPUT MUTE • It takes a few minutes to accurately measure acoustics for one position. Keep the room as quiet as possible while acoustics are measured. • Wait in a corner of the room, or leave it entirely, while acoustics are measured to avoid creating an obstruction between the speakers and the YPAO microphone. MLT.Position> SCENE ON SCREEN This completes preparation. To achieve more accurate results, take note of the following when measuring acoustics. ENT VOL. SW PL PR C L R SL SR SBL SBR “Multi Position” is set to “Yes” at initial factory settings. It is not necessary to perform step 5 when measuring at the multiple listening positions. k Cursor B / C k ENTER En 34 CONNECTIONS MAIN Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 2 Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select the “Measure” and press kENTER to start measurement. Auto measurement starts in 10 seconds. 6 HDMI 4 AUDIO AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER FM AM MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET YPAO TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE 7 Replace the optimizer microphone at your choosing position and press kENTER to restart the automatic measurement. Auto measurement restarts in 10 seconds. VOL. Save/Exit • To start the measurement immediately, press kENTER again. • To cancel the automatic setup and return to the previous screen, press kRETURN and then kENTER. CATEGORY INFO When “Multi Position” is set to “No” in step 5 The following display appears when measurement finishes without any problems. L SL SW C R SR The following illustration shows how to place the optimizer microphone to optimize the setup of this unit for seven listening positions for example. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD Display during measurement RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN YPAO VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT k VOL. Progress 0% SW PL PR C L R SL SR SBL SBR 6 4 Go to step 8. 21 3 7 5 When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes” in step 5 The following display appears when measurement at the first position finishes without any problems. YPAO >Yes VOL. No L SL SW C R SR Repeat step 7 until the measurement at all listening positions are made. INPUT MUTE Continues to the next page k Cursor B / C k ENTER k RETURN Go to step 7. En 35 CONNECTIONS MAIN Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ZONE 2 CODE SET The following display appears again when measurement at the last position finishes without any problems. SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK AUDIO 8 YPAO AV YPAO SIRIUS VOL. Save/Exit HDMI OUT TUNER [ A ] Press kCursor B / C to select “Save/Exit” and press kENTER. L SL SW C L SL SW C R SR CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET Press kENTER. YPAO is automatically terminated. Disconnect the YPAO microphone. VOL. Select:Save R SR 10 TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat. When you have finished measuring, store the microphone out of direct sunlight, and away from locations that may experience high temperatures, such as on top of AV equipment. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k DISPLAY NOTE TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT If a problem occurs, an error message or report is displayed either during or after acoustic measurement. Refer to “When an error message is displayed during measurement” (☞p. 38), or “When a warning message is displayed after measurement” (☞p. 38) to resolve the problem and measure acoustics with YPAO again. 9 Press kCursor D / E to select “SAVE” and press kENTER. YPAO VOL. Disconnect Mic L SL SW C R SR MUTE Result Displays the results of automatic acoustics measurement. Refer to “Reviewing and reloading automatic setup parameters” for details (☞p. 37). Save/Exit Applies the result to the speaker setup and finishes the automatic measurement. k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER En 36 CONNECTIONS MAIN Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Reviewing and reloading automatic SOURCE RECEIVER setup parameters HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 The results of automatic acoustics measurement can be reviewed once measurement is complete. Automatic setup parameters can also be reloaded if you are not satisfied with manually configured speaker setup and sound adjustments. AUDIO 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER c Diagram Shows the speaker setup and sound adjustment as diagram. d Message Displays warning or error messages. 2 Select the desired menu item (or enable a function) using kCursor B / C / D / E and kENTER. 3 Press kRETURN to finish “Result” menu. CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET NOTE TUN./CH When automatic setup parameters are reloaded, manually configured settings are cleared. To save manually configured settings before reloading automatic setup parameters, see “Prohibiting setting changes” (☞p. 103). ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER R DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE k 1 Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Result” and press kENTER immediately after the automatic measurement. Wiring Displays the polarity of each connected speaker. • “Normal” is displayed when the polarity of the connected speaker is normal. Size Displays the size of the connected speakers. • “Large” is displayed when the connected speaker has the ability to reproduce the low-frequency signals effectively. • “Small” is displayed when the connected speaker does not have the ability to reproduce the low-frequency signals effectively. Distance Displays the distance from the listening position to speakers. The unit for distance can be switched between “ft” (feet) and “m” (meter) by pressing kCursor D / E. Level Displays the result of the adjustment of each connected speaker output level. Setup Reload Applies “Result” menu settings to this unit. REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 The “Result” menu can also be viewed from the display shown after the YPAO microphone is connected. ENT The results of acoustics measurement are displayed. INPUT MUTE c k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN a d b a List of menu items Menu items available in the Result menu are displayed. b Number of measurement Indicates the number of measurements for multiple listening positions. En 37 CONNECTIONS MAIN Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ When an error message is SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] V-AUX AV 1 displayed during measurement See “Error messages” (☞p. 39) for instructions on resolving the problem and measure acoustics again. DOCK HDMI OUT 3 4 Press kCursor E to select “RETRY.” NOTE Press kENTER to use YPAO again. Although the results of acoustics measurement can be applied when a warning message is displayed, optimal sound will not be achieved. Resolving the problem and using YPAO to measure acoustics again is recommended. When “E-10” is displayed CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD RADIO Check the error code displayed and use YPAO to measure acoustics again as described below. OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER R displayed DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU k When “E-1,” “E-2,” “E-3,” “E-4” or “E-6” is MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN 1 2 3 4 5 Press kENTER. Press kCursor E to select “EXIT.” 1 2 3 4 5 Press kENTER. Press kCursor E to select “EXIT.” Press kENTER to terminate YPAO. Switch the unit to standby mode. Turn on the unit and use YPAO again. To exit YPAO with some options 1 2 Use kCursor B / C to select “Save/Exit” and press kENTER. Use kCursor D / E to select one of the following options and press kENTER. SAVE: Exits YPAO applying the results of measurement. CANCEL: Returns to the previous screen (warning message screen). EXIT: Exits YPAO without saving the results. ■ When a warning message is Press kENTER to terminate YPAO, and switch the unit to standby mode. Check that the speakers are properly connected. displayed after measurement See “Warning messages” (☞p. 40) for instructions on resolving the problem. The speaker causing the problem can be confirmed from the TV screen display. Turn on the unit and use YPAO again. When “E-5,” “E-7,” “E-8” or “E-9” is displayed 1 2 Press kENTER. Check that the environment is suitable for accurate measurement. En 38 CONNECTIONS Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ■ Message list ■ Error messages NOTE If the following messages appear, resolve the problems that have occurred and carry out the measurement process again. ■ When a warning message is displayed before measurement Connect MIC! The YPAO microphone is not connected. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel. Unplug HP! The headphones are connected. Remove the headphones. Memory Guard! The settings of this unit are protected. Set “Memory Guard” in the Setup menu to “Off” (☞p. 103). E-1: No Front SP E-2: No Sur. SP The unit was not able to find the front channel. Check that the left and right front speakers are connected correctly. The unit was only able to find one of side of the surround channels. Check that the left and right surround speakers are connected correctly. The unit was only able to find one of side of the presence channels. Check that the left and right presence speakers are connected correctly. E-4: SBR→SBL Only one surround back speaker is connected and only the right side surround back channel sound is detected. When only one surround back speaker is connected, connect to the left side (SINGLE) terminal. E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud, preventing accurate measurements from being taken. Measure again in quiet surroundings. Turn off any devices in the room that may be emitting noise, or place them further away from the YPAO microphone. When this message is displayed, selecting “PROCEED” will allow you to continue measuring. However, we recommend resolving the problem and measuring again, as continuing measurement without doing so will not give accurate results. E-3: No F.PRNS SP E-6: Check Sur. Even though surround left and right speakers are not connected, only the surround back speakers are connected. E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. While measuring, take care not to touch the YPAO microphone. E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone could not distinguish a test tone. Check that the YPAO microphone has been installed correctly. Check that each speaker has been connected and installed correctly. The YPAO microphone or the YPAO MIC jack may be broken. Inquire at the retailer where you purchased this unit, or the nearest Yamaha service center. E-9: User Cancel You have carried out an operation that has cancelled the measuring process. Carry out the measuring process again. Do not operate this unit by, for example, adjusting the volume. E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Carry out the measuring process again. Contact a Yamaha service center if “E-10” is displayed again. When using surround back speakers, connection of the surround left/right speakers is necessary. En 39 CONNECTIONS Setting up the speaker parameters automatically (YPAO) ■ Warning messages W-1: Out of Phase The speakers displayed are connected with the opposite polarity. Depending on the type of speakers you are using and the environment in which you have them installed, this message may occur even if the speakers are connected correctly. Depending on the type of speakers, “W-1” may display even if the speakers are connected correctly. W-2: Over 24m/80ft The speakers displayed are separated from the listening position by more than 24 m, and cannot be adjusted correctly. Install the speakers with 24 m of the listening position. W-3: Level Error Volume level varies greatly for individual channels, and cannot be adjusted correctly. Check that all speakers are installed in the same surroundings. Check that the speaker polarity + (positive), and - (negative) are correct. If these are connected correctly, you can use the speakers normally even this message appears. Check that the speaker polarity + (positive), and - (negative) are correct. We recommend the same speakers or speakers with as similar specifications as possible. Adjust the volume of the subwoofer. If “W-2” or “W-3” appears, you can apply measurement results, but they will not give optimal results. We recommend that you resolve the problem and carry out the measurement process again. En 40 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET Basic playback procedure SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AV d DOCK HDMI OUT r CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY 1 2 Turn on external components (TV, DVD player, etc.) connected to this unit. Use the dInput selector to select the input source. The name of the selected input source is displayed for a few seconds. J1 TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE When DOCK, TUNER, or SIRIUS is selected, the Content window is displayed (☞p. 55). STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD ENTER RETURN VOLUME u MUTE v 3 Use this function to select the HDMI OUT jack(s) used to output signal. Press rHDMI OUT repeatedly to select setting. The HDMI output setting changes as follows. HDMI OUT 1+2 HDMI OUT 1 HDMI OUT OFF HDMI OUT 2 HDMI OUT 1+2 Outputs the signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks simultaneously. HDMI OUT 1 Refer to the instruction manuals provided with the external component for details on playback. Outputs the signals at the HDMI OUT 1 jack. HDMI OUT 2 Outputs the signals at the HDMI OUT 2 jack. For details on the following operations, refer to the corresponding pages: HDMI OUT OFF Any signals are not output at the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. Select this setting when you do not use the video monitor connected to one of the HDMI OUT jacks. RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN ■ Selecting the active HDMI OUT jack Play the external component that you have selected as the source input, or select a radio station on the tuner. DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 • “FM/AM tuning” (☞p. 56) • “Listening to Satellite Radio” (☞p. 64) • “Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™” (☞p. 71) • “Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components” (☞p. 76) ENT INPUT MUTE d Input selector r HDMI OUT u VOLUME +/v MUTE 4 Press uVOLUME +/- to adjust the volume. To mute the output. • The HDMI OUT jack that utilizes the HDMI Control function can be selected with “Control Select” (☞p. 98). • The active HDMI OUT jack(s) can be registered with the SCENE function (☞p. 43). Press vMUTE to mute the audio output. Press vMUTE again to unmute. J 1 : You can change the input source name displayed on the front panel display as necessary (☞p. 79). En 41 PLAYBACK Basic playback procedure Adjusting high/low-frequency sound (Tone control) You can adjust the balance of the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds output from the front left and right speakers to obtain desired tone. The tone control of the speakers or headphones can be set separately. Set the headphone tone control with the headphones connected. 1 Press TONE CONTROL on the front panel repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass.” TONE CONTROL 2 Rotate PROGRAM selector to adjust the output level in those frequency ranges. Adjustable range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB Adjustment increments 0.5 dB The display returns to the previous display soon after you release the key. • The tone control settings are not effective when this unit is in the Pure Direct mode or “MULTI CH” is selected as an input source. • If you set the balance extremely off, sounds may not match those from other channels well. • The tone control can also be adjusted in the OPTION menu (☞p. 52). MAIN ZONE ZONE2 ZONE CONTROL INFO MEMORY PRESET CATEGORY FM AM INPUT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO PROGRAM PHONES YPAO MIC TONE CONTROL STRAIGHT SILENT CINEMA H PROGRAM selector The current setting is displayed on the front panel display. TONE Treble VOL. +0.5dB SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR En 42 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Changing input settings with a single key (SCENE function) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER This unit has a SCENE function that allows you switch this unit on and change input sources, sound programs, and HDMI OUT with one key. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] V-AUX AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT Four scenes are available for different uses, such as d playing movies or music. The following input sources, sound programs, and HDMI OUT are provided as the initial factory settings. CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH SCENE Input ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN s i Compressed Music Enhancer mode BD/ DVD HDMI1 Drama Off HDMI OUT 1+2 TV AV4 STRAIGHT On HDMI OUT 1+2 CD AV3 STRAIGHT Off HDMI OUT 1+2 RADIO TUNER STRAIGHT On HDMI OUT 1+2 DISPLAY TOP MENU HDMI OUT 1 2 Use dInput selector to select the input source you want to register. Use the sSound selection keys to select the sound program, Compressed Music Enhancer mode, or HDMI OUT you want to register. VOLUME ENTER RETURN Sound program Registering input sources/sound program/HDMI OUT POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE d Input selector i SCENE s Sound selection keys 3 Press the iSCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front panel display. SCENE1 VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR SET Complete Release the key when “SET Complete” is displayed • When changing “SCENE,” also change the external component that the remote control operates (☞p. 105). • Selecting a scene and editing the scene function are also available in the SCENE menu (☞p. 82). Enjoying the desired sound field effect This unit is also equipped with a Yamaha digital sound field processing (DSP) chip. Multi-channel playback from almost any audio source can be enjoyed using a variety of sound decoders and various sound field effect programs stored on the chip. Sound field effect programs built into this unit are called “sound programs.” Selecting sound programs and sound decoders This unit offers sound programs in many different categories suitable for movies, music and other uses. Choose a sound program that sounds best with the source you are playing back, rather than relying on the name or explanation of the program. • Sound programs are stored for each input source. When you change the input source, the sound program previously selected for that input source is applied again. • When you playback DTS Express sources or audio signals with sampling frequency of higher than 96 kHz, the straight decoding mode (☞p. 44) is automatically selected. • When you playback DTS-HD sources with CINEMA DSP, the DTS decoder is automatically selected. Continues to the next page En 43 PLAYBACK MAIN Enjoying the desired sound field effect ZONE 2 CODE SET HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM ■ Enjoying stereo playback Press sMUSIC repeatedly Use straight decoding mode when you want to playback sound without sound field processing. You can playback as follows in straight decoding mode. Selecting surround decoder: 2-channel sources such as CD Select “2ch Stereo” from the sound programs when you want to playback 2-channel stereo sound (from the front speakers only), regardless of the playback source. Selecting “2ch Stereo” will playback as follows for the playback of CD and BD/DVD sources. Press sSUR. DECODE repeatedly Stereo sound plays through the front left and right speakers. 2-channel sources such as CD Multi-channel playback sources such as BD/ DVD Multi-channel sources such as BD/DVD MOVIE category: Press sMOVIE repeatedly MUSIC category: Press sMUSIC repeatedly (Straight decoding mode) Selecting stereo reproduction: AV TUNER ■ Enjoying unprocessed playback Selecting sound program (☞p. 47): SOURCE RECEIVER AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD s Turning on Pure Direct mode (☞p. 46): Press sPURE DIRECT Turning on Compressed Music Enhancer mode (☞p. 46): VOLUME ENTER RETURN Press sSTRAIGHT RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN Turning on Straight decoding mode: Stereo sound plays back through the front speakers. Plays back audio from a playback source without applying sound field effects, using an appropriate decoder to split the signal into multiple channels. Press sMUSIC repeatedly to select “2ch Stereo.” Press sSTRAIGHT to enable the straight decoding mode. Press sENHANCER repeatedly DISPLAY MUSIC Sound program categories TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE VOL. MOVIE REC VOL. Sci-Fi 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Program ENT INPUT MUTE • You can use the speaker indicators on the front panel display to check what speakers are currently outputting sound (☞p. 10). • You can adjust sound field elements (sound field parameters) for each of the programs (☞p. 85). Straight L SL SBL SW C Sci-Fi VOL. SW 2ch Stereo L R R SR SBR To disable stereo playback, press any of the sSound selection keys to select a sound program other than “2ch Stereo.” To disable straight decoding mode, press sSTRAIGHT again. MOVIE Playback channels other than the front channels in the playback source are mixed with the front channels and played back through the front speakers. VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Previously selected program s Sound selection keys s MOVIE s MUSIC s ENHANCER s SUR. DECODE s STRAIGHT s PURE DIRECT En 44 PLAYBACK Enjoying the desired sound field effect ■ Enjoying sound programs without ■ Enjoying more spatial sound fields ■ Enjoying sound programs without This unit allows you to use virtual surround speakers to enjoy sound field surround effects, even without any surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP mode). You can even enjoy surround sound presence with just a minimal configuration of the front speakers only. This unit will switch to Virtual CINEMA DSP mode automatically when surround speakers are unavailable. J1 CINEMA DSP 3D mode creates an intensive and accurate stereoscopic sound field in the listening room. Connection of presence speakers is recommended to take full advantage of the effects of CINEMA DSP 3D mode. Do the following steps. J3 This unit allows you to use virtual presence speakers to create an intensive and accurate stereoscopic sound field, even when no presence speakers are connected (Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D mode). You can even enjoy surround sound presence with front speakers, center speaker, and surround speakers. This unit automatically switches to Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D mode when presence speakers are not available. Do the following steps. surround speakers ■ Enjoying sound programs with headphones Even when headphones are connected, you can enjoy the reproduction sound field presence with ease (SILENT CINEMA mode). J2 (CINEMA DSP 3D mode) • Connect the presence speakers to the EXTRA SP jacks and set the speakers to use (☞p. 14). • Enable CINEMA DSP 3D in the OPTION menu (☞p. 52). When a sound program runs in CINEMA DSP 3D mode, the CINEMA DSP 3D indicator on the front panel lights up. Lights up MUSIC presence speakers • Connect the front speakers, center speaker, and surround speakers. • Enable center speaker and surround speakers in “Configuration” (☞p. 92). • Enable CINEMA DSP 3D in the OPTION menu (☞p. 52). VOL. 3 Hall in Vienna SW PL PR C R L SL SR SBL SBR J 1 : However, Virtual CINEMA DSP mode is not available under the following J 2 : However, SILENT CINEMA mode is not available under the following conditions: • When headphones are connected to this unit. • When a “7ch Stereo” or “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected. • When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected. conditions: • When a “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected. • When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected. J 3 : However, CINEMA DSP 3D mode is not available under the following conditions: • When headphones are connected to this unit. • When a “7ch Stereo” or “2ch Stereo” sound program is selected. • When Pure Direct mode or straight decoding mode is selected. En 45 PLAYBACK MAIN Enjoying the desired sound field effect ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Enjoying Hi-Fi Sound Quality SOURCE RECEIVER (Pure Direct mode) HDMI 1 2 3 4 Use Pure Direct mode to enjoy the pure high fidelity sound of the selected source. When Pure Direct mode is enabled, this unit plays back the selected source with the least circuitry. J1 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER Press sPURE DIRECT to turn Pure Direct mode on. J2 CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV TUN./CH To disable Pure Direct mode, press sPURE DIRECT again. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT s ■ Enjoying enhanced compression artifacts (Compressed Music Enhancer mode) Compressed Music Enhancer mode improves the sound enhancer near to the original depth and width of compression artifacts. J3 This mode can be used along with any other DSP modes. Press sENHANCER to turn Compressed Music Enhancer mode on. Lights up INPUT MUTE ENHANCER Enhancer On s ENHANCER s PURE DIRECT VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR To disable Compressed Music Enhancer mode, press sENHANCER again. J 1 : The following features are disabled in Pure Direct mode. • sound program, tone control, YPAO PEQ, and Adaptive DRC • displaying and operating the OPTION menu and Setup menu J 2 : While Pure Direct mode is on, the front panel display screen turns off in order to reduce noise. When turning Pure Direct mode off, the screen returns on. J 3 : However, Compressed Music Enhancer mode is not available in the following audio: • Signals of which sampling rate is over 48kHz • High Definition stream En 46 PLAYBACK Enjoying the desired sound field effect Sound programs Action Game This sound field is suitable for action games such as car racing, fighting games and FPS games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer mode for a more dynamic sound field. Roleplaying Game This sound field is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects and dialog from a wide variety of scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer mode for a more dynamic sound field. Music Video This sound field offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot live space thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to the surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall. in the table indicates the sound program for CINEMA DSP. ■ Category: MOVIE Sound programs optimized for viewing video sources such as movies, TV programs, and games. Standard This program creates a sound field emphasizing the surround feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multi-channel audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the concept of an ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right and rear. Spectacle This program represents the spectacular feeling of large-scale movie productions. It reproduces a broad theater sound field that matches cinemascope and wider-screen movies with an excellent dynamic range providing everything from very small sound effects to large, impressive sounds. Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest science fiction and special effects-featuring movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialog, sound effects and background music. Adventure This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies. The sound field restrains reverberations but puts emphasis on reproducing a powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The reproduced depth is also restrained relatively to ensure the separation between audio channels and the clarity of the sound. Drama This sound field features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling, reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear words and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after long hours of viewing. Mono Movie This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources such as a classic movie in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program produces the optimum expansion and reverberation to the original audio to create a comfortable space with a certain sound depth. Sports This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts, the voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned clearly at the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an optimal space to offer the listeners a feeling of presence in the stadium. En 47 PLAYBACK Enjoying the desired sound field effect ■ Category: MUSIC ■ Category: SUR.DEC (Surround decode mode) This sound field is suitable when listening to music sources such as CDs. Select this program to playback sources with selected decoders. You can playback 2-channel audio sources in up to 7-channels using a surround decoder. Hall in Munich Hall in Vienna This sound field simulates a concert hall with approximately 2500 seats in Munich, using stylish wood for the interior finishing as normal standards for European concert halls. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the arena. This is an approximately 1700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound. Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music. Cellar Club This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field features powerful sound as if the listener is in a row in front of a small stage. The Roxy Theatre This is the sound field of a rock music live house in Los Angeles, with approximately 460 seats. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall. The Bottom Line This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound. 2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2-channels. When multi-channel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2-channels and output from the front left and right speakers. 7ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you playback multi-channel sources, this unit down-mixes the source to 2-channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties, etc. q Pro Logic Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic decoder. This is suitable for all kinds of audio sources. q PLIIx Movie / q PLII Movie Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for movies. J1 q PLIIx Music / q PLII Music Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for music. J1 q PLIIx Game / q PLII Game Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for games. J1 Neo:6 Cinema Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for movies. Neo:6 Music Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for music. J 1 : You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder in the following conditions: • When “Surround Back” is set to “None” (☞p. 92). • When headphones are connected. En 48 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Using the TV display to control this unit CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER This unit features a sophisticated on-screen display (OSD) that helps you to control the amplifier function of this unit. With the OSD, you can view information of the signals being input and the status of this unit. Visual guidance simplifies operations for menus. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK Basic operations via the TV screen display HDMI OUT TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TV STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT CD Use kCursor B / C to select “Input” and press kENTER. A TV screen is required to display the ON SCREEN or OPTION menu. Refer to “Connecting a TV monitor” for instructions on connecting a TV screen (☞p. 22). SCENE BD DVD 1 TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE ■ Selecting an input source RADIO • Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Press kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON SCREEN menu. • In addition to selecting an input source, detailed settings for each input source can be configured. Refer to “Configuring input sources (Input menu)” (☞p. 78) for details. j OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE k This section describes basic operations for configuring “Input,” “Scene” and “Sound Program” using the OSD. Press jON SCREEN. The ON SCREEN menu is displayed on the TV screen. Input source icons are displayed at the bottom of the TV screen. REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 2 Use kCursor D / E to select a Input source press kENTER. The input source is selected. ENT INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN En 49 PLAYBACK MAIN Using the TV display to control this unit ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Selecting a scene SOURCE RECEIVER ■ Selecting a sound program HDMI 1 2 3 4 1 AUDIO 5 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] V-AUX AV 1 Use kCursor B / C to select “Scene” and press kENTER. 1 Use kCursor B / C to select “Sound Program” and press kENTER. DOCK HDMI OUT NOTES Menus can be operated and the status of this unit confirmed from the following three main displays. • ON SCREEN menu (☞p. 78) • OPTION menu (☞p. 51) • Content window (☞p. 55) CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET These menus and status features can be used to configure more various functions in addition to selecting “Input,” “Scene” and “Sound Program.” Refer to each references for details on menus and status. TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO Scene icons are displayed at the bottom of the TV screen. OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE Sound program icons are displayed at the bottom of the TV screen. k 2 Use kCursor D / E to select a scene and press kENTER. The scene is selected. 2 Use kCursor D / E to select a sound program and press kENTER. The sound program is selected. REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN • Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Press kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON SCREEN menu. • Refer to “Changing input settings with a single key (SCENE function)” (☞p. 43) for details on the default scene settings. • Detailed SCENE function settings can be edited. Refer to “Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu)” (☞p. 82) for details. • Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Press kRETURN repeatedly to close the ON SCREEN menu. • Refer to “Enjoying the desired sound field effect” (☞p. 43) for various sound programs. • You can configure the detailed settings for each sound program. Refer to “Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu)” (☞p. 85) for details. En 50 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER This unit has a unique OPTION menu for each input source. OPTION menus can be used to enable features such as volume trim for compatible input sources or to display audio/video data. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK d OPTION menu display and setup HDMI OUT TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] OPTION menu operations are displayed on the front panel display or TV screen. TV display is used here to explain operation. CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN t k 1 2 Use dInput selector to select an input source to which options will be applied. Press tOPTION. The OPTION menu is displayed. 3 Use kCursor B / C to select the desired setting and press kENTER. 5 Press tOPTION to close the OPTION menu. Parameters of the selected item are displayed. 4 Use kCursor B / C / D / E to select the desired item (or enable a function). The keys on the remote control may not respond for a few seconds after the OPTION menu is closed. Should this occur, select the input source again. • Press kRETURN to display the previous screen or close the OPTION menu. • The OPTION menu may close automatically when some functions are enabled. DISPLAY OPTION menu TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE d Input selector k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN t OPTION The displayed OPTION menu settings differ depending on the input source. For more information, refer to the “OPTION menu” on the next page. En 51 PLAYBACK Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu) OPTION menu SIRIUS The following items are provided for each input source. J1 HDMI1-5 AV1-4 AV5-6 AUDIO1-2 V-AUX TUNER Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Extended Surround Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Extended Surround Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC DOCK (iPod) Tone Control Adaptive DRC Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC Dialogue Lift J2 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Volume Trim Shuffle J3 Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Pairing Repeat J3 DOCK (Bluetooth) Connect/ Disconnect MULTI CH Volume Trim CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Extended Surround Volume Trim Tone Control Adaptive DRC CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Dialogue Lift J2 Volume Trim J 1 : When “Tone Control,” “Adaptive DRC,” “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode,” “Dialogue Lift,” or “Extended Surround” is adjusted for an input source, the same value is applied to other input sources and “ALL” is displayed on the front panel display. When settings specific to a certain input source are selected, the input source name is displayed on the front panel display. If the name of the input source has been changed (☞p. 79), the original name of the ■ Adjusting high/low-frequency sound Tone Control Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH You can adjust the balance of the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) of sounds output from the front left and right speakers to obtain desired tone. Adjustable range -6.0 dB to +6.0 dB Adjustment increments 0.5 dB • The tone control of the speakers or headphones can be set separately. Set the headphone tone control with the headphones connected. • TONE CONTROL on the front panel can also be used (☞p. 42). input source is displayed. J 2 : “Dialogue Lift” can be adjusted only when the presence speakers are available. J 3 : Not available for Yamaha iPod wireless receiver. En 52 PLAYBACK Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu) ■ Auto-adjusting the sound level to make even low volumes more audible ■ Adjusts the vertical position of dialogues ■ Selecting the 5.1-channel signal playback method Dialogue Lift Adaptive DRC Input source: Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH Adjusts the dynamic range in conjunction with the volume level (from minimum to maximum). When you play audio at night or at low volumes, it is a good idea to set parameter to “On.” J1 On Adjusts the dynamic range automatically. Off (Default) Does not adjust the dynamic range automatically. Extended Surround All input sources except MULTI CH Adjusts the vertical position of center sound such as dialogues when presence speakers are used. Increasing this parameter raises the position. Input source: Selects whether to reproduce 5.1-channel input signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel when surround back speakers are used. Auto (Default) The ideal dialog position Automatically selects the most suitable decoder if a flag for reproducing surround back channel is present, and reproduces the signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel. q PLIIx Movie If the dialog seems to come out from a lower position than the video monitor screen, increase this parameter. Always reproduces signals in 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie decoder whether or not surround back channel signals are contained. You can select this parameter when two surround back speakers are connected. q PLIIx Music Always reproduces signals in 6.1- or 7.1-channel using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music decoder whether or not surround back channel signals are contained. You can select this parameter when one or two surround back speakers are connected. EX/ES Automatically selects the most suitable decoder for input signals whether or not the flag for reproducing surround back channel is present, and always reproduces signals in 6.1-channel. Off Always reproduces original channels whether or not the flag for reproducing surround back channel is present. When “On” is selected, the dynamic range is adjusted as follows. On Off Input Level Volume: low Output Level Output Level If the volume level is low, the dynamic range is narrow. If the volume level is high, the dynamic range is wide. On Off Input Level Volume: high ■ Enjoying more spatial sound fields CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Input source: All input sources except MULTI CH When CINEMA DSP 3D is enabled, set whether to use sound programs in CINEMA DSP 3D mode (☞p. 45). HDMI1-5, AV1-4, V-AUX J2 Move up to the ideal dialog position “0” (default) corresponds to the lowest position and “5” to the highest position. • “Dialogue Lift” can be adjusted only when the presence speakers are available. • You cannot move the dialog position lower than the default setting. J 1 : “Adaptive DRC” is also effective when you use headphones. J 2 : AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are also available when “Audio Return Channel” is on, and the input source is used for “TV Audio Input.” En 53 PLAYBACK Configuring settings specific to an individual input source (OPTION menu) ■ Adjusting volume between input sources Volume Trim Input source: ■ Repeat playback with iPod/iPhone Repeat Input source: All Reduces any change in volume when switching between input sources by correcting volume differences in each input source. You can adjust this parameter for each input source. DOCK (iPod) J1 Plays songs or albums repeatedly. When the repeat function is enabled, “ (One)” or “ (All)” appears on the TV screen. Off The repeat function is turned off. -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB One Plays a song back repeatedly. Default setting 0.0 dB All When all songs have completed playback, returns to the start and repeats playback. Adjustment increments 0.5 dB steps Adjustable range ■ Shuffle playback with iPod/iPhone ■ Connect / Disconnect Bluetooth component Connect Shuffle Input source: DOCK (iPod) J1 Plays back songs or albums in random order. When the shuffle function is enabled, “ ” appears on the TV screen. Off The shuffle function is turned off. Songs Plays songs back in random order. Albums Plays albums back in random order. Disconnect Input source: DOCK (Bluetooth) Switches communication with a Bluetooth component on and off (☞p. 76). ■ Pairing Bluetooth component Pairing Input source: DOCK (Bluetooth) Performs pairing of this unit and a Bluetooth component (☞p. 76). J 1 : Not available for Yamaha iPod wireless receiver. En 54 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Confirming and operating input sources from the Content window CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER When DOCK, TUNER, or SIRIUS is selected, the Content window is displayed on the TV screen. Playback style for iPod, functions for FM/AM tuner, and SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner can be set in the Content window. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER d A TV screen is required to display the Content window. Refer to “Connecting a TV monitor” for instructions on connecting a TV monitor (☞p. 22). CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT Displaying the Content window on the TV screen SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE Press dDOCK, dTUNER or dSIRIUS to display the Content window. k The Content window consists of two main displays, the Now Playing view and the Content browse view. l Below is the example of the Now playing view for TUNER. REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 c Screen button area Buttons to operate each input source are displayed here. These buttons vary depending on the selected input. For details on operations for each input, see the following. – FM/AM tuner (☞p. 58) – HD Radio tuner (☞p. 60) – SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner (☞p. 64) – iPod (☞p. 72) • In the Now playing view, press kENTER and use kCursor B / C to select the button. Then press kENTER to execute the selection. • In the Content browse view, press kCursor E and use kCursor B / C to select the button. Then press kENTER to execute the selection. • Press kRETURN repeatedly to exit from the operation. Content browse view or lDISPLAY or lDISPLAY Now playing view Switching the display between the Now Playing view and the Content browse view ENT INPUT MUTE d DOCK d TUNER d SIRIUS k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN l DISPLAY a b c a Image display Icon for each input source or album art is displayed. b Information display Information on the current input source is displayed. You can switch the display between the Now Playing view and the Content browse view by the following methods. • Press lDISPLAY to cycle between the Now Playing view and the Content browse view. • In the Now Playing view, press kENTER and use kCursor B / C to select the icon. Then press kENTER to switch to the Content browse view. • In the Content browse view, press kCursor E and use kCursor B / C to select the icon. Then press kENTER to switch to the Now Playing view. En 55 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 FM/AM tuning CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 When using the FM/AM tuner, adjust the direction of the FM/AM antenna connected to this unit to get the best reception. 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] AV HDMI OUT TUNER d CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE e STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT 1 2 SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN Selecting a frequency for reception (Normal tuning) DISPLAY Press dTUNER to switch to the tuner input. Press eFM or eAM to select a band to receive. 3 Use eTUN./CH H / I to set a frequency to receive. eTUN./CH H Increases the frequency. Press and hold this key for longer than a second to search automatically for a station on a higher frequency than the current one. J1 eTUN./CH I Decreases the frequency. Press and hold this key for longer than a second to search automatically for a station on a lower frequency than the current one. J1 Lights up when a broadcast is received from a station Lights up when a stereo broadcast is received VOL. HD TOP MENU POP-UP MENU FM87.5 MHz MUTE REC PRG SELECT SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR w 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 STEREO TUNED SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR FM98.5 MHz Lights up when a broadcast is received from a HD Radio station (☞p. 60) m In normal tuning mode, use the mNumeric keys to enter a frequency. Leave the decimal point out when entering a number. J2 For example, enter as follows to select a station on 98.5 MHz. INPUT MUTE d TUNER e FM e AM e MEMORY e TUN./CH H / I m Numeric keys w PRG SELECT 9 J 1 : When searching for a station, release the key once the search has started. J 2 : “Wrong Station!” appears on the front panel display when you enter a frequency that is out of receivable range. Make sure that the frequency entered is correct. 8 1 Tune in to the station you want to register, referring to “Selecting a frequency for reception (Normal tuning).” J3 2 Use one of the following methods to register the station you are currently receiving. Press eMEMORY for 3 seconds or longer. The station will be registered automatically to the lowest open preset number (or the next number after the one registered most recently). MEMORY ■ Entering a frequency number ENT Select stations manually and register them as presets individually. ■ Registering to a preset number to which no station is registered STEREO TUNED VOL. ■ Registering stations manually (Manual Preset) VOL. STEREO TUNED 01:FM98.5 MHz SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Registered frequencies 5 J 3 : When registering a sub-audio program “HD2” to “HD8” of the FM HD Radio station, press wPRG SELECT to select the desired audio program. En 56 PLAYBACK MAIN FM/AM tuning ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER ■ Designating a preset number for registration HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 AUDIO Press eMEMORY once, to display “Manual Preset” on the front panel display. After a small wait, the preset number that the station has been registered to will appear. 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH e ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TV CD The newly registered frequency 985 STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT VOL. STEREO TUNED 01:Empty SCENE BD DVD Preset number SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN Blinks VOLUME ENTER RETURN Press ePRESET F / G to select the preset number to register the station to, and then press eMEMORY to register. DISPLAY TOP MENU Empty, or the frequency registered most previously POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 m 5 6 7 9 0 10 8 To select a registered station, press ePRESET F / G to select the preset number of the station. J1 ENT INPUT MUTE e MEMORY e PRESET F / G m Numeric keys J 1 : To select a station by selecting a preset number, use the mNumeric keys to enter the preset number of the station you want to listen. When an invalid number is entered, “Wrong Num.” appears on the front panel display. Check that you have entered the correct number. En 57 PLAYBACK MAIN FM/AM tuning ZONE 2 CODE SET Confirming and operating the FM/AM tuner from the Content window SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO Screen buttons on the Now playing view To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. FM Mode Manual Tuning AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD The station currently received can be confirmed from the d menu displayed on the TV screen. Various FM/AM tuner operations can be performed from the Content window rather than controls on the front panel display. The Content window is displayed when dTUNER is pressed. You can operate the FM/AM tuner from the Now Playing view or the Content browse view. RADIO ■ Operating from the Now playing OPTION ON SCREEN You can tune in to a desired FM/AM station by specifying its frequency. FM Switches a band to FM. AM Switches a band to AM. Tuning - Decreases the frequency. Tuning + Increases the frequency. Auto - Automatically searches for a station on a lower frequency than the current station. Auto + Automatically searches for a station on a higher frequency than the current station. Direct Selects the frequency manually. Memory Registers the station currently received as a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations can be registered. view VOLUME ENTER RETURN k a b DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC d 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 Utility c e f g Selects “Stereo” or “Mono” when receiving the FM station. Scroll Switches the scroll target. Browse Switches the display to the Content browse view. Continues to the next page ENT Preset Select INPUT You can call preset stations. MUTE a Tuned indicator Lights up when a station is received. b Stereo indicator d TUNER k Cursor B / C k ENTER c d e f g Lights up when a stereo broadcast is received. When “Audio Mode” is set to “Mono,” the indicator does not light. Preset number The selected preset number is displayed. Band The selected band (FM or AM) is displayed. Frequency The frequency currently received is displayed. Frequency guide The frequency currently received is displayed as a cursor on the bar. Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Now playing view” for details. PRESET - Selects the previous preset number. PRESET + Selects the next preset number. Preset -8 Returns the previous page. Preset +8 Goes to the next page. Direct Selects a station directly by entering the preset number. Memory Registers the station currently received as a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations can be registered. En 58 PLAYBACK MAIN FM/AM tuning ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Operating from the Content browse SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 view Now Playing Switches the display to the Now playing view. AUDIO 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER a CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET b TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO a Preset station list OPTION ON SCREEN The list of preset stations is displayed. VOLUME ENTER RETURN Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details. DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU k b Screen button area MUTE Screen buttons on the Content browse view REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. Utility INPUT MUTE k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER Auto Preset Detects stations with a strong signal and automatically registers up to 40 stations, beginning with the next number after the current number. Clear Preset Clears registration of the preset station currently selected. Clear All Preset Clears registration of all preset stations. 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Scrolls the list to the next or previous page. En 59 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Using HD Radio™ features CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER HD Radio technology is a new technology that enables FM and AM radio stations to broadcast programs digitally. Digital broadcasting provides listeners with radically improved audio quality and reception as well as new data services. Furthermore, supplemental program services allow listeners to select from up to 8 HD Radio programs multicast on a single FM HD Radio channel. For further information on HD Radio technology, visit “http://www.ibiquity.com/”. This unit is equipped with an HD Radio reception feature, facilitating CD quality FM broadcasts as well as analog FM stereo quality AM broadcasts. In addition, this unit can receive both audio and data (such as song titles, artist names, program types, and comments) from all HD Radio programs (HD1 to HD8). HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER CATEGORY FM • The tuning method for HD Radio stations are same as analog FM/AM radio stations; however, you only tune into the analog part of a hybrid HD Radio station while this unit is in the monaural tuning mode (☞p. 63). • This unit is capable of receiving both hybrid and alldigital HD Radio station signals. However, this unit may not automatically receive all-digital FM station signals and the automatic tuning operation may stop. In this case, enter the frequency of the desired alldigital FM HD Radio station directly by using mNumeric keys (☞p. 56). AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC PRG SELECT w 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 m Selecting HD Radio™ audio programs ENT INPUT MUTE m Numeric keys m ENT w PRG SELECT b / a The HD indicator lights up in the front panel display when this unit is tuned into an HD Radio station. In this state, you can select the desired audio program if the selected FM HD Radio station provides multiple audio programs (up to 8). ■ When multiple audio programs are provided provided If this unit is tuned into an FM HD Radio station including only one audio program or an AM HD Radio station, you cannot select audio programs. Audio program number (relative/total) Lights up HD 1/3 ■ When only one audio program is VOL. HD STEREO TUNED FM88.9MHz1 Lights up SW C L R SL SR SBL SBR Audio program number (absolute) Press wPRG SELECT b / a repeatedly to select the desired audio programs. Audio programs can also be selected using mNumeric keys (1-8) and mENT when this unit is in the automatic or manual tuning mode. When the selected audio program is not available currently, “HDx Off” (“x” indicates the program number) appears. • When reception for an audio program ceases, the HD indicator disappears from the front panel display and HD1 is automatically selected after approximately 20 seconds. • Some audio programs may not contain data programs depending on the broadcasting station and the time period. HD HD VOL. HD STEREO TUNED SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR FM87.5MHz ■ Behavior of the display This unit automatically shows the HD Radio information (call sign, etc) on the front panel display after 3 seconds. You can switch HD Radio information to be displayed (☞p. 61). Frequency Audio program number 889-1 VOL. HD STEREO TUNED SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR WXYZ-FM Call Sign En 60 PLAYBACK MAIN Using HD Radio™ features ZONE 2 CODE SET Using the iTunes Tagging SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] This unit is equipped with the iTunes Tagging that enables HD Radio listeners to “tag” songs for subsequent preview and purchase on iTunes. For details on the iTunes Tagging, visit “http://www.ibiquity.com/”. AUDIO 2 AV HDMI OUT This unit transmits the “tag” data to the iPod/iPhone if an iPod/iPhone that supports iTunes Tagging is placed in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12, sold separately) connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit. Otherwise, this unit stores the “tag” data (up to 50) in the internal memory and will transmit it next time your iPod/ iPhone is placed in the dock. CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO TUN./CH f MEMORY 1 ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV If the selected HD Radio program (or song being played) supports the iTunes Tagging, the TAG indicator lights up on the front panel display. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD RADIO Lights up OPTION ON SCREEN Tune into an HD Radio station and select HD Radio audio program (if available). VOLUME ENTER 889-1 DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU VOL. HD TAG STEREO TUNED WXYZ-FM MUTE SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR TAG w 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT 2 While a song you want to tag is being played back, press wTAG. If a song is tagged, “StorageSuccess” and the number of stored iTunes Tagging information files (up to 50) appear in the front panel display. Album title, frequency, audio program number (absolute) Tag Info The number of iTunes Tagging information files stored in the internal memory, frequency, audio program number (absolute) DSP Program Current sound field program (☞p. 47), frequency, audio program number (absolute) Call Sign Call sign, frequency, audio program number (absolute) REC INPUT You can display the HD Radio information on the front panel display. J1 Press fINFO repeatedly to toggle the HD Radio information display modes as shown below. TAG RETURN Displaying the HD Radio™ information Album Audio Decoder Current audio decoder (☞p. 48), frequency, audio program number (absolute) Category Program category, frequency, audio program number (absolute) Frequency MUTE f INFO w TAG • “Insufficient Data” is displayed on the front panel display if tagging is not possible. • If a status or error message is displayed on the front panel, see “iTunes Tagging” (☞p. 121). Frequency, audio program number (absolute), audio program number (relative/total) Artist / Song Artist name, song title, frequency, audio program number (absolute) Back to “Call Sign” Display example (DSP Program) 889-1 VOL. HD STEREO TUNED SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Straight J 1 : If the HD Radio information contains a character that cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be displayed with a space. When an information is unavailable, “––––” appears. En 61 PLAYBACK MAIN Using HD Radio™ features ZONE 2 CODE SET Confirming and operating the HD Radio™ tuner from the Content window SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD RADIO VOLUME ENTER RETURN i ■ Operating from the Now playing m POP-UP MENU MUTE REC HOLD l 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 view k DISPLAY TOP MENU b c d e ENT INPUT MUTE b c d e f j k l n a f g h i j k l m n o a HOLD indicator Lights up when lHOLD is pressed to activate the hold d TUNER k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER l HOLD h A HD Radio station currently received can be confirmed d from the menu displayed on the TV screen. Various HD Radio operations can be performed from the Content window rather than controls on the front panel display. The Content window is displayed when dTUNER is pressed. You can operate the HD Radio from the Now Playing view or the Content browse view. OPTION ON SCREEN g Stereo indicator function. The artist name and song title currently received will remain displayed. Press lHOLD again to cancel the hold function. TAG indicator Lights up when the selected station supports the iTunes Tagging. Preset number The selected preset number is displayed. Band The selected band (FM or AM) is displayed. HD Radio indicator Lights up when receiving the HD Radio station. Tuned indicator Lights up when a station is received. o Lights up when a stereo broadcast is received. When “Audio mode” is set to “Mono,” the indicator does not light. Frequency The frequency currently received is displayed. Frequency guide The frequency currently received is displayed as a cursor on the bar. Channel Name The channel name currently received is displayed. Channel Category The category of the channel is displayed. Artist Name The artist name of the current song is displayed. Song Title The title of the current song is displayed. Album Name The album name of the current song is displayed. You can operate the HD Radio from the Now Playing view or the Content browse view. Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Now Playing view” for details. Memory Registers the station currently received as a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations can be registered. Program - Select the previous program of the HD Radio. Program + Select the next program of the HD Radio. Hold Activate the hold function. The artist name and song title currently received will remain displayed. Tag Applies the iTunes Tagging. Preset Select You can call preset stations registered. Preset - Selects the previous preset number. Preset + Selects the next preset number. Preset -8 Returns the previous page. Preset +8 Goes to the next page. Direct Selects a station directly by entering the preset number. Memory Registers the station currently received as a preset station. Up to 40 FM/AM stations can be registered. Hold Activate the hold function. The artist name and song title currently received will remain displayed. Tag Applies the iTunes Tagging. Screen buttons on the Now Playing view To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. Manual Tuning You can tune in to a desired FM/AM station by specifying its frequency. FM Switches a band to FM. AM Switches a band to AM. Tuning - Decreases the frequency. Tuning + Increases the frequency. Auto - Automatically searches for a station on a lower frequency than the current station. Auto + Automatically searches for a station on a higher frequency than the current station. Direct Selects the frequency manually. Continues to the next page En 62 PLAYBACK MAIN Using HD Radio™ features ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Utility HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] Utility 4 AUDIO Audio mode AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT Selects “Auto” or “Mono” when receiving the FM (or HD Radio) station. Auto: Stereo reception. HD radio program is received by priority. Automatically switches to monaural reception when a monaural station is received. Mono: Monaural reception. Reception is better in monaural mode. HD Radio program is not received. SCENE BD DVD TV CD POP-UP MENU k Clear All Preset Clears registration for all preset stations. Scrolls the list to the next or previous page. Browse DISPLAY TOP MENU Clears registration for a preset station currently selected. 1 Page Down Switches the scroll target. RETURN Clear Preset Scroll VOLUME ENTER Detects the stations with strong signals and register up to 40 stations automatically to the next number after the one being received. 1 Page Up RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN Auto Preset MUTE Switches the display to the Content browse view. ■ Operating from the Content browse REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 view Now Playing Switches the display to the Now Playing view. ENT INPUT MUTE a b k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER a Preset station list The list of preset stations is displayed. b Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details. Screen buttons on the Content browse view To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. En 63 PLAYBACK Listening to Satellite Radio To listen to Satellite Radio, you’ll need to connect a SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner (sold separately) to your Sirius-Ready receiver. SIRIUS Satellite Radio is available to residents of the US (except Alaska and Hawaii) and Canada. Satellite Radio delivers a variety of commercial-free music from categories ranging from Pop, Rock, Country, R&B, Dance, Jazz, Classical and many more plus coverage of all the top professional and college sports including play by play games from select leagues and teams. Additional programming includes expert sports talk, uncensored entertainment, comedy, family programming, local traffic and weather and news from your most trusted sources. Once you’ve purchased a SIRIUS tuner you’ll need to activate it and subscribe to begin enjoying the service. Easy to follow installation and setup instructions are provided with the SIRIUS tuner. There are a variety of programming packages available, including the option of adding “The Best of XM” programming to the SIRIUS service. The “Best of XM” service is not available to SIRIUS Canada subscribers at this time. Please check with SIRIUS Canada for any updates using the numbers and web address below. Family friendly packages are also available to restrict channels featuring content that may be inappropriate for children. To subscribe to SIRIUS, U.S. and Canadian customers can call 1-888-539-SIRI (1-888-539-7474) or visit sirius.com (US) or siriuscanada.ca (Canada). SIRIUS Radio Legal SIRIUS and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. All other marks and logos are the property of their respective owners. All rights reserved. SIRIUS subscription sold separately. Taxes and a one-time activation fee may apply. SIRIUS tuner required (sold separately) to receive the SIRIUS service. All programming and fees subject to change. It is prohibited to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, hack, manipulate or otherwise make available any technology or software incorporated in receivers compatible with the SIRIUS Satellite Radio System. Service not available in Alaska or Hawaii. Connecting the SiriusConnect™ tuner Connect the SiriusConnect tuner (sold separately) to the SIRIUS jack on the rear panel of this unit. For details, see the instruction manuals provided with the SiriusConnect tuner. SiriusConnect Tuner and the antenna (sold separately) DOCK HDMI OUT 1 2 ARC SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND AM PR 75 PB • To ensure optimal reception of the SIRIUS Satellite Radio signals, the antenna of the SiriusConnect tuner must be placed at or near a window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. The orientation of the antenna for the best reception differs depending on the area. Refer to the instruction manuals provided with the SiriusConnect tuner for the installation of the antenna. You can mount it indoors or outdoors. • Use the Antenna information on the front panel display or the SIRIUS information screen on the TV screen (☞p. 69) to check the antenna reception level and adjust the orientation of the antenna. • You need to connect the SiriusConnect tuner to the AC wall outlet. NOTES • If “CHECK SR TUNER” or “ANTENNA ERROR” appears on the front panel display, the connection of the SiriusConnect tuner or antenna is incorrect. In such cases, check the connection of the SiriusConnect tuner and the antenna. • If “NOT SUPPORTED” appears on the front panel display, this unit does not support the connected SiriusConnect tuner. VIDEO Y OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT To the AC wall outlet En 64 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET Activating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ subscription SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] V-AUX AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO Before using the SIRIUS Satellite Radio feature, you need to activate your SIRIUS Satellite Radio subscription. To activate the subscription you need the d Sirius ID which is uniquely assigned to the SiriusConnect tuner. Sirius ID is 12-digit number which is indicated on the package of the SiriusConnect tuner and on the label of the SiriusConnect tuner. Sirius ID is also configured on the front panel display when you tune into the SIRIUS Satellite Radio channel “0.” ■ Displaying the Sirius ID of your OPTION ON SCREEN SiriusConnect tuner VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE 1 Press dSIRIUS. 2 Press m0 and then mENT to display the Sirius ID of your SiriusConnect tuner. 3 Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to activate your subscription. SIRIUS Satellite Radio online information Contact for activation URL: https://activate.siriusradio.com/ Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-539-7474) Status messages appear on the front panel display and the TV screen during the activation. For details, see “SIRIUS Satellite Radio™” (☞p. 121). Once the activation is finished, “SUB UPDATED” appears. 2 3 4 SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ operations 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 INPUT MUTE ENT m “000 Sirius ID” and “xxxxxxxxxxxx” (“xxxxxxxxxxxx” indicates the 12-digit Sirius ID of your SiriusConnect tuner) appears alternately on the front panel display. 1 The SIRIUS indicator lights up on the front panel display and the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information (such as channel number, channel name, category, artist name, or song title) for the currently selected channel appears on the front panel display. J1 Write down the Sirius ID in the space provided below. ID:________________________________________ d SIRIUS m0 m ENT ALL 184Weather 2 Search for a channel by using one of the SIRIUS Satellite Radio search modes. All channel search mode Selects a channel from the all channel list (☞p. 66). Direct number access mode Selects a channel directly by entering the channel number (☞p. 66). Press dSIRIUS to select “SIRIUS” as the input source. SIRIUS • Before activating your subscription, you can only select “184” or “000.” • If a status message or an error message appears on the front panel display or TV screen, refer to “SIRIUS Satellite Radio™” (☞p. 121). Category search mode Selects a channel by category (☞p. 66). REC 1 NOTES VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Preset search mode Selects a channel from the preset channels (☞p. 67). You can preset channels by registering them to specific numbers, and later just select those numbers to tune in. • SIRIUS Satellite Radio information can be displayed on the front panel display and the TV screen (☞p. 69). • If you tune into a channel that you do not subscribe, “CALL SIRIUS on the front panel display” or “CALL 888-539-SIRIUS TO SUBSCRIBE” appears on the TV screen. Channel number Channel name J 1 : When you select “SIRIUS” as the input source, this unit automatically calls the previously selected channel. En 65 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ All channel search mode SOURCE RECEIVER NOTE HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 Press eTUN./CH H / I repeatedly to search for a channel within all channels. 4 AUDIO AV 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] All channel search mode DOCK HDMI OUT SIRIUS CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV e STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR 001Hits 1 TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE ALL RADIO • You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding eTUN./CH H / I. • You can skip channels to the previous or next category by pressing eCATEGORY D / E. OPTION ON SCREEN ■ Category search mode VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU 1 MUTE REC Press eCATEGORY D / E to select the channel category. When you select the category, the first channel in the category is selected. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT m Category search mode INPUT SIRIUS MUTE The first channel in the category CAT001 Pop VOL. L SL SBL SW C R SR SBR Category name e TUN./CH H / I e CATEGORY D / E e MEMORY m Numeric keys m ENT If you don’t operate within 10 seconds, the category search mode returns to “ALL (All Channel Search).” 2 This unit skips the following channels in all channel search mode or category search mode. This is not a malfunction. • channels that are locked (☞p. 69) • channels that are not currently in service • channels that you do not subscribe to ■ Direct number access mode Registering and recalling the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ channels Up to 40 SIRIUS Satellite Radio channels can be registered as preset channels. ■ Registering preset channels 1 Press the mNumeric keys to enter the desired three-digit channel number. For example, to enter the number 123, press “1,” “2” and then “3” of the mNumeric keys. • When entering a one-digit or two-digit channel number, enter the number using the mNumeric keys and then press mENT to confirm your entry. • This unit automatically accepts your entry if you do not press mENT within a few seconds after entering the number. • If the selected channel is locked, “PIN:___” appears on the front panel display. Enter the 4-digit Parental Lock code number by using the mNumeric keys or press mENT to cancel (☞p. 69). • If the selected channel is not available, an advisory message may appear. For details, refer to “SIRIUS Satellite Radio™” (☞p. 121). • If this unit is in preset search mode, a preset number is selected instead of a channel number when you press the mNumeric keys. To switch to direct number access mode, press eTUN./CH H / I. Search for a channel to be registered. For details on searching channels, refer to the following pages. • All channel search mode (☞p. 66) • Category search mode (☞p. 66) • Direct number access mode (☞p. 66) 2 Use one of the following methods to register the channel currently received. ■ Registering to a preset number for which no channel has been registered Press and hold eMEMORY for at least 2 second. The channel will be automatically registered to the lowest available preset number (or the next number after the last to which a channel was registered). SIRIUS MEMORY VOL. P01:001Preset Preset number SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Registered channel While “CAT” is displayed on the front panel display, press eTUN./CH H / I repeatedly to search for a channel within the selected channel category. You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and holding eTUN./CH H / I. En 66 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Designating a preset number for registration SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 Press eMEMORY once. AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] SIRIUS AV MEMORY VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR P01:--- << 001 HDMI OUT TUNER CATEGORY FM Preset number AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH e ENHANCER SUR. DECODE TV CD Press ePRESET F / G to select the preset number to which the channel will be registered and then press eMEMORY to register. RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU Channel to be registered STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD Previously registered channel (or “---” if no channel has been registered) POP-UP MENU k To cancel registration, press kRETURN or do not operate the remote control for about 30 seconds. MUTE ■ Recalling a preset channel (Preset REC Search mode) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 m Specify preset numbers to recall registered channels. Preset number INPUT MUTE e MEMORY e PRESET F / G k RETURN m Numeric keys ENT SIRIUS P01 001Hits1 VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Press ePRESET F / G to change the preset numbers (1 to 40). • Preset numbers to which no channel has been registered are skipped. • Preset numbers can also be selected by pressing mNumeric keys. En 67 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET Displaying the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ information SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO AV You can display the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information on the front panel display. J1 DOCK HDMI OUT NOTE CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO TUN./CH f MEMORY ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV If a status message or an error message appears on the front panel display or TV screen, see “SIRIUS Satellite Radio™” (☞p. 121). Composer Composer name, channel number Antenna Antenna reception level, channel number Signal reception level Channel number STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT ■ Front panel display SCENE CD Search mode RADIO SIRIUS OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN Press fINFO repeatedly to toggle the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information display modes as shown below. DISPLAY Signal reception level ALL008 Antenna VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Signal reception is shown in four levels. Channel TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE Channel number, channel name REC DSP Program 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT Current sound program (☞p. 47), channel number Category Channel category, channel number INPUT Audio Decoder MUTE Artist/Song Current Audio Decoder (☞p. 43), channel number Artist name, song title, channel number f INFO Back to “Channel” J 1 : If the SIRIUS Satellite Radio information contains a character that cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be displayed with a space. When an information is unavailable, “––––” appears. En 68 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET Confirming and operating SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ from the Content window SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 AUDIO 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO ■ Operating from the Now playing VOLUME ENTER RETURN POP-UP MENU MUTE REC HOLD l 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT The category of the channel is displayed. g Artist Name Parental Lock Restricts the access to specified channel. h Song Title i j The title of the current song is displayed. Composer Name The composer name of the current song is displayed. Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Now Playing view” for details. When the parental lock function is enabled for a particular channel, that channel is skipped in all channel search mode and category search mode. 1 Use kCursor D / E to select a number, and press kENTER to enter the selected number. 2 3 Repeat step 1 to enter the desired 4-digit code number. Screen buttons on the Now playing view To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. Radio Control b c e j a d f g h i MUTE a HOLD indicator Lights up when lHOLD is pressed to activate the hold d SIRIUS k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER l HOLD Utility view k DISPLAY TOP MENU The channel name currently received is displayed. f Channel Category The artist name of the current song is displayed. The Sirius channel currently received can be confirmed d from the menu displayed on the TV screen. Various Sirius Satellite Radio operations can be performed from the Content window rather than controls on the front panel display. The Content window is displayed when dSIRIUS is pressed. You can operate the Sirius Satellite Radio from the Now playing view or the Content browse view. OPTION ON SCREEN e Channel Name b function. The artist name and song title currently received will remain displayed. Press lHOLD again to cancel the hold function. Signal reception level Indicates the signal reception level. Weak signal Select a channel for reception. Memory Register the current channel as a preset number. Up to 40 channels can be registered. Preset - Select the previous preset number. Preset + Select the next preset number. CAT - Select the previous category. CAT + Select the next category. CH - Scan channels downwards from the current channel. CH + Scan channels upwards from the current channel. Direct Specify a specific channel by manually entering the channel number. Hold Activate the hold function. The artist name and song title currently received will remain displayed. Use kCursor C to select “Enter,” and press kENTER to confirm the 4-digit code number. Selecting “Clear” and pressing kENTER clears all the code entered. 4 Use kCursor B / C to select the category and press kENTER. Continues to the next page Strong signal c Preset number The selected preset number is displayed. d Channel number The channel number currently received is displayed. En 69 PLAYBACK MAIN Listening to Satellite Radio ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 5 HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 AUDIO Use kCursor B / C to select the channel to be locked and press kENTER. Check mark AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] Scroll 1 Page Up Switches the scroll target (channel name, channel category, artist name, song title, or composer name). 1 Page Down Scrolls the list to the next or previous page. Browse HDMI OUT TUNER Switches the display to the Content browse view. CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET ■ Operating from the Content browse TUN./CH Now Playing Switches the display to the Now playing view. view ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU When kENTER is pressed, the selected channel is received for confirmation. Each time kENTER is pressed after that, lock switches between on and off. To lock channels in other categories, press MUTE kRETURN to display the category selection screen, REC and follow the procedure described above. a Preset station list The list of preset stations is displayed. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE k Cursor B / C / D / E k RETURN k ENTER m Numeric keys m ENT m NOTES • If a code number is already registered and the different code number is entered, “Wrong Number” appears. Use kCursor B / C to select Parental Lock and press kENTER, and then enter the correct number. • If you forget the parental lock code or want to change it, reset it using “SR PIN” (☞p. 109). Receiving locked channels Use direct number access mode (☞p. 66) or preset search mode (☞p. 67) to receive locked channels. When a locked channel is received, “Locked” is displayed followed by the parental lock code input screen. Use mNumeric keys to enter the 4-digit code number, select OK and then press mENT. b Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details. Screen buttons on the Content browse view To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. Utility Parental Lock Restricts the access to specified channel. Clear Preset Clears registration of the preset station currently selected. Clear All Preset Clears registration of all preset stations. En 70 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Once you have connected a Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (such as the YDS-12, sold separately) to this unit, you can enjoy playback of your iPod/iPhone using the remote control supplied with this unit. When playing back from an iPod/iPhone, you can also use the compressed music enhancer sound programs to give compressed audio formats such as MP3 a sharper, more dynamic sound (☞p. 46). A Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10, sold separately) can also be connected to this unit to play back iPod/iPhone with wireless connection. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] d Controlling an iPod™/iPhone™ HDMI OUT • When playing back iPod/iPhone with wired connection CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH f ENHANCER SUR. DECODE TV CD RADIO VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 INPUT • When playing back iPod/iPhone with wireless connection Refer to “Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with wireless connection” (☞p. 74). OPTION ON SCREEN ENT Connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone After setting your iPod/iPhone in your dock, just press dDOCK to switch to DOCK input to play your iPod/ iPhone. The iPod/iPhone can be operated in the following two ways. Switch this unit on and place your iPod/iPhone in the dock. The unit is now ready for playback. DOCK • iPod touch, iPod (4th Gen/5th Gen/Classic), iPod nano, iPod mini, iPhone, iPhone 3G, and iPhone 3GS are supported (As of March 2010). • When connecting iPhone, iPhone 3G and iPhone 3GS, use a YDS-12. • Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or the software version of your iPod/iPhone. • Some functions may not be available for some Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone models. This explanation focuses on the YDS-12. • When an iPod that supports iTunes Tagging is connected to this unit, this unit transmits iTunes Tagging information to the iPod (☞p. 61). VOL. iPodconnected L SL SBL SW C R SR SBR DOCK Use the dedicated cable to connect the dock to the DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit. Refer to the operating instructions of the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone for information on how to connect your iPod/ iPhone. MUTE d DOCK f INFO To prevent accidents, switch this unit to standby mode before connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD Refer to “Connecting the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone.” CAUTION SIRIUS ANTE HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO F PR 75 PB Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone Menu browse control: Plays the iPod/iPhone while viewing the menu displayed on the TV. Refer to “Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu screen (Menu browse control)” (☞p. 72). Simple remote control: Plays audio and video through this unit while viewing the menu displayed on the iPod/iPhone screen. Refer to “Operating basic playback functions via the remote control (Simple remote control)” (☞p. 74). VIDEO Y OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 OPTI (CD) ( TV AV • Song information (artist, album, song) is displayed on the front panel. Press fINFO repeatedly to display subsequent/previous information. • The Yamaha logo is displayed on the iPod screen when iPod stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone (does not apply to the iPod touch or iPhone). • Manual control of the iPod/iPhone is not possible while the iPod stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone. Locate the dock at the distance as far as from the unit. When this unit is in standby mode, iPod/iPhone can be charged automatically (☞p. 80). En 71 PLAYBACK MAIN Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ ZONE 2 CODE SET Playing iPod/iPhone from the menu screen (Menu browse control) SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 10 Pages Up ■ Operating from the Now playing view AUDIO 5 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] V-AUX AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM ■ Operating from the Content browse TUN./CH MEMORY view ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV 1 Page Up 1 Page Down Scrolls the list to the next or previous page. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD a b VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU e f d h k g i j RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN a b c Goes to 10 pages forwards or backwards. AM PRESET INFO 10 Pages Down The iPod/iPhone can be operated from the menu displayed on the TV screen. d You can operate the iPod/iPhone from the Now playing view or the Content browse view. k c Now Playing Switches the display to the Now playing view. d Close MUTE e REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT a b c d MUTE e Input name / List name Menu items Input icon Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Content browse view” for details. Current menu number / Number of all menu items Returns to the video playback, turning off the menu display. 1 2 a b c d e f g Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input. Press kCursor B / C to select the content (music or video) that you want to play, and press kENTER. J1 h i j k Repeat icon Shuffle icon Play icon Album image Artist name Album title Screen button area Buttons for available operations are displayed. See “Screen buttons on the Now playing view” for details. Song title Remaining time Progress bar Elapsed time Screen buttons on the Now playing view d DOCK k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER Screen buttons on the Content browse view To use these buttons, first press kCursor E. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. 3 Press kCursor B / C to select iPod/iPhone menu items, and press kENTER to play. To use these buttons, first press kENTER. Then select the desired one with kCursor B / C and kENTER. The Now playing view appears during playback. J 1 : Videos will not be displayed when your iPod or Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone do not support the browser function for browsing video files. En 72 PLAYBACK MAIN Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Play Control HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 p (Play) Starts playback. 5 6 MULTI DOCK s (Stop) Stops playback. TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] e (Pause) Stops playback temporarily. b (Skip -) Skips to the beginning of the currently playing song. Press kENTER at the beginning of the song to skip to a previous song. a (Skip +) Skips to the beginning of the next song. w (Scan -) Searches backwards. f (Scan +) Searches forwards. Operates the basic playback functions of iPod/iPhone. AUDIO AV 1 HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE Scroll Switches the scroll target (artist name, album name, or song name). REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT Browse Switches the display to the Content browse view. INPUT Close MUTE Returns to the video playback, turning off the menu display. k ENTER En 73 PLAYBACK MAIN Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ ZONE 2 CODE SET Operating basic playback functions via the remote control (Simple remote control) SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] 4 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY d Use the following remote control keys to operate (playback, stop, skip, etc.) your iPod/iPhone. Press lREC to enable the Simple remote control. Press lREC again to return to the Menu browse control. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT dDOCK SCENE BD DVD TV CD kCursor B / C RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU TAG l PRG SELECT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 INPUT MUTE d DOCK k Cursor B / C k ENTER k RETURN l REC ls le lp lw lf lb la Move the cursor up and down to different fields. kRETURN Returns to the previous menu. kENTER Enables the selected menu. lw Searches backwards while held down. lf Searches forwards while held down. lb Skips to the beginning of the currently playing song. Pressing repeatedly skips one song backwards with each press. MUTE REC HOLD Switches to the DOCK (iPod) input. ENT Playing iPod™/iPhone™ with wireless connection A Yamaha iPod wireless system (YID-W10, sold separately) can be connected to this unit to play back iPod/iPhone with wireless connection. The iPod/iPhone can be used as the remote control. J1 Place the iPod/iPhone in the wireless transmitter. Setup is complete. DOCK Skips to the beginning of the next song. ls Stops playback. le Switches between playback and pause. lp Switches between playback and pause. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR iPodconnected ■ Connecting the Yamaha iPod DOCK wireless transmitter and playing back iPod/iPhone SIRIUS AN Use the dedicated cable to connect the wireless receiver to the DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit. Refer to the operating instructions of the YID-W10 for more information. HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO PR PB Yamaha iPod wireless receiver VIDEO Y CAUTION To prevent accidents, unplug the power cable of this unit before connecting the iPod wireless receiver. OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 O (CD) 3 12 A la VOL. B Position the wireless receiver as far as possible from the unit. When this unit is in standby mode, iPod/iPhone can be charged automatically, if “Standby Charge” is set to “Auto” (☞p. 80) or “Power & Input” of “iPod Interlock” is set to “On” (☞p. 81). J 1 : Video signals cannot be transmitted wirelessly. En 74 PLAYBACK MAIN Playing back tunes from your iPod™/iPhone™ ZONE 2 CODE SET Use iPod/iPhone to start playback. SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 When “iPod Interlock” → “Volume” in the Input menu is set to “Off,” the volume of this unit is not adjusted when iPod/iPhone volume controls are adjusted (☞p. 81). AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX • Adjusting volume control on the iPod/iPhone also adjusts the volume (max 0.0 dB) of this unit. 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] d HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH CAUTION ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 INPUT MUTE d DOCK ENT • This unit, which is placed in the main zone, functions as follows when iPod/iPhone controls are used to start playback. – The input source switches to DOCK (iPod) when this unit is turned on. – When this unit is in standby mode when iPod/iPhone playback starts, this unit turns on and the input source switches to DOCK (iPod). J1 • This unit automatically enters standby mode when the following operations are performed. – iPod/iPhone is removed from the YID-W10 – iPod/iPhone is not operated for a while after playback is stopped When iPod/iPhone controls are used to adjust volume, playback volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to this unit or the speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, immediately remove the iPod/iPhone from the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone. “Max Volume” can be used to specify the maximum volume level to prevent excessively loud playback (☞p. 95). • Pressing dDOCK also switches the input source to DOCK (iPod). • When a menu is operated, this function is not activated. • When “iPod Interlock” → “Power & Input” in the Input menu is set to “Off,” the power and the input source do not switch automatically (☞p. 81). J 1 : This function is also activated when sound of application is reproduced or ringtone is received. En 75 PLAYBACK MAIN ZONE 2 Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER You can connect a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver (such as the YBA-10, sold separately) to this unit and enjoy wireless playback from Bluetooth-compatible portable music players. J1 HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 1 V-AUX 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] NOTE d HDMI OUT When playing back from a Bluetooth component for the first time, you must first pair the devices (register the Bluetooth components). When establishing a wireless connection you must carry out pairing on both this unit and on the Bluetooth component. CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH e ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT Connecting a Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver Pairing Bluetooth™ components SCENE CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN Use the dedicated cable to connect the dock to the t DOCK jack on the rear panel of this unit. The Bluetooth wireless audio receiver connection will be k complete when this unit is turned on. DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 DOCK 2 3 4 Be sure to carry out pairing when connecting a Bluetooth component for the first time, or when settings have been deleted. Refer to the operating instructions of your Bluetooth component as necessary when carrying out pairing. The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver can be paired with up to eight Bluetooth components. When the ninth device is paired, the pairing settings for the device which has not been used for the longest period of time will be deleted. 6 7 HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO 8 Press tOPTION to display the OPTION menu and use kCursor B / C to select “Pairing.” OPTION VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR Pairing 4 Press kENTER to start pairing. DOCK VOL. Searching... SIRIUS ANTE 5 3 SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR F PR 9 0 10 75 ENT PB INPUT Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver VIDEO Y MUTE OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) d DOCK e MEMORY k Cursor B / C k ENTER k RETURN t OPTION OPTI ( TV AV 1 2 Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input. • To cancel pairing, press kRETURN. • You can also press and hold eMEMORY on the front panel to begin pairing. Turn on the Bluetooth component you want to pair with and set it to pairing mode. Continues to the next page CAUTION To prevent accidents, switch this unit to standby mode before connecting a Bluetooth wireless audio receiver. J 1 : This unit supports A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile) of the Bluetooth profile. En 76 PLAYBACK MAIN Playing back tunes from Bluetooth™ components ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 5 HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 4 AUDIO AV 1 2 3 5 6 MULTI DOCK When the device is recognized, it will appear in the Bluetooth component list, for example as “YBA-10 YAMAHA.” d HDMI OUT TUNER SIRIUS Make sure the Bluetooth component recognizes the Bluetooth wireless audio receiver. [ A ] Using Bluetooth™ components When pairing is complete, perform the following procedure to achieve a wireless connection between this unit and the Bluetooth component. When the wireless connection is complete, Bluetooth components can be played back. 3 When wireless connection is complete DOCK FM AM MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH 6 ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT Select the Bluetooth wireless audio receiver from the Bluetooth component list, and enter a pass key “0000” into the Bluetooth component. J1 Depending on Bluetooth components, a wireless connection is established automatically or by operating the Bluetooth components. In that case, it is not necessary to carry out the following procedure. SCENE BD DVD TV CD RETURN t VOLUME ENTER When pairing occurs correctly RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN k DOCK Completed VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 1 2 Press dDOCK to switch to the DOCK input. Press tOPTION to display the OPTION menu. VOL. SW C R L SL SR SBL SBR BTconnected CATEGORY INFO Use kCursor B / C to select “Connect” and press kENTER. J2 “Not found” is displayed when there is an error connecting. Check that the following conditions have been satisfied, and try to establish a wireless connection again. • Both this unit and the Bluetooth component are paired. • The Bluetooth component is switched on. • The Bluetooth component is within 32 ft. (10 m) of the Bluetooth wireless audio receiver. 4 Operate the Bluetooth component for playback. To disconnect a wireless connection, repeat the same steps, and in step 3, select “Disconnect.” ENT INPUT MUTE d DOCK k Cursor B / C k ENTER t OPTION J 1 : Depending on Bluetooth components, wireless connection is carried out right after the pairing. In this case, “BT connected” is displayed instead of “Completed.” J 2 : “Disconnect” is displayed when a Bluetooth component has been connected. En 77 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET Configuring input sources (Input menu) SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 Settings, such as the name of an input source or the icon displayed for an input source can be changed from the Input menu. 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK AV Configuring input sources HDMI OUT TUNER SIRIUS The name of an input source and its icon, as well as other input source settings, can be changed from the Input menu displayed on the TV screen. [ A ] CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH 3 Use kCursor D / E to select an input source to be configured and press kCursor B. 4 Use kCursor B / C to select an item and press kENTER. 6 Press jON SCREEN to close the menu. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE 1 STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO j VOLUME k Press jON SCREEN. OPTION ON SCREEN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT 2 Use kCursor B / C to select “Input” and press kENTER. INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN If the selected item contains additional items, use kCursor B / C to select the desired item and press kENTER. 5 Use kCursor B / C to adjust the setting. Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Repeat steps 4 to 5 to adjust multiple settings. En 78 SETUP MAIN Configuring input sources (Input menu) ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Changing an input source name or Input menu SOURCE RECEIVER icon HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 4 AUDIO HDMI1-5 AV 1 2 3 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS AV1-2 AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY Decoder Mode [ A ] CATEGORY FM Audio In Enhancer HDMI OUT TUNER Rename/ Icon Select TUN./CH Rename/ Icon Select Audio In Decoder Mode Enhancer Enhancer 3 Press kENTER, and then press kCursor B / C / D / E to edit the new input name. 4 Press kENTER and press kCursor C to select “OK” and press kENTER. Rename/Icon Select Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-6, AUDIO1-2, V-AUX, DOCK (iPod), DOCK (Bluetooth), MULTI CH Changes the input source name (up to nine characters) and icon displayed on the front panel display or TV screen. Confirm the new input name. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT AV3-4 Rename/ Icon Select Decoder Mode AV5-6 Rename/ Icon Select Enhancer AUDIO1-2 Rename/ Icon Select Enhancer V-AUX Rename/ Icon Select Decoder Mode Enhancer TUNER Enhancer SIRIUS Enhancer DOCK (iPod) Rename/ Icon Select Enhancer Standby Charge SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k 1 Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Rename/Icon Select” and press kENTER. 2 Use kCursor D / E to choose an icon and press kCursor C. DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT iPod Interlock J1 INPUT MUTE DOCK (Bluetooth) Rename/ Icon Select Enhancer MULTI CH Rename/ Icon Select Video Out k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER J 1 : Not available when playing back iPod/iPhone with wired connection. En 79 SETUP Configuring input sources (Input menu) ■ Combining HDMI/AV1-2 input source video and audio ■ Setting the format of digital audio signals Decoder Mode Audio In Input source: Input source: HDMI1-5, AV1-2 Combines video from HDMI or AV input sources with analog/ digital audio inputs in situations such as: – an playback device is connected with an HDMI cable but cannot transmit audio through HDMI – an playback device with component video output and analog audio output (such as certain game consoles) are connected to the system To change assignments, select an input source (HDMI1-5 or AV1-2) as the video input first, and then select audio input jacks in this menu. Set as follows according on the desired combination of audio input jacks. Audio inputs Settings method Optical digital audio input Select AV1 or AV4. Connect the external component audio cable to the optical digital jack for the selected input. Coaxial digital audio input Select AV2 or AV3. Connect the external component audio cable to the coaxial digital jack for the selected input. Analog audio input Select one of AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2. Connect the external component audio cable to the audio jack for the selected input. HDMI1-5, AV1-4, V-AUX J1 Sets the format of digital audio to playback to DTS. For example, if the format is not automatically detected correctly even during playback of DTS format audio, this item can be used to set the playback format to DTS. Auto (Default) The audio format is automatically selected to match the format of the input audio. DTS Selects DTS signals only. Other input signals are not reproduced. ■ Selecting the sound program suitable for listening to compressed audio, such as MP3 Enhancer Input source: All input sources other than MULTI CH Turns on/off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode. Off (Default) Turns off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode. On Turns on the Compressed Music Enhancer mode. ■ Charging an iPod™/iPhone™ in standby mode Standby Charge Input source: DOCK (iPod) Charges an iPod/iPhone stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod / iPhone or iPod wireless receiver while the receiver is in standby mode. Auto (Default) This unit charges iPod/iPhone when this unit is in standby mode. While charging an iPod/iPhone, the HDMI Through/iPod Charge indicator lights. When HDMI Through function is off, the indicator goes out after the charging is complete. Off This unit does not charge iPod/iPhone. J 1 : AV5-6 or AUDIO1-2 are also available when “Audio Return Channel” is on, and the input source is used for “TV Audio Input.” En 80 SETUP Configuring input sources (Input menu) ■ Setting the interlock functions with iPod/ iPhone (when a Yamaha iPod wireless receiver is connected) iPod Interlock Input source: ■ Outputting a video signal input from another input source while playing a multi-channel audio signal Video Out DOCK (iPod) This unit can be automatically operated in conjunction with operations on iPod when the iPod wireless receiver is connected to this unit. Power & Input Starting playback of iPod/iPhone turns on this unit and switches the input source to DOCK (iPod) automatically when this item is set to “On.” This unit automatically enters standby mode when iPod/iPhone is not operated for a while after playback is stopped. This interlock function is disable with “Off.” Volume Adjusting the volume on the iPod/iPhone also adjusts the volume of this unit when this item is set to “On.” This interlock function is disable with “Off.” Input source: MULTI CH When “MULTI CH” is selected as the input source, a video signal input from another terminal can be output to the video monitor. For example, even if an audio and video component such as a DVD player that does not support a multi-channel digital audio output, the video signal can be output to the video monitor while reproducing a multi-channel analog audio signal. En 81 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER The SCENE function (☞p. 43) can be edited from the SCENE menu displayed on the TV screen. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 Editing a scene AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] Various settings, such as the name of a scene or the icon displayed for a scene, can be changed from the SCENE menu. HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE 1 STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT 3 Use kCursor D / E to select a scene to be edited and press kCursor B. 5 Use kCursor B / C / D / E to adjust the setting. Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to adjust multiple settings. Press jON SCREEN. SCENE CD RADIO j 6 OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k 4 DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU Press jON SCREEN to close the menu. Use kCursor B / C to select an item and press kENTER. MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT 2 Use kCursor B / C to select “Scene” and press kENTER. INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN When the Utility is available in the selected item, use kCursor B / C to select the Utility and press kENTER. En 82 SETUP Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu) SCENE menu ■ Registering SCENE function settings Save SCENE1 Save Load Rename/Icon Select Reset Registers the settings currently applied to this unit for each SCENE. ■ Adjusting settings registered with the SCENE function SCENE2 Save Load Rename/Icon Select Reset SCENE3 Save Load Rename/Icon Select Reset SCENE4 Save Load Rename/Icon Select Reset Load Loads input sources or sound programs that have been registered with the SCENE function, or specifies whether or not an external component registered as the input source is automatically turned on when a scene is selected. Ok Loads items indicated with a check mark in “Setting.” Cancel Cancels settings applied with “Setting.” DETAIL Specifies “SCENE IR” function and displays settings registered with the SCENE function in detail. Foe more information, see “SCENE IR” and “Detail” at right. SCENE IR Specify whether or not a Yamaha BD/DVD player or CD player connected to this unit turns on automatically. Off Disables the SCENE IR function. Yamaha BD/DVD Player1 Select this when a Yamaha BD/DVD player is connected to this unit. Yamaha BD/DVD Player2 Select this if the player dose not turn on when “Yamaha BD/DVD Player1” is selected. Yamaha CD Player Select this when a Yamaha CD player is connected to this unit. Detail Display details of settings registered with the SCENE function. Items indicated with a check mark in “Setting” are loaded. Input Displays “Input” and “Audio Select” settings registered with the SCENE function. Mode Displays the sound program registered with the SCENE function. Enhancer Displays the “Enhancer” setting registered with the SCENE function. En 83 SETUP MAIN Editing the SCENE function (SCENE menu) ZONE 2 CODE SET ■ Changing a scene name and icon SOURCE RECEIVER ■ Resetting a scene HDMI 1 2 3 4 Rename/Icon Select AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front panel display or TV screen. AV Reset Restores all settings to their default values. DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH 1 Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Rename/Icon Select” and press kENTER. 2 3 Use kCursor D / E to choose an icon and press kCursor C. 4 Press kENTER and press kCursor C to select “OK” and press kENTER. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT Press kENTER, and then press kCursor B / C / D / E to edit the new scene name. INPUT MUTE Confirm the new scene name. k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER En 84 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Sound effects can be adjusted from the Sound Program menu. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 Editing sound programs AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] Adjust sound field elements (sound program parameters) to achieve sound effects suited to the acoustics of audio/ video sources or rooms if you are not satisfied with the results achieved with default sound program settings. Follow the procedure described below to adjust sound program parameters. HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT 3 Use kCursor D / E to select a sound program and press kCursor B. Sound programs TV CD RADIO j VOLUME k OPTION ON SCREEN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU 1 2 Press jON SCREEN. MUTE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 Press jON SCREEN to close the Sound Program menu. ■ To initialize sound program parameters Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Sound Program” and press kENTER. 4 REC Use kCursor D / E to adjust the parameter and press kRETURN. J1 When there are multiple parameters in the selected sound program, repeat steps 4 and 5 to adjust other parameters. 6 SCENE BD DVD 5 Use kCursor B / C to select a parameter and press kENTER. To set the parameters of the sound program back to their default settings, use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Reset” in step 4 and press kENTER. When the following message is displayed, select “OK” and press kENTER to initialize. Sound program parameters ENT INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN Choices To cancel initializing, select “CANCEL” and press kENTER when the message above is displayed. J 1 : An asterisk (*) appears on the left of the sound field parameter name displayed on the TV when you change the parameter from its default setting. En 85 SETUP Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) -6 dB to +3 dB Default setting 0 dB Adjust “DSP Level” as follows: Surround Room Size Surround Back Initial Delay Surround Back Room Size Initial delay. Presence, surround, and surround back sound field initial delay. Changes the apparent size of the sound field by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the smaller the sound field seems to the listener. Adjustable range 1 to 99 ms (Initial Delay) 1 to 49 ms (Surround Initial Delay and Surround Back Initial Delay) • The effect sound is too soft. • There are no differences between effects of the sound programs. → Increase the effect level. • The sound is dull. • The sound field effect is added too much. → Reduce the effect level. Room size. Presence, surround, and surround back room size. Adjusts the apparent size of the sound field. The larger the value, the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter from one to two doubles the apparent length of the room. Adjustable range Source sound 0.1 to 2.0 Level Level Early reflections Time Delay Source sound Time Time Delay Delay Audio source Time Time Time Audio source Reflection face Small value = 1 ms Early reflections Level Adjustable range Surround Initial Delay Level Change the effect level (level of the sound field effect to be added). You can adjust the level of the sound field effect while checking the sound effect. Room Size Level DSP Level Initial Delay Level CINEMA DSP parameters Large value = 99 ms When you adjust the initial delay parameters, we also recommend that you adjust the corresponding room size parameters likewise. Small value = 0.1 Large value = 2.0 When you adjust the room size parameters, we also recommend that you adjust the corresponding initial delay parameters likewise. En 86 SETUP Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) Reverb Time Surround Liveness Surround Back Liveness Liveness. Surround and surround back liveness. Adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual walls in the hall by changing the rate at which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of an audio source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall surfaces than in one which has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to as “dead,” while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live.” This parameter lets you adjust the early reflection decay rate and thus the “liveness” of the room. Reverb Delay Reverberation time. Adjusts the amount of time taken for the dense, subsequent reverberation sound to decay by 60 dB at 1 kHz. This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment over an extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time to get more sustaining reverberation sound, and set a shorter time to get articulate sound. Adjustable range Adjustable range Reverberation Source sound 60 dB Short reverberation Source sound Reverberation 60 dB 60 dB 60 dB Time Rev. Time Source sound (dB) Early reflections Rev. Time 0 to 10 0 to 250 ms 1.0 to 5.0 s Time Adjustable range Reverberation delay. Adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and the beginning of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound begins. A later reverberation sound makes you feel as if you are in a larger acoustic environment. Level Liveness Reverberation Time Time Rev. Time Long reverberation Rev. Delay Rev. Time Audio source Time Small reflected sound Small value = 0 Level Dead Level Level Live Time Small value = 1.0 s Large value = 5.0 s Time Large reflected sound Large value = 10 En 87 SETUP Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) Reverb Level Reverberation level. Adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the stronger the reverberation becomes. 2ch Stereo only Direct 0 to 100% Level Adjustable range Parameters usable in certain sound programs Automatically bypasses the DSP circuit and tone control circuit depending on the condition of tone control etc., when an analog audio source is played back. You can enjoy a higher quality sound. Source sound Auto (Default) Rev. Level Off Outputs sound by bypassing the DSP circuit and tone control circuit when both tone controls of “Bass” and “Treble” are set to 0 dB. Surround R Level Adjusts the volume of the surround R channel. J2 Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 100% Surround Back L Level Adjusts the volume of the surround back L channel. J2 Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 35% (7.1-channel configuration) 50% (6.1-channel configuration) Does not bypass the DSP circuit and tone control circuit. Time Surround Back R Level 7ch Stereo only Decode Type Adjusts the volume of the surround back R channel. J2 Selects a surround decoder to be used with a sound program in the MOVIE category. J1 PLIIx Movie PLII Movie Selects the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie (or Dolby Pro Logic II Movie) decoder. Neo:6 Cinema Selects the Neo:6 (Cinema) decoder. Center Level Adjusts the center channel volume. J2 Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 100% Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 35% (7.1-channel configuration) 50% (6.1-channel configuration) Front Presence L Level Surround L Level Adjusts the volume of the front presence L channel. J2 Adjusts the volume of the surround L channel. J2 J 1 : Surround decoders cannot be changed when used with the following MOVIE Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 100% Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 33% J 2 : Not displayed when speakers are set to be inactive. sound programs. • Mono Movie • Sports • Action Game • Roleplaying Game En 88 SETUP Setting sound program parameters (Sound Program menu) Front Presence R Level Parameters usable in surround decoder Adjusts the volume of the front presence R channel. J1 Adjustable range 0 to 100% Default setting 33% Decode Type Selects a surround decoder. Pro Logic Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic decoder. This is suitable for all kinds of audio sources. PLIIx Movie / PLII Movie Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for movies. J2 PLIIx Music / PLII Music Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for music. J2 PLIIx Game / PLII Game Reproduces sound using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) decoder. This is suitable for games. J2 Neo:6 Cinema Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for movies. Neo:6 Music Reproduces sound using the DTS Neo:6 decoder. This is suitable for music. Center Width Spreads the center channel sound to the front left and right speakers to suit your needs or preferences. Set this parameter to 0 for outputting the center sound from the center speaker only, or to 7 for outputting it from the front left/right speaker only. Adjustable range 0 to 7 Default setting 3 Dimension Adjusts the difference in level between the front sound field and the surround sound field. You can adjust the difference in level created by the software being played back to obtain the preferred sound balance. The surround sound gets stronger as you make the value more negative, and the front sound gets stronger as you make the value more positive. Adjustable range -3 to +3 Default setting 0 Dolby PLIIx Music and Dolby PLII Music only When Neo:6 Music is selected Panorama Adjusts the soundscape of the front sound field. Sends front left/ right channels sounds to the surround speakers as well as the front speakers for a wraparound effect. Off (Default) Disables the effect. On Enables the effect. Center Image Adjusts the front left and right channel output relative to the center channel to make the center channel more or less dominant as necessary. Adjustable range 0.0 to 1.0 Default setting 0.3 J 1 : Not displayed when speakers are set to be inactive. J 2 : You cannot select the Dolby Pro Logic IIx decoder in the following conditions: • When “Surround Back” is set to “None” (☞p. 92). • When headphones are connected. En 89 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 Setting various functions (Setup menu) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Various settings, such as speaker volume or HDMI functions, can be changed from the Setup menu. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 Operating the Setup menu AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] Setup menu setting Speaker Adjusts parameters for speakers, such as speaker status, and volume adjustment for each speaker (☞p. 91). Sound Sets functions related to audio output, such as adjustment of maximum volume and of dynamic range (☞p. 95). Video Sets video output functions, such as video conversion settings (resolution and aspect ratio) (☞p. 96). HDMI Sets HDMI functions, such as the HDMI Control function and output destination for HDMI sound (☞p. 97). HDMI OUT TUNER 1 2 CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT Press jON SCREEN. Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Setup” and press kENTER. SCENE CD RADIO j VOLUME k OPTION ON SCREEN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE Multi Zone Sets multi-zone functions, such as volume adjustment for speakers in the secondary zone (☞p. 100). Function Sets functions such as the Auto Power Down function, that make the unit easier to use (☞p. 100). Language Selects the language of the menus and messages displayed on TV screen (☞p. 103). REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN 3 Use kCursor D / E to select a menu and press kENTER. 4 Use kCursor B / C to select an item and press kENTER. When the selected item contains detailed ones, use kCursor B / C to select the detailed item and press kENTER. 5 Use kCursor B / C / D / E to adjust the setting. Pressing kRETURN displays the previous menu screen. Repeat steps 4 to 5 to adjust multiple settings. 6 Press jON SCREEN to close the menu. En 90 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) Setup menu Manages settings for speakers ■ Manual speaker setup Manual Setup The following parameters can be specified manually. Speaker Auto Setup Manual Setup Sound Lipsync Dynamic Range Max Volume Initial Volume Adaptive DSP Level Speaker Setup items Video Analog to Analog Conversion Processing HDMI HDMI Control Control Select ARC (Audio Return Channel) TV Audio Input Audio Output Standby Through Multi Zone Auto Setup Optimizes the speaker configuration automatically. Manual Setup Manually adjusts parameters for speakers. Power Amp Assign Adds the extra speakers to the 7.1-channel speaker connection. Configuration Manually manages speaker configuration, such as speaker size (sound production capacity), and bass audio processing. Distance Manually adjusts the output of each speaker based on distance to the listening position. Level Manually adjusts the volume of each speaker. Parametric EQ Selects an equalizer to adjust speaker output characteristics. Test Tone Generates test tones. ■ Automatic speaker setup Auto Setup Optimizes the speaker configuration automatically using YPAO (☞p. 33). Power Amp Assign In addition to the 7.1-channel speaker connection, various speaker configurations are possible using the presence speakers connection, bi-amp connection or Zone2 function (☞p. 17, p. 18). Zone2 Set Party Mode Set Function Auto Power Down Display Set Trigger Output Memory Guard Language En 91 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) Configuration Adjusts the output characteristics of the speakers based on manually set parameters. In the “Configuration,” you can select the speaker size characteristic (Large or Small). Select the size (sound reproduction capacity) that matches your speakers. Front Selects the size (sound reproduction capacity) of the front speakers. J1 Large Small (Default) Select this for large speakers. The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components. Select this for small speakers. The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components. J2 Center Selects the size of the center speakers. Woofer diameter • 6-1/4 in (16 cm) or larger → Large • 6-1/4 in (16 cm) or smaller → Small When speaker size is set to “Small,” low-frequency components of the speakers that you configured are produced from the subwoofer (or from the front speakers if there is no subwoofer). Large Select this when a large center speaker is connected. Small (Default) Select this when a small center speaker is connected. None Select this when there is no center speaker. The front speakers will produce center channel audio. Surround Selects the size of the surround speakers. Large Select this when the surround speakers are large. Small (Default) Select this when the surround speakers are small. None Select this when no surround speakers are connected. The front speakers will produce surround channel audio signals. • When set to “None,” no sound is produced from the surround back speaker even if that speaker is connected. • When set to “None,” the sound programs will change to Virtual CINEMA DSP mode. Surround Back Selects the size of the surround back speakers. Largex1 Select when one large surround back speaker is connected. Largex2 Select when two large surround back speakers are connected. Smallx1 Select when one small surround back speaker is connected. Smallx2 (Default) Select when two small surround back speakers are connected. None Select this when no surround back speakers are connected. • When there are no surround speakers are connected, the setting will automatically change to “None.” • You can set surround back audio signals, including from the playback source, to be mixed down and produced from a single speaker (6.1-channel layout) or produced from left and right surround speakers (5.1-channel layout). Front Presence Specify connection of front presence speakers. Use (Default) Select this when front presence speakers are connected. None Select this when front presence speakers are not connected. J 1 : When “Subwoofer” is set to “None,” you can only choose “Large.” If the front speaker setting is “Small” and you change “Subwoofer” to “None,” it will automatically change to “Large.” J 2 : You can set the low-frequency components of audio signals transmitted from the front speakers to the subwoofer by using “Bass Cross Over.” En 92 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) Subwoofer Confirms the subwoofer. Use (Default) Select this when subwoofer is connected. During playback, the subwoofer will produce audio from the LFE (low-frequency effect) channel and bass audio from other channels. J1 None Select this when subwoofer is not connected. The front speakers will produce audio from the LFE (lowfrequency effect) channel and bass frequency audio from other channels. Phase Sets the phase of the subwoofer if the bass audio is lacking or unclear. Normal (Default) Does not change the subwoofer phase. Reverse Reverses the subwoofer phase. Extra Bass Allows the front channel low-frequency components to be produced exclusively by the subwoofer, or by both the subwoofer and the front speakers. Bass Cross Over Sets the lower limit of low-frequency component which is produced from speakers of which the size is set to “Small.” A frequency sound which is lower than the specified frequency will be produced from the subwoofer or the front speakers. J2 Level Separately adjusts the volume of each speaker. Use kCursor B / C to select the desired speaker, and press kENTER. Then use kCursor D / E to adjust the volume for the selected speaker. 40Hz 110Hz 60Hz 120Hz Adjustable range -10.0 dB to +10.0 dB 80Hz (Default) 160Hz Default setting 90Hz 200Hz 0.0 dB (Front L/Front R/Center/Surround L/ Surround R/Surround Back L/Surround Back R/ Front Presence L/Front Presence R/Subwoofer) Adjustment increments 0.5 dB 100Hz Distance Adjusts the timing at which the speakers produce audio so that sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same time. Selecting adjustment units Use kCursor B / C to select the unit for distance (meters or feet), and press kENTER. Setting distances for each speaker Off (Default) Depending on the size of the front speakers, either the front speakers or the subwoofer produce the front channel low-frequency components. On The subwoofer and the front speakers produce the front channel low-frequency components. When “Subwoofer” is set to “None” or “Front” is set to “Small,” “Extra Bass” is disabled. Use kCursor B / C to select the speaker you want to configure, and press kENTER. Then use kCursor D / E to set the distance from the speaker to your listening position. Adjustable range 1.0 ft to 80.0 ft (0.30 m to 24.0 m) Default setting 10.0 ft (3.00 m) (Front L/Front R/Center/Surround L/ Surround R/Surround Back L/Surround Back R/ Front Presence L/Front Presence R/Subwoofer) Adjustment increments 0.2 ft (0.05 m) J 1 : Enabling “Extra Bass” allows both the subwoofer and the front speakers to produce bass audio. J 2 : If your subwoofer has a volume control or a crossover frequency control, set the crossover frequency to maximum and the volume to half (or slightly less). En 93 SETUP MAIN Setting various functions (Setup menu) ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Parametric EQ HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 Adjusts sound quality of tone using a parametric equalizer. AUDIO AV 1 2 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] PEQ Select Select an equalizer type. DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV PRESET TUN./CH Manual Manually adjust equalizer sound. Flat Adjust individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics. Select this option if speakers offer the same quality. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT j SCENE CD RADIO Front OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN k Adjust individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as the front left and right speakers. Select this option if front left and right speakers offer significantly greater quality than other speakers. DISPLAY Natural TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT MUTE Through (Default) Disable the equalizer. PEQ Data Copy Select 1 of the 3 parametric equalizer types acquired with automatic setup and manually copy that information to the manual adjustments. Flat > Manual j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER Adjust all speakers to achieve a natural sound. Select this if high-frequency sounds seem too strong when “PEQ Select” is set to “Flat.” Copy the “Flat” parametric equalizer information acquired with automatic setup. Front > Manual Copy the “Front” parametric equalizer information acquired with automatic setup. Natural > Manual Copy the “Natural” parametric equalizer information acquired with automatic setup. Front L / Front R / Center / Surround L / Surround R / Surround Back L / Surround Back R / Front Presence L / Front Presence R The parametric equalizer can be used to manually adjust sound quality for individual speakers. Set “PEQ Select” to “Manual” and use “PEQ Data Copy” to copy information acquired with automatic setup. This information can be used as a basis for performing manual adjustments. 1 Use kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Band / Gain,” “Freq. / Gain,” or “Q / Gain” and press kENTER. 2 Use kCursor D / E repeatedly to adjust the parameter and use kCursor B / C repeatedly to adjust the gain. 3 4 Press kENTER to exit the edit window. Test Tone Turns the test tone generator on or off. Off (Default) Does not generate test tones. On Generates test tones. While “On” is selected, test tones are produced constantly. You can use the test tone in a variety of circumstances. For example, you can adjust the volume balance settings for each speaker, or whenever you adjust the settings on the internal parametric equalizer, you can listen to the actual effect while operating this unit. Turn the test tone off when you have finished making adjustments. Repeat steps 1 to 3 to configure other parameters. To reset all parameter settings for the selected speaker, select “Reset to Flat” and press kENTER. 5 Press jON SCREEN to close the menu. En 94 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) Setting the audio output function of this unit ■ Synchronizing audio/video output Mode Selects a compensation method for the delay between audio and video output. Auto (Default) J1 Lipsync Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for Dolby Digital and DTS playback. Max Volume Sets the maximum volume for this receiver. Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. Adaptive DSP Level Adjusts the level of DSP effect in conjunction with the volume level. dynamic range Lipsync Adjusts the delay between audio and video output (Lipsync function). Sound Setup items ■ Auto-adjusting Dolby Digital and DTS Manual When connecting to a TV via HDMI, automatically adjusts output timing if the TV supports an automatic lipsync function. Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for audio bitstream (Dolby Digital and DTS) signal playback. MAX (Default) Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range. STD Adjusts the dynamic range for optimum volume for regular home use. MIN/AUTO (MIN) Sets the dynamic range suitable for low volume or a quiet environment, such as at night, for bitstream signals except for Dolby TrueHD signals. (AUTO) Adjusts the dynamic range for Dolby TrueHD signals based on input signal information. Manually adjusts the correction time. Select this when the monitor does not support the automatic lipsync function. ■ Setting the maximum volume Delay Adjustable range 0 ms to +250 ms Default setting 0 ms Adjustment increments 1 ms Max Volume Specify the maximum volume level so that sound is not too loud. The default setting of +16.5 dB produces the highest volume. Adjustable range -30.0 dB to +16.5 dB (maximum volume) Default setting +16.5 dB Adjustment increments 5.0 dB J 1 : This setting is effective at the HDMI OUT jack selected by using rHDMI OUT. En 95 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Setting the startup volume Setting this unit’s video output function Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. When this parameter is set to “Off,” the volume is set at the level when the receiver last entered standby mode. J1 Adjustable range Off, Mute, -80 dB to +16.5 dB Default setting Off Adjustment increments 0.5 dB Video Setup items ■ Adjusting DSP effect and volume level Adaptive DSP Level Automatically adjust the level of DSP effect in conjunction with the volume level. Off Disables automatic adjustment of the level of DSP effect. On (Default) Adjusts the degree of DSP effect in conjunction with volume level. The higher the volume level, the less the DSP effect applied. The lower the volume level, the greater the DSP effect applied. Analog to Analog Conversion Enable or disable video conversion between analog video jacks. Processing Enable or disable adjustment of resolution and aspect ratio for video signal converted to HDMI video. • Analog-to-HDMI video conversion is always possible unless video signals are being input at the HDMI input jacks or 1080presolution analog video signals are being input (☞p. 126). • This unit does not convert 480 line video signals and 576 line video signals interchangeably. • 480p-, 576p-, 1080i- and 720p-resolution video signals can not be output at the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack (☞p. 126). • The converted video signals are only output at the MONITOR OUT jacks. • When composite video signals from a VCR are converted into component video signals, the picture quality may suffer depending on your VCR. • Unconventional signals input at the composite video jacks cannot be converted or may be output abnormally. In such cases, set “Analog to Analog Conversion” to “Off.” ■ Analog-to-analog video conversion Analog to Analog Conversion Enables or disables video conversion between analog video jacks. Off Disables video conversion between analog video jacks. On (Default) Enables video conversion between analog video jacks. J 1 : When you set “Max Volume” at a lower level than “Initial Volume,” “Max Volume” has priority. En 96 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Adjusting resolution and aspect ratio with conversion of video signal to HDMI Through (Default) The aspect ratio of HDMI video signal sources is not adjusted. 16:9 Normal Transmits 4:3 aspect ratio video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the screen. Processing Adjust resolution and aspect ratio with conversion of video input to HDMI video (upscaling). Off (Default) Resolution and aspect ratio are not adjusted with processing. On Resolution and aspect ratio are adjusted with processing. Setting HDMI functions Aspect • The Aspect setting is automatically disabled when “Resolution” is set to “Through.” • The Aspect setting is automatically disabled for video input with aspect ratios other than 4:3. • Changing the aspect ratio of 720p, 1080i, or 1080p has no effect. HDMI Setup items Resolution Auto (Default) Automatic upscaling in accordance with TV resolution. 480p Upscaling to 480p (576p). 720p Upscaling to 720p. 1080i Upscaling to 1080i. 1080p Upscaling to 1080p. Through No upscaling. • The 720p-, 1080i- and 1080p-resolution video signals cannot be upscaled (☞p. 126). • When a TV is connected to this unit via the HDMI jack, this unit automatically detects a resolution that the TV supports. Only the detected resolution can be selected. • If this unit cannot detect the resolution that the TV supports, set “MON.CHK” in the Advanced Setup menu to “SKIP” (☞p. 110) and try again. HDMI Control Turns the HDMI Control on or off. Control Select Choose an HDMI OUT jack on which HDMI Control function is enabled. ARC (Audio Return Channel) Turns the Audio Return Channel function on or off. TV Audio Input Chooses automatically selected audio input in conjunction with TV operation when the HDMI Control is turned on. Audio Output Specifies whether or not audio signal is output through this unit and a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. Standby Through J1 Turns the Standby Through function on or off. J 1 : This item appears depending on “HDMI Control.” En 97 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Receiver operation via TV (HDMI Control) ■ Listening to TV audio via single HDMI cable (Audio Return Channel) ■ Selecting an input source to assign audio input for the TV HDMI Control Set the HDMI Control function to “On” to operate devices connected via HDMI. If the TV or other external components support HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link), you can use the remote controls of those devices to operate some of this unit’s functions, and to synchronize this unit with the operation of those devices. Refer to “Using the HDMI Control function” (☞p. 111) for setting instructions. Off (Default) Sets HDMI Control to “Off.” On Sets HDMI Control to “On.” J1 If this unit is connected to HDMI devices that do not support the HDMI Control function, these functions will not operate. ■ Selecting an HDMI OUT jack for the HDMI Control function ARC (Audio Return Channel) You can enable or disable the Audio Return Channel function. When using a TV that supports Audio Return Channel function and the function is enabled, the TV’s audio output is transmit to this unit via an HDMI cable. The TV audio input to this unit is regarded as the input source selected in “TV Audio Input.” J2 By means of this function, you do not need to connect the TV’s audio output (digital audio output or analog audio output) to the unit. Off (Default) Sets the Audio Return Channel to “Off.” On Sets the Audio Return Channel to “On.” TV Select the HDMI OUT jack that utilizes the HDMI Control function. Refer to “Using the HDMI Control function” (☞p. 111) for setting instructions. Out1(TV1) Applies the HDMI Control function for the HDMI OUT 1 jack. Out2(TV2) Applies the HDMI Control function for the HDMI OUT 2 jack. J 1 : When the HDMI Control is “On,” the Standby Through function is automatically enabled. When this unit enters standby mode, the audio and video signals from the last-selected HDMI input source will continue to be transmitted to the TV. The HDMI input source can only be changed using the remote control. VOL. L SL SBL Select the input source that receives audio signals from TV while the HDMI Control function is on. When using a TV that supports Audio Return Channel function and the function is enabled, the audio input for the TV is assigned to the input source selected here. J2 TV1 Audio input AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 Default setting AV4 TV2 When the TV audio is input to the unit using Audio Return Channel, “TV” is displayed on the front panel display. AV4 Control Select TV Audio Input SW C R SR SBR Audio input AV1-6 or AUDIO1-2 Default setting AV1 • “TV Audio Input” is enabled only for the HDMI OUT 1 or 2 jack selected with “Control Select.” • Refer to “Switching the input source on this unit automatically when listening to TV audio” (☞p. 112) for instructions. • “ARC (Audio Return Channel)” is enabled only for the HDMI OUT 1 or 2 jack selected with “Control Select.” • Refer to “Single HDMI cable input to TV audio with Audio Return Channel function” (☞p. 113) for setting instructions. J 2 : While the Audio Return Channel function is on, the jack selected for the input source cannot be used. En 98 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Specify whether or not audio signal is output through this unit and a TV Audio Output OUT2 Specify whether or not audio signal is output through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 2 jack. Off (Default) Choose whether audio is played back through this unit or through a TV. Amp Specify whether or not audio signal is output through this unit. Off Audio is not output through this unit. On (Default) Audio is output through this unit. When this setting is selected, audio from the external component is output in a format compatible with this unit. OUT1 Specify whether or not audio signal is output through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 1 jack. Off (Default) Audio is not output through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 1 jack. On Outputs audio through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 1 jack. When this setting is selected, audio from the external component is output in a format compatible with the TV. On ■ Transmitting HDMI audio/video to the TV during standby mode (Standby Through) Standby Through Audio is not output through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 2 jack. Outputs audio through a TV connected via the HDMI OUT 2 jack. When this setting is selected, audio from the external component is output in a format compatible with the TV. This function allows audio/video signals from HDMI inputs to continue to be transmitted to a TV when this unit is in standby mode. When the Standby Through function is “On,” audio/video signals continue to be output to the TV from the last HDMI input source before this unit enters standby mode. The HDMI input source can be selected using dHDMI1-5 or dV-AUX in standby mode. Off (Default) Sets Standby Through to “Off.” On Transmits audio/video signals from the selected HDMI input source to the TV. • When “HDMI Control” is “On,” Standby Through function is automatically enabled and “Standby Through” is not displayed. • When the Standby Through function is on, the HDMI Through/ iPod Charge indicator on the front panel lights during the standby mode. This unit consumes approximately 3 W of power. En 99 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) Setting this unit’s multi-zone function ■ Adjusting Zone2 volume Making the receiver easier to use Zone2 Set Max Volume Specify the maximum volume level in Zone2 so that sound is not too loud. Adjustable range -30.0 dB to +16.5 dB (maximum volume) Default setting +16.5 dB Adjustment increments 5.0 dB Multi Zone Setup items Zone2 Set Adjusts Zone2 volume level. Party Mode Set Enable or disable the party mode function. Function Setup items Initial Volume Specify the initial volume level in Zone2 when this unit is turned on. Adjustable range Off, Mute, -80 dB to +16.5 dB Default setting Off Adjustment increments 0.5 dB Auto Power Down This unit enters standby mode if no operations are performed. Display Set Specifies menu items displayed on TV screen and the front panel. Trigger Output Specifies TRIGGER OUT jack function. Memory Guard Protects some settings against accidental modification. ■ Setting the party mode Party Mode Set In party mode, the main zone sources can be played in Zone2 simultaneously (☞p. 116). Select “Zone2,” and then select “Enable” or “Disable.” Enable (Default) Enables the party mode function. Disable Disables the party mode function. En 100 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Goes enter standby mode automatically when you leave it without operating ■ Specifying menu display Display Set Auto Power Down If you do not operate this unit or use the remote control for an extended period of time, it will automatically go into standby mode (Auto Power Down function). This function’s default setting is “Off.” When you want to enable this function, set the amount of time to pass before this unit will enter standby. 4hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated this unit for four hours. 8hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated this unit for eight hours. 12hours Goes into standby mode, when you have not operated this unit for twelve hours. Off (Default) Auto Power Down function is disabled. Wall Paper Specify the wall paper displayed on the TV screen when no video signal is input. Select one that you prefer. Specify front panel display brightness and TV screen wall paper. Picture Front Panel Display Specify front panel display brightness and message scroll pattern. Displays an image on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Dimmer Adjustable range: -4 - 0 Reduce brightness of the front panel display. As the value is lowered, the panel display darkens. Scroll Selects the manner in which display scrolls when the total number of characters exceeds the display area on the front panel display. Select “Continue” for continuous scrolling of all characters. Select “Once” to scroll through all characters once and then halt scrolling for display of only the first 14 characters. This unit starts a countdown of 30 seconds before entering the standby mode. Pressing any key of the remote control during the countdown cancels entering the standby mode and reset the timer. En 101 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Setting TRIGGER OUT functions Trigger Output Sets the TRIGGER OUT jack to function synchronized with power status of each zone or input switching. Target Zone Specify the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized. Main (Default) Trigger Mode Specify the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. Power (Default) Source Manual The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the power status of the zone specified with “Target Zone.” The TRIGGER OUT jack functions synchronized with the input switching in the zone specified with “Target Zone.” Electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Target Source.” When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in the main zone. Zone2 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in Zone2. All When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with power status of the main zone or Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source,” electronic signal transmission is synchronized with input switching in the main zone or Zone2. Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with “Manual.” Manual Manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external component connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack. Low Stops the electronic signal transmission. High (Default) Transmits the electronic signal. This setting is available only when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Manual.” Target Source Specify the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input switching. Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source specified in this option. High (Default) Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in this option. This setting is available only when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source.” En 102 SETUP Setting various functions (Setup menu) ■ Prohibiting setting changes Memory Guard Prohibits setting changes to prevent careless changes being made to the settings on Setup menu. Off (Default) Settings are not protected. On Prohibits changes to the settings on Setup menu until it is returned to “Off.” While set to “On,” the unit displays “Memory Guard!” when an attempt is made to change the settings. Language Select the language used for display of menus and messages. J1 Choices: English (English), (Japanese), (French), (German), (Spanish), (Russian) J 1 : Content window information is displayed in the language in which that information was released. En 103 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 Confirming information of this unit (Information menu) CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER A variety of information for this unit can be displayed. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 Selecting information AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER 1 CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH Press jON SCREEN. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE TV ■ Video information Displays information on the current audio signal. Displays information on the current video signal. Format Signal format. When this unit is unable to detect a digital signal, it automatically switches to analog input. HDMI signal Source video signal type and video signal output to this unit’s HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. Sampling The number of samples taken per second from a continuous signal to make a discrete signal. HDMI Resolution Input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI) resolution. Analog Resolution Channel The number of source channels in the input signal (front/surround/LFE). For example, a multi-channel soundtrack with 3 front channels, 2 surround channels and LFE is displayed as “3/2/0.1”. Resolution of the source video signal and the analog video signal output to this unit’s COMPONENT MONITOR OUT jacks. HDMI Error Error message for HDMI sources or connected HDMI devices (☞p. 117). STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD ■ Audio information CD RADIO j VOLUME k OPTION ON SCREEN ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 2 Use kCursor B / C to select “Information” and press kENTER. ENT INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER 3 Use kCursor D / E to select an Information menu and press kENTER. Bitrate The number of bits passing a given point per second. Dialogue The dialogue normalization level preset to the current input bitstream signal. • “___” is displayed when this unit cannot display the corresponding information. • Some high-definition audio bitstream contents may not include the discrete surround back left and right channel signals, but are encoded at a bitrate of 192 kHz. • Even when direct bitstream output settings are applied, some players convert the Dolby TrueHD or Dolby Digital Plus bitstreams to the Dolby Digital bitstreams, while converting DTS-HD Master Audio or DTS-HD High Resolution Audio bitstreams to DTS bitstreams. ■ HDMI monitor Displays information on the TV screen connected to this unit’s HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. Interface Displays information on the current connection interface. Video Resolution Displays the frequency for each video resolution of the TV currently connected. ■ System information Displays information on the current settings of “Remote ID,” “TV Format” and “Speaker Impedance.” ■ Zone information Displays information on Zone2 settings. En 104 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER c p You can operate an external component such as TV and DVD player with the remote control of this unit by setting the code for external component (remote control code). The remote control code can be set for each input source. Individual setting allows you to switch external components seamlessly depending on the selected input source. HDMI 1 2 3 4 AUDIO 5 V-AUX 1 2 3 4 AV 1 2 6 MULTI SIRIUS [ A ] 5 Controlling other components with the remote control d Selecting input source connected to DVD player DOCK Selecting input source connected to CD player HDMI OUT TUNER Keys connecting external components CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH DVD player DVD player ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD Playback/Stop RADIO Playback/Stop OPTION ON SCREEN CD player VOLUME ENTER RETURN k If you are unable to operate this unit after operating an external component, light up pSOURCE/RECEIVER in orange by pressing it, and then try operating the remote control again. DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE l REC HOLD TAG 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 CD player PRG SELECT m 10 TV VOL TV CH cSOURCE A Switches an external component on and off. kCursor, kENTER, kRETURN Operates the menus of external components. lDISPLAY Switches an external component display. lExternal component operation keys Functions as a recording or playback key of an external component, or a menu display key. mNumeric keys Functions as numeric keys of an external component. ENT TV INPUT MUTE The remote control keys for controlling external components are available only when the external components have corresponding control keys. n nTV control keys J1 c SOURCE A d Input selector k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER k RETURN l External component nINPUT Switches video inputs of TV. nMUTE Mutes TV volume temporarily. nTV VOL +/- Controls the volume of TV. nTV CH +/- Switches TV channels. nA Turns on and off TV. operation keys l DISPLAY m Numeric keys n TV control keys n INPUT n MUTE n TV VOL +/n TV CH +/nA p SOURCE/RECEIVER J 1 : When remote control codes for external components are registered with dInput selector or nA (nTV control keys), the following operations are possible. • When a TV remote control code is registered with dInput selector, the kCursor, mNumeric keys and nTV control keys can be used to control the TV selected with dInput selector. • When a remote control code for a device other than a TV is registered with dInput selector, keys including the kCursor and mNumeric keys can be used to control external components, and the nTV control keys can be used to control the TV registered with nA. • When a TV remote control code is registered with nA, only nTV control keys can be used to control the TV. En 105 SETUP MAIN Controlling other components with the remote control ZONE 2 CODE SET o SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] d Default remote control code settings Registering remote control codes for external component operations The following remote control codes are assigned to input sources as factory default settings. For a complete list of available remote control codes, refer to “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM. The following section describes how to register remote control code using an example of the registration of the remote control codes of a Yamaha BD player connected to HDMI2 jack. AUDIO AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET Category Manufacturer Remote control code ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY BD DVD TV STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT HDMI1 Blu-ray player/ recorder Yamaha 2064 HDMI2 — — — HDMI3 — — — HDMI4 — — — HDMI5 — — — AV1 — — — AV2 — — — AV3 CD player Yamaha 5095 AV4 — — — AV5 — — — AV6 — — — AUDIO1 — — — AUDIO2 — — — V-AUX — — — A J1 — — — DOCK — — — TUNER — — — SIRIUS — — — SCENE CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT TV INPUT TV VOL TV CH MUTE d HDMI2 n TV control keys nA o CODE SET Press oCODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. blinks twice MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI TUN./CH Input MOVIE 2 n J 1 : Use A for external component operations only. Set these keys to remote control codes if you want to perform external component operations without linking to input source selection of this unit. For example, it may be convenient to assign remote control codes for devices such as TVs. • Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Settings will be automatically stopped if more than 1 minute passes since the last operation. To reset, repeat from step 2. • Remote control code of an external component cannot be set from the name or model number of a unit. Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CD-ROM to search the available remote control codes from the category or manufacturer of external components. • If multiple remote control codes exist, first set the first code in the list, if it does not work then try the other codes. 1 1 3 2 3 4 Press dHDMI2 to switch the input source to HDMI2. J2 Perform the following steps to register the selected input source here to the remote control code. Continues to the next page Use “Remote Control Code Search” in the CDROM to search the available remote control codes from the category or manufacturer of external components. “2064” can be used for a Yamaha BD player. J 2 : When you want to register a remote control code to the nTV control keys, press nA (nTV control keys) in step 3. En 106 SETUP MAIN Controlling other components with the remote control ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER o p HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 d AUDIO 4 Enter a remote control code “2064” using mNumeric keys. J1 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] 2 CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY PRESET TUN./CH Registration successful: blinks twice Registration failed: blinks 6 times ENHANCER SUR. DECODE MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY MAIN TV CD RADIO i ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 3 Enter “9981” using mNumeric keys. 9 Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Settings will be automatically stopped if more than 1 minute passes since the last operation. To reset, repeat from step 1. STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD Resetting all remote control codes for external components to the initial factory settings. 4 Once the remote control code is registered successfully pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice. HDMI OUT TUNER 6 0 Resetting all remote control codes 1 Press oCODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. 8 9 1 Once the remote control code is reset successfully pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice. Reset successful: blinks twice Reset failed: blinks 6 times MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER OPTION ON SCREEN blinks twice HDMI 1 4 MAIN DISPLAY TOP MENU 3 HDMI 1 2 3 4 VOLUME ENTER RETURN 2 POP-UP MENU • If the registration fails, repeat from step 2. • In case of an external component with multiple remote control codes, the other remote control codes may be supported. Repeat from step 2 with the other remote control codes. MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 m ZONE 2 CODE SET If setup fails, repeat from step 1. SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 2 3 4 Press pSOURCE/RECEIVER on the remote control. ENT INPUT MUTE d HDMI2 i SCENE m Numeric keys o CODE SET p SOURCE/RECEIVER 5 To switch between BD player linked to scene selections, press iSCENE and at the same time press dHDMI2 and hold it for approximately 3 seconds. Then you can operate the external components by switching the input source to HDMI2, or selecting HDMI2 in the registered scene. Same steps for operating other external components, press iSCENE and at the same time press the input source key selected in step 3 and hold it for approximately 3 seconds. J 1 : When you want to register a remote control code to the nTV control keys, enter the TV remote control code in step 4. En 107 SETUP Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu) The Advanced Setup menu can be used for unit initialization and other useful extended functions. The Advanced Setup menu can be operated as follows. Displaying/Setting the Advanced Setup menu 3 Rotate PROGRAM selector to select the item to be set from the following items. Setting the impedance of speakers In the Advanced Setup menu, you can set the following settings. 1 2 Switch this unit to the standby mode. SP IMP. Sets the impedance of speakers. REMOTE ID Changes the remote control ID of a receiver. Press MAIN ZONE A while pressing and holding STRAIGHT on the front panel. SR PIN Resets the parental lock code for the SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner. Release STRAIGHT when “ADVANCED SETUP” is displayed on the front panel display. After a few seconds, the top menu items are displayed. TV FORMAT Specifies the TV’s color encoding format. MON.CHK Removes the up-scaling limitation on HDMI video output. INIT Initializes various settings for this unit. MAIN ZONE A SPIMP.-8MIN Changes the unit settings depending on the impedance of the speakers connected. J1 6ΩMIN Select the impedance when 6 Ω speakers are connected. 8ΩMIN (Default) Select the impedance when speakers above 8 Ω are connected. STRAIGHT MAIN ZONE ZONE2 ZONE CONTROL INFO MEMORY PRESET CATEGORY FM AM INPUT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO PROGRAM PHONES YPAO MIC TONE CONTROL 4 5 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select the value you want to change. Switch this unit to the standby mode, and then switch it on again. STRAIGHT The settings become effective and the unit is powered on. SILENT CINEMA PROGRAM selector J 1 : For detailed procedures of speaker impedance settings, refer to “Changing speaker impedance” (☞p. 18). En 108 SETUP MAIN Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu) ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER o p HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 AUDIO 2 Avoiding crossing remote control signals when using multiple Yamaha receivers AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT TUNER REMOTEID-ID1 CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH The remote control of the unit can only receive signals from a receiver which has an identical ID (remote control ID). When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver. On the contrary, if you are setting the same remote control ID for all receivers, you can use one remote control to operate 2 receivers. ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE ID1 (Default) REC ID2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 m Receives the remote control signals set in ID1. Receives the remote control signals set in ID2. ■ To change the remote control ID Resetting the SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ parental lock code Perform each of the following steps within 1 minute. Settings will be automatically stopped if more than 1 minute passes since the last operation. To reset, repeat from step 1. 1 2 3 Press oCODE SET using a pointed object such as the tip of a ballpoint pen. Press pSOURCE/RECEIVER. Enter the desired remote control ID code. SRPIN-CANCEL Reset the SIRIUS Satellite Radio parental lock code to the factory default setting. If you forget the code, it can be reset. RESET Resets the code to the factory default setting. CANCEL (Default) Cancels resetting of the parental lock code. To switch to ID1: Enter “5019” using mNumeric keys. To switch to ID2: Enter “5020” using mNumeric keys. Once the remote control code is registered successfully pSOURCE/RECEIVER will blink twice. ENT INPUT MUTE ID1 is set for both remote control and receiver by default. To avoid crossing remote control, change the remote control ID for both remote control and receiver. Registration successful: blinks twice Registration failed: blinks 6 times MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER m Numeric keys o CODE SET p SOURCE/RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 • If setup fails, repeat from step 1. • Returns to ID1 after the remote control code is initialized (☞p. 107). En 109 SETUP Extended functionality that can be configured as needed (Advanced Setup menu) Changing TV format Initializing various settings for this unit TVFORMAT-NTSC INIT- CANCEL Change the color encoding format of OSD to PAL or NTSC (default), to match the format used by the TV connected via the HDMI OUT 1-2 or VIDEO (MONITOR OUT) jack. Initializes various settings stored in this unit and sets it back to default. Select the items to be initialized from the following. Removing HDMI video output up-scaling limits MON.CHK-YES Removes the up-scaling limitation on video resolution when this unit and a TV are connected via HDMI jacks. If a resolution supported by the monitor cannot be detected when configuring the up-scaling settings, this setting will remove the output limitation. YES (Default) Video output signals of a resolution not supported by the TV will not be transmitted. SKIP This unit ignores the TV’s support capability and transmits input video signals to the TV. DSP PARAM Initializes all parameters for the sound programs. VIDEO Resets video conversion settings (resolution/aspect ratio) in the Setup menu. ALL Resets this unit to default factory settings. CANCEL (Default) Does not initialize. When an option other than CANCEL is selected, the applicable default settings will be restored when the unit switches to standby mode. En 110 SETUP Using the HDMI Control function This unit supports the HDMI Control function, which allows you to operate external components via HDMI. If devices that support HDMI Control (e.g., Panasonic VIERA Link-compatible TVs, DVD/Blu-ray Disc players, etc.) are connected J1, remote controls for those devices can be used to perform the following operations: – Power synchronization (on/standby) – Volume control, including Mute – Changing the volume of the audio output signal device (either the TV or this unit) 1 2 3 Connect the TV that supports the HDMI Control function to this unit’s HDMI output jack. 4 Set the TV and this unit’s HDMI Control function to “On.” 8 If DVD/BD player that supports the HDMI Control function are connected to this unit, turn them on. Connect the DVD recorder that supports the HDMI Control function to this unit’s HDMI input jack. This unit Confirm that the input source for the DVD/BD players has been selected. If a different input source has been selected, change it manually. Turn on the TV and this unit. TV and DVD/BD player Confirm that the video signal from the player is being properly received by the TV. Refer to the TV’s instruction manual on how to operate external components. Operations 1-8 will not be required more than twice. TV Control signal (such as volume control) This unit Confirm that “HDMI Control” is set to “On” (☞p. 98) and select the HDMI OUT jack connected to the TV in “Control Select” (☞p. 98). J2 TV and DVD/BD player Check the instruction manuals for those devices. HDMI connection HDMI Remote control of TV 5 Turn the TV off. 6 Turn the TV on. 7 Change the TV’s input setting to the input jack that is connected to this unit (e.g., HDMI1). This unit NOTE The following is an example of how to connect this unit, a TV, and a DVD/BD player. Follow the instructions in your TV and DVD/BD player manuals, as well as the ones written below. – Set the TV’s HDMI Control function to “On” – Follow the AV amplifier connection instructions, and connect this unit to the TV Other synchronized HDMI Control devices are turned off with the TV. If they are not synchronized, turn them off manually. 9 Confirm that this unit is properly synchronized with the TV through the following operations by using the TV remote control. • Power On/Off • Volume Control • Switching between audio output devices If this unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check that the HDMI Control function is set to “On” for both devices. If they will not properly synchronize, unplugging and replugging the devices and turning them on and off may solve the problem. Confirm that this unit has turned on in conjunction with the TV. If it is still off, turn it on manually. J 1 : We recommend that you use TVs and DVD/BD players from the same manufacturer whenever possible. J 2 : The default setting for the HDMI Control function is “Off.” En 111 SETUP MAIN Using the HDMI Control function ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 2 4 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO AV 1 DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM PRESET INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE TV CD j RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN To use other jacks to input audio signals from TV, carry out the following procedure. When the HDMI Control (☞p. 111) is operating properly, the input source of this unit is automatically changed to match operations carried out on the TV. When the TV is connected with HDMI OUT 1, the default input jack is AV4. If the AV4 optical digital jack is connected to the TV’s audio output jack, then you can enjoy TV sound through this unit right away. 1 2 Audio output (Optical) HDMI 1 DOCK HDMI OUT 1 (BD/DVD) SELECTABLE 5 Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select “HDMI” and press kENTER. Connect TV’s audio output to this unit. The input jacks listed below are available to input TV’s audio signals. Use the same jack type as used for the TV. HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND COMPONENT VIDEO AM VOLUME O k AV1 or AV4 (Default) Coaxial digital audio output AV2 or AV3 Analog stereo output AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, or AUDIO2 IN 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y DISPLAY Input jack R PR PR ENTER TV output jack Optical digital audio output ARC ANTENNA OPTICAL MONITOR OUT TR TV TOP MENU Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Setup” and press kENTER. Connect this unit and the TV with an HDMI cable. 2 ARC SIRIUS RETURN 4 STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD ■ Switching the input source on this unit automatically when listening to TV audio HDMI POP-UP MENU MUTE Available input jacks O OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 OPTICAL (CD) AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURR MU REC HDMI 1 DOCK 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT INPUT HDMI 2 HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 2 ARC 2 (BD/DVD) HDMI OUT 1 1 SELECTABLE ARC SIRIUS When the TV is connected with HDMI OUT 2, the default input jack is AV1. If the AV1 optical digital jack is connected to the TV’s audio output jack, then you can enjoy TV sound through this unit right away. ANTENNA HD Radio COMPONENT VIDEO FM GND FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO AM CENTER SURRO REMOTE PR PR IN 75 OUT PB PB VIDEO VIDEO Y Y +12V MONITOR OUT 0.1A MAX. TRIGGER OUT Continues to the next page CENTER MUTE OPTICAL COAXIAL COAXIAL AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 (CD) j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER 3 OPTICAL ( TV ) AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV OUT FRONT AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 SURROUND SUR.BACK MULTI CH INPUT SUBWOOFER AUDIO OUT ZONE2 OUT FRONT SUR Press jON SCREEN. J1 J 1 : Refer to the “Setting various functions (Setup menu)” (☞p. 90) for details on the Setup menu. En 112 SETUP MAIN Using the HDMI Control function ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER 6 HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO Make sure that “HDMI Control” is “On” When “HDMI Control” is set to “Off,” press kENTER and kCursor B / C to set to “On.” AV Press kCursor C to select “Control Select” and press kENTER. DOCK HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET Use kCursor B / C to select the HDMI OUT jack connected to the TV. TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT j SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 7 8 9 10 11 k Press kCursor C to select “TV Audio Input” and press kENTER. ■ Single HDMI cable input to TV audio with Audio Return Channel function 3 Press kCursor B / C repeatedly to select “Setup” and press kENTER. 4 Press kCursor D / E repeatedly to select “HDMI” and press kENTER. When using a TV that supports HDMI functions and Audio Return Channel function, audio/video output from this unit to the TV or audio output from the TV to this unit can be transmitted through a single HDMI cable (Audio Return Channel function). Audio signals transmitted from the TV to this unit can be assigned to any input source. 1 Connect this unit and the TV with an HDMI cable. Use kCursor B / C to select the input jack connected in step 2. TV HDMI Press jON SCREEN when you have finished changing the settings. If the TV hereafter transmits audio output signals, this unit will automatically switch to the input source chosen in step 10. HDMI Video / Audio output TV audio output ENT HDMI INPUT HDMI 1 HDMI OUT 1 MUTE HDMI 2 ARC SELECTABLE HD Radio FM HDMI 4 ARC ANTENNA NT HDMI 3 (BD/DVD) 2 GND AM FRONT COMPONENT VIDEO Continues to the next page CENTER REMOTE PR IN 75 OUT PB j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C / D / E k ENTER VIDEO 2 VIDEO Press jON SCREEN. J1 J 1 : Refer to the “Setting various functions (Setup menu)” (☞p. 90) for details on the Setup menu. En 113 SETUP MAIN Using the HDMI Control function ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER HDMI 1 2 3 4 5 V-AUX 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] AUDIO 5 Make sure that “HDMI Control” is “On.” 6 7 8 9 Press kCursor C to select “Control Select” and press kENTER. 2 When “HDMI Control” is set to “Off,” press kENTER and kCursor B / C to set to “On.” AV HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT j SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO OPTION ON SCREEN VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU k Use kCursor B / C to select the HDMI OUT jack connected to the TV. Press kCursor C to select “TV Audio Input” and press kENTER. Use kCursor B / C to select the input source to which the HDMI audio signals will be assigned, and press kRETURN. MUTE REC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 ENT 10 Press kCursor C to select “ARC (Audio Return Channel)” and press kENTER. J1 11 Press kCursor C to select “On.” 12 Press jON SCREEN to close the Setup menu. The Audio Return Channel function will turn on. INPUT MUTE j ON SCREEN k Cursor B / C k ENTER k RETURN If the TV hereafter transmits audio output signals, this unit will automatically switch to the input source chosen in step 9. J 1 : While the Audio Return Channel function is on, the jack selected for the input source cannot be used. En 114 SETUP Using multi-zone configuration This unit allows you to configure a multi-zone audio system. The Zone2 feature allows you to set this unit to reproduce separate input sources in the main zone and the second zone (Zone2). You can control this unit from the second zone using the supplied remote control. From the ZONE2 OUT jacks ■ Using the external amplifier An amplifier located in the secondary zone can be connected to this unit as shown below. Amplifier Main zone Second zone (Zone2) Audio input HDMI 3 HDMI 4 HDMI 5 RS-232C AUDIO L SPEAKERS DVD player (etc.) EXTRA SP FRONT CENTER R SURROUND BACK/ SURROUND BI-AMP ZONE2/PRESENCE Remote control This unit Infrared signal emitter SINGLE Infrared signal receiver Amplifier NTER CENTER R WOOFER From the REMOTE OUT jack SINGLE L Second Zone (Zone2) AUDIO OUT ZONE2 OUT FRONT SURROUND SUR.BACK PRE OUT 1 SUBWOOFER 2 To the REMOTE IN jack Only analog signal can be sent to Zone2. If you want to output sound from Zone2, connect an external component to AV5-6, AUDIO1-2, or VIDEO AUX by analog connection. For example, if you want to output sound from an HDMI DVD player in Zone2, you must connect the component to this unit by both HDMI and analog connections. Connecting Zone2 You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-zone functions of this unit: • An infrared signal receiver in the second zone. • An infrared signal emitter in the main zone. This emitter transmits infrared signals from the remote control to a CD player or a DVD player, etc. in the main zone via the infrared signal receiver in the second zone. • An amplifier and speakers in the second zone. Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-zone configuration, we recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center about the Zone2 connections that best meet your requirements. To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT USE the Zone2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS. ■ Using the internal amplifier of this unit Connect the speakers in the second zone to the EXTRA SP jacks directly (☞p. 18). ■ Using REMOTE IN/OUT jacks for multi-zone components This unit is equipped with REMOTE IN and REMOTE OUT jacks. You can use these jacks to control this unit and other components from Zone2 (☞p. 30). Some Yamaha models can be directly connected to the REMOTE jacks of this unit. These models may not require an infrared signal emitter. Up to 6 Yamaha components can be connected as shown below. REMOTE IN Infrared signal receiver REMOTE OUT IN This unit REMOTE OUT Yamaha component En 115 SETUP MAIN ZONE 2 CODE SET SOURCE RECEIVER Using multi-zone configuration b q Controlling Zone2 Using the party mode The remote control can be used to select and control Zone2 devices. The available operations are as follows: Use this feature to play main zone sources in Zone2 simultaneously. This feature is useful when you want to play back main sources as background music in a home party, etc. When using the party mode, set “Party Mode Set” to “Enable” (☞p. 100). HDMI 1 2 3 5 V-AUX 1 4 AUDIO 2 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 MULTI DOCK TUNER SIRIUS [ A ] HDMI OUT CATEGORY FM AM INFO MEMORY MOVIE MUSIC SLEEP PARTY PRESET TUN./CH ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT PURE DIRECT SCENE BD DVD TV CD RADIO VOLUME ENTER RETURN DISPLAY TOP MENU POP-UP MENU MUTE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 10 MUTE b MAIN/ZONE2 d Input selector g SLEEP h PARTY q RECEIVER A h ■ Activating the Zone2 operation Set bMAIN/ZONE2 to ZONE2 before attempting to use the remote control to control Zone2 devices. Press hPARTY to turn on or off the party mode. “PARTY MODE ON” or “PARTY MODE OFF” appears on the front panel display or the TV screen. While this unit is in the party mode, the ZONE2 indicators turn on in the front panel display. Input audio signals are mixed down to 2ch Stereo and output at the analog ZONE2 OUT jacks. ■ Operating Zone2 To enable and disable the audio output to Zone2 Press qRECEIVER A. REC INPUT • Tuning into FM or AM when “TUNER” is selected as the input source of Zone2. • Tuning into SIRIUS Satellite Radio when “SIRIUS” is selected as the input source of Zone2. • Adjust the volume of Zone2 devices (when connected via g the built-in amplifier). mode OPTION ON SCREEN d • Selecting the input source of Zone2. To select an input source for Zone2 Press dInput selector. ENT To enable the sleep timer for Zone2 Automatically switch the Zone2 device to standby mode after a specified period of time has elapsed (sleep timer). Press gSLEEP repeatedly to specify a time for the sleep timer function. Sleep 120min. Sleep Off Sleep 90min. Sleep 30min. Sleep 60min. En 116 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below, or if the instructions below do not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. General Problem Cause Remedy See page The power will not turn on. The protection circuitry operated 3 times consecutively. As a safety precaution, when the protection circuitry operates 3 times consecutively, the capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair. — The unit enters standby mode soon after the power is turned on. The power cable is not completely inserted. Connect the power cable properly to an AC wall outlet. — (When this unit is turned back on and “CHECK SP WIRES!” is displayed.) The protection circuitry has been activated because this unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Make sure that all speaker cables between this unit and speakers are connected properly. 19 The internal microcomputer is hung-up due to an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or by a drop in power supply voltage. Disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet, wait about 30 seconds and then plug it in again. — The batteries in the remote control may have lost their charge. Replace all batteries. The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit, etc. This unit cannot be turned off or does not work properly. The unit enters standby mode. The sleep timer has turned off the unit. Problem Cause Remedy See page After display of a countdown on the front panel, the unit goes into standby mode. If you do not use take any action, the Auto Power Down function operates. Turn on the unit, and play the source again. — In the Setup menu “Auto Power Down” (“Function” → “Auto Power Down”), increase the time until switching to standby mode, or turn off the Auto Power Down function. 101 No sound. Incorrect input or output cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. 25 Speaker connections are not secure. Secure the connections. 19 The HDMI components connected to the unit do not support the HDCP copy protection standards. Connect HDMI components that support the HDCP copy protection standards. — The audio input into the device is set to playback through the TV. In the Setup menu, set the “Amp” of “Audio Output” (“HDMI” → “Audio Output” → “Amp”) to “On.” 99 No appropriate input source has been selected. Select an appropriate input source with Input selector. 41 7 — — The volume is turned down or muted. Turn up the volume. Check that the speaker with an impedance of at least 6 Ω. 18 Use an input source that has signals that can be reproduced on this unit. Check that the speaker wires are not touching each other, then turn the unit back on. — Signals that this unit cannot reproduce are being input from a source component, such as a CDROM. — Check that the speaker impedance settings are correct. Turn on the unit, and play the source again. — En 117 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Problem No picture. No sound is output from a specific speaker. See page Cause Remedy The video signal output from this unit is not supported by a monitor connected to this unit via the HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks. Displays the Advanced Setup menu and select “VIDEO” in “INIT” to reset the video parameters. 110 Displays the Advanced Setup menu and set “MON.CHK” to “YES.” 110 An appropriate video input is not selected on the TV. Select an appropriate video input on the TV. — The speaker is malfunctioning. Check the Speaker indicators on the front panel display. If the corresponding indicator lights up, connect another speaker and check if sound is output. If sound is not output, the unit may be malfunctioning. 10 The playback component or speakers are not connected properly. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. 19, 25 Output from that speaker is disabled. Check the Speaker indicators on the front panel display. If the corresponding indicator is turned off, try the following. 1) Change to a different input source. 2) With the selected sound program, sound is not output from that speaker. Select another sound program. 3) “None” may have been selected for that speaker on this unit. Display “Speaker” in the Setup menu, and set respective parameters to enable output from that speaker (“Speaker” → “Manual Setup” → “Configuration”). 10, 91 The volume of that speaker is set to the minimum in “Speaker” in the Setup menu. Display “Speaker” in the Setup menu and adjust the volume (“Speaker” → “Manual Setup” → “Level”). 93 (If hardly any sound comes from one channel) Speaker output balance is not set correctly. Balance the volume of each speaker from “Level” in the Setup menu (“Speaker” → “Manual Setup” → “Level”). 93 Sound may not be output from certain channels, depending on the input source or sound program. Try another sound program. 43 Problem Cause See page Remedy Only the center speaker outputs substantial sound. When a monaural source sound program is applied, for some surround decoders, sound from all channels is output from the center speaker. Try another sound program. 43 No sound is heard from the presence speakers. This unit is in straight decoding mode and a monaural source is being played back. Press STRAIGHT to exit straight decoding mode. 44 Sound may not be output from certain channels depending on input sources or sound programs. Try another sound program. 43 This unit is in straight decoding mode and a monaural source is being played back. Press STRAIGHT to exit straight decoding mode. 44 Sound may not be output from certain channels depending on input sources or sound programs. Try another sound program. 43 No sound is heard from the surround back speakers. “Extended Surround” in the OPTION menu is set to “OFF,” or an input signal does not contain a surround back flag with “Extended Surround” set to “Auto.” Set “Extended Surround” other than “OFF” or “Auto.” 53 No sound is heard from the subwoofer. A subwoofer is not connected, or it is inactive. Check that a subwoofer is connected correctly, and from the Setup menu “Subwoofer” (“Speaker” → “Manual Setup” → “Configuration” → “Subwoofer”), set the subwoofer to “Use.” 20, 93 The subwoofer is turned off. Turn the subwoofer power on. If the subwoofer includes an Auto Power Off function, then lower the Auto Power Off sensitivity settings. — No sound is heard from the surround speakers. The source does not contain LFE (☞p. 125) or low frequency signals. The right combination of audio / video jacks to connect cannot be found. Combine input connected to the external component video output with another input audio jack. — Display the Input menu for the connected video output, select “Audio In” and select the jack to use for audio input. En 80 118 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Problem Cause Remedy See page The audio input sources cannot be played in the desired digital audio signal format. The connected component is not set to output the desired digital audio signals. There is noise interference from digital or radio frequency equipment. This unit is too close to other digital or radio frequency equipment. Noise/hum noise is heard. Incorrect cable connection. Connect the audio cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. — A DTS-CD is being played back. 1) When only noise is output If a DTS bitstream signal is not properly input to this unit, only noise is output. Connect the playback component to this unit by digital connection and playback the DTS-CD. If the condition is not improved, the problem may results from the playback component. Consult the manufacturer of the playback component. 2) When noise is output during playback or skip operation Before playing back the DTS-CD, display the Input menu after selecting the input source and set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS.” — The component connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned on. When the component connected to the output jacks of this unit is not turned on, the sound may be distorted, or the volume may decreased due to the nature of AV receivers. Turn on all components connected to this unit. — “Max Volume” is set to a low value. Set it to a higher value. 95 The volume cannot be increased, or the sound is distorted. Set the playback component properly referring to its instruction manual. Move this unit further away from such equipment. HDMI™ — Problem — Cause See page Remedy The front panel display HDMI indicator is flashing. An error with the HDMI connection has occurred. Try re-inserting the HDMI cable. — Confirm that HDMI video that is not supported by the unit is not being input (Information menu → “Video information”). 104 No picture or sound. The number of components is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI components. — The connected HDMI component does not support high-bandwidth digital copyright protection (HDCP). Connect an HDMI component that supports HDCP. — The TV audio output is not connected to this unit, or the setting to match operations carried out on TV is not set. Connect the TV audio output to this unit, and then select the connected input source in “TV Audio Input” (Setup menu → HDMI → TV Audio Input). 98 (When using Audio Return Channel function) The Audio Return Channel function is not working. Make sure that your TV supports Audio Return Channel. Set the Audio Return Channel function to on (Setup menu → HDMI → ARC (Audio Return Channel)). 98 (When using HDMI Control function) TV sound is not output from this unit when operating the remote control of the TV. En 119 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Tuner (FM/AM) Problem FM Problem FM stereo reception is noisy. Cause You are too far from the station transmitter, or the input from the antenna is weak. Remedy See page Check the antenna connections. 32 Switch to monaural mode. 58 Replace the outdoor antenna with a more sensitive multi-element antenna. — There is distortion, and clear reception cannot be obtained even with a good FM antenna. There is multi-path interference. Adjust the antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. — The desired station cannot be tuned into with the automatic tuning method. You are in an area far from a station, or input from the antenna is weak. Replace the outdoor antenna with a more sensitive multi element antenna. — Use TUN./CH H / I to manually select the station. 56 “No Presets” is displayed. No preset stations are registered. Register stations you want to listen to as preset stations before operation. 56 “Wrong Station” is displayed. An invalid FM/AM frequency has been input. Input a frequency that can be received. — AM Problem Cause The desired station cannot be tuned into with the automatic tuning method. The signal is weak, or the antenna connections are loose. Automatic station preset does not work. Automatic station preset is not available for AM stations. Remedy See page Adjust the AM loop antenna orientation. 32 Use the manual tuning method. 56 Use manual station preset. 56 Cause See page Remedy Continuous crackling and hissing noises are heard. The supplied AM loop antenna is not connected. Connect the AM loop antenna correctly even if you use an outdoor antenna. 32 The noises may be caused by lightning, fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or other electrical equipment. It is difficult to completely eliminate noise, but it can be reduced by installing and properly grounding an outdoor AM antenna. 32 Buzzing and whining noises are heard. A TV set is being used nearby. Move this unit away from the TV set. — HD Radio™ Reception See page Problem Cause Remedy This unit cannot receive the HD Radio signals of the selected radio station. The radio station provides analog FM/AM radio service only. Select other radio stations that provides the HD Radio service. 60 The signal is too weak. Adjust the antenna position. — Use a high-quality FM/AM antenna. — Set “Audio Mode” to “Auto.” 63 “Audio Mode” in the Option menu is set to “Mono.” This unit cannot select other audio programs than the main program. The radio station provides one audio program only. — HD Radio information does not appear. The radio station does not provide the information. — There is no sound immediately after a station is received. After an HD Radio station is received, about 5 seconds passes before sound can be heard. — HD Radio information is not displayed properly. The hold function is enabled. Press HOLD to disable the hold function. En 62 120 APPENDIX Troubleshooting iTunes Tagging Problem Tag data cannot be transferred to your iPod when it is station in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-10). Status message Insufficient Data SIRIUS Satellite Radio™ Cause “YDS-10” does not support tag file transfer. Remedy Use “YDS-12” or “YDS-11” to transfer tag data from this unit to your iPod. See page — Problem SIRIUS Satellite Radio information is not displayed properly. Display Cause Tag data is not saved because of invalid data. Remedy The selected HD Radio program (or song being played) does not support the iTunes Tagging feature. See page — Cause The hold function is enabled. Cause See page Remedy Press HOLD to disable the hold function. 69 See page Remedy ANTENNA ERROR The antenna is not connected to the SiriusConnect tuner properly. Check the connection of the antenna and SiriusConnect tuner. 64 SIRIUS LOADING This unit is communicating with the SiriusConnect tuner. The message disappears normally within several tens of seconds. — CHECK SR TUNER The SiriusConnect tuner is not connected to the SIRIUS jack of this unit correctly. Check the connection of the SiriusConnect tuner and this unit. 64 The SiriusConnect tuner is not connected to the AC wall outlet. Connect the power cable of the SiriusConnect tuner to the AC wall outlet. — NOT SUPPORTED This unit does not support the connected SIRIUS Satellite Radio tuner. Connect the SiriusConnect tuner that this unit supports, — ACQUIRING The signal is too weak. Adjust the orientation of the antenna of the SiriusConnect tuner. Check the antenna reception level from the Antenna information on the front panel display, or the SIRIUS Information screen on the TV screen. UPDATING Tag Already Stored Tag data for the same content has been already saved. Tag Storage full Tag data cannot be stored because the internal memory of this unit is full. Station your iPod/iPhone in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12) connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit. — iPod full Tags cannot be stored Tag data cannot be stored on your iPod/iPhone because the HDD space of your iPod/iPhone is full. Delete unnecessary data from your iPod/ iPhone with iTunes to make room and try again. — Transferring Failed Tag data cannot be transferred to your iPod/iPhone. Check if the iPod/iPhone is stationed in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone (YDS-12) properly. — Storing Tag Tag data is being stored in the internal memory of this unit. — — Tag data is being transferred to your iPod/iPhone. — The SiriusConnect tuner is updating the channel list. Wait until the updating is complete. Transferring Tag data has been transferred to your iPod/iPhone. — The period of the subscription is end. Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to renew the subscription. — Tag(s)Sent The SiriusConnect tuner is updating the firmware. Wait until the updating is complete. — — F/W UPDATING En 68, 69 121 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Display CALL SIRIUS (CALL 888-539SIRIUS TO SUBSCRIBE) Cause The selected channel is not subscribed. SUB UPDATED The subscription information is updated. LOCK The parental lock function is enabled. INVALID The selected channel is currently out of service. Not Available The operation you made is not available. Remedy See page Contact SIRIUS Satellite Radio to subscribe the selected channel. URL: https://activate.siriusradio.com/ Phone: 1-888-539-SIRIUS (1-888-5397474) — Select another channel. 65 iPod™/iPhone™ Display Loading... Use Numeric keys to enter the 4-digit code, select OK and then press ENT. 70 Reset the SIRIUS Satellite Radio parental lock code to the factory default setting. 109 Select another channel. 65 Connect error Cause See page Remedy The unit is in the process of recognizing the connection with your iPod/iPhone. — The unit is in the middle of acquiring song lists from your iPod/iPhone. — There is a problem with the signal path from your iPod/iPhone to the unit. Turn off the unit and reconnect the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone to the DOCK jack of the unit. 71 Remove your iPod/iPhone from the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone and then place it back in the dock. 71 Connect an iPod/iPhone supported by the unit. — Unknown iPod The iPod/iPhone being used is not supported by the unit. iPod connected Your iPod/iPhone is properly placed in the Universal Dock for iPod/iPhone. — Your iPod/iPhone is properly placed in the Yamaha iPod wireless transmitter and connected with this unit via wireless transmission. 74 Your iPod/iPhone is removed from the Universal Dock for iPod/ iPhone. — Your iPod/iPhone is disconnected with this unit via wireless transmission. — Disconnected Unable to play The unit cannot playback the songs currently stored on your iPod/iPhone. Check that songs are currently stored on your iPod/iPhone. En — 122 APPENDIX Troubleshooting Bluetooth™ Display Searching... Remote control Cause Remedy See page The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver and the Bluetooth component are in the process of pairing. — The Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver and the Bluetooth component are in the process of establishing a connection. — Completed The pairing is completed. — Canceled The pairing is canceled. — BT connected The connection between the Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver and the Bluetooth component is established. — The Bluetooth component is disconnected from the Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver. — Disconnected Not found The Bluetooth component is not found. Pairing may not have been achieved. During pairing: – pairing must be performed on the Bluetooth component and this unit simultaneously. Check if the Bluetooth component is in pairing mode. During connecting: – check if the Bluetooth component is turned on. – check if the Bluetooth component is within 32 ft. (10 m) of the Yamaha Bluetooth wireless audio receiver. — Try pairing again. 76 Problem The remote control does not work or function properly. External components cannot be controlled using the remote control. Cause See page Remedy Wrong distance or angle. The remote control will function within a maximum range of 20 ft. (6 m), and no more than 30 degrees off-axis from the front panel. — Direct sunlight or lighting (from an inverter type of fluorescent lamp, strobe light, etc.) is striking the remote control sensor of this unit. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition this unit. — The batteries are weak. Replace all batteries. 7 The remote control ID of the remote control and this unit do not match. Match the remote control ID of this unit and the remote control. 106 The remote control code is not correctly set. Set the remote control code correctly using “Remote control code search” on the CDROM. — Try setting another code for the same manufacturer using “Remote control code search” on the CD-ROM. — If this unit does not work when you press Cursor B / C / D / E, do the following. When the key does not work during DVD disc menu operation: press the Input selector again. When there is no response with remote control operation of the OPTION menu/ Setup menu: press SOURCE/RECEIVER (it should glow orange) and try operating the remote control again. — — Even if the remote control code is correctly set, there are some models that do not respond to the remote control. En 123 APPENDIX Glossary Audio information Audio and video synchronization (Lipsync) Lip sync, an abbreviation for lip synchronization, is a technical term that involves both a problem, and the capability of maintaining audio and video signals synchronized during post-production and transmission. Whereas the audio and video latency requires complex end-user adjustment, HDMI version 1.3 incorporates an automatic audio and video syncing capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization automatically and accurately without user interaction. Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp) A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. One amplifier is connected to the woofer section of a loudspeaker while the other is connected to the combined mid and tweeter section. With this arrangement each amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range. This restricted range presents each amplifier with a much simpler job and each amplifier is less likely to influence the sound in some way. Dolby Digital Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3 front channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio channels. With an additional channel especially for bass effects, referred to as LFE (Low-Frequency Effect), the system has a total of 5.1channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and surround sound environments are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic range from maximum to minimum volumes that are reproduced by the 5 full-range channels, and the precise sound orientation generated using digital sound processing provides listeners with unprecedented excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment. Dolby Pro Logic II Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources. This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center channel, and 2 surround left and right channels, instead of only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic technology. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources, and “Game mode” for game sources. Dolby Pro Logic IIx DTS Digital Surround Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete multichannel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources (for 2-channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game sources. DTS Digital Surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of movies with a 5.1-channel digital sound track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the world. DTS, Inc. has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of DTS Digital Surround in your home. This system produces practically distortion-free 5.1-channel sound (technically, left, right and center channels, 2 surround channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1-channels). This unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1-channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel to the existing 5.1-channel format. Dolby Surround Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a surround channel for special sound effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs, as well as in many TV and cable broadcasts. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects and directionality. Dolby TrueHD Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 18.0 Mbps, Dolby TrueHD can carry up to 8 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Dolby TrueHD also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems and retains the metadata capability of Dolby Digital, allowing dialog normalization and dynamic range control. DTS 96/24 DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality for multichannel sound on DVD video, and is fully backward-compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz sampling rate. “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1channel sound with full-quality full-motion video for music programs and motion picture soundtracks on DVD video. DTS Express This is an audio format for next-generation optical discs such as Blu-ray discs. It uses optimized low bit rate signals for network streaming. In the case of a Blu-ray disc, this format is used with secondary audio, enabling you to enjoy the commentary of the movie producer via the Internet while playing the main program. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a high resolution audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers sound that is virtually indistinguishable from the original, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 6.0 Mbps for Blu-ray Disc, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround. DTS-HD Master Audio DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio technology developed for high-definition disc-based media including Blu-ray Disc. Selected as an optional audio standard for Blu-ray Disc, this technology delivers sound that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master, offering a high-definition home theater experience. Supporting bitrates up to 24.5 Mbps for Blu-ray Disc, DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to 7.1 discrete channels of 24-bit/96 kHz audio simultaneously. Supported by HDMI version 1.3 and designed for the optical disc players and AV receivers/amplifiers of the future, DTS-HD Master Audio also remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that incorporate DTS Digital Surround. En 124 APPENDIX Glossary DSD Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as Super Audio CDs. Using DSD, signals are stored as single bit values at a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while noise shaping and oversampling are used to reduce distortion, a common occurrence with very high quantization of audio signals. Due to the high sampling rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered by the PCM format used for normal audio CDs. The frequency is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This unit can transmit or receive DSD signals via the HDMI jack. LFE 0.1 channel This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals, and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is counted as 0.1, because it only enforces a low-frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5-channels in Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1-channel systems. Neo:6 Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the full-range channels with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. PCM (Linear PCM) Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for “Pulse Code Modulation,” the analog signal is encoded as pulses and then modulated for recording. Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is sampled per second is called the sampling frequency, while the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is determined based on the sampling rate, whereas the dynamic range representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number of quantized bits, the more accurately the sound level can be reproduced. Sound program information Video information CINEMA DSP Component video signal Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in a theater having many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that is heard. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, Yamaha CINEMA DSP uses Yamaha’s original DSP technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital, and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual experience of a movie theater in the listening room of your own home. With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the PB and PR signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. The component signal is also called the “color difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to output component signals. Compressed Music Enhancer The Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances your listening experience by regenerating the missing harmonics in compression artifacts. As a result, it compensates for flattened complexity due to the loss of high-frequency fidelity as well as lack of bass due to the loss of lowfrequency bass, providing improved performance for the overall sound system. Composite video signal With the composite video signal system, the video signal comprises the three basic elements of a video picture: color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite video jack on a video component transmits these three elements combined. Deep Color Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on headphones. Deep Color refers to the use of various color depths in displays, up from the 24-bit depths in previous versions of the HDMI specification. This extra bit depth allows HDTVs and other displays increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. The increased contrast ratio can represent many times more shades of gray between black and white. Additionally, Deep Color increases the number of available colors within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Virtual CINEMA DSP HDMI Yamaha has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP surround effects even without any surround speakers, by using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker system that does not include a center speaker. HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first industry supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video interface. Providing an interface between any sources (such as set-top boxes or AV receivers) and audio/video monitors (such as digital televisions), HDMI supports standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as multichannel digital audio using a single cable. HDMI transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and supports 8-channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to accommodate future enhancements and requirements. When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure audio/video interface that meets the security requirements of content providers and system operators. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http:// www.hdmi.org/.” SILENT CINEMA CINEMA DSP 3D The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP 3D feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room. En 125 APPENDIX Glossary “x.v.Color” A color space standard supported by HDMI version 1.3. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB, and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and can thus produce more vivid, natural images. It is particularly effective for still pictures and computer graphics. Video conversion Analog-to-HDMI video conversion is performed according to resolution of video signals as shown below. Analog-to-analog video conversion is also possible when “Analog to Analog Conversion” is set to “On” (☞p. 96). ✓: HDMI output HDMI input COMPONENT VIDEO output Resolution 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i 1080p 480i/576i ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 480p/576p ✓ 480p/576p ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ VIDEO output 1080i 1080p 480i/576i ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 1080i ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ 720p 480i/576i 720p ✓ 1080p VIDEO input 480p/576p ✓ 1080i COMPONENT VIDEO input 480i/576i ✓ 720p 480i/576i available conversion ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ En 126 APPENDIX Information on HDMI™ ■ HDMI signal compatibility NOTES Audio signals Audio signal types Audio signal formats Compatible media 2ch Linear PCM 2ch, 32-192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio, etc. Multi-ch Linear PCM 8ch, 32-192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit DVD-Audio, Blu-ray Disc, HD DVD, etc. DSD 2/5.1ch, 2.8224 MHz, 1 bit SACD, etc. Bitstream Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video, etc. Bitstream (High definition audio) Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, DTS Express Blu-ray Disc, HD DVD, etc. • If the input source component can decode the bitstream audio signals of audio commentaries, you can playback the audio sources with the audio commentaries mixed down by using the digital audio input (optical or coaxial) connections. • Refer to the supplied instruction manuals of the input source component, and set the component appropriately. • When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video and audio signals may not be output, depending on the type of the DVD player. • This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI components. • Refer to the supplied instruction manuals for details. To decode audio bitstream signals on this unit, set the input source component appropriately so that the component outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream signals on the component). • This unit is not compatible with the audio commentary features (for example, the special audio contents downloaded via Internet) of Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD. This unit does not playback the audio commentaries of the Blu-ray Disc or HD DVD content. Video signals This unit is compatible with the video signals of the following resolutions: – – – – 480i/60 Hz 576i/50 Hz 480p/60 Hz 576p/50 Hz – 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz – 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz – 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz About trademarks Bluetooth™ Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG and is used by Yamaha in accordance with a license agreement. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent No’s: 5,451,942;5,956,674;5,974,380;5,978,762;6,226,616;6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD Master Audio are trademark of DTS, Inc. © 1996-2007 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. “HDMI,” the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks, or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. iPod™, iPhone™ “iPod” is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. “iPhone” is a trademark of Apple Inc. SIRIUS, XM and all related marks and logos are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. All rights reserved. Service not available in Alaska and Hawaii. HD Radio™ Technology Manufactured Under License From iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD Radio logo are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. En 127 APPENDIX Specifications ■ Input jacks ■ Remote jacks ■ TUNER • Analog audio Audio x 5 (AV5, AV6, AUDIO1, AUDIO2, V-AUX) MULTI CH INPUT x 1 (8ch Input) • Digital audio Optical x 2 (AV1, AV4) Coaxial x 2 (AV2, AV3) • Video Composite x 5 (AV3, AV4, AV5, AV6, V-AUX) Component x 2 (AV1, AV2) • HDMI input HDMI (Front Panel) x 1 (V-AUX) HDMI (Rear Panel) x 5 (HDMI 1-5) • Other DOCK x 1 (AUDIO, VIDEO [Composite]) • REMOTE IN x 1 • Analog Tuner FM/AM x 1 (TUNER) ■ Output jacks • Analog Audio Speaker out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R*1, EXTRA SP L/R*2) *1 Note: assignment is possible. [SURROUND BACK, BI-AMP (FRONT L/R)] *2 Note: assignment is possible. [ZONE2, PRESENCE] Pre Out x 7 [FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R] Subwoofer out x 2 (MONO, SUBWOOFER) AV OUT x 1 AUDIO OUT x 1 ZONE2 OUT x 1 • Video MONITOR OUT - Component x 1 - Composite x 1 AV OUT - Composite x 1 • HDMI Output HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1-2) • REMOTE OUT x 1 • TRIGGER OUT x 1 ■ HDMI • HDMI Specification: Deep Color, “x.v.Color,” Auto Lips Sync, ARC (Audio Return Channel), 3D • Video Format (Repeater Mode) - VGA - 480i/60 Hz - 576i/50 Hz - 480p/60 Hz - 576p/50 Hz - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 24 Hz • Analog up Conversion - 480i/60 Hz (NTSC) - 576i/50 Hz (PAL) - 480p/60 Hz - 576p/50 Hz - 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz - 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz • Up-Scaling - 480i → 480p/720p/1080i/1080p - 480p → 720p/1080i/1080p - 576i → 576p/720p/1080i/1080p - 576p → 720p/1080i/1080p • Audio Format - Dolby Digital - DTS - DSD 6ch - Dolby Digital Plus - Dolby TrueHD - DTS-HD - PCM 2ch-8ch (Max 192 kHz/24 bit) • Satellite Radio Ready [U.S.A. model] SIRIUS Radio x 1 (SIRIUS) • HD Radio tuner [U.S.A. model] HD Radio tuner with iTunes Tagging x1 (TUNER) ■ Compatible Decoding Formats • Decoding Format - Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus - DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution, DTS Express - Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital EX - DTS, DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 • Post Decoding Format - Dolby Pro Logic - Dolby Pro Logic II Music, Dolby Pro Logic II Movie, Dolby Pro Logic II Game - Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game - DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema ■ AUDIO SECTION • Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround (20-20 kHz, 0.08% THD, 8 Ω) FRONT L/R ................................................................... 95 W+95 W CENTER................................................................................... 95 W SURROUND L/R ..........................................................95 W+95 W SURROUND BACK L/R ..............................................95 W+95 W • Dynamic Power (IHF) Front Speakers 8/6/4/2 Ω...................................130/165/195/240 W • Dynamic Headroom 8 Ω ........................................................................................ 1.36 dB • Content Protection: HDCP compatible En 128 APPENDIX Specifications • Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance AV5, etc. ....................................................................200 mV/47 kΩ MULTI CH IN ...........................................................200 mV/47 kΩ ■ VIDEO SECTION ■ GENERAL • Video Signal Type...................................................................... NTSC • Power Supply............................................................ AC 120 V, 60 Hz • Maximum Input Voltage AV5, etc. (1 kHz 0.5% THD) ..................................... 2.3 V or more • Video Conversion...............................................................NTSC/PAL • Power Consumption .....................................................400 W/500 VA • Signal Level Composite ..................................................................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω Component ...................... 1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Y), 0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω (PB/PR) • Standby Power Consumption HDMI Control off / Standby Through off ....................0.2 W or less HDMI Control on/ Standby Through on (Input: HDMI1, when no HDMI signal is input) ... 2.7 W (typical) • Rated Output Voltage/Output Impedance AUDIO OUT ............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ PRE OUT......................................................................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ SUBWOOFER (2ch Stereo & Front: Small)................1.0 V/1.2 kΩ ZONE2 OUT ............................................................200 mV/1.2 kΩ • Headphone Jack Rated Output/Impedance AV5, etc. (1 kHz, 50 mV, 8 Ω) ..................................100 mV/560 Ω • Frequency Response AV5 to FRONT..................................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, +0/-3 dB • Total Harmonic Distortion AV5, etc. to FRONT (PURE DIRECT) (20-20 kHz, 50 W, 8 Ω) ............................................ 0.06% or less • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) [U.S.A. model] AV5, etc. (PURE DIRECT). Input Shorted (250 mV to Front Speakers)...................................100 dB or more [Other models] PHONO Input Shorted (5 mV to Front Speakers)......81 dB or more AV5, etc. (PURE DIRECT). Input Shorted (250 mV to Front Speakers)...................................100 dB or more • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Front Speakers ............................................................150 µV or less • Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off) .......1.5 Vp-p or more • Signal to Noise Ratio .................................................... 50 dB or more • Frequency Response [MONITOR OUT] Component (Video Conversion Off) ............ 5 Hz to 60 MHz, -3 dB ■ FM SECTION • Tuning Range......................................................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz • Dimensions (W x H x D) 435 x 171 x 367.5 mm (17-1/8 x 6-3/4 x 14-1/2 in) • Weight 11.2 kg (24.7 lbs) * Specifications are subject to change without notice. • 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity (IHF) Mono ...................................................................... 3.0 µV (20.8 dB) • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) [U.S.A. model] Mono/Stereo/HD ................................................ 74 dB/70 dB/80 dB [Other models] Mono/Stereo..................................................................74 dB/70 dB • Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz) [U.S.A. model] Mono/Stereo/HD .........................................................0.3/0.3/0.03% [Other models] Mono/Stereo........................................................................0.3/0.3% • Antenna Input (unbalanced)......................................................... 75 Ω • Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz) AV5, etc. (5.1 kΩ shorted)............................... 60 dB/45 dB or more ■ AM SECTION • Volume Control ...................................... MUTE / -80 dB to +16.5 dB • Tuning Range.............................................................530 to 1710 kHz • Tone Control (Front Speakers) Bass Boost/Cut ..............................................±6 dB/0.5 dB at 50 Hz Bass Turnover Frequency ...................................................... 350 Hz Treble Boost/Cut..........................................±6 dB/0.5 dB at 20 kHz Treble Turnover Frequency .................................................. 3.5 kHz • Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz) H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back)............. 12 dB/oct. L.P.F. (Subwoofer)............................................................ 24 dB/oct. En 129 APPENDIX Index Numerics 5 channel speaker layout .............................................................. 15 5.1-channel speaker layout........................................................... 15 7.1-channel speaker connection ................................................... 17 7.1-channel speaker layout........................................................... 14 A Adaptive DRC, OPTION menu ................................................... 53 Advanced Setup menu ............................................................... 108 All channel search mode .............................................................. 66 AM antenna connection ............................................................... 32 AM tuning.................................................................................... 56 Analog to Analog Conversion, Video Setup................................ 96 ARC (Audio Return Channel), HDMI Setup............................... 98 Aspect, Processing, Video Setup ................................................. 97 Audio information, Information menu....................................... 104 Audio Input, Input menu.............................................................. 80 AUDIO jack ................................................................................. 21 Audio Output, HDMI Setup......................................................... 99 Audio Return Channel function ................................................. 113 Auto Power Down, Function Setup ........................................... 101 Auto Preset................................................................................... 59 Auto Setup, Speaker Setup .......................................................... 91 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode, OPTION menu.................................. 53 CINEMA DSP indicator ............................................................. 10 Clear All Preset ..................................................................... 59, 70 Clear Preset ........................................................................... 59, 70 COAXIAL jack ........................................................................... 21 COMPONENT VIDEO jack....................................................... 21 Compressed Music Enhancer mode ............................................ 46 Configuration, Manual Setup, Speaker Setup ............................. 92 Connect, OPTION menu............................................................. 54 Connecting speakers.................................................................... 17 Connections................................................................................. 13 Content browse view................................................................... 55 Content window .......................................................................... 55 Control Select, HDMI Setup ....................................................... 98 Cursor indicators ......................................................................... 10 D BD player connection .................................................................. 25 Bi-amp connection, speaker......................................................... 18 Bluetooth™ component playback................................................ 76 Decode Type, Sound Program menu .................................... 88, 89 Decoder Mode, Input menu......................................................... 80 Dialogue Lift, OPTION menu..................................................... 53 Dimension, Sound Program menu .............................................. 89 Direct number access mode ........................................................ 66 Direct, Sound Program menu...................................................... 88 Disconnect, OPTION menu ........................................................ 54 Display Set, Function Setup...................................................... 101 Distance, Speaker Setup.............................................................. 93 DSP Level, Sound Program menu .............................................. 86 DVD player connection............................................................... 25 Dynamic Range, Sound Setup..................................................... 95 C E Cable plug .................................................................................... 21 Category search mode.................................................................. 66 Center Image, Sound Program menu ........................................... 89 Center Level, Sound Program menu ............................................ 88 Center speaker.............................................................................. 13 Center Width, Sound Program menu ........................................... 89 Changing speaker impedance ...................................................... 18 CINEMA DSP 3D mode.............................................................. 45 Enhancer, Input menu ................................................................. Extended Surround, OPTION menu ........................................... External component connection.................................................. External decoder connection ....................................................... B 80 53 21 29 F FM Mode..................................................................................... 58 FM tuning .................................................................................... 56 Front panel..................................................................................... 8 Front panel display ...................................................................... 10 Front Presence L Level, Sound Program menu........................... 88 Front Presence R Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 89 Front speaker ............................................................................... 13 Function Setup........................................................................... 100 G Game connection......................................................................... 29 H HD Radio™ reception................................................................. 60 HDMI Control function............................................................. 111 HDMI Control, HDMI Setup ...................................................... 98 HDMI indicator ........................................................................... 10 HDMI jack................................................................................... 21 HDMI monitor, Information menu............................................ 104 HDMI Setup ................................................................................ 97 High-frequency sound adjustment............................................... 42 I Information menu ...................................................................... 104 INIT, Advanced Setup menu..................................................... 110 Initial Delay, Sound Program menu ............................................ 86 Initial Volume, Sound Setup ....................................................... 96 Input menu................................................................................... 78 iPhone™ playback ...................................................................... 71 iPod Interlock, Input menu.......................................................... 81 iPod wireless system ................................................................... 74 iPod™ playback .......................................................................... 71 iTunes Tagging............................................................................ 61 J Jack.............................................................................................. 21 FM antenna connection ............................................................... 32 En 130 APPENDIX Index L Language.................................................................................... 103 Level, Speaker Setup ................................................................... 93 Lipsync, Sound Setup .................................................................. 95 Liveness, Sound Program menu .................................................. 87 Load, SCENE menu..................................................................... 83 Low-frequency sound adjustment................................................ 42 M Manual Preset............................................................................... 56 Manual Setup, Speaker Setup ...................................................... 91 Manual Tuning....................................................................... 58, 62 Max Volume, Sound Setup .......................................................... 95 Memory Guard, Function Setup ................................................ 103 Menu browse control ................................................................... 72 MON.CHK, Advanced Setup menu........................................... 110 Multi information display ............................................................ 10 Multi Zone ................................................................................. 100 Multi-format player connection ................................................... 29 Multi-zone function ................................................................... 115 MUTE indicator ........................................................................... 10 N Normal tuning .............................................................................. 56 Now playing view ........................................................................ 55 O ON SCREEN menu...................................................................... 49 On-screen display......................................................................... 12 OPTICAL jack ............................................................................. 21 OPTION menu ............................................................................. 51 P Pairing, OPTION menu ............................................................... 54 Panorama, Sound Program menu................................................. 89 Parametric EQ, Speaker Setup ..................................................... 94 Party Mode Set, Multi Zone....................................................... 100 PHONES jack ................................................................................ 8 Portable audio player connection................................................. 29 Power Amp Assign, Manual Setup, Speaker Setup .................... 91 PREOUT connection................................................................... 30 Presence speaker ......................................................................... 13 Presence speaker layout .............................................................. 14 Preset Select .......................................................................... 58, 62 Pure Direct mode......................................................................... 46 R Radio Control .............................................................................. 69 Rear panel...................................................................................... 9 Remote control ............................................................................ 11 Remote control battery installation ............................................... 7 Remote control connection ......................................................... 30 Remote control, Controlling other components ........................ 105 REMOTE ID, Advanced Setup menu ....................................... 109 Rename/Icon Select, Input menu ................................................ 79 Rename/Icon Select, SCENE menu ............................................ 84 Repeat, OPTION menu ............................................................... 54 Reset, SCENE menu ................................................................... 84 Resolution, Processing, Video Setup .......................................... 97 Reverb Delay, Sound Program menu.......................................... 87 Reverb Level, Sound Program menu .......................................... 88 Reverb Time, Sound Program menu........................................... 87 Room Size, Sound Program menu .............................................. 86 S Satellite Radio ............................................................................. 64 Save, SCENE menu .................................................................... 83 SCENE function.......................................................................... 43 SCENE menu .............................................................................. 82 Setup menu.................................................................................. 90 Shuffle, OPTION menu .............................................................. 54 SILENT CINEMA mode ............................................................ 45 Simple remote control ................................................................. 74 SIRIUS Satellite Radio ............................................................... 64 SiriusConnect™ tuner ................................................................. 64 Sound program ............................................................................ 43 Sound Program menu.................................................................. 85 Sound Setup ................................................................................ 95 SP IMP., Advanced Setup menu ............................................... 108 Speaker connection...................................................................... 13 Speaker indicators ....................................................................... 10 Speaker layout ............................................................................. 14 Speaker setting ............................................................................ 33 Speaker Setup .............................................................................. 91 SR PIN, Advanced Setup menu ................................................ 109 Standby Charge, Input menu ....................................................... 80 Standby Through, HDMI Setup .................................................. 99 Straight Decoding Mode ............................................................. 44 Subwoofer ................................................................................... 13 Supplied accessories...................................................................... 7 Surround Back Initial Delay, Sound Program menu................... 86 Surround Back L Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 88 Surround Back Liveness, Sound Program menu......................... 87 Surround Back R Level, Sound Program menu .......................... 88 Surround Back Room Size, Sound Program menu ..................... 86 Surround back speaker ................................................................ 13 Surround Initial Delay, Sound Program menu ............................ 86 Surround L Level, Sound Program menu.................................... 88 Surround Liveness, Sound Program menu .................................. 87 Surround R Level, Sound Program menu ................................... 88 Surround Room Size, Sound Program menu............................... 86 Surround speaker......................................................................... 13 T Test Tone, Speaker Setup............................................................ 94 Tone control ................................................................................ 42 Tone Control, OPTION menu ..................................................... 52 Trigger connection ...................................................................... 31 Trigger Output, Function Setup................................................. 102 Tuner indicator ............................................................................ 10 TV Audio Input, HDMI Setup .................................................... 98 TV FORMAT, Advanced Setup menu...................................... 110 TV monitor connection ............................................................... 22 V VIDEO AUX input cover.............................................................. 7 Video information, Information menu ...................................... 104 VIDEO jack................................................................................. 21 Video Out, Input menu................................................................ 81 En 131 APPENDIX Index Video Setup.................................................................................. 96 Virtual CINEMA DSP 3D mode ................................................. 45 Virtual CINEMA DSP mode ....................................................... 45 VOLUME ...................................................................................... 8 VOLUME indicator ..................................................................... 10 Volume Trim, OPTION menu ..................................................... 54 Y YPAO........................................................................................... 33 Z Zone2 Set, Multi Zone ............................................................... 100 En 132 © 2010 Yamaha Corporation YC710A0/OMEN1 List of remote control codes Lista de códigos de mando a distancia Liste des codes de commande Lijst met afstandsbedieningscodes Liste der Fernbedienungscodes Lista över fjärrstyrningskoder Elenco dei codici di telecomando TV A.R. Systems Acme Acura ADC Admiral 0320 0342 0323, 0343 0337 0054, 0178, 0336, 0337, 0339, 0346, 0347 Advent 0158 Adventura 0057 Adyson 0277, 0282, 0342 Agashi 0277, 0282 Agazi 0337 Aiko 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0343 Aim 0320 Aiwa 0078, 0379 Akai 0050, 0055, 0109, 0159, 0181, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343, 0349, 0350 Akiba 0320, 0340 Akura 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340 Alaron 0277 Alba 0161, 0277, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0349, 0351, 0372, 0382 Albatron 0140 Alcyon 0171 Alleron 0059 Allorgan 0282 Allstar 0320, 0350 America Action 0179 AMOi 0276 Amplivision 0161, 0282, 0321, 0342 Amstrad 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340, 0343 Amtron 0058 Anam 0179, 0343 Anam National 0052, 0058 Anglo 0323, 0343 Anitech 0171, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0343 Ansonic 0161, 0168, 0320, 0323, 0341, 0343 AOC 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053 Apex 0039, 0111, 0217 Arcam 0277, 0282 Arcam Delta 0342 Aristona 0320, 0349, 0350 Arthur Martin 0321 ASA 0339, 0347 Asberg 0171, 0320, 0350 Astra 0343 Asuka 0277, 0282, 0337, 0340, 0342 Atlantic 0277, 0320, 0342, 0349, 0350 Atori 0323, 0343 Auchan 0321 Audiosonic 0161, 0282, 0320, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350 AudioTon 0161, 0282, 0342 Audiovox 0058, 0179, 0194 Ausind 0171 Autovox 0171, 0282, 0337, 0339, 0342 Aventura 0051 Awa 0277, 0282 Axion Baird Bang & Olufsen Basic Line 0156 0282 0180, 0339 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343, 0350 Bastide 0282, 0342 Baur 0320, 0349 Bazin 0282 Beko 0161, 0269, 0294, 0302, 0311, 0320, 0328, 0351 Belcor 0008 Bell & Howell 0019, 0054 Benq 0097, 0242, 0361 Beon 0320, 0349, 0350 Best 0161 Bestar 0161, 0320, 0350 Binatone 0282, 0342 Blue Sky 0320, 0340 Blue Star 0348 Boots 0282, 0342 BPL 0320, 0348 Bradford 0058, 0179 Brandt 0322, 0345 Brillian 0182 Brinkmann 0320 Brionvega 0320, 0339, 0349, 0350 Britannia 0277, 0282, 0342 Brockwood 0008 Broksonic 0109, 0179 Bruns 0339 BTC 0340 Bush 0269, 0282, 0283, 0304, 0320, 0323, 0328, 0332, 0340, 0343, 0344, 0346, 0348, 0349, 0350, 0372, 0382, 0463, 0470, 0472 Candle 0008, 0026, 0050, 0057 Capsonic 0337 Carena 0320 Carnivale 0050 Carrefour 0344 Carver 0010 Cascade 0320, 0323, 0343 Casio 0367 Cathay 0320, 0349, 0350 CCE 0183, 0282 Celebrity 0055, 0107 Celera 0039 Centurion 0320, 0349, 0350 Century 0339 CGE 0161, 0171 Changhong 0039 Chimei 0273 Cimline 0323, 0343 Citizen 0007, 0008, 0026, 0050, 0058 City 0323, 0343 Clarion 0179 Clarivox 0349 Clatronic 0161, 0171, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0350, 0351 CMS 0277 CMS Hightec 0282 Coby 0197 Colortyme 0008, 0026 Commercial Solutions 0021 Concerto 0008, 0026 Concorde 0323, 0343 Condor 0161, 0277, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0350, 0351 Contec 0179, 0277, 0323, 0342, 0343, 0344 Contec/Cony 0012, 0058 Continental Edison 0345 Cosmel 0323, 0343 Craig 0058, 0179 Crosley 0010, 0037, 0171, 0339 Crown 0058, 0161, 0171, 0179, 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349, 0350, 0351 CS Electronics 0277, 0340, 0342 CTC Clatronic 0341 CTX 0205 Curtis Mathes 0007, 0008, 0010, 0019, 0021, 0026, 0049, 0050, 0178 CXC 0058, 0179 Cybertron 0340 Cytron 0152 Daewoo 0007, 0008, 0026, 0037, 0053, 0167, 0266, 0275, 0277, 0282, 0315, 0320, 0323, 0331, 0335, 0342, 0343, 0350, 0381, 0465 Dainichi 0277, 0340 Dansai 0277, 0282, 0320, 0337, 0349, 0350 Dantax 0161, 0349 Dawa 0320 Daytron 0007, 0008, 0026, 0323, 0343 De Graaf 0346 Decca 0282, 0320, 0342, 0349, 0350 Dell 0145, 0245 Denver 0358, 0362 Desmet 0320, 0349, 0350 Diamant 0320 Diamond 0277 DiamondVision 0135, 0143 Dimensia 0049 Disney 0219 Dixi 0282, 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349, 0350 Dream Vision 0461, 0498 DTS 0323, 0343 Dual 0282, 0320, 0342 Dual-Tec 0342, 0343 Dumont 0008, 0030, 0062, 0282, 0339, 0341, 0342 Durabrand 0031, 0051, 0179, 0215 Dux 0349 Dwin 0178 Dynatron 0320, 0349, 0350 Dynex 0228, 0231 Elbe 0161, 0168, 0282, 0320 Elcit 0339 Electa 0348 ELECTRO TECH 0343 Electroband 0055, 0107 Electrograph 0176 Electrohome 0008, 0026, 0052, 0055 Element 0230 -1- Elin Elite Elman Elta Emerson Emprex Envision Epson Erres ESA ESC Etron Eurofeel Euro-Feel Euroline Euroman Euromann Europhon Expert Exquisit Fenner Ferguson Fidelity Filsai Finlandia Finlux FIRST LINE Firstline Fisher Flint Formenti Formenti/Phoenix Fortress Fraba Friac Frontech Fujitsu Fujitsu General Fujitsu Siemens Funai Futuretech Galaxi Galaxis Gateway GBC GE Geant Casino GEC Geloso General Technic 0277, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0349, 0350 0320, 0340, 0350 0341 0277, 0323, 0343 0000, 0007, 0008, 0012, 0013, 0019, 0026, 0031, 0037, 0051, 0058, 0059, 0161, 0179, 0320, 0339 0154 0008, 0026, 0050 0155, 0206, 0359 0320, 0349, 0350 0051 0282 0343 0282 0337 0349 0161, 0277, 0282 0320, 0337, 0342, 0350 0277, 0282, 0320, 0341, 0342, 0350 0321 0320 0323, 0343 0322, 0345, 0349 0277, 0320, 0342, 0346 0282 0346 0171, 0282, 0320, 0339, 0341, 0342, 0349, 0350 0342, 0343, 0350 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323 0019, 0161, 0282, 0339, 0342, 0344, 0351 0320, 0350 0171, 0277, 0336, 0339, 0342, 0349 0277 0336, 0339 0161, 0320 0161 0282, 0323, 0337, 0343, 0346, 0347 0059, 0069, 0074, 0075, 0282 0282 0504, 0505, 0507, 0510, 0511 0051, 0058, 0059, 0112, 0113, 0115, 0118, 0119, 0179, 0337 0058, 0179 0320, 0351 0161, 0320 0176, 0177, 0241 0323, 0343, 0344 0008, 0021, 0023, 0026, 0027, 0031, 0034, 0049, 0052, 0056, 0209 0321 0282, 0320, 0342, 0347, 0349, 0350 0323, 0343, 0346 0323, 0343 Genexxa 0320, 0340, 0347, 0350 GFM 0128, 0227 Giant 0282 Gibralter 0008, 0030, 0050, 0062 GoldHand 0277 Goldline 0320 GoldStar 0007, 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031, 0050, 0053, 0161, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0343, 0346, 0349, 0350 Goodmans 0246, 0272, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0343, 0344, 0349, 0350, 0462, 0473, 0477 Gorenje 0161, 0351 GPM 0340 GPX 0129 Gradiente 0240 Graetz 0347 Granada 0171, 0282, 0320, 0321, 0342, 0344, 0346, 0349, 0350 Grandin 0340, 0343, 0348, 0349 Gronic 0282 Grundig 0160, 0161, 0171, 0310, 0320 Grunpy 0058, 0059, 0179 Haier 0157, 0233 Halifax 0277, 0282, 0337, 0342 Hallmark 0008, 0026, 0031 Hampton 0277, 0282, 0342 Hanseatic 0161, 0168, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0349, 0350 Hantarex 0320, 0323, 0343 Hantor 0320 Harman/Kardon 0010 Harvard 0058, 0179 Harwood 0320, 0323 Havermy 0178 HCM 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0342, 0343, 0348 Hema 0282, 0323 Hewlett Packard 0192 Higashi 0277 HiLine 0320 Hinari 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343, 0344, 0349, 0350 Hisawa 0321, 0340, 0348 Hisense 0247 Hitachi 0008, 0012, 0026, 0066, 0084, 0092, 0093, 0120, 0172, 0173, 0255, 0270, 0271, 0282, 0320, 0335, 0338, 0342, 0344, 0346, 0347, 0365, 0382, 0448, 0456, 0467 Hornyphon 0320, 0350 Hoshai 0340 Huanyu 0277, 0342 Hygashi 0277, 0282, 0342 Hyper 0277, 0282, 0323, 0342, 0343 Hypson 0282, 0320, 0321, 0337, 0342, 0348, 0349, 0350 Hyundai 0141 Iberia 0320 ICE 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0350 ICeS 0277 Ilo 0148, 0153 IMA 0058 Imperial 0161, 0171, 0320, 0347, 0350, 0351 Indiana 0320, 0349, 0350 Infinity InFocus 0010 0250, 0327, 0363, 0479, 0508 Ingelen 0347 Ingersol 0323, 0343 Initial 0153 Inno Hit 0171, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350 Innovation 0337, 0343 Insignia 0131, 0228, 0236, 0238 Inteq 0030 Interactive 0161 Interbuy 0323, 0343 Interfunk 0161, 0320, 0339, 0347, 0349, 0350 International 0277 Intervision 0161, 0282, 0320, 0337, 0341, 0342 Irradio 0171, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343, 0349, 0350 Isukai 0320, 0340 ITC 0282, 0342 ITS 0277, 0320, 0340, 0348, 0350 ITT 0343, 0347 ITV 0320, 0343, 0349 Janeil 0057 JBL 0010 JC Penney 0007, 0008, 0026, 0027, 0049, 0053, 0056 JCB 0055, 0107 Jensen 0008, 0026 JVC 0012, 0014, 0015, 0056, 0064, 0065, 0067, 0169, 0174, 0297, 0314, 0344, 0350, 0375 Kaisui 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0348 Kamosonic 0342 Kamp 0277, 0342 Kapsch 0347 Karcher 0161, 0320, 0342, 0343, 0349 Kawasho 0008, 0026, 0055, 0277 KEC 0179 Kendo 0161, 0320, 0341, 0346 Kenwood 0008, 0026, 0050 KIC 0282 Kingsley 0277, 0342 KLH 0039 Kloss Novabeam 0057, 0058 Kneissel 0161, 0168, 0320 Kolster 0320, 0350 Konka 0340 Korpel 0320, 0349, 0350 Korting 0161, 0339 Kosmos 0320 Koyoda 0343 KTV 0007, 0050, 0058, 0179, 0183, 0282, 0342 Kyoto 0277, 0282 Lasat 0161 Lenco 0323, 0343 Lenoir 0323, 0342, 0343 Leyco 0320, 0337, 0349, 0350 LG 0031, 0053, 0066, 0116, 0117, 0140, 0161, 0164, 0175, 0195, 0269, 0277, 0282, 0300, 0309, 0317, 0320, 0323, 0328, 0342, 0343, 0346, 0349, 0350, 0366, 0368, 0377, 0466, 0471, 0478 LG/GoldStar 0164 Liesenk 0349 Liesenkotter 0320 Life 0337, 0343 Lifetec 0320, 0323, 0337, 0343 Lloyds 0323 Loewe 0161, 0168, 0265, 0320, 0330, 0352 Loewe Opta 0339, 0349, 0350 Logik 0054 Luma 0320, 0323, 0346, 0349 Lumatron 0282, 0320, 0346, 0349, 0350 Lux May 0350 Luxman 0008, 0026 Luxor 0282, 0342, 0346 LXI 0010, 0019, 0021, 0026, 0027, 0031, 0049, 0111 M Electronic 0342, 0343, 0345, 0347, 0349, 0350 MAG 0096 Magnadyne 0339, 0341, 0349 Magnafon 0171, 0277, 0341, 0342 Magnavox 0008, 0009, 0010, 0013, 0026, 0032, 0033, 0048, 0050, 0128, 0211, 0212, 0224, 0226, 0239 Magnum 0337, 0343 Majestic 0054 Mandor 0337 Manesth 0282, 0320, 0337, 0342, 0349, 0350 Marantz 0008, 0010, 0026, 0050, 0204, 0320, 0349, 0350 Marelli 0339 Mark 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0349, 0350 Masuda 0282 Matsui 0282, 0320, 0323, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0346, 0349, 0350, 0455 Matsushita 0017 Maxent 0147, 0176 Mediator 0320, 0349, 0350 Medion 0320, 0337, 0343 Megapower 0140 Megatron 0026, 0031 MElectronic 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323 Melvox 0321 Memorex 0019, 0026, 0031, 0053, 0054, 0137, 0215, 0323, 0343 Memphis 0323, 0343 Mercury 0320, 0323 Metz 0339 MGA 0008, 0026, 0031, 0050, 0053 Micromaxx 0337, 0343 Microstar 0337, 0343 Midland 0007, 0021, 0023, 0027, 0030, 0056, 0062 Minerva 0171 Minoka 0320, 0350 Mintek 0153 Mitsubishi 0008, 0026, 0031, 0053, 0066, 0084, 0093, 0098, 0150, 0178, 0289, 0320, 0339, 0344, 0350, 0376 Mivar 0161, 0168, 0171, 0277, 0282, 0342 Monivision 0140 Montgomery Ward 0054 Motion 0171 Motorola 0052, 0178 MTC 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053, 0161, 0277 Multi System 0349 -2- Multitech Murphy NAD Naonis NEC Neckermann NEI Net-TV Neufunk New Tech New World NewTech Nicamagic Nikkai Nikko Nobliko Nokia Norcent Nordic Nordmende Nordvision Novatronic Oceanic Okano Olevia ONCEAS Onwa Opera Oppo Optimus Optoma Optonica Orbit Orion Orline Osaki Oso Otto Versand Pael Palladium Palsonic Panama Panasonic Panavision Pathe Cinema Pausa Penney Perdio Perfekt Philco Philharmonic Philips 0058, 0161, 0179, 0183, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0346, 0349 0277, 0342 0026, 0031, 0111 0346 0008, 0026, 0050, 0052, 0053, 0072, 0103, 0282, 0344 0161, 0282, 0320, 0339, 0342, 0346, 0349, 0350, 0351 0320, 0349, 0350 0176 0320, 0323 0343, 0350 0340 0282, 0320, 0323 0277, 0342 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340, 0342, 0349, 0350 0026, 0031, 0050 0171, 0277, 0341, 0342 0347 0201 0282 0339, 0345, 0347, 0350 0349 0320 0321, 0347 0161, 0320, 0351 0102, 0199, 0200, 0207, 0222 0342 0058, 0179 0320 0130 0017, 0019 0144 0178 0320, 0350 0043, 0146, 0283, 0320, 0323, 0328, 0343, 0349, 0350 0320 0282, 0320, 0337, 0340, 0342 0340 0282, 0320, 0336, 0342, 0344, 0348, 0349, 0350 0277, 0342 0161, 0282, 0320, 0342, 0351 0282 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0342, 0343 0016, 0017, 0020, 0022, 0023, 0035, 0052, 0056, 0084, 0085, 0133, 0163, 0193, 0284, 0286, 0290, 0292, 0320, 0325, 0347, 0356 0320 0161, 0168, 0277, 0321, 0342 0323, 0343 0021, 0023, 0031, 0050, 0111 0277, 0320 0320 0008, 0009, 0010, 0012, 0026, 0050, 0052, 0053, 0161, 0171, 0320, 0339 0282, 0342 0008, 0009, 0010, 0011, 0012, 0032, 0048, 0049, 0052, 0122, 0128, 0134, 0186, 0187, 0213, 0221, 0224, 0226, 0239, 0256, 0257, 0259, 0261, 0263, 0267, 0280, 0281, 0287, 0296, 0299, 0301, 0303, 0305, 0313, 0319, 0320, 0324, 0333, 0339, 0342, 0349, 0350, 0353, 0357, 0360, 0380, 0383, 0452, 0459, 0460 Philips Magnavox 0011, 0032, 0033 Phoenix 0161, 0277, 0320, 0339, 0349, 0350 Phonola 0277, 0320, 0339, 0349, 0350 Pilot 0007, 0008, 0050 Pioneer 0008, 0026, 0094, 0095, 0161, 0320, 0345, 0347, 0349, 0350, 0458 Plantron 0320, 0323, 0337, 0350 Playsonic 0282 Polaroid 0039, 0142, 0202, 0234 Poppy 0323, 0343 Portland 0007, 0008, 0026, 0053 Prandoni-Prince 0171, 0346 Precision 0282, 0342 Prima 0157, 0243, 0323, 0343, 0347 Princeton 0140 Prism 0023, 0056 Profex 0323, 0343 Profi-Tronic 0320, 0350 Proline 0320, 0350 Proscan 0021, 0027, 0049 Prosonic 0161, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0342, 0349 Protech 0282, 0337, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350 Proton 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031 Protron 0196 PROVIEW 0096, 0246 Provision 0320, 0349 Pulsar 0008, 0030, 0062 Pye 0256, 0320, 0349, 0350, 0378 Pymi 0323, 0343 Quandra Vision 0321 Quasar 0017, 0023, 0052, 0056 Quelle 0282, 0320, 0337, 0342, 0349, 0350 Questa 0344 Radialva 0320 RadioShack 0019, 0021, 0031, 0050, 0179, 0320 RadioShack/Realistic 0007, 0008, 0012, 0026, 0049, 0058 Radiola 0282, 0320, 0349, 0350 Radiomarelli 0320, 0339 Radiotone 0161, 0320, 0323, 0350 Rank 0344 RCA 0008, 0021, 0024, 0025, 0026, 0027, 0042, 0049, 0052, 0053, 0063, 0136, 0225 Realistic 0019, 0031, 0050, 0179 Recor 0320 Redstar 0320 Reflex 0320 Revox 0161, 0320, 0349, 0350 Rex 0337, 0346, 0347 RFT 0161, 0168, 0339 Rhapsody 0277 R-Line 0320, 0349, 0350 Roadstar 0323, 0337, 0340, 0343 Robotron Rowa Royal Lux RTF Runco Saba 0339 0277, 0282 0161 0339 0030, 0050, 0062 0298, 0322, 0339, 0345, 0347 Saisho 0282, 0323, 0337, 0342, 0343 Salora 0346, 0347 Sambers 0171, 0341 Sampo 0007, 0008, 0026, 0050, 0176 Samsung 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007, 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031, 0036, 0050, 0053, 0076, 0077, 0079, 0114, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, 0139, 0161, 0183, 0185, 0190, 0191, 0258, 0264, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0334, 0337, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350, 0351, 0373, 0453, 0468 Sandra 0277, 0282, 0342 Sansui 0043, 0109, 0320, 0350 Sanyo 0008, 0019, 0068, 0070, 0071, 0099, 0161, 0168, 0223, 0237, 0277, 0282, 0288, 0295, 0323, 0342, 0344, 0369, 0469 SBR 0320, 0349 Sceptre 0235, 0244 Schaub Lorenz 0347 Schneider 0282, 0316, 0318, 0320, 0333, 0340, 0342, 0349, 0350, 0382 Scotch 0026, 0031 Scott 0008, 0012, 0026, 0031, 0058, 0059, 0149, 0179 Sears 0008, 0010, 0019, 0021, 0026, 0027, 0031, 0049, 0051, 0059, 0111 SEG 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0341, 0342, 0344, 0349, 0382 SEI 0320 SEI-Sinudyne 0339, 0341, 0347 Seleco 0344, 0346, 0347 Sencora 0323, 0343 Sentra 0323 Serino 0277 Sharp 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0007, 0008, 0012, 0026, 0060, 0088, 0089, 0091, 0138, 0165, 0170, 0178, 0198, 0229, 0262, 0278, 0279, 0291, 0308, 0312, 0336, 0344, 0354, 0370, 0449, 0450, 0451, 0464, 0474, 0476 Sheng Chia 0178 Shogun 0008 Siarem 0320, 0339, 0341 Sierra 0320, 0350 Siesta 0161 Signature 0054 Silva 0277 Silver 0344 Singer 0321, 0339, 0341 Sinudyne 0320, 0339, 0341, 0349 Skantic 0347 Solavox 0347 Sonitron 0161, 0282 Sonoko 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350 Sonolor 0321, 0347 Sontec 0161, 0320, 0349, 0350 Sony 0038, 0044, 0045, 0047, 0055, 0104, 0105, 0107, 0110, 0123, 0184, 0220, 0248, 0249, 0251, 0252, 0254, 0326, 0343, 0344, 0371, 0374, 0457, 0475 Sound & Vision 0340, 0341 Soundesign 0008, 0026, 0031, 0058, 0059, 0179 Soundwave 0320, 0349, 0350 Squareview 0051 SSS 0008, 0058, 0179 Standard 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0350 Starlite 0058, 0179, 0320, 0323, 0349 Stenway 0348 Stern 0346, 0347 Strato 0320, 0323 Stylandia 0282 Sunkai 0343 Sunstar 0320, 0323 Sunwood 0320, 0323, 0343, 0350 Superla 0277, 0282, 0342 Superscan 0013, 0178 SuperTech 0277, 0320, 0323 Supra 0323, 0343 Supre-Macy 0057 Supreme 0055, 0107 Susumu 0340 Sutron 0323, 0343 SVA 0151 Sydney 0277, 0282, 0342 Sylvania 0008, 0009, 0010, 0011, 0013, 0026, 0048, 0050, 0051, 0128, 0227, 0253 Symphonic 0051, 0058, 0062, 0128, 0179, 0215 Syntax 0199 Syntax-Brillian 0199 Sysline 0349 Sytong 0277 Tandy 0178, 0282, 0336, 0340, 0342, 0347 Tashiko 0277, 0282, 0342, 0344, 0346 Tatung 0052, 0177, 0282, 0320, 0342, 0349, 0350 TCM 0337, 0343 Teac 0282, 0320 Tec 0282, 0323, 0342, 0343 Technics 0017, 0023, 0056 TechniSat 0274, 0496, 0497, 0499 Techwood 0008, 0023, 0026, 0056 TEDELEX 0282 Teknika 0007, 0008, 0010, 0012, 0026, 0053, 0054, 0058, 0059, 0179 Teleavia 0345 Telecor 0282, 0320 Telefunken 0320, 0322, 0345, 0350 Telegazi 0320 Telemeister 0320 Telesonic 0320 Telestar 0320 Teletech 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349 Teleton 0282, 0342 Televideon 0277 Televiso 0321 Tensai 0282, 0320, 0323, 0340, 0343, 0350 -3- Tesmet Tevion Texet 0350 0337, 0343 0277, 0282, 0323, 0342 Thomson 0162, 0188, 0189, 0285, 0320, 0322, 0342, 0345, 0350 Thorn 0320, 0349 TMK 0008, 0026, 0031 TNCi 0030 Tokai 0282, 0320, 0350 Tokyo 0277, 0342 Tomashi 0348 Toshiba 0018, 0019, 0040, 0041, 0046, 0073, 0100, 0103, 0108, 0109, 0111, 0121, 0132, 0166, 0208, 0210, 0214, 0217, 0260, 0268, 0282, 0283, 0293, 0304, 0306, 0307, 0329, 0344, 0355, 0454 Totevision 0007 Towada 0282, 0347 Trakton 0282 Trans Continens 0282, 0320 Transtec 0277 Trident 0282 Triumph 0320 Uher 0161, 0171, 0320, 0347, 0350 Ultravox 0277, 0320, 0339, 0341, 0342 Unic Line 0320 United 0349 Universum 0161, 0171, 0282, 0320, 0337, 0349, 0350, 0351 Univox 0320 Vector Research 0050 Vestel 0282, 0320, 0346, 0347, 0349, 0350, 0351 Vexa 0320, 0323, 0343, 0349 Victor 0015, 0344, 0350 VIDEOLOGIC 0277 Videologique 0277, 0282, 0340, 0342 VideoSystem 0320, 0350 Videotechnic 0277, 0282 Vidikron 0010 Vidtech 0008, 0026, 0031, 0053 Viewsonic 0176, 0203, 0232, 0364 Viking 0057 Viore 0148 Visiola 0277, 0342 Vision 0282, 0320, 0350 Vizio 0008, 0177, 0218, 0242, 0500, 0501, 0502, 0503, 0506 Vortec 0320, 0349, 0350 Voxson 0171, 0320, 0339, 0346, 0347, 0350 Waltham 0282, 0320, 0342 Wards 0008, 0009, 0010, 0026, 0031, 0048, 0049, 0050, 0053, 0054, 0059 Watson 0320, 0349, 0350 Watt Radio 0277, 0341, 0342 Waycon 0111 Wega 0320, 0339, 0344 Wegavox 0323 Weltblick 0282, 0320, 0349, 0350 Westinghouse 0107, 0216, 0220 White Westinghouse 0037, 0090, 0277, 0320, 0341, 0342, 0349 Wincom 0101, 0106 Xrypton 0320 Yamaha Yamishi Yokan Yoko Yorx Zanussi Zenith 0008, 0026, 0050, 0053, 0080, 0081, 0082, 0083, 0086, 0087 0282, 0320 0320 0161, 0277, 0282, 0320, 0323, 0337, 0340, 0342, 0343, 0349, 0350 0340 0282, 0346 0008, 0028, 0029, 0030, 0031, 0054, 0061, 0062 VCR ABS Adventura Adyson Aiwa 1016 1069 1008 1024, 1026, 1027, 1069 Akai 1021, 1027 Akiba 1008, 1029 Akura 1008, 1027, 1029 Alba 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025, 1029, 1030 Alienware 1016 Ambassador 1030 American High 1068 Amstrad 1008, 1009, 1026 Anitech 1008, 1029 Apex 1088 ASA 1028, 1031 Asha 1070 Asuka 1008, 1026, 1028, 1029, 1031 Audio Dynamics 1064 Audiosonic 1009 Audiovox 1071 Baird 1009, 1025, 1026, 1027 Bang & Olufsen 1017 Basic Line 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025, 1029, 1030 Baur 1028 Beaumark 1070 Bell & Howell 1065 Bestar 1009, 1025, 1030 Black Panther Line 1009, 1025 Blaupunkt 1028 Bondstec 1008, 1030 Broksonic 1100 Bush 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025, 1029, 1049, 1051, 1063, 1217 Calix 1071 Candle 1070, 1071 Canon 1068 Cathay 1009 Catron 1030 CGE 1026, 1027 Cimline 1008, 1024, 1029 CineVision 1104 Citizen 1070, 1071 Clatronic 1008, 1030 Colortyme 1064 Condor 1009, 1025, 1030 Craig 1070, 1071 Crown 1008, 1009, 1025, 1029, 1030 Curtis Mathes 1064, 1068, 1070 Cybernex 1070 CyberPower 1016 Daewoo 1009, 1025, 1030, 1038, 1069, 1223 Dansai 1008, 1009, 1029 Dantax 1024 Daytron 1009, 1025 DBX 1064 De Graaf 1028 Decca 1026, 1027, 1028 Dell 1016 Denko 1008 DiamondVision 1096 DigiFusion 1014 DIRECTV 1019, 1105, 1110, 1111, 1113, 1116, 1122 Dish Network 1018 Dishpro 1018 Dual 1009, 1027, 1028 Dumont 1026, 1028 Durabrand 1114 Dynatech 1069 Echostar 1018 Elbe 1009 Elcatech 1008 Electrohome 1071 Electrophonic 1071 Elsay 1008 Elta 1008, 1009, 1029 Emerson 1008, 1020, 1068, 1069, 1071 ESC 1009, 1025 Etzuko 1008, 1029 Expressvu 1018 Ferguson 1027 Fidelity 1008, 1026 Finlandia 1028 Finlux 1026, 1027, 1028 Firstline 1008, 1024, 1029, 1031 Fisher 1065 Flint 1024 Formenti/Phoenix 1028 Frontech 1030 Fuji 1068 Fujitsu 1026 Funai 1026, 1069 Galaxy 1026 Garrard 1069 Gateway 1016 GBC 1029, 1030 GE 1068, 1070 GEC 1028 Geloso 1029 General 1030 General Technic 1024 GOI 1018 GoldHand 1008, 1029 Goldstar 1026, 1031, 1064, 1071 Goodmans 1008, 1009, 1025, 1026, 1029, 1030, 1031 Gradiente 1069 Graetz 1027 Granada 1028 Grandin 1008, 1009, 1025, 1026, 1029, 1030, 1031 Grundig 1028, 1029 Hanseatic 1009, 1028, 1031 Harley Davidson 1069 Harman/Kardon 1064 Harwood 1008 HCM 1008, 1029 Headquarter 1065 Hewlett Packard 1016 Hinari 1008, 1009, 1024, 1029 Hisawa 1024 Hitachi 1011, 1026, 1027, 1028, 1046, 1062 HNS 1110 Howard Computers 1016 HP 1016 HTS 1018 Hughes 1111, 1113, 1122 Hughes Network Systems 1110, 1116 Humax 1012, 1110, 1113 Hush 1016 Hypson 1008, 1009, 1024, 1029 iBUYPOWER 1016 Impego 1030 Imperial 1026 Inno Hit 1008, 1009, 1025, 1028, 1029, 1030 Innovation 1024 Instant Replay 1068 Interbuy 1008, 1031 Interfunk Intervision Irradio ITT ITV JC Penney 1028 1009, 1026 1008, 1029, 1031 1027 1009, 1025, 1031 1064, 1065, 1068, 1070, 1071 JCL 1068 JVC 1007, 1018, 1027, 1039, 1064, 1065, 1066, 1067, 1078, 1089, 1092, 1093, 1094, 1095, 1113, 1208, 1209, 1212, 1213, 1215, 1218 Kaisui 1008, 1029 Karcher 1028 Kendo 1008, 1024, 1025, 1030 Kenwood 1027, 1064, 1065 Kodak 1068, 1071 Korpel 1008, 1029 Kyoto 1008 Lenco 1025 Leyco 1008, 1029 LG 1010, 1026, 1031, 1047, 1054, 1056, 1071, 1103, 1221 Lifetec 1024 Linksys 1016 Lloyd's 1069 Loewe Opta 1028, 1031 Logik 1008, 1029 Lumatron 1009, 1025 Luxor 1008 LXI 1071 M Electronic 1026 Magnavox 1020, 1068, 1114, 1126 Magnin 1071 Manesth 1008, 1029 Marantz 1028, 1064, 1065, 1068 Mark 1009 Marta 1071 Matsui 1024, 1031 Matsushita 1068 Media Center PC 1016 Mediator 1028 Medion 1024 MEI 1068 Memorex 1023, 1026, 1031, 1065, 1068, 1069, 1070, 1071, 1098, 1114 Memphis 1008, 1029 MGN Technology 1070 Micromaxx 1024 Microsoft 1016 Microstar 1024 Migros 1026 Mind 1016 Mitsubishi 1026, 1028, 1079 Motorola 1068 MTC 1070 Multitech 1008, 1026, 1028, 1029, 1030, 1069, 1070 Murphy 1026 NEC 1027, 1064, 1065 Neckermann 1027, 1028 NEI 1028 Nesco 1008, 1029 Nikkai 1008, 1009, 1030 Nikko 1071 Niveus Media 1016 Noblex 1070 Nokia 1009, 1027 Nordmende 1027 Northgate 1016 Oceanic 1026, 1027 Okano 1008, 1009, 1024 Olympus 1068 Optimus 1071 Orion 1023, 1024, 1051, 1115, 1217 Orson 1026 Osaki 1008, 1026, 1029, 1031 -4- Otto Versand Palladium 1028 1008, 1027, 1029, 1031 Panasonic 1000, 1022, 1044, 1055, 1068, 1072, 1085, 1090, 1091, 1120, 1121, 1214 Pathe Marconi 1027 Perdio 1026 Philco 1008, 1068 Philips 1006, 1013, 1028, 1035, 1040, 1045, 1046, 1050, 1058, 1059, 1061, 1068, 1076, 1101, 1110, 1113, 1116, 1117, 1122, 1126, 1210, 1211 Philips Magnavox 1076 Phonola 1028 Pilot 1071 Pioneer 1028, 1036 Polaroid 1088, 1099 Portland 1009, 1025, 1030 Prinz 1026 Profex 1029 Proline 1026 Proscan 1019 Prosonic 1009, 1024 Pulsar 1114 Pye 1028, 1102 Quarter 1065 Quartz 1065 Quasar 1068 Quelle 1026, 1028 Radialva 1008 RadioShack 1071 RadioShack/Realistic 1065, 1068, 1069, 1070, 1071 Radiola 1028 Radix 1071 Randex 1071 RCA 1019, 1068, 1070, 1075, 1110, 1113, 1122, 1125 Realistic 1065, 1068, 1069, 1070, 1071 ReplayTV 1022, 1123 Rex 1027 RFT 1008, 1028, 1030 Ricavision 1016 Roadstar 1008, 1009, 1025, 1029, 1031 Royal 1008 Runco 1114 Saba 1027 Saisho 1024, 1029 Samsung 1002, 1034, 1041, 1043, 1057, 1060, 1070, 1084, 1110, 1116, 1122, 1124, 1220, 1222 Samurai 1008, 1030 Sanky 1114 Sansui 1023, 1027, 1106, 1115 Sanyo 1032, 1065, 1070 Saville 1009 SBR 1028 Schaub Lorenz 1026, 1027 Schneider 1008, 1009, 1024, 1025, 1026, 1028, 1029, 1030, 1031 Sears 1065, 1068, 1071 SEG 1008, 1009, 1029 SEI-Sinudyne 1028 Seleco 1027 Sentra 1008, 1030 Sentron 1008, 1029 Sharp 1003, 1033, 1077, 1107, 1127, 1219 Shintom 1008, 1029 Shivaki 1031 Shogun 1070 Siemens 1031 Silva 1031 Silver 1009 Singer 1068 Sinudyne Solavox Sonic Blue Sonneclair Sonoko Sontec Sony 1028 1030 1022, 1123 1008 1009, 1025 1031 1001, 1016, 1048, 1053, 1073, 1074, 1080, 1081, 1082, 1083, 1108, 1118, 1216 Stack 1016 Stack 9 1016 Standard 1009, 1025 Stern 1009 STS 1068 Sunkai 1024 Sunstar 1026 Suntronic 1026 Sunwood 1008, 1029 Superscan 1020 Sylvania 1020, 1068, 1069, 1102, 1126 Symphonic 1008, 1069, 1126 Systemax 1016 Tagar Systems 1016 Taisho 1024 Tandberg 1009 Tandy 1065 Tashiko 1026, 1071 Tatung 1026, 1027, 1028 TCM 1015, 1024, 1042 Teac 1009, 1069 Tec 1008, 1009, 1030 Technics 1068 Teknika 1068, 1069, 1071 Teleavia 1027 Telefunken 1027 Teletech 1008, 1009 Tenosal 1008, 1029 Tensai 1008, 1026, 1029, 1031 Tevion 1024 Thomson 1005, 1027 Thorn 1027 Tivo 1108, 1110, 1111, 1113, 1117, 1118, 1119, 1122 TMK 1070 Tokai 1008, 1029, 1031 Tonsai 1029 Toshiba 1004, 1016, 1027, 1028, 1037, 1049, 1052, 1086, 1087, 1097, 1109, 1112, 1194 Totevision 1070, 1071 Touch 1016 Towada 1008, 1029 Towika 1008, 1029 TVA 1030 Uher 1031 UltimateTV 1019 Ultravox 1009 Unitech 1070 United Quick Star 1009, 1025 Universum 1026, 1028, 1031 Vector Research 1064 Video Concepts 1064 Videon 1024 Videosonic 1070 Viewsonic 1016 Voodoo 1016 Wards 1068, 1069, 1070, 1071 Weltblick 1031 XR-1000 1068, 1069 Yamaha 1064, 1065 Yamishi 1008, 1029 Yokan 1008, 1029 Yoko 1008, 1029, 1030, 1031 Zenith 1114 ZT Group 1016 DVD 4Kus 2051 Accurian Advent AEG Airis Aiwa Akai 2142 2155, 2251 2362 2364 2322 2145, 2177, 2179, 2248 Akura 2356 Alba 2064, 2165, 2186, 2337, 2346 Alco 2149 Alize 2361 Allegro 2133 Amitech 2362 Amphion MediaWorks 2195 AMW 2195, 2363 Apex 2030, 2124, 2125, 2126, 2127, 2130, 2131 Apple 2241 Arrgo 2138 Asono 2364 Aspire 2152, 2222 Astar 2240 ATACOM 2364 Audiovox 2061, 2149 Avious 2367 Awa 2363 Axion 2249 Bang & Olufsen 2128 Baze 2367 BBK 2364 Bellagio 2363 Best Buy 2359 Blaupunkt 2131 Blue Parade 2157 Boghe 2382 Brainwave 2362 Brandt 2148, 2188 Broksonic 2145, 2146 Bush 2064, 2110, 2170, 2268, 2290, 2346, 2358, 2367, 2383 California Audio Labs 2151 Cambridge Audio 2354 CAT 2352, 2353 CAVS 2192 Centrum 2353 CGV 2354, 2362 Changhong 2140 Cinetec 2363 CineVision 2133, 2237 Clatronic 2358, 2367 Coby 2031, 2046, 2360 Conia 2383 Continental Edison 2363 Crown 2362 C-Tech 2355 Curtis Mathes 2139 CVG 2377 CyberHome 2022, 2098, 2138, 2187, 2336 Cytron 2244 Daenyx 2363 Daewoo 2001, 2133, 2276, 2298, 2330, 2362, 2363, 2377 Daewoo International 2363 Dalton 2357 Dansai 2362, 2381 Daytek 2184, 2195, 2363 Dayton 2363 DEC 2358 Decca 2362 Denon 2059, 2151, 2193, 2332 Denver 2356, 2358, 2360, 2370 Denzel 2380 Desay 2205 Diamond 2354, 2355 DiamondVision 2225, 2232 Disney 2010, 2028 DK Digital 2339 Dmtech 2176 Dual 2380 Durabrand 2136 DVX 2355 Easy Home 2359 Eclipse 2354 E-Dem 2364 Electrohome 2362 Elin 2362 Elta 2341, 2361, 2362 Emerson 2129, 2137, 2150 Enterprise 2129 Enzer 2380 Epson 2247 ESA 2137 Finlux 2354, 2362, 2367 Fintec 2377 Fisher 2134 Funai 2137 Gateway 2051 GE 2029, 2131, 2156 Gericom 2351 GFM 2226 Giec 2382 Global Solutions 2355 Global Sphere 2355 Go Video 2133, 2213 Goodmans 2165, 2280, 2291, 2358, 2371, 2376, 2382 GPX 2227 Gradiente 2151 Graetz 2380 Greenhill 2131 Grundig 2349 Grunkel 2362, 2366 GVG 2377 H&B 2358 H_her 2364 Haaz 2354, 2355 Haier 2254 Harman/Kardon 2047, 2135 HiMAX 2359 Hitachi 2062, 2090, 2115, 2274, 2282, 2316, 2359, 2380 Hiteker 2130 Home Tech Industries 2364 Hyundai 2366 Ilo 2245 Initial 2131, 2245 Innovation 2182 Insignia 2002, 2137, 2253 Integra 2157 Irradio 2053 iSymphony 2246 JBL 2135 JVC 2020, 2096, 2097, 2099, 2100, 2101, 2102, 2103, 2106, 2107, 2160, 2257, 2260, 2262, 2263, 2321, 2324, 2326, 2327, 2343, 2464, 2465, 2468, 2469, 2471 Jwin 2198 Kansai 2360 Kawasaki 2149 Kennex 2362 Kenwood 2041, 2151, 2348 KeyPlug 2362 Kiiro 2362 Kingavon 2358 Kiss 2380 KLH 2131, 2149 Koda 2358 Koss 2013, 2148, 2158 KXD 2359 Landel 2143 Lasonic 2132 Lawson 2355 Lecson 2381 Lenco 2358, 2362, 2367 Lenoxx 2136, 2153 -5- LG Life Lifetec Limit Liquid Video Liteon Loewe LogicLab Magnavox Magnex Majestic Marantz Marquant Matsui McIntosh Mecotek Medion Memorex MiCO Micromaxx Microsoft Microstar Minoka Minowa Mintek Mitsubishi Mizuda Monyka Mustek Mx Onda Mystral Naiko Nesa Neufunk Nevir Next Base Nexxtech NU-TEC Onkyo Oopla Oppo Optim Optimus Orava Orbit Orion Oritron P&B Pacific Panasonic Parasound peeKTON Philips Phonotrend Pioneer 2002, 2033, 2038, 2057, 2129, 2133, 2189, 2191, 2223, 2238, 2270, 2288, 2335, 2373, 2375 2182 2182 2355 2158 2043, 2051, 2142 2320 2355 2025, 2050, 2137, 2150, 2159, 2224, 2230, 2358 2367 2360 2328 2362 2148, 2378 2199 2362 2182 2028, 2145, 2234 2354, 2382 2182 2156 2182 2362 2367 2131, 2245 2003 2358, 2359 2380 2186 2354 2366 2362 2131 2380 2362 2143 2243 2383 2159, 2368 2051 2196, 2255 2381 2180 2358 2363 2073, 2110 2148, 2158 2358 2355 2011, 2024, 2034, 2042, 2058, 2062, 2066, 2067, 2093, 2116, 2117, 2118, 2119, 2120, 2121, 2122, 2123, 2151, 2159, 2164, 2166, 2167, 2172, 2173, 2175, 2209, 2214, 2275, 2277, 2278, 2281, 2282, 2283, 2301, 2374, 2470 2197 2364 2008, 2012, 2025, 2044, 2050, 2051, 2053, 2060, 2072, 2108, 2111, 2147, 2159, 2163, 2169, 2174, 2181, 2185, 2230, 2261, 2266, 2267, 2286, 2287, 2289, 2295, 2300, 2302, 2317, 2328, 2338, 2342, 2350, 2467 2367 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2035, 2092, 2094, 2095, 2109, 2157, 2180, 2190, 2212, 2269, 2272, 2299, 2304, 2305, 2306, 2307, 2308, 2309, 2310, 2311, 2344, 2345, 2347, 2379 Pointer 2362 Polaroid 2125, 2215, 2235 Portland 2362 Powerpoint 2363 Prima 2252 Proceed 2130 Proscan 2156 Prosonic 2360, 2377 Protron 2202 Provision 2358 Pye 2144 Qwestar 2148 Raite 2380 RCA 2021, 2029, 2104, 2105, 2131, 2149, 2156, 2157, 2229 RedStar 2356, 2360, 2362 Regent 2153 Reoc 2355 Rimax 2361 Rio 2133 Roadstar 2331, 2358 Ronin 2363 Rotel 2203 Rowa 2154, 2383 Rownsonic 2353 Saba 2148, 2188 Sabaki 2355 Saivod 2362 Sampo 2141 Samsung 2000, 2045, 2077, 2112, 2113, 2114, 2115, 2151, 2200, 2216, 2219, 2228, 2264, 2265, 2271, 2279, 2294, 2303, 2329, 2365 Sansui 2073, 2145, 2354, 2355, 2362 Sanyo 2134, 2145, 2217, 2292 ScanMagic 2186 Schaub Lorenz 2362 Schneider 2176 Scientific Labs 2355 Scott 2161, 2357 Seeltech 2364 SEG 2162, 2355, 2363, 2380 Sharp 2006, 2040, 2088, 2091, 2182, 2194, 2220, 2221, 2231, 2236, 2293, 2340 Shinsonic 2245 Sigmatek 2359, 2364 Silva 2356 Singer 2354, 2355 Skymaster 2325, 2355 Skyworth 2356 Slim Art 2362 SM Electronic 2355 Sonic Blue 2133 Sontech 2366 Sony 2004, 2005, 2007, 2009, 2014, 2015, 2023, 2026, 2027, 2052, 2068, 2069, 2070, 2071, 2074, 2075, 2084, 2085, 2087, 2168, 2171, 2208, 2210, 2211, 2258, 2273, 2284, 2285, 2312, 2313, 2314, 2315, 2318, 2319, 2466 Soundmaster 2355 Soundmax 2355 Spectra 2363 Spectroniq 2201 Standard 2355 Star Cluster 2355 Starmedia 2358, 2364 Sungale 2204 Sunkai 2362 Superscan 2150 Supervision 2355 Sylvania 2012, 2137, 2150, 2178, 2230, 2239 Symphonic 2108, 2230 Synn 2355 T.D.E. Systems 2366 Tatung 2001, 2362 TCM 2182, 2297 Teac 2149, 2333, 2355, 2383 Tec 2356 Technics 2151 Technika 2362, 2367 Telefunken 2353 Tensai 2362 Tevion 2182, 2355, 2357 Theta Digital 2157 Thomson 2183, 2188, 2334, 2372 Tokai 2356, 2380 Top Suxess 2364 Toshiba 2032, 2036, 2037, 2039, 2048, 2049, 2054, 2055, 2072, 2073, 2076, 2078, 2079, 2086, 2145, 2159, 2218, 2233, 2256, 2259, 2296, 2369 TRANScontinents 2363, 2367 Transonic 2367 Trio 2362 Trutech 2242 TruVision 2359 TSM 2364 Umax 2361 United 2367 Urban Concepts 2159 US Logic 2245 Venturer 2149 Viewmaster 2364 Vocopro 2206 VocoStar 2207 Waitec 2364 Welltech 2382 Westinghouse 2063, 2250 Wharfedale 2354, 2355 Woxter 2361, 2364 Xbox 2156, 2183 Xlogic 2355, 2362 XMS 2362 Xoro 2382 Yamada 2051, 2361, 2363 Yamaha 2056, 2064, 2065, 2080, 2081, 2082, 2083, 2089, 2118, 2151, 2323 Yamakawa 2363, 2380 Yukai 2186 Zenith 2002, 2129, 2133, 2159, 2223 Blu-ray Disc LG Panasonic Pioneer Samsung Sharp Sony Yamaha 2033 2011, 2209, 2214 2212 2045, 2113 2194, 2220, 2221 2075 2064, 2474 DVR Bush Hitachi Panasonic Philips Pioneer RCA Samsung Sharp Sony Toshiba Yamaha 2110 2090 2066, 2067, 2093, 2116, 2117, 2119, 2120, 2122, 2123 2108, 2111 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2092, 2094, 2095, 2109 2105 2113, 2219 2088, 2091 2084, 2085, 2087 2086 2089, 2118 DVD Recorder Aspire Astar Broksonic Go Video Hitachi Insignia Irradio JVC LG Liteon Panasonic Philips Pioneer Pye Samsung Sansui Sanyo Sony Sylvania Toshiba Yamaha 2222 2240 2146 2213 2062 2002 2053 2100, 2101, 2106, 2107 2033, 2057, 2223, 2238 2043 2011, 2034, 2058, 2062, 2116, 2117, 2119, 2120, 2121, 2123 2008, 2044, 2050, 2051, 2147 2017, 2035 2144 2000, 2112, 2216 2073 2217 2004, 2005, 2007, 2052, 2068, 2069, 2074, 2208, 2210, 2211 2239 2032, 2036, 2037, 2039, 2049, 2054, 2055, 2076 2056 Cable ABC 3002, 3003, 3017, 3066, 3067, 3086, 3093, 3119, 3122 ADB 3020 Adelphia 3081 Alcatel 3016 Americast 3124 Amstrad 3022, 3098 Antronix 3065, 3070 Archer 3070 Arcon 3098 AT&T 3095 Axis 3098 Bell South 3124 Cable Vision 3092 Cabletenna 3065 Cabletime 3104 Cableview 3087 Clearmaster 3127 ClearMax 3127 Clyde Cablevision 3105 Colour Voice 3068 Comcast 3084, 3088, 3117 Comcrypt 3107 Comtronics 3069 Contec 3074 Coolmax 3127 COX 3084 Cryptovision 3110 Director 3084 Eastern 3075 Everquest 3123 Fidelity 3098 Filmnet 3107 Filmnet Cablecrypt 3111 Filmnet Comcrypt 3111 Finlux 3097 Focus 3126 Foxtel 3022 France Telecom 3100, 3101 Freebox 3023 GC Electronics 3070 GE 3066, 3093 GEC 3105 Gemini 3072, 3123 General Instrument 3017, 3025, 3066, 3084, 3090, 3096, 3117 -6- Goldstar Gooding Grundig Hamlin Hirschmann Hitachi HomeChoice Humax ITT Nokia Jasco Jerrold 3120 3099 3098, 3099 3073, 3078 3097 3066 3106 3021, 3080, 3083 3097 3123 3017, 3018, 3025, 3066, 3072, 3084, 3090, 3096, 3119, 3123 JVC 3099 Kabel Deutschland 3024, 3027, 3121 Macab 3101 Magnavox 3079 Maspro 3099 Matsui 3099 MegaCable 3117 Memorex 3076, 3122 Minerva 3099 Mnet 3107 Motorola 3025, 3026, 3084, 3088, 3090, 3095, 3117 Movie Time 3077, 3109 Mr Zapp 3101 Multichoice 3107 Multitech 3127 NEC 3064 NET Brazil 3085 Nokia 3097 Noos 3101 NSC 3077 Oak 3074 Pace 3006, 3089, 3121 Palladium 3099 Panasonic 3112, 3118, 3122 Paragon 3122 Philips 3068, 3071, 3079, 3099, 3100, 3101, 3103 Pioneer 3001, 3006, 3094, 3098, 3114, 3116, 3120 Popular Mechanics 3126 Proscan 3066, 3093 Pulsar 3122 PVP Stereo Visual Matrix 3018 Quasar 3122 RadioShack 3123, 3127 RCA 3030, 3031, 3087, 3118 Realistic 3070 Recoton 3126 Regal 3078 Regency 3075 Rembrandt 3066 Runco 3122 Sagem 3101 Samsung 3069, 3089, 3114, 3120 SAT 3098 Scientific Atlanta 3000, 3001, 3002, 3003, 3006, 3028, 3029, 3081, 3086, 3089, 3094, 3095, 3108 Signal 3072, 3123 Signature 3066 Sony 3092, 3125 Sprucer 3118 Standard Component 3115 Starcom 3017, 3072, 3119, 3123 Stargate 3072, 3123 Starquest 3072, 3123 Supercable 3090 Supermax 3127 Tele+1 3107, 3111 Telepiu 3107 Thomson 3082, 3091 TIME WARNER 3084 Tocom Torx Toshiba Tristar Tudi Tusa TV86 Unika United Cable Universal Universum V2 Videoway View Star Viewmaster Vision Visiopass Vortex View Wittenberg Zenith Zentek 3067 3017 3122 3127 3102 3072, 3123 3077 3065, 3070 3018, 3119 3065, 3070 3097, 3099 3127 3019 3074, 3077, 3079 3127 3127 3097, 3100, 3101 3127 3098 3113, 3122, 3124 3126 Satellite AB Sat AccessHD ADB AGS Akai Alba 4216, 4217 4104 4220 4216 4053, 4055 4001, 4004, 4006, 4007, 4062, 4217 Aldes 4005, 4007, 4010 Allsat 4048, 4053, 4055 Allsonic 4005, 4008, 4024 Alltech 4217 Alpha 4053 Alpha Digital 4104 Alphastar 4077 Amitronica 4217 Amstrad 4011, 4035, 4217, 4218 Anglo 4217 Ankaro 4005, 4008, 4024, 4217 Anttron 4001, 4004 Apollo 4001 Armstrong 4011, 4053 Artec 4100 Asat 4053, 4055 ASLF 4217 Astacom 4216 Astra 4009, 4011, 4054, 4217, 4219 Astro 4004, 4008, 4010, 4015, 4024, 4213, 4218, 4219 AudioTon 4004, 4048 Aurora 4222 Austar 4222 Axiel 4216 Axis 4008, 4009, 4024, 4050 Best 4008, 4024 Blaupunkt 4015 Blue Sky 4217 Boca 4011, 4054, 4059, 4217 Boston 4216 Brain Wave 4013 Broadcast 4012 Broco 4217 BSkyB 4035, 4041 BT 4216 Bubu Sat 4217 Bush 4006, 4045 Cambridge 4218 Canal Satellite 4213 Canal+ 4213 CaptiveWorks 4099 Channel Master 4007, 4110 Chaparral 4075 CHEROKEE 4216 Chess 4212, 4217 CityCom 4006, 4215, 4219 Clatronic 4013 CNT 4010 Comag 4080, 4081, 4082, 4083, 4086 Commlink Comtech Condor Connexions Conrad 4005 4050 4008, 4024, 4219 4014, 4024 4024, 4215, 4218, 4219 Conrad Electronic 4217, 4219 Contec 4050 Coolsat 4096 Cosat 4048 Coship 4109 Crown 4011 Daeryung 4014 Daewoo 4057, 4217 DDC 4007 Delega 4007 Dew 4050 Diamond 4051 Digiality 4219 Digital Stream 4105 DIRECTV 4056, 4064, 4067, 4068, 4070, 4071, 4074, 4107, 4116, 4119, 4121, 4122, 4123, 4127, 4192, 4193, 4194, 4195, 4196, 4197, 4198, 4199, 4200, 4201, 4202, 4203, 4206, 4207, 4221 Discoverer 4212 Discovery 4216 Diseqc 4216 Dish Network 4018, 4065, 4089, 4092, 4094, 4095, 4117 Dishpro 4018, 4117 Distrisat 4053 Ditristrad 4048 DNT 4014, 4053, 4055 Drake 4072 DStv 4222 Dune 4024 Echostar 4014, 4018, 4065, 4089, 4117, 4217 Einhell 4001, 4005, 4011, 4217, 4218 Elap 4216, 4217 Elekta 4010 Elsat 4217 Elta 4001, 4008, 4024, 4048, 4053, 4055 Emanon 4001 Emme Esse 4008, 4024 Engel 4217 Ep Sat 4006 EURIEULT 4031 Eurodec 4052 Europa 4053, 4218, 4219 Europhon 4219 Eurosat 4011 Eurosky 4024, 4011, 4008, 4215, 4218, 4219 Eurostar 4011, 4215, 4219 Eutelsat 4217 Exator 4001, 4004 Expressvu 4117 Fenner 4024, 4212, 4217 Ferguson 4006, 4052, 4214 Fidelity 4218 Finlandia 4006 Finlux 4006 FinnSat 4050, 4052 Flair Mate 4217 Foxtel 4222 Freecom 4001, 4049, 4218 FTEmaximal 4024, 4217 Fuba 4024, 4001, 4008, 4014, 4015, 4055, 4215 Galaxis 4024, 4005, 4008, 4009, 4050, 4048, 4215, 4222 GE 4093, 4066, 4111, 4197 General Instrument 4073, 4019 GMI 4011 GOI 4117 Goldbox GoldStar Goodmans Goodmind Grandin Grothusen Grundig 4213 4049 4029, 4002, 4006 4111 4031 4001, 4049 4006, 4004, 4015, 4035, 4211, 4218, 4222 Hänsel & Gretel 4219 Hantor 4001, 4013 Hanuri 4010 Hauppauge 4044 Heliocom 4219 Helium 4219 Hinari 4007 Hirschmann 4024, 4015, 4210, 4218, 4219, 4216 Hisawa 4013 Hisense 4016 Hitachi 4114, 4006, 4199, 4203 Homecast 4087, 4084, 4085 Houston 4048 HTS 4117 Hughes 4064, 4068, 4194, 4192, 4196, 4202 Hughes Network Systems 4071 Humax 4097, 4025, 4030, 4060 Huth 4005, 4011, 4012, 4013, 4050, 4048, 4219, 4223 Hypson 4031 Ilo 4016 Imex 4031 Innovation 4008 Insignia 4107 Intertronic 4011 Intervision 4048, 4219 ITT Nokia 4006 Jerrold 4019 Johansson 4013 JOK 4216 JSR 4048 JVC 4089, 4065, 4117, 4029 Kamm 4217 Kathrein 4015, 4055, 4053, 4063, 4034, 4042, 4215, 4216, 4217 Kathrein Eurostar 4215 Klap 4216 Konig 4219 Kosmos 4049 KR 4004 Kreiselmeyer 4015 K-SAT 4217 Kyostar 4001 L&S Electronic 4024 Lasat 4024, 4010, 4008, 4054, 4215, 4212, 4219 Lasonic 4108 Lenco 4024, 4001, 4049, 4215, 4219, 4217 Leng 4013 Lennox 4048 Lenson 4218 Lexus 4053 LG 4103, 4107, 4049 Lifesat 4024, 4008, 4212, 4217 Lifetec 4008 Lorenzen 4219 Lorraine 4049 Lupus 4024, 4008 Luxor 4218 Lyonnaise 4052 Macab 4052 Magnavox 4127, 4101 Manata 4031, 4216, 4217 Manhattan 4006, 4010, 4048, 4216 Marantz 4055 Mascom 4010 Maspro 4006, 4217 Matsui 4216 -7- Max Mediabox Mediamarkt Mediasat Medion Medison Mega Memorex Metronic 4219 4213 4011 4009, 4213, 4218 4024, 4008, 4217 4217 4055, 4053 4127 4031, 4028, 4001, 4004, 4005, 4010, 4217 Metz 4015 Micro electronic 4218, 4219, 4217 Micro Technology 4217 MicroGem 4106 Micromaxx 4024, 4008 Microstar 4008 Microtec 4217 Minerva 4015 Mitsubishi 4006, 4015, 4202 Mitsumi 4054 Morgan's 4011, 4054, 4055, 4053, 4217 Motorola 4090, 4091, 4088, 4019 Multichoice 4222 Multitec 4212 Muratto 4049 Mysat 4217 Navex 4013 Neuhaus 4009, 4048, 4218, 4219, 4217 Neusat 4217 Next Level 4019 NextWave 4223 Nikko 4011, 4217 Nokia 4006, 4040 Nordmende 4001, 4006, 4007, 4010, 4052 Nova 4222 Novis 4013 Oceanic 4051 Octagon 4001, 4004, 4050 Okano 4011 Optex 4048 Optus 4213, 4222, 4223 Orbitech 4001, 4212, 4213, 4218 OSat 4004 Otto Versand 4015 Pace 4006, 4015, 4035, 4043, 4047, 4216 Pacific 4051 Packsat 4216 Palcom 4007 Palladium 4011, 4218 Palsat 4212, 4218 Panasat 4222 Panasonic 4121, 4126, 4124, 4006, 4035, 4036, 4221, 4198 Panda 4006, 4219 Pansat 4125 Patriot 4216 Paysat 4127 PCT 4110 Philco 4101 Philips 4071, 4068, 4127, 4006, 4055, 4053, 4061, 4033, 4213, 4216, 4196, 4202, 4203, 4201, 4206 Phoenix 4050 Phonotrend 4006, 4005, 4048 Pioneer 4046, 4213 Polsat 4052 Predki 4013 Premiere 4048, 4213 Priesner 4011 Primestar 4076 Profile 4216 Promax 4006 Prosat 4007, 4005 Proscan 4093, 4066, 4122, 4197 Protek 4051 Proton 4016 Provision 4010 Quadral Quelle Quiero RadioShack Radiola Radix Rainbow RCA Realistic Redpoint Redstar RFT Roadstar Roch Rover Saba Sabre Sagem Sakura Samsung SAT Sat Cruiser Sat Partner Sat Team Satcom Satec Satelco Satford Satmaster Satplus Schneider Schwaiger SCS Seemann SEG Seleco Servi Sat Siemens Silva Skantin Skardin 4024, 4007, 4005, 4008, 4216 4015, 4215, 4219 4052 4019 4055, 4053 4014, 4037 4004 4093, 4066, 4112, 4113, 4118, 4119, 4116, 4122, 4197, 4207 4078 4009 4024, 4008 4005, 4055, 4053 4217 4031 4024, 4217 4010, 4215, 4219, 4216 4006 4023, 4052 4050 4064, 4071, 4069, 4123, 4120, 4003, 4000, 4001, 4032, 4196, 4200 4007, 4218 4223 4001, 4004, 4010, 4013, 4049, 4218 4217 4012, 4219 4217 4024 4012 4012 4212 4008, 4212, 4216 4051, 4212, 4219 4215 4011, 4009, 4014 4024, 4001, 4008, 4013 4048 4031, 4217 4015 4049 4217 4009 Skinsat SKR Skymaster Skymax SkySat Skyvision SM Electronic Smart Sony SR Star Choice Starland Starring Start Trak Strong STS STVI Sumida Sunny Sound Sunsat Sunstar Supermax Tandberg Tandy Tantec TCM Techniland TechniSat Technology Technosat Technowelt Teco Telanor Telasat Telecom Telefunken Teleka Telemaster Telesat Telestar Televes Telewire Tempo Tevion 4218 4217 4017, 4022, 4005, 4212, 4217 4055, 4053 4212, 4218, 4219, 4217 4048 4212, 4217 4215, 4217 4067, 4070, 4213 4011, 4054 4019 4217 4013 4001 4024, 4001, 4004, 4008, 4049, 4222 4115 4031 4011 4024 4217 4024, 4011, 4054 4223 4052 4004 4006 4008 4012 4021, 4026, 4027, 4014, 4053, 4038, 4039, 4212, 4213, 4218 4222 4223 4219 4011, 4054 4007 4215, 4219 4217 4017, 4001, 4216 4004, 4011, 4014, 4218, 4219 4010 4219 4212, 4213, 4218 4006, 4218 4048 4223 4008, 4217 Thomson Thorens Thorn Tivax Tivo Tokai Tonna Toshiba Triad Triasat Triax Turnsat Tvonics Twinner UEC Uher UltimateTV Uniden Unisat Unitor Universum US Digital Variosat Vega Ventana Viewsat Visiosat Voom Vortec Welltech WeTeKom Wevasat Wewa Winersat Wisi Woorisat Worldsat Xrypton XSat Zehnder Zenith Zodiac © 2010 Yamaha Corporation 4020, 4006, 4052, 4058, 4208, 4215, 4213, 4219, 4216, 4217 4051 4006 4104 4196 4053 4006, 4012, 4048, 4218, 4217 4194, 4202, 4203 4049 4218 4015, 4215, 4218, 4217 4217 4214 4031, 4217 4222 4212 4070 4079, 4127 4011, 4050, 4053 4013 4015, 4215, 4219 4016 4015 4024 4055, 4053 4098 4013, 4048, 4216, 4217 4019 4001 4212 4212, 4218 4006 4006 4013 4006, 4014, 4015, 4218, 4219 4010 4216 4024 4217 4024, 4010, 4008, 4209, 4215 4102, 4107, 4195 4004 CD Yamaha 5082, 5095 CD Recorder Yamaha 5083 MD Yamaha 5080, 5081, 5086 Tape Yamaha 5084, 5087 Tuner Yamaha 5066, 5071, 5085, 5088, 5090, 5092, 5094 XM Yamaha 5091, 5093 SIRIUS Yamaha 5064, 5067 DOCK Yamaha 5068, 5089 NET Yamaha 5076, 5079 LD Yamaha 2080 Amplifier Yamaha 5019, 5020 YC513F0/RC -8-
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138
  • Page 139 139
  • Page 140 140
  • Page 141 141

Yamaha RX-A800 El manual del propietario

Categoría
Receptores AV
Tipo
El manual del propietario